Polycom Welding System 3725 77601 001H User Manual

6.2.4 | June 2013 | 3725-77601-001H  
Polycom® CMA® System  
Operations Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
1 Polycom® CMA® System Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1  
Polycom, Inc.  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
4 Polycom® CMA® System Conference Scheduling Overview . 39  
iv  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
Polycom, Inc.  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
vi  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
Polycom, Inc.  
vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
viii  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
Polycom, Inc.  
ix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
x
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
Polycom, Inc.  
xi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
xii  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
Polycom, Inc.  
xiii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
xiv  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
Polycom, Inc.  
xv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
xvi  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
Polycom, Inc.  
xvii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
xviii  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
Polycom, Inc.  
xix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1
Polycom® CMA® System Overview  
This chapter provides an overview of the Polycom® Converged Management  
Application™ (CMA®) system and includes these topics:  
Polycom CMA System Features and Capabilities  
The CMA system is an integrated scheduling and device management  
platform for video conferencing that can include these features:  
The Polycom CMA Desktop client for Windows and MAC operating  
systems—an easy-to-use video and audio conferencing application that  
lets your users see and hear the people they call on their desktop system.  
Automatic provisioning for dynamically-managed endpoint systems and  
scheduled provisioning for standardly-managed and legacy endpoints.  
Automatic softupdates for dynamically-managed endpoint systems and  
scheduled softupdates for standardly-managed and legacy endpoints.  
On-demand conferencing using embedded MCUs or external MCUs.  
Conference scheduling via the CMA system Web Scheduler or the  
optional Polycom Scheduling Plugins for Microsoft® Outlook® or IBM®  
Lotus® Notes.®  
Advanced routing to distribute audio and video calls across multiple  
conferencing platforms (MCUs), creating a single seamless resource pool.  
Firewall management capabilities which enable videoconferencing across  
firewalls.  
Gatekeeper as well as alternate and neighboring gatekeeper functionality.  
Polycom, Inc.  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Access to user and room directories for on-demand and scheduled calls.  
Directory services include:  
Presence and contact list functionality for dynamically-managed  
endpoints.  
Global Address Book for a single directory structure or Multiple  
Address Books for multiple managed directories.  
H.350 and LDAP directory functionality. H.350 defines a directory  
services architecture for multimedia conferencing for H.323, H.320,  
SIP and generic protocols.  
Device monitoring and management.  
Conference monitoring and management.  
An optional high-availability, redundant management server  
configuration.  
Polycom CMA System Models  
Polycom offers two CMA system models.  
The single microprocessor CMA 4000 system supports up to 400  
concurrently registered endpoints and 240 concurrent calls. Integration  
with a corporate directory and an external database is optional. The CMA  
4000 system is not available in redundant configurations or maximum  
security configurations.  
The dual microprocessor CMA 5000 system can support up to 5000  
concurrently registered endpoints and 3000 concurrent calls in direct  
mode and 1500 concurrent calls in routed mode. The CMA 5000 system is  
also available in an optional redundant configuration.  
Integration with a corporate directory is optional for CMA 5000 systems.  
Integration with an external database (Microsoft SQL Server) is required  
for redundant CMA 5000 systems or for CMA 5000 systems supporting  
more than 400 concurrently registered endpoints and 240 concurrent calls.  
Minimum System Requirements  
The Polycom CMA System Release Notes describe the minimum system  
requirements for your CMA system. To find the most current Release Notes, go  
to support.polycom.com and navigate to UC Infrastructure > Polycom  
Converged Management Application CMA 4000 & 5000.  
Any scheduled call that requires an external MCU requires a Polycom RMX™  
or Polycom MGCconferencing platform. For example, any conference with  
a dial-in participant requires an external MCU. And some features and  
2
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom® CMA® System Overview  
services, such as Conference on Demand also requires an RMX or MGC  
system. Not all conferencing features are supported on all RMX system. For  
more information about supported functionality, see the Polycom RMX System  
Release Notes for your conferencing platform.  
Working in the Polycom CMA System  
This section includes some general information you should know when  
working in the CMA system. It includes these topics:  
Log Into the Polycom CMA System  
To log into the CMA system web interface, you need:  
Microsoft Internet Explorer® 6.0, 7.0 or 8.0, Mozilla FireFox® 3.5 or 3.6, or  
Apple Safari 3.2, 4.0 or 5.0.  
If your system is operating in maximum security mode, you may use only  
Microsoft Internet Explorer.  
Adobe® Flash® Player 9.x or 10.x  
The IP address or host name of the CMA system server and your  
username, password, and domain.  
Note  
The CMA system user interface is best viewed with an SXGA display resolution of  
at least 1280x1024 pixels. The minimum support display resolution is XGA  
1024x768 pixels.  
Generally, you get three opportunities to enter the correct password. After  
three failed attempts, the system returns an error message.  
Polycom, Inc.  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
To log into a CMA system  
1
Open a browser window and in the Address field enter the CMA system  
IP address or host name.  
If prompted to install the Adobe Flash Player, click OK.  
If you receive an HTTPS Security Alert, click Yes.  
If you see a login banner, click Accept to accept the terms and  
continue.  
If you cannot connect to the system, there may be certificate issues.  
2
When the CMA system Log In screen appears, enter your Username and  
Password.  
3
4
If necessary, select a different Language or Domain.  
Click Login.  
If you log in as an administrator, you see the CMA system Dashboard.  
For more information about roles and the functionality associated with  
Field Input Requirements  
While every effort was made to internationalize the CMA system, not all  
system fields accept Unicode entries. If you work in a language other than  
English, be aware that some CMA system fields may accept only ASCII or  
extended ASCII characters.  
Filter and Search a List  
In the CMA system interface, information is often summarized in lists or grids.  
Lists that include many items may have filters or searchable fields, which  
allow you to view a subset of items or search for a specific entry. The available  
filtering options depend on the type of information in the list. For example in  
the conference list:  
If you select Custom Date as the filter, a calendar filter field appears.  
If you select Ongoing Plus as the filter, an attribute option appears. You  
can select the attribute Conference Name and enter all or part of the  
conference name into the associated text field.  
In general, most text filter fields are ASCII only and the CMA system search  
function is a case-insensitive, substring search. That means when you enter a  
search string, the CMA system looks for that string whereever it occurs  
(beginning, middle, or end) in the word or number.  
4
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom® CMA® System Overview  
However, if the CMA system is integrated with an Active Directory, the CMA  
system uses the LDAP search function for searches of the directory. LDAP  
searches are prefix-searches that include an appended wildcard. In this case,  
when you enter a search string, the system looks for that search string only at  
the beginning of the indexed fields.  
For example, all of the following searches for a participant will find Barbara  
Smithe:  
Barbara  
Smithe  
Bar  
Smi  
To optimize LDAP searches, the CMA system (and its dynamically-managed  
endpoints) searches only indexed LDAP fields and a limited set of attributes.  
The attributes include:  
ObjectCategory  
memberOf  
DisplayName  
GivenName  
Sn  
Cn  
Samaccountname  
groupType  
distinguishedName  
objectGuid  
These are the requested attributes to be returned by the search:  
Sn  
Givenname  
Mail  
Ou  
Objectguid  
Telephonenumber  
Cn  
Samaccountname  
Memberof  
Displayname  
Objectclass  
Title  
localityName  
department  
Change a Password  
For local users, CMA system password requirements (for example, password  
length and password age) are managed by the CMA system administrator. For  
enterprise users, CMA system password requirements are managed by  
Microsoft Active Directory.  
Polycom, Inc.  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
To change your system password  
1
2
3
4
5
Click Settings in the top-right corner of the page.  
In the Settings dialog box, click Change Password.  
Enter your Old Password.  
Enter a New Password.  
Confirm the new password and click OK.  
Log Out of the Polycom CMA System  
To log out of the CMA system  
Click Log Out in the top-right corner of the page.  
Restart or Shut Down a Polycom CMA System  
You have several options for an orderly shutdown or restart of a CMA system  
in non-emergency situations.  
The options for an orderly shutdown or restart of the system include:  
Use the Shutdown option on the user interface when you must disconnect  
the CMA system server for some reason; for example, to move it. All CMA  
system functionality is stopped during a Shutdown.  
If the system interface is not available and you must shut down the  
system, press once (but do not hold) the power switch on the CMA system  
server. This is equivalent to selecting the Shutdown option described  
previously.  
Use the Restart option on the user interface when you must cycle the CMA  
system for some reason; for example, if the system locks up or loses  
connection with the database.  
If you have access to the CMA system user interface, you can also stop future  
scheduled conferences from starting automatically and wait for active  
conferences to end before performing an orderly shut down or restart of the  
system.  
During a restart, the system will drop all IP conferences. In general, ISDN  
conferences will not drop. Also, endpoints registered to the gatekeeper will  
drop. IP endpoints not registered with the gatekeeper can continue in  
conference.  
6
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom® CMA® System Overview  
To restart or shut down a CMA system  
1
(Optional) To stop future scheduled conferences from starting before you  
perform the restart or shutdown:  
a
b
Go to Admin > Conference Settings.  
Check the Conference Auto-Launch Disabled check box and click  
Update.  
c
Go to Admin > Dashboard.  
d
Monitor the Today’s Conferences section to determine when all  
active conferences are completed.  
2
Go to Admin > Dashboard and click Restart  
required.  
or Shutdown  
, as  
In a redundant CMA system configuration, if you requested a shutdown  
of the primary server, the system displays a warning indicating that it is  
initiating a failover.  
If you select Restart, it may take the CMA system up to 10 minutes to  
shutdown and then restart all server processes.  
Emergency Shutdown of a Polycom CMA System  
You have two options to perform an emergency shutdown of a CMA system.  
Use these options only when you must immediately cut power to the server.  
Press and hold the power switch on the CMA system server.  
Pull the system power cord.  
After an emergency shutdown (that is when you press and hold the power  
switch, or you pull the system cord, or you lose power to the system), a system  
battery may continue to cache information until the battery runs out. In this  
case, the system enters an error state. To recover, you must connect a keyboard  
and monitor to the CMA system and boot the system to clear the error  
message. Then the system can begin recovery.  
Polycom, Inc.  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
8
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2
Polycom CMA System Configuration  
This chapter describes the configuration tasks that may be required, based on  
your system design and installation to complete your implementation of a  
Polycom® Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system after First  
Time Setup. It includes these topics:  
IMPORTANT  
If during First Time Setup, you enabled the Maximum Security option, please see  
how the system operates in this configuration.  
Add DNS SRV Record for Polycom CMA System Services  
You must configure the DNS server, if you wish it to resolve queries for the  
CMA system by the CMA system’s host name or IP address.  
We recommend that the DNS server be configured to find the CMA system by  
its fully qualified domain name (FQDN). This ensures that client systems  
running desktop Polycom CMA Desktop can access the CMA system.  
Polycom, Inc.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
The DNS should also have entries for your Active Directory server (if different  
from the DNS) and for the external database server being used by the CMA  
system.  
Note  
If you configure the DNS server to use two or more Active Directory servers, make  
sure that the servers have the same services available.  
To dynamically manage endpoints (which includes automatic provisioning,  
automatic softupdate, and presence) right out-of-the-box, they must be able to  
automatically discover the CMA system. This means you must add the DNS  
service record (SRV record) for the CMA system. The lookup key for this  
service record is _cmaconfig._tcp. So the record will resemble this:  
__cmaconfig._tcp.customerdomain.com 86400 IN SRV 0 0 443 cma5000.customerdomain.com  
For more information about DNS, DNS records, and how DNS works, see  
Microsoft Technet  
Configure the Connection to the External Database  
If during First Time Setup you did not configure the CMA system to use an  
external Microsoft SQL Server database, but need to do so now, see “Database  
Note  
It is not recommended, but you can create the CMA system databases manually  
using Microsoft SQL scripts. Contact Polycom Global Services to request the  
creation scripts.  
Integration with an external Microsoft SQL Server database is required for  
redundant CMA 5000 systems or for CMA 5000 systems supporting more than  
400 concurrently registered endpoints and 240 concurrent calls.  
Configure the Connection to an External Enterprise Directory  
If during First Time Setup you did not configure your CMA system to use an  
enterprise directory, but need to do so now, see “Directory Operations” on  
Connecting to an enterprise directory allows users to enter their network  
usernames and password to log into CMA system. It also allows users to  
access the enterprise directory when selecting conference participants.  
10  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Configuration  
Configure Redundancy  
You can install the CMA 5000 system in a fault-tolerant, high-availability,  
redundant configuration. The CMA 4000 system is not available in a  
redundant configuration.  
A redundant CMA system configuration requires the installation of two CMA  
system servers on the same network. During First Time Setup, you are  
instructed to assign these two servers physical IP addresses. Once the two  
system servers are installed, see “Polycom CMA System Redundancy” on  
page 431 to finish implementing redundancy.  
Set Up Video Call Routing  
The video call routing setup includes the gatekeeper, site topology, gateway  
and MCU dial plan services, and bandwidth management.  
You can perform the following tasks:  
Handle inbound ISDN calls and route them to correct endpoints.  
Enable outbound IP- based calls.  
Connect through a firewall using an SBC device.  
Allow or deny calls to and from unregistered endpoints (rogue calls).  
When you have a third-party MCU that registers with the gatekeeper  
using standard H.323 protocol, add gateway and MCU dial plan services  
manually.  
Define new sites and site links.  
Add IP-to-ISDN call routing using least-cost routing.  
Define neighboring gatekeepers.  
Enable routing of H.323 calls to neighboring gatekeepers.  
Define a site for each physical location in which a LAN or an ISDN  
connection exists. If you use VPN connections, you can consolidate  
distinct physical locations into a single logical site to simplify  
management tasks.  
For each site, define the subnets in which the video endpoint systems are  
deployed. It is important that the IP addresses used by the endpoints  
belong to only one subnet at a site.  
Define least-cost routing tables only when you use the least-cost routing  
feature.  
Customize default dialing rules.  
Polycom, Inc.  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Set Up Automatic Provisioning  
The CMA system automatic provisioning feature allows an administrator to  
configure one or more endpoints with the standard set of information the  
registering endpoints need to operate within the network. This eliminates the  
need to configure each endpoint individually.  
Automatic provisioning is enabled at the endpoint, but the CMA system must  
have automatic provisioning profiles for both the endpoint and the site at  
which the endpoint resides.  
To ensure out-of-box usability, the CMA system comes with default automatic  
provisioning profiles. However, to create your desired user experiences, you  
should:  
Create customized automatic provisioning profiles for endpoint types.  
Edit provisioning profile for each site.  
Set Up Automatic Softupdate  
The CMA system automatic softupdate feature allows an administrator to  
upgrade the software on one or more endpoints with a standard software  
package. This eliminates the need to upgrade each endpoint individually.  
The automatic softupdate feature is enabled at the endpoint. At start up and at  
designated intervals, endpoints in automatic softupdate mode automatically  
look for a new softupdate profile and package on the CMA system.  
To implement automatic softupdates, you must create a softupdate package  
for each endpoint type you wish to support with updates.  
Set Up Conference Templates  
The CMA system uses conference templates and global conference settings to  
manage system and conference behavior.  
The CMA system has a Default Template and default global conference  
settings. You may want to create additional templates with different settings  
or change the global conference settings.  
For more information, see “Polycom® CMA® System Conference Scheduling  
12  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Configuration  
Set Up Directory Services  
Directory services provide information about all users, endpoints, and  
resources on your video communication network.  
To set up CMA system directory services, complete the following tasks:  
1
Register devices. On endpoints, you must set the gatekeeper and/or  
Global Directory Server (GDS) to point to the CMA system IP address or  
DNS name. We recommend using the IP address to prevent data  
inconsistencies.  
It may take a device up to 5 minutes to register with the gatekeeper and  
indicate an online status.  
Most device information is automatically populated in the CMA system  
through the gatekeeper registration or Global Address Book access. You  
must review the information for these devices in the CMA system  
Directory Setup page and fill in missing information.  
To select endpoints when scheduling conferences, you must first associate  
them with a user or conference room by editing the specific user or room  
settings. For more information, see “Endpoint and Peripheral  
2
Set up users and associate them with endpoints. Unless your CMA  
system is integrated with an enterprise directory, you must enter all user  
information manually including endpoint association. If your system is  
integrated with an enterprise directory, general user information (First  
Name, Last Name, UserID, Password, E-mail Address) is directly pulled  
from the directory and cannot be changed. However, you must still  
associate enterprise users with endpoints. For more information, see  
3
4
Set up groups, add members, and associate them with provisioning  
profiles. For more information, see “Users and Groups Overview” on  
Set up rooms and associate them with endpoints. Unless your CMA  
system is integrated with an enterprise directory that includes conference  
rooms, you must enter all room information manually including  
endpoint association. For more information, see “Room Overview and  
Set Up a Certificate for the Polycom CMA System  
By default, the CMA system uses httpsand a self-signed certificate for its data  
interchanges. As a best practice, we recommend replacing the CMA system  
self-signed certificate with a certificate from a Certificate Authority. For more  
Polycom, Inc.  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Distribute Polycom Applications  
The CMA system allows you to download several Polycom applications for  
use in specific environments. This includes two scheduling plugins and two  
desktop video applications. These are:  
These are discussed in the following topics.  
Note  
The Polycom RealPresence Desktop can be downloaded from the Polycom  
website at support.polycom.com.  
The Polycom RealPresence Mobile application for Androidcan be  
downloaded from play.google.com/store.  
The Polycom RealPresence Mobile application for iPhone® and IPad® can be  
downloaded from the www.apple.com/store.  
Distribute Polycom CMA Desktop for Windows Systems  
IMPORTANT  
On a Windows XP system, the user installing the Polycom CMA Desktop must  
sign in with administrative privileges. On a Windows Vista system, the user  
installing the Polycom CMA Desktop must sign into the Administrator account.  
The following procedures assumes you have implemented DNS lookup and  
Windows authentication for single sign on.  
To deploy the CMA Desktop client to users, you have at least four distribution  
options  
Option 1: Distribute the CMA Desktop client via an E-mail link  
You can copy the link for the CMA Desktop client from the CMA system  
Downloads page into an E-mail that you can send to users.  
To do this, copy and paste the CMA Desktop link (for example,  
http://10.47.9.136/SoftUpdate/vvl/CMADesktop_4_1_1_1010/CMADesktop.exe) from  
the Downloads page into an E-mail to be sent to users. Include the IP address  
of the CMA system and usernames and passwords (as required) in the E-mail  
to users.  
Option 2: Distribute the CMA Desktop client via the management system  
You can provide users access to the CMA system, from which they can  
download the CMA Desktop client.  
14  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Configuration  
To do this, copy and paste the IP address of the CMA system into an E-mail to  
be sent to users. Include usernames and passwords (as required) in the E-mail  
to users and instruct them to access the Downloads link.  
Option 3: Distribute the CMA Desktop client via a desktop management or  
group policy object  
Distribute the .exeinstallation file as a desktop management or group policy  
object to a location on client systems and provide directions to users on how to  
run the executable.  
To do this, build a desktop management or group policy object that writes the  
.exeinstallation file to a directory (for example, C:\temp) on the user’s local  
system. Include the command for executing the file in an E-mail to be sent to  
users. For example:  
C:\temp\CMA Desktop.exe”/s /v"/qn SBSERVERTYPE=2 SBSERVERADDRESS=nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn  
Include the IP address of the CMA system and usernames and passwords (as  
required) in the E-mail to users.  
Option 4: Distribute the CMA Desktop client via a .zip file  
Zip the .exeinstallation file and send it in an E-mail to users. Include the IP  
address of the CMA system and usernames and passwords (as required) in the  
E-mail to users. For endpoints on the public network that will be accessing the  
system through a firewall, include the IP address of the Polycom VBP system  
rather than the CMA system.  
Distribute Polycom CMA Desktop for MAC OS Systems  
IMPORTANT  
On a MAC system, the user installing the CMA Desktop client must sign in with  
administrative privileges and an Administrator account.  
The following procedures assumes you have implemented DNS lookup and  
MAC authentication for single sign on.  
To deploy the CMA Desktop for MAC OS clients to users, you have at least three  
distribution options  
Option 1: Distribute the CMA Desktop for MAC OS client via an E-mail link  
You can copy the link for the CMA Desktop for MAC OS clients from the CMA  
system Downloads page into an E-mail that you can send to users. To do this,  
copy and paste the CMA Desktop for MAC OS link (e.g.,  
http://10.47.9.136/SoftUpdate/vvl/CMADesktopMac_5_1_0_7458/CMADesktop.dmg)  
from the Downloads page into an E-mail to be sent to users. Include the IP  
address of the CMA system and usernames and passwords (as required) in the  
E-mail to users.  
Polycom, Inc.  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Option 2: Distribute the CMA Desktop Mac client via the management system  
You can provide users access to the CMA system, from which they can  
download the client. To do this, copy and paste the IP address of the CMA  
Desktop Mac system into an E-mail to be sent to users. Include usernames and  
passwords (as required) in the E-mail to users and instruct them to access the  
Downloads link.  
Option 3: Distribute the CMA Desktop Mac client via a .dmg file  
Send the .dmgfile in an E-mail to users. Include the IP address of the CMA  
system and usernames and passwords (as required) in the E-mail to users. For  
endpoints on the public network that will be accessing the system through a  
firewall, include the IP address of the Polycom VBP system rather than the  
CMA system.  
16  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3
Operating in Maximum Security  
Environments  
This chapter describes how the Polycom® Converged Management  
Application™ (CMA®) system operates when in Maximum Security mode. It  
includes these topics:  
Maximum Security Mode Overview  
The CMA system provides a Maximum Security option for those businesses  
that must adhere to the most stringent security protocols.  
You can only enable the Maximum Security option during First Time Setup.  
The process is irreversible and has significant consequences, as many CMA  
system features aren’t supported in this mode.  
Polycom, Inc.  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
In maximum security, the CMA system does not include support for the  
following features:  
Operation on the CMA 4000 platform or in a redundant system  
configuration  
CMA system gatekeeper functionality  
External databases  
Legacy endpoints. Only HDX systems operating in dynamic  
management mode are supported.  
ISDN scheduling  
Global Address Books  
Standard (scheduled) management and monitoring of endpoints  
Presence  
SNMP  
Remote desktop  
Integration with Microsoft (MS) Exchange for calendaring  
Integration with MS Office Communications Server or MS Lync  
Support for the Polycom CMA Desktop clients or the Polycom  
Scheduling Plug-ins for Microsoft Outlook and IBM Lotus Notes  
Least Cost Routing  
Audio only conferences  
Online help  
The following sections describe in detail the operational differences for a CMA  
system in Maximum Security mode.  
Conference Scheduling in Maximum Security Mode  
Conference scheduling functionality is available to users assigned the basic  
Scheduler, Advanced Scheduler, and Operator roles. The conference  
scheduling workflow on a CMA system operating in maximum security mode  
does not change. However, because all conferences must be hosted on RMX  
conferencing systems, the MCU Settings for all Conference Templates has  
changed in the following ways:  
The Supported MCUs section lists only RMX systems.  
The Always Use MCU option on the Conference Template page is not  
available (grayed-out); it is always enabled and cannot be changed.  
18  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operating in Maximum Security Environments  
Endpoint Management in Maximum Security Mode  
Endpoint management functionality is available to users assigned the Device  
Administrator role. Users assigned the standard Administrator role may only  
monitor endpoints.  
The endpoint management workflow on a CMA system operating in  
maximum security mode changes in that it only supports HDX endpoints  
operating in dynamic management mode. The system changes made to  
support this workflow change include:  
The Scheduled Provisioning and Scheduled Software Update pages and  
the ACTIONS associated with them are not available.  
Only HDX endpoints that are automatically provisioned by the CMA  
system are displayed in the endpoint list.  
The ACTIONS on the Endpoint > Monitor View page changes as follows:  
Actions  
Use this action to...  
Add  
Not available. Endpoints can only be added to the  
system during automatic provisioning.  
Search Devices  
Not available.  
The Device Summary section of the Endpoint > Monitor View page does  
not change.  
The Device Status section of the Endpoint > Monitor View page changes  
as follows:  
Field  
Description  
Gatekeeper  
Registration  
The status of the device’s registration with the  
gatekeeper service always indicates  
Unknown.  
Directory  
The status of the device’s registration with the Global  
Registration  
Directory Service always indicates  
Not Registered.  
Presence  
Not available.  
Registration  
Exchange  
Not available.  
Registration  
SIP Registration  
Device Managed  
Not available.  
Indicates Heartbeat Timeout.  
Gatekeeper  
Address  
The IP address of the gatekeeper to which the device is  
registered.  
Last GK  
Not available.  
Registration  
Polycom, Inc.  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
ISDN Line Status  
Type  
Not available.  
ISDN Assignment  
Type  
How the ISDN type was assigned to the device. This  
always indicates Undefined.  
Device ISDN Type  
Not available.  
The Call Info section of the Endpoint > Monitor View page does not  
change.  
The Device Alerts section of the Endpoint > Monitor View page changes  
as follows:  
Field  
Description  
Errors  
Device error message text always shows Gatekeeper  
Unregistered.  
The Provisioning Details section of the Endpoint > Monitor View page  
does not change.  
Network Device Management in Maximum Security Mode  
Network device management functionality is available to users assigned the  
Device Administrator role. Users assigned the standard Administrator role  
may only monitor network devices.  
The network device management workflow on a CMA system operating in  
maximum security mode changes in that it supports only RMX conferencing  
systems. The system changes required for this workflow change include:  
The VBPs and DMAs pages and the ACTIONS associated with them are  
not available.  
The ACTIONS on the MCU > Monitor View page do not change.  
The Add New Device dialog box for the RMX MCU does not change. Note  
that when operating in maximum security mode, the Admin ID for an  
MCU is the CMA machine account created on the RMX system just for this  
purpose and the Password is the password designated for this CMA  
machine account.  
20  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operating in Maximum Security Environments  
Polycom RMX Systems in Secure Mode  
The CMA system automatically detects when a Polycom RMX system is  
operating in secure (HTTPS) mode. By default, in non-secure (HTTP) mode,  
the Polycom RMX system uses port 80 for its communications and in secure  
(HTTPS) mode, the Polycom RMX system uses port 443 for its  
communications.  
You can determine via the CMA system interface whether or not a Polycom  
RMX system is operating in secure mode by viewing the HTTP port number  
If an administrator changes the secure mode setting on a Polycom RMX  
system, the CMA system will lose connection to the RMX, but will  
automatically regain it using the correct protocol. The CMA system may take  
up to a minute to restore the connection.  
User Management in Maximum Security Mode  
User management functionality is divided among different roles: Scheduler,  
Operator, and Administrator.  
Scheduler  
Users assigned the basic Scheduler and Advanced Scheduler role can add  
guest participants to the Guest Book.  
The Guest Book workflow for schedulers on a CMA system operating in  
maximum security mode has not changed.  
Operator  
Users assigned the Operator role can add, edit, and delete guest participants  
from the Guest Book as well as add, edit, and delete their own Favorites lists.  
The Guest Book and Favorites workflow for operators on a CMA system  
operating in maximum security mode has not changed.  
Administrator  
The administrator’s user management functionality and workflow on a CMA  
system operating in maximum security mode has changed significantly.  
When integrated with an enterprise directory (Microsoft Active Directory), the  
CMA system can have only one local account—the default administrator  
account used to access and administer the system. This account cannot be  
deleted in any circumstances.  
Polycom, Inc.  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
When integrated with an enterprise directory, this local administrator can  
perform the following user management functions:  
Integrate the CMA system with Active Directory. Note that when you  
integrate the CMA system with an Active Directory, all local users other  
than the default local administrator are removed from the system.  
Edit a subset of enterprise user attributes, such as their role, area, or  
endpoint associations. This allows the local administrator to assign the  
Administrator role to enterprise users.  
Troubleshoot and administrate the system if the Active Directory  
connection to the system is lost.  
When not integrated with an enterprise directory, this local administrator can  
perform the following user management functions:  
Add and edit local user attributes including their contact information and  
other user attributes such as their role, area, or endpoint associations.  
Delete local users.  
Note  
As a best practice, use this local administrator account for user management tasks  
on the CMA system. Do not use it to log into managed devices.  
The user management workflow on a CMA system operating in maximum  
security mode has changed in the following ways:  
Once integrated with an enterprise directory, the local administrator can  
see enterprise users as well as associate them to endpoints, roles, and areas  
(when applicable).  
Administrators cannot create custom roles with a custom set of  
permissions. The system has only pre-defined roles and associated  
permissions as described in “Default CMA System Roles and  
The system changes required to support this workflow change are:  
The User Roles page and the ACTIONS associated with it are not  
available.  
The ACTIONS on the User > Users page includes an additional  
command, so that you can view the permissions that come with the  
role a user has been assigned.  
Action  
Use this action to...  
View Permissions  
Display the set of permissions that come with the user’s  
assigned role.  
22  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operating in Maximum Security Environments  
Administrators cannot assign users more than one role.  
The system change required to support this workflow change is:  
The user interface for assigning roles (Add/Edit User > Associated Roles)  
has changed to a radio button list from which you can assign only one role  
from a set of mutually exclusive, predefined options.  
Via the Edit function, local administrators can now enable and disable  
local users rather than permanently deleting their user accounts. This  
function is only available for local users. Enterprise users must be enabled  
and disabled in Active Directory.  
Note  
Disabled local users (when not integrated with an enterprise directory) still appear  
in the CMA system Users list. However, disabled enterprise users (when integrated  
with an enterprise directory) won’t appear in the CMA system User list if the Ignore  
Disabled Enterprise Directory Users option on the Enterprise Directory page is  
enabled.  
The system change required to support this workflow change is:  
The General Info tab of the Edit User dialog box now has an Enable User  
option. By default, when a local user is created, this option is selected.  
Via the Edit function, administrators can unlock user accounts that  
become locked when a user reaches the Failed login threshold.  
Note  
Administrators cannot lock user accounts. This functionality is triggered only when  
the failed login threshold is met.  
The system change required to support this workflow change is:  
The General Info tab of the Edit User dialog box now has an Unlock User  
option. By default, when a local user is created, this option is not selected.  
However, when a local user reaches the Failed login threshold, the  
administrator can reset the lock by enabling the Unlock User option.  
Users cannot be associated with an alert profile because a CMA system  
operating in maximum security mode does not include remote alerts.  
The system change required to support this workflow change is:  
The Add/Edit User > Associated Alert Profile tab has been removed from  
the user interface.  
A CMA system has password requirements, local user account configuration  
requirements, and session management requirements that affect local users  
and local user accounts. For more information about these requirements, see  
Polycom, Inc.  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Group Management in Maximum Security Mode  
Group management functionality is available to users assigned the  
Administrator role.  
The group management workflow on a CMA system operating in maximum  
security mode has not changed except that users cannot inherit roles from  
groups.  
When not integrated with an enterprise directory, local administrators can add  
local groups with local users. When integrated with an enterprise directory,  
the single local administrator and any enterprise users assigned the  
Administrator role can Add local groups, Import Enterprise Groups, and  
Synchronize Groups with Active Directory.  
Reporting in Maximum Security Mode  
Reporting functionality is divided among different roles: Administrator,  
Operator, and Auditor.  
Administrator  
The administrator’s reporting functionality and workflow on a CMA system  
operating in maximum security mode has changed. Users assigned the  
Administrator role can access the following system reports:  
Endpoint Usage Report  
Conference Type Report  
System Log Files  
Audit Log Files  
Users assigned the Administrator role cannot access the following system  
reports, since these reports have been removed from the system:  
Site Statistics  
Site-link Statistics  
IP Call Detail Records  
Conference Usage Report  
Gatekeeper Message Log  
For more information on these reports, see “System Reports” on page 281.  
24  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Operating in Maximum Security Environments  
Operator  
The operator’s reporting functionality and workflow on a CMA system  
operating in maximum security mode has changed . Users assigned the  
Operator role can only access the following system report:  
Conference Usage Report  
Users assigned the Operator role cannot access the following system reports:  
IP Call Detail Records  
Endpoint Usage Report  
Gatekeeper Message Log  
For more information on these reports, see the Polycom CMA System  
Administrator’s Guide.  
Auditor  
Users assigned the Auditor role can access the following system reports:  
Endpoint Usage Report  
System Log Files  
Audit Log Files  
For more information on these reports, see the Polycom CMA System  
Administrator’s Guide.  
The Auditor role and workflow allows the auditor to:  
View online the Endpoint Usage Report for selected endpoints.  
The system change required to support this workflow change is:  
The Endpoint Usage Report menu option and page is available from the  
Reports menu, but the Generate Report and Download All CDRs options  
are not available to the auditor.  
Download the System Log Files.  
The system changes required to support this workflow change are:  
The System Log Files menu option and page is available from the  
Reports menu.  
The Download ALL command is available from the list of ACTIONS.  
Backup and Delete audit log files.  
The system changes required to support this workflow change are:  
The Audit Log Files menu option and page is available from the  
Reports menu.  
The Backup and Delete command is available from the list of  
ACTIONS. This option allows an auditor to backup and delete  
selected audit logs. During this process, the CMA system requires that  
Polycom, Inc.  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
the auditor download and run a verification utility that performs a  
checksum operation to make certain that the downloaded audit log is  
complete and uncorrupted before the audit log is deleted from the  
CMA system.  
Change the audit log Alert Level.  
The system change required to support this workflow change is:  
The Change Settings command is available from the list of ACTIONS. By  
default the audit log Alert Level is set to 70% of the Max File Size Usage,  
which is 2 gigabytes.  
Device Administration in Maximum Security Mode  
Only users assigned the Device Administrator role can perform device  
administration tasks.  
In addition to the tasks described in the Endpoint Management in Maximum  
Security Mode section, the device administrator workflow on a CMA system  
operating in maximum security mode allows the device administrator to:  
See the system Dashboard.  
Add, edit, and delete machine accounts for endpoint systems.  
The system change required to support this workflow change is:  
The Machine Accounts menu option and page is available from the  
Admin > Management and Security menu. Before the CMA system can  
dynamically manage a HDX system, a device administrator must add a  
machine account for the HDX system. This is the same username that the  
HDX system administrator should enter on the HDX system for the  
provisioning service. This allows the HDX and CMA systems to  
authenticate and communicate without using a specific user’s account.  
About Machine Accounts  
Before the CMA system can dynamically manage HDX systems operating in  
maximum security mode, a user assigned the Device Administrator role must  
create an HDX machine account for each HDX that the CMA system will  
manage. The machine account allows the endpoint to connect and authenticate  
with the CMA system for dynamic management purposes without using the  
endpoint user’s account.  
The Add Machine Account dialog box includes the following information.  
Field  
Description  
Enable Machine  
Account  
Select or clear this option to enable and disable  
(respectively) the machine account you create for the  
endpoint.  
26  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Operating in Maximum Security Environments  
Field  
Description  
Unlock Machine  
Account  
Select this option to unlock machine accounts that  
become locked when they exceed the Failed login  
threshold. This will only happen when the password  
expires.  
User ID  
Enter a unique name for the machine account.  
As a best practice, name the machine account in a way  
that associates it with the corresponding device. For  
example, if your company names endpoint systems for  
the system user or room (for example, bsmith_HDXor  
Evergreen_Room), then give the machine account an  
associated User ID (bsmith_HDX_machineor  
evergreen_room_machine).  
Password/  
Confirm Password  
Enter a password for the machine account user ID.  
This password must meet the Local Password  
Requirements. This password expires in 365 days.  
Description  
Enter a meaningful description for the endpoint.  
Associate with an  
existing user or room  
Select this option to associate the endpoint system with  
a specific user or room. This may be a local or  
enterprise user or room.  
Associate with a new  
room (created  
Select this option to associate the endpoint system with  
a system-generated room name.  
automatically)  
Once you have created this machine account on the CMA system, provide this  
information to the appropriate HDX system administrator. They should enter  
this User ID and Password as the User Name and Password on the HDX  
Provisioning Service page.  
Note that the machine account password expires after one year. After the  
expiration, the HDX login will fail. After three failed login attempts, the  
system locks the machine account. You can reset the password and unlock the  
machine account by editing it and assigning a new password.  
System Administration in Maximum Security Mode  
Only users assigned the Administrator role can perform general CMA system  
administration functions. The CMA system administration functionality and  
workflow on a CMA system operating in maximum security mode has  
changed. The following sections describe the areas of functionality and how  
they have changed.  
Users assigned the Administrator role can see the system Dashboard, the  
Admin menu, and the pages and ACTIONS associated with it.  
Polycom, Inc.  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Admin Menu  
The Admin menu in maximum security mode changes in the following ways:  
The Global Address Book, SNMP Settings, Gatekeeper Settings, and  
Alert Settings menu options and their associated functionality have been  
removed.  
Removed gatekeeper functionality resulted in the following system  
changes:  
The system cannot display bandwidth usage. Bandwidth usage for  
sites, subnets, or site limits is always 0.  
Site exclusions cannot be enforced.  
Dial rules are required for ISDN calling in translating numbers, but  
have no affect for IP calls.  
The system is not the gatekeeper, so it cannot perform address  
resolution.  
E164 aliases assigned by the CMA system are not communicated to  
the gatekeeper, so they cannot be resolved.  
Dialing rules can be configured on the CMA system, but they are not  
communicated to the gatekeeper, so they cannot be implemented.  
Threshold alarms and hardware alarms are always 0.  
Site topology cannot provide a graphical representation of status  
(color).  
The CMA system has no knowledge of external gatekeeper or its rules.  
Conference Templates  
As was noted before, because all conferences scheduled on a CMA system  
operating in maximum security mode must be hosted on a RMX conferencing  
system, the MCU Settings for all Conference Templates has changed in the  
following ways:  
The Supported MCUs section lists only RMX.  
The Always Use MCU option on the Conference Template page is not  
available (grayed-out); it is always enabled and cannot be changed.  
Conference Settings  
On a CMA system operating in maximum security mode, a setting is available  
on the Conference Setting page. The Conference and chairperson password  
length field allows an administrator to designate the required length of the  
system-generated conference password and chairperson password. The  
acceptable length for both of these passwords is six to 16 characters. By default,  
the required length for both of these passwords is set to 15 characters.  
28  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Operating in Maximum Security Environments  
Note  
Depending on the system settings, the scheduler may be allowed to change the  
Conference Password or Chairperson Password. However, the password length  
requirement still applies.  
Other than this requirement, the conference settings, conference password,  
and chairperson password workflow on a CMA system operating in  
maximum security mode have not changed.  
Provisioning Profiles  
Because a CMA system operating in maximum security mode supports only  
HDX endpoints running version 2.7.0J operating in dynamic management  
mode, the Scheduled Provisioning Profiles page and the ACTIONS  
associated with it are not available.  
The Automatic Provisioning Profiles page and the ACTIONS associated with  
it has not changed on a CMA system operating in maximum security mode.  
Software Updates  
Because a CMA system operating in maximum security mode supports only  
HDX endpoints running version 2.7.0J operating in dynamic management  
mode, the Scheduled Software Update page and the ACTIONS associated  
with it are not available.  
The Automatic Software Update page and the ACTIONS associated with it  
has not changed on a CMA system operating in maximum security mode.  
Server Settings  
The Server Settings menu for a CMA system operating in maximum security  
mode has changed significantly. The following options have been removed:  
Database  
Calendaring Management  
Microsoft Lync or Office Communications Server Integration  
Redundant Configuration  
Remote Alert Setup  
E-mail  
In addition, you will also note the following changes and additions:  
The Network settings page now includes the ability to enable IPv6 and to  
include a preferred and alternate DNS server.  
Polycom, Inc.  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
The System Time page does not include the Minutes Between  
Synchronization option when using an NTP server.  
What was formerly titled the LDAP page is now titled the Enterprise  
Directory page.  
On the Enterprise Directory page:  
You must identify the enterprise directory by DNS Name. You cannot  
identify the enterprise directory server by IP address.  
The Security Level defaults to StartTLS and cannot be modified.  
The Reclaim Inactive CMA Desktop Licenses option has been removed  
from the Licenses page.  
The CMA Desktop Logo option has been removed from the Custom Logo  
page.  
The Include dynamically-managed devices in the Global Address Book  
option has been removed from the Directory Setup page.  
Management and Security  
A CMA system operating in maximum security mode offers a Management  
and Security workflow. The following sections describe the changes.  
Server Software Upgrade  
The Server Software Upgrade workflow on a CMA system operating in  
maximum security mode has not changed.  
Certificate Management  
Because a CMA system operating in maximum security mode always operates  
in encrypted mode, the Use HTTPS is not an option on the Certificate  
Management page.  
By default, to support encrypted communications and establish a minimum  
level of trust, the CMA system includes a default key and self-signed  
certificate. However, to implement a full certificate chain to a root certificate  
authority (CA), a CMA system requires both a root CA certificate and a  
identity server certificate signed by the root CA. Therefore, at some time you  
must request these certificates from your CA. The question is when.  
You must install the root CA certificate during First Time Setup. However, you  
can complete First Time Setup with just the root CA certificate and the CMA  
system default self-signed certificate. Then you can use the Certificate  
Management page to finish certificate set up.  
30  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operating in Maximum Security Environments  
Session Management  
The Session Management page allows an administrator to change but not  
disable the following settings:  
Field  
Description  
CMA user interface  
timeout  
By default the CMA system user interface times out after 10  
minutes of inactivity. Use this procedure to change the  
timeout value for the user interface inactivity timer. Possible  
value is 5 to 60 minutes.  
Maximum number  
of sessions per  
user  
The number of simultaneous login sessions per user ID.  
Possible value is 1 to 10 sessions.  
Maximum number  
of sessions per  
system  
The number of simultaneous login sessions by all users.  
Possible value is 2 to 50 sessions.  
Note  
If this limit is reached, but none of the logged-in users is an  
Administrator, the first Administrator user to arrive is granted  
access, and the system terminates the non-Administrator  
session that’s been idle the longest.  
Banner Configuration  
The Banner Configuration page allows users assigned the Administrator role  
to customize (but not disable) the long and short login banners.  
A log in banner is the message that appears when users attempt to access the  
system. Users must acknowledge the message before they can log in.  
By default, the long banner field on the Banner Configuration page displays  
the required Standard Mandatory Notice and Consent Provision for systems  
operating in maximum security mode. The short banner field displays a  
shortened version of this same notice.  
The long banner is used for the CMA system log in banner. It is also  
provisioned to HDX systems that the CMA system manages. The short banner  
is provisioned to HDX systems that the CMA system manages for those  
situations in which the long banner length exceeds the available display area.  
The CMA system provides several sample long banners. You can use these  
banners as is or edit them to create a custom long banner. The CMA system  
provides a single short banner, which you can also customize. If you  
customize the banners, remember that the long banner message may contain  
up to 5000 characters. The short banner message may contain up to 1315  
characters.  
Polycom, Inc.  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Local User Account Management  
The Local User Account Management page allows an administrator to change  
but not disable the following local user account settings:  
Field  
Description  
Account Lockout  
Failed login  
threshold  
Specify how many consecutive login failures cause the  
system to lock an account. Possible value is 2 to 10.  
Failed login window  
(hours)  
Specify the time span within which the consecutive failures  
must occur in order to lock the account. Possible value is 1  
to 24.  
Customized user  
account lockout  
duration (minutes)  
Specify how long the user’s account remains locked.  
Possible value is 1 to 480.  
Account Inactivity  
Customize account  
inactivity threshold  
(days)  
Specify the inactivity threshold that triggers disabling of  
inactive accounts. Possible value is 30 to 180.  
Local Password Requirements  
The Local Password Requirements page allows an administrator to change  
but not disable password security requirements by specifying password age,  
length, and complexity.  
Field  
Description  
Password Management  
Maximum password  
age (days)  
Specify at what age a password expires. Possible value  
is 30 to 180.  
Minimum password age  
(days)  
Specify how frequently a password can be changed.  
Possible value is 1 to 30.  
Password warning  
interval (days)  
Specify when users start to see a warning about their  
password expiration. Possible value is 1 to 7.  
Minimum length  
Specify the number of characters a password must  
contain. Possible value is 8 to 18.  
Minimum changed  
characters  
Specify the number of characters that must be different  
from the previous password. Possible value is 1 to 4.  
Reject previous  
passwords  
Specify how many of the user’s previous passwords the  
system remembers and won’t permit to be reused.  
Possible value is 8 to 16.  
32  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operating in Maximum Security Environments  
Field  
Description  
Password Complexity  
Lowercase letters  
Specify the number of lowercase letters (a-z) that a  
password must contain. Possible value is 1 or 2.  
Uppercase letters  
Numbers  
Specify the number of uppercase letters (A-Z) that a  
password must contain. Possible value is 1 or 2.  
Specify the number of digit characters (0-9) that a  
password must contain. Possible value is 1 or 2.  
Special characters  
Specify the number of non-alphanumeric keyboard  
characters that a password must contain. Possible  
value is 1 or 2.  
Maximum consecutive  
repeated characters  
Specify how many sequential characters may be the  
same. Possible value is 1 to 4.  
Reset System Passwords  
The CMA system has several underlying service passwords. The Reset  
System Passwords page allows an administrator to reset these underlying  
service passwords. When you select this option, all of these underlying service  
passwords will be changed to the same obscured system-generated value.  
Dial Plan and Sites  
The Dial Plan and Sites workflow on a CMA system operating in maximum  
security mode has changed. The Least Cost Routing and Services menu  
options and their associated functionality are not displayed. Also, because the  
CMA system is not the gatekeeper, the CMA system Site Topology display is  
less informative. It used data provided to it by the gatekeeper functionality.  
Backup System Settings  
A CMA system operating in maximum security mode offers the Backup  
System Settings feature, which allows an administrator to create an archive  
that includes not only a backup of the CMA system databases but also all CMA  
system configuration settings.  
The process for backing up the CMA system settings is documented in  
Polycom, Inc.  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
To restore a system from a backup archive  
1
Restore the system to its factory default configuration. You will need  
the Restore to Factory Default DVD that shipped with the CMA system  
server. This DVD has the base image of the CMA system server software.  
WARNING  
This is a last resort, so never do this without being instructed to do so by PGS  
support.  
This process will wipe out your system database and all other system data.  
The Restore to Factory Default DVD is specific to the CMA system server type  
and version.  
2
3
Perform First Time Setup. For more information about First Time Setup,  
see the Polycom CMA System Getting Started Guide for this release.  
Restore the system configuration using the last archived configuration.  
The archived configuration will overwrite the configuration that resulted  
from First Time Setup. The only CMA system configuration settings not  
included in the archive and thus not overwritten are the network settings  
and the security certificates required for an operational system.  
In cases when the CMA system is functional, but the configuration or database  
is corrupted, the backup archive can also be used to return a CMA system back  
to its last known good archive. As long as the network settings and security  
certificates are operational, the last known good archive will return the CMA  
system to its former functional state.  
Network Intrusion Detection in Maximum Security Mode  
The CMA system detects network intrusions by processing the Microsoft  
Windows Firewall logs, inserting dropped packet information into a  
temporary system database table, and identifying certain patterns in the data.  
The CMA system detects the following types of instrusions: a fast port scan, a  
slow port scan, a denial of service (DoS) attack, and a flood attack. These are  
currently defined as:  
Fast port scan:  
10 connections in a 5-second time period from the same source IP.  
Slow port scan:  
100 connections in a 1-hour time period from the same source IP.  
DoS attack:  
100 connections in a 5-second time period to the same destination port.  
Flood attack:  
100 connections in a 5-minute window to any destination port from any  
source IP.  
34  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operating in Maximum Security Environments  
If the CMA system detects an intrusion, it displays a system alert on the user  
interface. The alert text will indicate the type of intrusion detected, such as:  
Port scan detected. See audit log for details.  
DoS attack detected. See audit log for details.  
Flood attack detected. See audit log for details.  
Troubleshooting in Maximum Security Mode  
Troubleshooting Utilities  
A CMA system operating in maximum security mode has most of the same  
troubleshooting utilities of the standard commercial CMA system; however  
the Traces functionality has changed and functionality has been added. The  
following sections describe the troubleshooting utilities.  
Windows Event Logs  
There is no change in the Windows Event Logs function.  
CMA System Logs  
There is no change in the CMA System Logs function.  
Database Backup  
There is no change in the Database Backup function.  
Test Network Connect  
The Test Network Connect function allows you to perform a Traceroute or  
Ping operation. Traceroute allows you to investigate the route path and transit  
times of packets as they travel across an IP network. Ping allows you to test the  
availability of a host on an IP network.  
Synchronize Certificate Stores  
The Synchronize Certificate Stores function allows you to reset all certificate  
stores with the currently uploaded certificates and certificate revocation lists  
(CRLs).  
Systems  
The Systems pane displays summary information about the devices that  
access the CMA system. For a CMA system operating in maximum security  
mode, systems are limited to Endpoints, MCUs, and Rooms.  
Polycom, Inc.  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
CMA Configuration  
The CMA Configuration pane displays information about the configuration  
of the CMA system. For a CMA system operating in maximum security mode,  
configuration items are limited to Software Version, Hardware Version,  
Enterprise Directory, Database, Time Source, and Enterprise Directory DC  
(Domain Controller).  
CMA Info  
The CMA Info pane displays general information about the CMA system. For  
a CMA system operating in maximum security mode, this includes the  
following:  
Standard information:  
CPU Utilization, Paging File Utilization, Last Hard Start/Reboot,  
Provisioning Operations in Progress operations, Software Update  
Operations in Progress, Hardware Alarms, Threshold Alarms,  
Temperature, Power Supply Status, Battery Status, and Cooling Fan  
Status.  
Additional information:  
Total Memory, Free Memory, and Partition States.  
CMA Licenses  
There is no change in the CMA Licenses function.  
Users Logged-In  
The Users Logged In pane displays the type and number of users that are  
currently logged into the system. For a CMA system operating in maximum  
security mode, this includes a user role of Auditor.  
Services  
The Services pane displays information about the CMA system services,  
including the running services and the stopped services. For a CMA system  
operating in maximum security mode, there are 8 services rather than the 14  
services in a commercial CMA system. The following table lists the services,  
their purpose, and whether or not they are essential to the health of a CMA  
system operating in maximum security mode.  
Service  
Manages the system’s...  
Web processes  
Comment  
Essential  
Essential  
Essential  
Apache2  
MSSQLSERVER  
OpenDS  
Database processes  
Site topology database  
openfire  
Presence/XMPP processes Not available  
Polycom Cascader  
Cascaded conferencing  
processes  
Required for  
cascading conferences  
36  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operating in Maximum Security Environments  
Service  
Manages the system’s...  
Comment  
Polycom Conference  
Scheduling Service  
Conference scheduling  
processes  
Essential  
Polycom Device Manager Device management  
processes  
Not Available  
Essential  
Polycom DialRuleService Dial rule management  
processes  
Polycom Gatekeeper  
Polycom JServer  
Gatekeeper processes  
Not Available  
Essential  
Java processes including  
LDAP, SNMP, device  
management, Site  
Topology, and  
dynamically-managed  
device logins and  
provisioning.  
Polycom Master Service  
Polycom Serial COM  
Basic operation processes  
Essential  
Serial port management  
processes  
Not Available  
Polycom Service Monitor  
Redundancy monitoring  
processes  
Not Available  
Not Available  
Polycom Global Address  
Book  
Global Address Book  
management processes  
Report Administration  
The only Report Administration function supported on a CMA system  
operating in maximum security mode is the Days to keep Conference and  
Endpoint CDRs. All other Report Administration functions including  
creating and storing a weekly archive of the CDRs are not available.  
Polycom, Inc.  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
38  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4
Polycom® CMA® System Conference  
Scheduling Overview  
This chapter providesan introduction to the Polycom® Converged  
Management Application™ (CMA®) system video conference scheduling  
functionality and operation. It includes these topics:  
To log into the CMA system web interface, you need:  
Microsoft Internet Explorer® 6.0, 7.0 or 8.0, Mozilla FireFox® 3.5 or 3.6, or  
Apple Safari 3.2, 4.0 or 5.0.  
If your system is operating in maximum security mode, you may use only  
Microsoft Internet Explorer.  
Adobe® Flash® Player 9.x or 10.x  
The IP address or host name of the CMA system server and your  
username, password, and domain.  
Note  
The CMA system user interface is best viewed with an SXGA display resolution of  
at least 1280x1024 pixels. The minimum support display resolution is XGA  
1024x768 pixels.  
Generally, you get three opportunities to enter the correct password. After  
three failed attempts, the system returns an error message.  
To log into a CMA system  
1
Open a browser window and in the Address field enter the CMA system  
IP address or host name.  
If prompted to install the Adobe Flash Player, click OK.  
If you receive an HTTPS Security Alert, click Yes.  
Polycom, Inc.  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
If you see a login banner, click Accept to accept the terms and  
continue.  
If you cannot connect to the system, there may be certificate issues.  
2
When the CMA system Log In screen appears, enter your Username and  
Password.  
3
4
If necessary, select a different Language or Domain.  
Click Login.  
If you log in as an administrator, you see the CMA system Dashboard.  
For more information about roles and the functionality associated with  
Conference Menu Overview  
This section includes some general information you should know about the  
Conference menu and views. It includes these topics:  
Conference Menu and Views  
The Conference menu provides these views of the Conference list:  
Future—Displays the list of future conferences in the main window.  
Use this view to view and edit future conferences.  
Ongoing—Displays the list of active conferences in the main window.  
Use this view to manage ongoing conferences.  
Users can only work with the conferences that appear in their Conference list.  
By default, schedulers see only their conferences in the Conference list, while  
operators see all the conferences on the system. However, when areas are  
defined, operators see all the conferences for the areas to which they belong.  
By default, users assigned other roles cannot view conferences.  
40  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom® CMA® System Conference Scheduling Overview  
The Conference views have these sections.  
Section  
Description  
The views you can access from the page.  
Views  
Conference Actions The set of available commands. The constant commands in  
the Conference views are:  
Refresh  
with current information.  
—Use this command to update the display  
Add  
—Use this command to create a new video  
and/or audio conference.  
Conference List  
The context-sensitive Conference list for the selected view.  
Conference Details  
Displays information about the selected conference. For  
more information, see “Conference Details” on page 81.  
Conference  
Features  
Displays the status of system features for the selected  
conference. For more information, see “Conference  
Bridge (MCU)  
Features  
Displays the status of MCU features for the selected  
conference. For more information, see “Bridge (MCU)  
Participants  
Displays the list of participants for the selected conference.  
For more information, see “Participants List” on page 85.  
Participant Details  
Displays information about the participant selected in the  
Participants list. For more information, see “Participant  
Polycom, Inc.  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Conference Views—Future and Ongoing  
The Conference list in both the Future and Ongoing view has these fields.  
Field  
Description  
Filter  
Use the filter to display other views of the conference list,  
which include:  
Future Only - Displays scheduled conferences that  
have not yet started  
Today Only - Displays scheduled conferences  
(completed, active, or future) for the current day and  
active ad hoc conferences  
Custom Date - Displays scheduled conferences  
(completed, active, or future) for a selected day. Select  
the day from the calendar.  
Ongoing Plus - Displays active and future scheduled  
conferences for the day. You can further filter this  
request by Owner, Conference Name, Endpoint  
Name, and Bridge.  
Today Plus - Displays scheduled conferences  
(completed, active, or future) for the current day, current  
ad hoc conferences, and all future conferences. You can  
further filter this request by Owner, Conference Name,  
Endpoint Name, and Bridge.  
Yesterday Plus - Displays completed scheduled  
conferences for yesterday and earlier. You can further  
filter this request by Owner and Conference Name.  
These filters apply to scheduled conferences only. Ad hoc  
conferences are not displayed in the filtered list.  
For information on filters, see “Filter and Search a List”.  
Export as Excel file  
Status  
Click this button to download the currently displayed  
Conference list to a Microsoft Excel spreadsheet.  
The state of the conference. For more information, see  
Type  
The type of scheduled conference. Possible values include:  
Video Conference  
—All conference participants  
have video endpoints.  
Audio Only Conference  
—All conference  
participants have audio endpoints. Audio only  
conferences require an MCU.  
Recurring Conference  
a recurring series.  
—The conference is one in  
Multi-Bridge Conference —The scheduler assigned  
the conference to multiple bridges and created bridge  
links.  
42  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom® CMA® System Conference Scheduling Overview  
Field  
Description  
Conference Name  
The system- or scheduler-assigned name of the  
conference. By default, the system assigns a conference  
name and appends the day and date to that name. The  
scheduler can change the system-assigned name.  
Start Time  
Bridge  
The user-assigned start time for the conference. The  
system appends the time difference between the local time  
and the standard time.  
If applicable, the user-assigned bridge for the conference.  
Possible values are:  
N/A—A bridge is not required for the conference.  
<Bridge Name>—The user assigned the conference to  
a single bridge. In this case, the bridge name is  
displayed.  
Multi bridge  
—The user assigned the conference  
to multiple bridges and created bridge links.  
Owner  
The conference creator.  
Conference States  
Conferences may be in the following states.  
State  
Description  
Future  
Conference  
Scheduled conference that has not yet started. This  
conference state is possible in all views except the  
Yesterday Plus view.  
Completed  
Conference  
A scheduled conference that occurred in the past. This  
conference state is possible in all views except the Future  
and Ongoing Plus view.  
Active  
Conference  
A conference that is still active/ongoing. This conference  
state is possible in all views except the Future and  
Yesterday Plus view.  
Active Alerts  
Conference  
The bridge on which the active/ongoing conference is being  
hosted has sent an alert. Examples of events that will  
trigger a bridge alert are:  
A participant is connected in secondary mode (audio  
only).  
A conference is not yet full (i.e., not all scheduled  
participants have joined the conference).  
Polycom, Inc.  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
State  
Description  
Declined  
Conference  
Applies only to conferences scheduled through the Polycom  
Scheduling Plugin for Microsoft Outlook. This state  
indicates that most participants did not accept the  
conference invitation.  
If your system is in maximum security mode, the Polycom  
Scheduling Plugin for Microsoft Outlook is not available.  
Conference End  
Warning  
The conference is ending, i.e., it is in its last five minutes  
unless someone extends it.  
Context-Sensitive Conference Actions  
Besides the constant Refresh  
and Add  
actions, the Conference Actions  
section may include these context-sensitive actions depending on the type of  
conference selected.  
Action  
Available for future conferences only  
Edit Use this command to edit the selected conference. For  
Description  
more information, see “Edit a Conference” on page 56.  
Available for future and past conferences  
Delete  
Use this command to delete the selected conference.  
Available for future, past, and active conferences  
Copy  
Use this command to copy the selected conference.  
Available for active conferences only  
Manage  
Operators only. Use this command to display the Manage  
Conference page for the conference selected in the  
Conference List. Use this command to manage  
participants and endpoints in the selected active  
conference. For more information, see “Manage an Active  
Terminate  
Operators only. Ends the selected conference.  
44  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom® CMA® System Conference Scheduling Overview  
General Scheduling Information  
You may find the following general topics useful when you are scheduling  
conferences.  
Scheduling Participants and Endpoints  
When you schedule conferences, you select the participants you wish to join  
the conference from your endpoint directory. Depending on your system  
configuration, your endpoint directory may be the enterprise directory, the  
Global Address Book, or one or more local address books. It may also include  
Guest Book entries.  
For participants that have multiple endpoints registered with the CMA  
system, the system selects the participant’s default endpoint. You can change  
to another endpoint by selecting it from the Call Info list or by editing the  
participant.  
You can schedule participants without endpoints into conferences. You cannot  
schedule endpoints without owners into conferences. The CMA system can be  
configured to allow you to overbook dial-in participants. In this case, dial-in  
participants can be scheduled to dial into multiple conferences during the  
same time period, but the system reserves resources for the participant for  
only the first scheduled conference. Dial-out participants cannot be scheduled  
into multiple conferences.  
Also, if you schedule participants into conference as Dial In participants, the  
conference will require external MCU resources.  
Bridge Selection and Cascading  
When a conference is scheduled with one of the CMA system scheduling  
applications (Web Scheduler or Scheduling Plug-in for Microsoft Outlook or  
IBM Lotus Notes) and the conference requires external MCU resources (such  
as a Polycom RMX or MGC system), then by default the CMA system  
automatically assigns the conference to a bridge. However, the system allows  
users with the Advanced Scheduler role to select a bridge for their  
conferences. It also allows them to create multibridge, cascaded conferences.  
Bridge Selection  
When scheduling a conference, users with the Advanced Scheduler role can  
select a bridge to host their conference by selecting the Single Bridge option.  
When they select this option, the system presents a list of bridges that have the  
capabilities and resources required to host their conference.  
Polycom, Inc.  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Because this bridge list depends on the template selection, users should make  
their template selection before selecting a bridge. Otherwise, they may select a  
bridge that cannot meet their conferencing requirements. In this case, the  
conference will fail to schedule.  
Bridge Selection and Cascading Conferences  
When scheduling a conference, users with the Advanced Scheduler role can  
select the Multi Bridge option to create cascading conferences.  
In some respects, a cascaded conference looks like a single conference, but it is  
actually two or more conferences on different bridges that are linked together.  
The link is created by a dial-out from one conference to a second conference  
via a special cascaded entry queue.  
Some reasons you may wish to create cascading conferences include:  
To invite more conference participants than any single bridge can host  
To connect different bridges at different sites into a single conference  
To use the different capabilities of different bridges (for example, different  
communication protocols, such as, serial connections, ISDN, etc.)  
When you create a multibridge, cascaded conference, you must manually  
select bridges and create the cascaded links between bridges by identifying the  
originating bridge, the terminating bridge, and the network type (IP or ISDN).  
The system displays an interconnection diagram that illustrates the cascaded  
links. Once scheduled, each cascaded link appears as a participant in the  
conference.  
By default, the system automatically assigns participants to the “best bridge”  
for them based on available capacity, location, and least cost routing rules.  
However, you may also choose to manually assign participants to bridges.  
Bridge Scheduling and Reassignment  
When a conference is scheduled with one of the CMA system scheduling  
applications (Web Scheduler or Scheduling Plug-in for Microsoft Outlook or  
IBM Lotus Notes), by default the system automatically assigns the conference  
to a bridge unless a user with the default Advanced Scheduler role intercedes.  
If that bridge is down at the time the system starts the conference, the CMA  
system attempts to dynamically reassign the conference to another bridge with  
sufficient capabilities and resources.  
If the system can successfully reassign the conference to another bridge,  
the conference starts on the newly selected bridge, and the system sends  
an updated conference email to all scheduled participants. This updated  
email includes a new dial-in number that dial-in participants must use to  
join the conference.  
If the system cannot successfully reassign the conference to another  
bridge, the conference fails to start. The system sends an email to notify the  
conference organizer of the failure.  
46  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom® CMA® System Conference Scheduling Overview  
Some notes about bridge reassignment:  
The bridge reassignment process only occurs when the system detects that  
a bridge is down. It does not occur if the system determines that a bridge  
does not have sufficient resources required to host the conference.  
If the CMA system cannot find another bridge with the features and  
capacity needed to support a conference, the conference fails to start. The  
system does not attempt to modify the conference settings in any way.  
Instead, the system sends an email to notify the conference organizer of  
the failure.  
The system will chain bridge reassignments. This means that if the next  
bridge to which the system assigns a conference is down at the time the  
system tries to start the conference, the system will try to reassign the  
conference again.  
If the bridge to which the system reassigns a conference has ad hoc  
conferences on it, the CMA system is unaware of those conferences. The  
reassigned conference may fail to start if ad hoc conferences are  
consuming resources the CMA system expected to schedule. This is  
known behavior and is avoided by applying the best practice of not using  
bridges for both scheduled and ad hoc conferences.  
Polycom, Inc.  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
48  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5
Conference Scheduling Operations  
This chapter describes the Polycom® Converged Management Application™  
(CMA®) system conference scheduling operations. It includes these topics:  
Add/Schedule a Conference  
By default, only schedulers and operators can schedule conferences.  
Schedulers have two options for scheduling a new conference:  
These options are discussed in the following topics.  
Add/Schedule a New Conference  
To add or schedule a new conference  
1
2
Go to Conference > Future and click Add  
.
In the conference scheduling page, enter a Conference Name and set a  
conference Start Date, Start Time, and either an End Time or Duration.  
Polycom, Inc.  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
3
To make the conference recurring, click Recurrence and in the  
Appointment Recurrence dialog box, set:  
Recurrence frequency (Daily, Weekly, or Monthly)  
Recurrence day (Sunday through Saturday)  
Recurrence range (Start date and End After occurrences or End by  
date)  
The maximum number of recurrences is 365.  
Click OK.  
4
5
For an Audio Only conference, change the Conference Type to Audio  
Only.  
To change the template, click Default Template or Default Audio  
Template and select a different template, if available.  
Notes  
Conference templates provide default conference settings. When you select a  
different template, you are selecting the default conference settings for your  
conference.  
The Default Template and Default Audio Template are available to all users  
who can schedule conferences. Other templates may also be available if they  
have been assigned to users with your role.  
The Default Template and Default Audio Template are stored in the system  
database and their names are not localized.  
6
To add conference participants from the local directory or enterprise  
directory:  
a
Enter all or part of a participant’s Last Name or First Name into one  
of the name fields and click Add Participants.  
The Add Participants dialog box appears with the list of participant  
names that meet your search criteria.  
Notes  
Depending on the search domain, the search function may return different  
The search results only include participants associated with endpoints.  
b
c
Select the participant of interest’s name from the list.  
The participant’s name appears in the underlying Selected  
Participants and Rooms list.  
Repeat steps a and b to add all domain participants and then click  
Close.  
50  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Conference Scheduling Operations  
7
To add a guest from the Guest Book:  
a
b
Click Add From Guest Book.  
In the Add From Guest Book dialog box, select the guest of interest’s  
name from the list.  
The guest’s name appears in the underlying Selected Participants  
and Rooms list.  
c
Repeat step b to add all participants from the Guest Book and then  
click Close.  
8
To add new guest participants (participants not available through the  
local directory, enterprise directory, or Guest Book):  
a
b
Click Add Guest.  
Configure these fields in the Add Guest dialog box.  
Field  
Description  
First Name  
Last Name  
The guest’s first name.  
The guest’s last name.  
Note  
The system allows you to add multiple users with the  
same first and last name into the Guest Book.  
Email  
The guest’s E-mail address. The system only validates  
the structure of the E-mail address.  
Note  
The E-mail field is ASCII only.  
Location  
The location of the guest’s endpoint system. This is a  
free-form field that the system does not validate.  
How will the  
participant  
join the  
Specify how the participant will join the conference.  
In Person —The participant will attend the  
conference by going to a room that is included in the  
conference or joining another participant who is  
attending the conference.  
conference  
Audio Only —The participant will attend the  
conference by telephone. The system will either call  
out to the participant or the participant will dial in.  
Use Video—The participant will attend the  
conference using a video endpoint system. The  
system will either call out to the participant or the  
participant will dial in.  
This selection will in part determine what other fields of  
the Add Guest dialog box you will need to complete.  
Polycom, Inc.  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
Bit Rate  
(Video only) Set as required. You can change the  
connection speed for an endpoint up to the maximum  
speed specified by the conference template.  
Dial Options  
Dial Type  
Specify whether the guest will dial into the conference or  
require that the system dial out to the guest.  
Specify the protocol that the guest’s endpoint supports:  
H.323 (IP), SIP (IP), or H.320 (ISDN).  
This selection will determine what other sections of the  
Add New Guest dialog box you will need to complete.  
c
If the guest has an H.323 (IP) endpoint, configure these settings:  
Field  
Description  
Number and  
Number Type  
The specific dial string for the guest, and the  
format of the number that the MCU must resolve  
to contact the guest. This may be an IP address,  
E.164 address, H.323, or Annex-O.  
For Annex-O dialing, in the Number field enter  
the H.323.alias@IP, for example:  
Notes  
Polycom endpoints must register with a  
gatekeeper before they will attempt an  
Annex-O call.  
You can enter a dial string for another MCU as  
a guest. If so, you may need to specify the  
conference ID in the Extension field also.  
Extension  
Use this field to connect the conference to  
another conference on another MCU. In this field,  
specify the conference ID or passcode for the  
conference on the other MCU.  
MCU Service  
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on  
the MCUs with which the CMA system is  
registered. Leave this at Any Available Service  
unless you have specific knowledge of MCU  
services.  
52  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Conference Scheduling Operations  
d
If the guest has a SIP (IP) endpoint, configure these settings:  
Field  
Description  
Sip URI  
The SPI URI the MCU must resolve to contact the  
guest.  
MCU Service  
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on  
the MCUs with which the CMA system is  
registered. Leave this at Any Available Service  
unless you have specific knowledge of MCU  
services.  
e
If the guest has an H.320 (ISDN) endpoint, configure these settings:  
Field  
Description  
Use Modified Dial  
Number  
Select this option first (as needed) as it will  
determine the other fields you must configure.  
Country  
(Not available when Use Modified Dial Number  
is selected.) The country to which the system will  
dial out to the guest. Click Select to view a list of  
country codes.  
Area/City Code  
(Not available when Use Modified Dial Number  
is selected.) The area code to which the system  
will dial out to the guest.  
Number  
The participant’s phone number.  
Cannot be configured.  
Extension  
MCU Service  
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on  
the MCUs with which the CMA system has  
registered. Leave this at Any Available Service  
unless you have specific knowledge of MCU  
services.  
f
Select Save to Guest Book to have this guest participant added to the  
system Guest Book.  
g
Click OK.  
The guest’s name appears in the Selected Participants and Rooms  
list.  
9
Adjust the conference date and time as needed to match participant and  
endpoint availability.  
Polycom, Inc.  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
a
Review their availability and adjust the conference date and time as  
needed.  
Notes  
For participants who are associated with endpoints, the CMA system schedules  
their availability according to the endpoint’s availability.  
For participants with multiple endpoints, check the availability for each endpoint.  
Click Call Info to change the participant’s endpoint.  
Dial-in participants can be scheduled to dial into multiple conferences during the  
same time period; dial-out participants cannot.  
b
To edit a participant’s dial settings, select the participant from the  
Selected Participants and Rooms list and click Edit. For more  
information on editing participants settings, see “Edit a Participant’s  
10 To add conference rooms to the Selected Participants and Rooms list:  
a
b
Click Select Site.  
Select the site of interest from the site list.  
The conference room list for the selected site appears.  
Select the conference room of interest from the list.  
c
The conference room name appears in the underlying Selected  
Participants and Rooms list.  
d
Repeat steps b and c to add all required conference rooms and then  
click OK.  
11 If you have the Advanced Scheduler role, now is the time to assign  
conference leadership roles, edit conference settings, and make bridge  
12 To edit a participant’s dial settings, select the participant from the  
Selected Participants and Rooms list and click Edit. For more  
information on editing participants settings, see step 5 on page 57.  
13 When finished, click Schedule.  
The system verifies that it has a bridge with the capabilities and resources  
required for your conference. If it does, the conference notification E-mail  
appears with a message indicating Conference Successfully Scheduled.  
14 To exit without sending an E-mail to participants, click Skip Email.  
15 To send an E-mail notification to participants:  
a
Copy additional people on the notification and/or add notes about  
the conference.  
Note that the To, CC, and BCC fields are ASCII only.  
54  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Conference Scheduling Operations  
b
c
As needed, add information in the Enter additional notes to include  
in the email section.  
Click Send.  
The system sends the conference notification E-mail. The Future view  
appears. The conference appears in the conference list.  
The E-mail that the CMA system sends can be read by E-mail systems that  
accept plain text E-mails, iCal attachments, or vCal attachments.  
Copy an Existing Conference  
Future, ongoing, or past conferences can be copied as a template for a future  
conference.  
Users can only copy conferences that appear in their Conference list. By  
default, schedulers see only their conferences in the Conference list, while  
operators see all the conferences on the system, unless areas are defined. In  
which case operators see all the conferences for the areas to which they belong.  
By default, users assigned other roles cannot view conferences.  
To copy a conference  
1
2
3
Go to the appropriate conference view.  
Select the conference of interest and click Copy  
.
If you used a template other than the default when you created the  
conference, reselect the template.  
4
5
Make the required changes to the conference date, participants, rooms, or  
other settings. For information on performing these tasks, see  
When finished, click Schedule.  
The system verifies that it has a bridge with the capabilities and resources  
required for your conference. If it does, the conference notification E-mail  
appears with a message indicating Conference Successfully Scheduled.  
6
To exit without sending an updated E-mail to your participants, click  
Skip Email.  
Polycom, Inc.  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Edit a Conference  
Only future conferences can be edited. Active or past conferences cannot be  
edited.  
Users can only edit the conferences that appear in their Conference list. By  
default, schedulers see only their conferences in the Conference list, while  
operators see all the conferences on the system, unless areas are defined. In  
which case operators see all the conferences for the areas to which they belong.  
By default, users assigned other roles cannot view conferences.  
To edit a future conference  
1
2
3
Go to Conference > Future.  
Select the conference of interest and click Edit  
.
If you select a recurring conference, a dialog box appears asking if you  
want to edit all conferences in the series or just the selected one. Make the  
appropriate choice and click Edit.  
The conference scheduling page appears.  
4
To change the template, click Default Template or Default Audio  
Template and select a different template, if available.  
Notes  
Conference templates provide default conference settings. When you select a  
different template, you are selecting the default conference settings for your  
conference.  
The Default Template and Default Audio Template are available to all users  
who can schedule conferences. Other templates may also be available to you if  
they have been assigned to users with your role.  
The Default Template and Default Audio Template are stored in the system  
database and their names are not localized.  
5
6
Make the required changes to the conference date, participants, rooms, or  
other settings. For information on performing these tasks, see  
When finished, click Schedule.  
The system verifies that it has a bridge with the capabilities and resources  
required for your conference. If it does, the conference notification E-mail  
appears with a message indicating Conference Successfully Scheduled.  
7
To exit without sending an updated E-mail to your participants, click  
Skip Email.  
56  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Conference Scheduling Operations  
8
To send an updated E-mail to your participants:  
a
Copy additional people on the notification and/or add notes about  
the conference.  
Note that the To, CC, and BCC fields are ASCII only.  
b
Click Send.  
The system sends the updated conference notification E-mail. The  
Future view appears. Your conference appears in the conference list.  
Edit a Participants Settings  
Participant’s settings for future scheduled conferences may be edited.  
Schedulers cannot edit a participant’s settings for an active or past conference.  
Users can only work with the conferences that appear in their Conference list.  
By default, schedulers see only their conferences in the Conference list, while  
operators see all the conferences on the system, unless areas are defined. In  
which case operators see all the conferences for the areas to which they belong.  
By default, users assigned other roles cannot view conferences.  
To edit a participants settings  
1
2
3
Go to Conference > Future.  
Select the conference of interest and click Edit  
.
If you select a recurring conference, a dialog box appears asking if you  
want to edit all conferences in the series or just the selected one. Make the  
appropriate choice and click Edit.  
4
5
In the conference scheduling page, select the participant of interest from  
the Selected Participants and Rooms list and click Edit.  
In the Edit Participant Settings dialog box, edit the participant settings as  
required.  
Polycom, Inc.  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
a
If the guest has an H.323 (IP) endpoint, configure these settings:  
Field  
Description  
Number and  
Number Type  
The specific dial string for the guest, and the  
format of the number that the MCU must resolve  
to contact the guest. This may be an IP address,  
E.164 address, H.323, or Annex-O.  
For Annex-O dialing, in the Number field enter  
the H.323.alias@IP, for example:  
Notes  
Polycom endpoints must register with a  
gatekeeper before they will attempt an  
Annex-O call.  
You can enter a dial string for another MCU as  
a guest. If so, you may need to specify the  
conference ID in the Extension field also.  
Extension  
Use this field to connect the conference to  
another conference on another MCU. In this field,  
specify the conference ID or passcode for the  
conference on the other MCU.  
MCU Service  
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on  
the MCUs with which the CMA system is  
registered. Leave this at Any Available Service  
unless you have specific knowledge of MCU  
services.  
b
If the guest has a SIP (IP) endpoint, configure these settings:  
Field  
Description  
Sip URI  
The SPI URI the MCU must resolve to contact the  
guest.  
MCU Service  
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on  
the MCUs with which the CMA system is  
registered. Leave this at Any Available Service  
unless you have specific knowledge of MCU  
services.  
58  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Conference Scheduling Operations  
c
If the guest has an H.320 (ISDN) endpoint, configure these settings:  
Field  
Description  
Use Modified Dial  
Number  
Select this option first (as needed) as it will  
determine the other fields you must configure.  
Country  
(Not available when Use Modified Dial Number  
is selected.) The country to which the system will  
dial out to the guest. Click Select to view a list of  
country codes.  
Area/City Code  
(Not available when Use Modified Dial Number  
is selected.) The area code to which the system  
will dial out to the guest.  
Number  
The participant’s phone number.  
Cannot be configured.  
Extension  
MCU Service  
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on  
the MCUs with which the CMA system has  
registered. Leave this at Any Available Service  
unless you have specific knowledge of MCU  
services.  
6
Click OK.  
View Scheduling Information for a Conference  
Users can only view scheduling information for the conferences that appear in  
their Conference list. By default, schedulers see only their conferences in the  
Conference list, while operators see all the conferences on the system, unless  
areas are defined. In which case operators see all the conferences for the areas  
to which they belong. By default, users assigned other roles cannot view  
conferences.  
To view the scheduling information for a conference  
1
To see the scheduling information for a future conference, go to  
Conference > Future. To see the scheduling information for an active  
conference, go to Conference > Ongoing.  
2
From the list of All Conferences, select the conference of interest and  
click View.  
Polycom, Inc.  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
The View conference page appears displaying the following details about  
the conference:  
Section  
Description  
Start Date  
End Date  
Duration  
The date on which the conference started or will start.  
The date on which the conference is scheduled to end.  
The scheduled duration of the conference in hours and  
minutes.  
Recurrence  
Owner  
The recurrence information for the conference.  
The person who scheduled the conference.  
Type  
The type of conference as identified by an icon. Hover over  
the icon to determine the conference type.  
Conference  
Passcode  
The conference passcode assigned to the conference.  
For future conferences, users with the Advanced  
Scheduler role can change this conference password. See  
Chairperson  
Whether or not the conference has a chairperson. This field  
will include a participant’s name or N/A.  
For future conferences, users with the Advanced  
Scheduler role can assign a conference chairperson. See  
Participants  
List  
Information for the participant, including  
Name  
Dial Mode  
Participant Type  
Access  
Endpoint  
3
Click Back to List to return to the conference list.  
60  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6
Advanced Scheduling Operations  
This chapter describes how users with the Advanced Scheduler role have  
more options when scheduling conferences using the Polycom® Converged  
Management Application™ (CMA®) system.  
When scheduling conferences, advanced schedulers can:  
Edit Conference Settings  
By default, users with the Advanced Scheduler role can overwrite certain  
conference template settings as described here.  
Note  
Two conferences scheduled with the same template may have different settings  
and behavior if they are hosted on different types of MCUs. Minimize or eliminate  
such differences by ensuring that all MCUs are similarly configured and that all  
CMA system templates are synchronized with RMX profiles.  
Schedulers can edit conference settings only for scheduled conferences. They  
cannot edit conference settings for active conferences.  
To edit the conference settings  
1
On the conference scheduling page, as you are adding or editing a  
conference, click Edit Conference Settings.  
Polycom, Inc.  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
2
As needed, configure these settings on the Conference Settings dialog  
box. The settings that you can edit may depend on the template selected.  
Setting  
Description  
Conference ID  
By default, the system assigns a Conference ID. You  
can change this ID to permit integration with third-party  
scheduling tools. This identifier must be 8 or less  
numeric digits.  
Notes  
The CMA system compares the Conference ID to its  
database to verify that it is unique. If it is not unique,  
you will be prompted to enter a new Conference ID.  
If a conference is scheduled on a Polycom RMX  
system and the room ID is the same as the assigned  
Conference ID, then the conference will not be  
created on RMX. The conference will launch on the  
CMA system with an active status, but will display no  
endpoints connected.  
Conference  
Passcode  
By default, the system assigns an 15-digit Conference  
Passcode and provides this passcode to participants  
within the content of the conference notification E-mail.  
You can change this passcode to another 9- through  
16-digit number.  
Enable  
Chairperson  
You can select a video chairperson to control the  
conference from his or her video endpoint system. The  
video chairperson must have a video endpoint system  
and Chairperson conferences require an MCU.  
Notes  
If the conference template has the Conference  
Requires Chairperson parameter enabled, then  
Enable Chairperson is automatically selected and  
cannot be changed.  
If a conference is scheduled on a Polycom RMX  
system and the RMX profile has Conference  
Requires Chairperson selected but the template  
does not, and the conference is scheduled without a  
chairperson, then all users will remain in the waiting  
room and will not be able to join the conference.  
Polycom RMX 1000 systems do not support the  
Chairperson feature.  
62  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Scheduling Operations  
Setting  
Description  
Chairperson  
Passcode  
If Enable Chairperson is selected, the system assigns  
an 15-digit Chairperson Password and provides this  
password to the video chairperson in a separate E-mail.  
If Enable Chairperson is selected, the chairperson  
must enter this 15-digit password at his or her video  
endpoint to assume control of the conference.  
You can change this password to another 4- through  
16-digit number.  
Dial Options  
You have three options:  
To create a conference for which the same dial-in  
information and a PIN code are assigned to all  
conference participants, use the Dial-In setting. This  
setting allows participants to dial in from an audio or  
video endpoint and connect to the same conference  
on the MCU.  
To dial out to all participants in the conference, use  
the Dial-Out setting.  
To allow participants both options, select  
Dial-In+Dial-Out.  
Note  
When you change a conference from Dial-In to Dial  
In+Dial Out, the selected resources remain set to  
Dial-In. You must change them manually.  
Always Use MCU  
Video Mode  
This setting forces the conference to an MCU and  
prevents video endpoints from connecting to each other  
directly. This setting is automatically selected and cannot  
be changed when Audio Only is the conference type or  
when Enable Chairperson is selected.  
Determines the initial layout on a video endpoint's  
monitor for a multipoint conference that requires an  
MCU. The options are:  
Switching.  
Indicates that the display changes  
each time the speaker changes, and everyone sees  
the current speaker.  
Select a Frame Count, then select the specific  
layout for the frames.  
The available layouts are Continuous Presence  
settings.  
Polycom, Inc.  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Setting  
Description  
Bit Rate  
Specifies the maximum connection speed for endpoints  
in the conference. Individual endpoints that specify a  
lower connection speed connect at that lower speed.  
Endpoints that specify a higher connection speed  
connect at the speed identified in the conference  
template.  
If you select a higher speed than an endpoint can  
support, the system reduces the speed that endpoint;  
however, the conference uses the default connection  
speed for endpoints that can match it. If you place the  
calls through an endpoint with an embedded MCU, the  
behavior depends on the capabilities of that endpoint.  
Bit Rate  
(continued)  
When the dial speed is higher than the number of  
channels defined in the H.320 service for the endpoint,  
you receive a warning. To continue, lower the dial speed  
to less than or equal to the ISDN capability of the  
endpoint.  
Higher speed is important for high-quality video in a  
conference. Because higher speeds use greater  
bandwidth, scheduling a high-bandwidth conference  
may limit the number of conferences that you can  
reserve at one time.  
64  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Scheduling Operations  
Setting  
Description  
People + Content  
Controls the ability for one endpoint to send two types of  
data—a data stream and a video stream—over the same  
bandwidth to display people and content. The receiving  
endpoint handles the two video streams differently and  
may display them on separate screens or through video  
switching mode.  
Endpoints that do not support the selected method  
connect with either video through IP or audio only  
through ISDN.  
Select from these available settings:  
None. Select this option when dual data streams are  
not required.  
People +Content (H.329). This enables the industry  
standard H.239 dual streams for endpoints that  
support H.239 or the Polycom proprietary People +  
Content dual streams for older Polycom endpoints  
without H.239 capabilities. The MCU requires that  
conferences with People + Content use a minimum  
speed of 192 K.  
People and Content VO. This Polycom proprietary  
technology works with PictureTel endpoints. Select  
this option for older endpoints.  
Visual Concert PC. Select this option for use with  
Polycom ViewStation MP/512/SP/323 endpoints.  
Visual Concert FX. Select this option for use with  
Polycom ViewStation FX/EX and VS4000 endpoints.  
Duo Video. This setting supports IP and ISDN and  
is available with TANDBERG endpoints, in which  
one part of the conference is set as the video  
conference and the other as the presentation  
conference.  
Polycom, Inc.  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Setting  
Description  
T.120 Mode  
For MGC-hosted conferences only, selects the protocols  
and specifications for multipoint data communication.  
If your system is in maximum security mode, the T.120  
options are not supported.  
In the T.120 menu, select the speed for the T.120  
connection. See your IT department to determine the  
best combinations for your conferences. To disable the  
T.120 mode, select None.  
If you select T.120, these options may be available,  
according to the participant’s endpoint and software:  
Application Sharing. Allows two or more  
participants to work on the same document or  
application, even when only one participant has the  
application. In application sharing, one participant  
launches the application, and it runs simultaneously  
on all other computers.  
File Transfer. Enables participants to send files to  
each other.  
Chat or Whiteboard. Allows participants to  
communicate with each other by writing.  
In all of these modes, participants can view and hear  
each other.  
3
If the conference is configured for Chairperson or Lecturer modes, assign  
participants leadership roles:  
a
To assign a participant the lecturer role, in the Lecturer field select the  
participant’s name from the list.  
b
To assign a participant the video chairperson role, in the Video  
Chairperson field select the participant’s name from the list.  
Notes  
If the Lecturer or Video Chairperson features are not available, then the  
selected template does not support these features.  
To be assigned Lecturer, a participant must have a manageable video endpoint.  
4
or return to adding or editing the conference, as described in “Conference  
66  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Scheduling Operations  
Select a Bridge for a Conference  
By default, when scheduling a conference, the CMA system will automatically  
select a bridge for the conference. However, users with the Advanced  
Scheduler role can select a specific bridge for a conference.  
To select a single bridge for a conference  
1
When you’re adding or editing a conference, after you’ve made all of  
your other conference configuration choices, from the Bridge Selection  
list select Single Bridge.  
A bridge selection drop down list appears based on the template selection  
and conference settings.  
2
3
From the MCU list, select a specific MCU to host the conference.  
on page 67, as required, or return to adding or editing the conference, as  
Create a Cascaded Conference Across Multiple Bridges  
Users with the Advanced Scheduler role can create cascaded conferences.  
To create a cascaded conference across multiple bridges  
1
When you’re adding or editing a conference, after you’ve made all of  
your other conference configuration choices, from the Bridge Selection  
select Multi Bridge.  
Note  
If the Multi Bridge option is not available, then the system is not configured to  
support this option.  
The Schedule button changes to a Manual Cascade button and the  
Recurrence button is grayed out.  
2
Click Manual Cascade.  
The People To Bridges dialog box appears displaying the selected  
conference participants and their bridge assignments. Bridge assignments  
default to Auto. These system assignments are based on bridge capacity  
and/or least cost routing principles.  
In the Selected Bridge Availability section, the system shows a count of  
the available ports on the available bridges for the specified time period.  
Polycom, Inc.  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
If the port count is within 5% of the maximum ports available, it is  
displayed in red.  
3
To change a bridge assignment for a selected participant, click Auto and  
select a bridge from the pull-down menu.  
Note  
A CMA system can only show port counts for conferences scheduled via the  
system. Ad hoc conferences are not included in the port count.  
4
When you’ve completed all bridge assignments, click Next.  
The Bridge To Bridge Links dialog box displays a graphical view of the  
selected bridges.  
Note  
If an MCU does not show up in the Bridge To Bridge Links dialog box, then the  
MCU software does not support cascading.  
5
6
To add a hub bridge (a bridge used to connect one bridge to another),  
from the Available Bridges window, select a bridge and click Add  
Bridge.  
Specify bridge-to-bridge connections by selecting the bridges of interest  
and clicking Add Link.  
The link is graphically represented by an arrow. The bridge at the base of  
the arrow dials to the bridge at the point of the arrow.  
Note  
A Polycom RMX system cannot dial a Polycom MGC, so do not link from an RMX  
system to an MGC system.  
7
In the Add Link dialog box, select the Link Type.  
Notes  
You can add links from a Polycom MGC system to a Polycom RMX system.  
There is no support for ISDN cascaded links on RMX MCUs.  
The lag time required to update cascaded links may cause more than one  
participant to hear the prompt about being the first person to join the conference.  
8
Return to adding or editing the conference, as described in “Conference  
68  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7
Conference and Participant  
Management Operations  
This chapter describes the Polycom® Converged Management Application™  
(CMA®) system conference and participant management operations. It  
includes these topics:  
Manage an Active Conference  
The Manage Conference page provides a detailed view of a single active  
conference and allows an operator to make some changes to the conference.  
To manage an active conference  
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.  
From the list of All Conferences, select the conference of interest and  
click Manage  
.
Polycom, Inc.  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
The conference page appears in a new tab displaying the Participants list.  
The Participants list displays these settings:  
Section  
Description  
Status  
The state of the participant’s connection as identified by an  
icon. Hover over the icon to determine the status.  
Type  
The type of conference as identified by an icon. Hover over  
the icon to determine the type.  
Name  
The participant’s name.  
Endpoint  
The name assigned to the participant’s endpoint when it  
registered or was added to the system.  
Access  
The endpoint’s network interface type. Possible values  
include:  
H323  
ISDN  
Address  
Bit Rate  
Dial Mode  
The IP address or ISDN number of the participant’s endpoint  
(if a dial-out).  
The sum of the audio and video data transfer rate (in kbps)  
of the participant’s endpoint.  
How the participant joined the call. Possible values include:  
Audio or Video Dial-In  
Audio or Video Dial-Out  
Bridge  
The MCU on which the participant’s call resides.  
3
Use these conference actions as needed:  
Action  
Use this action to...  
Copy  
.
Schedule a new conference that duplicates the  
selected conference settings.  
View  
View information for the selected conference.  
End an active conference.  
Terminate  
Extend Duration  
Extend the duration of an active conference.  
70  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Conference and Participant Management Operations  
Action  
Use this action to...  
Change Layout  
For applicable endpoints.  
Change the default video layout for the conference  
display.  
Switching.  
Indicates that the display changes  
each time the speaker changes, and everyone  
sees the current speaker.  
Select a Frame Count, then select the specific  
layout for the frames.  
The available layouts are Continuous Presence  
settings.  
Add Participant  
Add one or more participants to the selected  
conference.  
Add Guest  
Add a guest to the selected conference.  
Add Room  
Add one or more rooms to the selected conference.  
Add Favorites  
Add participants from one of your Favorites lists to the  
selected conference.  
Join Conference  
Join the conference, monitor the conference, and talk  
with participants as needed.  
4
Use these participant actions as needed:  
Action  
Use this action to...  
Mute  
Unmute Audio  
or  
Mute or unmute the selected participant’s audio line  
into the conference. This option appears only when the  
conference is running on an external MCU. The Audio  
column in the Participants list shows the current status  
of this setting.  
Block  
Unblock Video  
or  
Block or unblock the selected participant’s video line  
into the conference. This option appears only when the  
conference is running on an external MCU. The Video  
column in the Participants list shows the current status  
of this setting.  
Connect  
Disconnect  
or  
Disconnect or reconnect the selected participant to the  
conference. A disconnected participant is still  
associated with the conference and cannot be  
scheduled for other conferences.  
Remove  
Remove the selected participant from the Participants  
list at which time the participant can be scheduled for  
another conference.  
Send Message  
Send a message to the selected participant’s  
registered Polycom endpoint. The message appears  
briefly on the monitor for the selected video endpoint.  
Polycom, Inc.  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Action  
Use this action to...  
Acknowledge  
Help  
Acknowledge a request for help and send a message  
to the requesting endpoint.  
Manage Device  
Open the web-based user interface for the selected  
participant’s endpoint in a new browser window.  
Save as Favorite  
Function available when the selected participant has  
an associated endpoint to which the system can dial  
out.  
Save the selected participant to an existing Favorites  
List.  
Connect All New  
Function available only when the system is displaying  
the New Conference Participants list.  
Initiates the system dial out to new participants.  
Add Additional Participants to an Active Conference  
Operators can add additional participants to an active conference.  
Note  
Dial Out is the only Dial Option the system allows for adding participants to an  
active conferences.  
To add additional conference participants to an active conference  
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.  
From the list of All Conferences, select the conference of interest and  
click Manage  
.
3
To add participants from the local directory or enterprise directory:  
a
b
Click Add Participant  
.
Enter all or part of a participant’s Last Name or First Name into the  
appropriate field and click Search.  
A list appears of participant’s names that meet the search criteria.  
Notes  
Depending on the search domain, the search function may return different  
The search results only include users associated with endpoints.  
72  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Conference and Participant Management Operations  
c
Select the participant’s name from the list.  
The participant’s name appears in the underlying New Conference  
Participants list.  
d
e
Repeat steps a through c to add all domain participants and then click  
Close.  
If necessary, edit the new participants’ settings. See “Edit a  
4
To add participants from the Guest Book:  
a
b
Click Add Guest.  
From the Guest Book dialog box, select the guest’s name from the list.  
The guest’s name appears in the underlying New Conference  
Participants list.  
c
Repeat step b to add all guest participants and then click Close.  
5
6
To add new guest participants (participants not available from the local  
directory, enterprise directory, or Guest Book), see step 8 on page 51.  
To initiate the system dial out to new participants, select the participants  
of interest from the New Conference Participants list and click Connect  
New Participants.  
The system dials out to the participants and adds them to the conference.  
Add a Room to an Active Conference  
To add a room to an active conference  
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.  
From the list of All Conferences, select the conference of interest and  
click Manage  
.
3
4
From the Conference Actions list, click Add Room.  
From the Add Room dialog box, select the site location of the room.  
The list of conference rooms at the site appears.  
Select the conference room of interest.  
5
6
The conference room name appears in the underlying New Conference  
Participants list.  
Click Close.  
Polycom, Inc.  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
7
To initiate the system dial out to the room, select the room from the New  
Conference Participants list and click Connect New Participants.  
The system dials out to the room endpoint system and adds the room to  
the conference.  
View the Video of a Participant in an Active Conference  
To view the video of a participant in an active conference  
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.  
From the list of All Conferences, select the conference of interest and  
click Manage  
.
3
Select a participant from the Participants list.  
The selected participant’s video appears in the Conference Image section  
of the interface.  
4
Click Shuffle  
to shuffle to the next participant’s video.  
Join an Active Conference  
By default, users assigned the Operator role can join an active conference to  
offer conference support.  
To join an active conference  
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.  
From the list of All Conferences, select the conference of interest and  
click Manage  
.
3
From the Conference Actions list, click Join Conference.  
The Join Conference dialog box appears.  
4
5
6
If the conference uses bridge cascading, select a bridge for the call into the  
conference.  
If you have multiple endpoints, choose the endpoint to use to join the  
conference.  
Click Join Conference.  
Your endpoint is added to the conference with your video blocked but  
your audio not muted.  
74  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Conference and Participant Management Operations  
Add a Participant from a Favorites List to an Active  
Conference  
By default, users assigned the Operator role can work with favorites lists.  
To add a participant from a favorites list to an active conference  
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.  
From the list of All Conferences, select the conference of interest and  
click Manage  
.
3
4
From the Conference Actions list, click Add Favorites.  
From the Favorites List, expand the list of interest.  
The names of the participants in the list is displayed.  
Select the participant of interest from the list.  
5
The participant’s name appears in the underlying New Conference  
Participants list.  
6
7
Repeat steps 4 and 5 to add all participants from the Favorites List and  
then click Close.  
To initiate the system dial out to new participants, select the participants  
of interest from the New Conference Participants list and from the New  
Participants Action menu, click Connect New Participants.  
The system dials out to the participants and adds them to the conference.  
Add/Save a Participant to a Favorites List  
By default, users assigned the Operator role can work with favorites lists.  
To add or save a conference participant to a favorites list  
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.  
From the list of All Conferences, select the conference of interest and  
click Manage  
.
3
4
From the Participants list, select the participant of interest.  
From the Participant Actions menu, click Save as Favorite.  
The names of the participants in the list is displayed.  
5
From the Save as Favorite Participant dialog box, select the Favorite List  
to which to save the participant and click OK.  
Polycom, Inc.  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Manage a Participants Endpoint During a Conference  
The Manage page also allows operators to manage conference participant’s  
endpoints.  
These context-sensitive commands only appear when the participant’s endpoint  
supports the action.  
These commands work for rooms on the participant list as well.  
To manage a participants endpoint  
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.  
Select the conference of interest and click Manage  
The Participants list appears.  
.
3
4
5
To view participants geographically, click  
Double-click on the participant of interest.  
.
Use these participant actions as needed. These actions are also available  
from the View Participants Details dialog box.  
Action  
Use this action to...  
Mute  
Unmute Audio  
or  
Mute or unmute the selected participant’s audio line  
into the conference. This option appears only when the  
conference is running on an external MCU. The Audio  
column in the Participants list shows the current status  
of this setting.  
Block  
Unblock Video  
or  
Block or unblock the selected participant’s video line  
into the conference. This option appears only when the  
conference is running on an external MCU. The Video  
column in the Participants list shows the current status  
of this setting.  
Connect  
Disconnect  
or  
Disconnect or reconnect the selected participant to the  
conference. A disconnected participant is still  
associated with the conference and cannot be  
scheduled for other conferences.  
Remove  
Remove the selected participant from the Participants  
list at which time the participant can be scheduled for  
another conference.  
76  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Conference and Participant Management Operations  
Action  
Use this action to...  
Send Message  
Send a message to the selected participant’s  
registered Polycom endpoint. The message appears  
briefly on the monitor for the selected video endpoint.  
Acknowledge  
Help  
Acknowledge a request for help and send a message  
to the requesting endpoint.  
Manage Device  
Open the web-based user interface for the selected  
participant’s endpoint in a new browser window.  
View a Participants Details During a Conference  
This procedure describes how to view details for a participant’s endpoint  
while it is in conference.  
To view a participants endpoint details  
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.  
Select the conference of interest and click Manage  
The Participants list appears.  
.
3
4
To view participants geographically, click  
Double-click on the participant of interest.  
.
The View Participant Details dialog box appears with the Call Properties  
displayed. It includes the Near End and Far End video, the Participant’s  
name, Status, Errors, Warnings, Endpoint Type, Address, Access, and Bit  
Rate.  
It also includes a list of Participant Actions. For more information about  
5
To view additional participant details, change the selection in the Call  
Properties drop-down menu.  
If you select Device, you’ll see these participant details:  
Setting  
Description  
Endpoint Type  
Usually the endpoint model, such as Polycom HDX  
system.  
IP Address  
Site  
The IP address for the endpoint.  
The location of the endpoint as identified by its IP  
address and the subnet of the site.  
Polycom, Inc.  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Setting  
Gatekeeper  
GDS  
Description  
The gatekeeper with which the endpoint is registered.  
The Global Directory Service for the endpoint. Usually  
the Polycom Global Address Book.  
Presence  
Whether or not the endpoint is registered with a  
Presence service, so that its availability can be  
reported.  
Device Managed Whether or not the endpoint is registered with a  
Provisioning service, so that it can be configured  
automatically.  
ISDN Line Status The status of the ISDN line. Possible values include:  
Operational  
Non-operations  
This field is blank for the following endpoint types:  
PVX, MGC, RMX, GW/MCU, Other, and TANDBERG.  
Alias Type  
Alias Value  
If the endpoint has an alias designation, the type of  
alias. Possible types include E.164, H.323 ID, URL,  
Transport Address, E-mail, Party Number, and  
Unknown.  
Value for the alias type shown.  
If you select Call Details, you’ll see these participant details:  
Setting  
Description  
Video Protocol  
The video connection protocol, both transmission (Tx)  
and reception (Rx), the endpoint is using. Possible  
values include:  
H.261  
H.261 is an ITU standard designed for two-way  
communication over ISDN lines and supports  
data rates which are multiples of 64Kbit/s. H.261  
supports CIF and QCIF resolutions.  
H.263  
H.263 is based on H.261 with enhancements that  
improve video quality over modems. It supports  
CIF, QCIF, SQCIF, 4CIF and 16CIF resolutions.  
H.264  
Video Format  
Video Rate  
The video format, both transmission (Tx) and  
reception (Rx), the endpoint is using.  
The video bandwidth negotiated with the far site.  
Video Rate Used The actual video bandwidth used in the call to the far  
site.  
78  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Conference and Participant Management Operations  
Setting  
Description  
Video Frame  
Rate  
Specifies the frame rate to use.  
Video FEC  
Errors  
The number of Forward Error Correction (FEC) errors  
that have been corrected in the current call.  
Cause Code  
Audio Rate  
The audio bandwidth negotiated with the far site  
Audio Protocol  
The audio connection protocol, both transmission (Tx)  
and reception (Rx), the endpoint is using.  
If you select Call Quality of Service, you’ll see these standard service  
measurements: Total Packet Loss, % Packet Loss, Audio Packet Loss,  
Video Packet Loss, Audio Jitter, and Video Jitter.  
Terminate an Active Conference  
To terminate an active conference  
1
2
3
Go to Conference > Ongoing.  
Select the conference of interest and click Terminate  
Click Terminate to confirm the termination.  
.
Delete a Conference  
Users can delete future or past conferences. Users cannot delete active  
conferences.  
To delete a conference  
1
2
Go to Conference > Future.  
To delete a past conference, select the appropriate filter (such as  
Yesterday Plus).  
3
4
Select the conference of interest and click Delete  
.
If you select a recurring conference, a dialog box appears asking you if  
you want to delete just the conference you selected or all conferences in  
the series. Make the appropriate choice. Active conferences in the series  
cannot be deleted.  
Polycom, Inc.  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
5
Click Delete to confirm the deletion.  
The conference is deleted. For future conferences, the system E-mails the  
change to the conference owner and participants and releases the  
participant and room resources.  
80  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8
Conference and Participant Details  
This chapter lists the conference and participant detail fields for reference. It  
includes:  
Conference Image  
The Conference Image section displays the selected participant’s video.  
Shuffle to shuffle to the next participant’s video  
Conference Details  
The Conference Details section has these fields.  
Section  
Description  
Owner  
The name of the person who created the conference.  
Schedulers only see the conferences they own.  
Not applicable for ad hoc conferences.  
Start Date/Time  
For a scheduled conference, the start date and time of the  
conference and the time difference between the local time and  
the standard time.  
For an unscheduled conference, the date and time the  
conference started.  
Polycom, Inc.  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Section  
Description  
Duration  
For a scheduled conference, how long the conference is  
scheduled to last.  
For a completed conference, how long the conference actually  
lasted.  
End Date/Time  
Type  
The date and time the conference ended  
The type of conference. Possible values include:  
Audio  
Audio-Video  
Status  
The state of the conference. Possible values include:  
Active  
Finished  
Future  
Declined  
Recurring  
Whether or not the conference was scheduled as a recurring  
conference  
Connection  
Connection information about the conference. Possible values  
include:  
Multipoint  
Point To Point  
Gateway  
Bit Rate  
The rate (in kbps) at which to transfer the conference audio or  
video data  
Schedule ID  
System-assigned ID used for troubleshooting  
System-assigned ID used for troubleshooting  
Conf Monitoring  
ID  
Video Layout  
The video layout for the conference: Video Switching or  
Continuous.  
Video Format  
For a conference hosted on an MCU, the video format of the  
conference data stream. Possible values include:  
Auto  
CIF  
VGA  
SVGA  
XGA  
QCIF  
4CIF  
16CIF  
NTSC  
Video Protocol  
For a conference hosted on an MCU, the video protocol of the  
conference data stream. Possible values include:  
Auto  
H.263  
H.264  
H.261  
82  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Conference and Participant Details  
Section  
Description  
Audio Algorithm  
For a conference hosted on an MCU, the audio compression  
ratio of the conference data stream. Possible values are:  
AUTO  
G.711  
G.722  
Siren 7 (16 kbps)  
Conference Features  
The Conference Features section has these fields.  
Section  
Description  
Conference  
Passcode  
The conference passcode, which is assigned either by the  
system or the scheduler.  
Chairperson  
Option  
Indicates whether or not the conference requires a  
chairperson.  
Note  
The RMX 1000 system does not support the Chairperson  
feature.  
Chairperson  
Passcode  
The passcode the chairperson must enter to take control of  
the conference. Not applicable when no chairperson is  
designated.  
Chairperson  
The name of the chairperson. Not applicable when no  
chairperson is designated.  
Lecture Mode  
The type of Lecture Mode, if any, that was selected when  
the conference was created. Possible values are None,  
Lecture, and Presentation.  
Note  
The RMX 1000 system does not support Lecture Mode.  
Lecturer  
The name of the lecturer. Not applicable when Lecture  
Mode is None.  
Lecture View  
Switching  
Indicates whether or not automatic switching between  
participants is enabled.  
Dual Stream Mode  
Possible values are:  
None  
Duo Video  
Unknown  
People+Content  
Visual Concert PC  
Visual Concert FX  
Polycom, Inc.  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Section  
Description  
T120 Rate  
Possible values are:  
None  
MLP - 62.4  
MLP - 46.4  
MLP - 40  
MLP - 38.4  
MLP - 32  
MLP - 30.4  
MLP - 24  
MLP - 22.4  
MLP - 16  
MLP - 14.4  
MLP - 6.4  
MLP - 4  
HMLP - Var  
HMLP - 384  
HMLP - 320  
HMLP - 256  
HMLP - 192  
HMLP - 128  
HMLP - 6.4  
HMLP - 62.4  
HMLP - 14.4  
MLP - Var  
MLP - 64.4  
End Time Alert  
Entry Tone  
Exit Tone  
Whether or not the system alerts participants to the end of  
the conference by playing an end tone  
Whether or not an entry tone is played to all connected  
participants when a participant joins the conference  
Whether or not an exit tone is played to all connected  
participants when a participant disconnects from the  
conference  
Bridge (MCU) Features  
The Bridge (MCU) Features section, which applies only for conferences that  
use an MCU, has these fields.  
Section  
Description  
MCU Name  
The MCU device name hosting the conference. Not  
applicable when the conference is not being hosted on an  
MCU.  
Numeric ID  
The unique conference identifier assigned by the MCU  
Whether or not the conference has an entry queue enabled  
Entry Queue  
Access  
Note  
The CMA system enables entry queues on a per MGC  
basis and all conferences on an entry queue enabled MGC  
will be scheduled with entry queue access.  
84  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Conference and Participant Details  
Section  
Description  
Meet Me per Conf  
Whether or not the a conference is a Meet Me conference,  
for which a dial-in number is assigned, so that undefined  
participants can connect to the conference  
Conference on Port  
(MGC only) Indicates whether or not the MGC is set to  
Conference on Port, which conserves bandwidth and ports.  
In this case, all participants are on a single video port and  
use the same connection speed and video format.  
Message Service  
Type  
Displays the type of messages participants joining the  
conference hear. Possible values are:  
None  
Welcome (No wait)  
Attended (Wait)  
IVR  
Message Service  
Name  
Name on the MCU of the Message Service. So, for  
example, a service name IVR70 which provides the IVR  
service  
Participants List  
The Participants section has these fields.  
Section  
Name  
Description  
The participant’s name  
Call Info  
How the participant joined the call. Possible values include:  
Video Dial-Out  
Audio Dial-In@<Address>  
Video Dial-In@<Address>  
In Person  
Room Only  
Polycom, Inc.  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Participant Details  
The Participant Details section has these fields.  
Section  
Description  
Name  
Type  
The participant’s name  
The type of conference connection. Possible values  
include:  
Audio Only  
Audio-Video  
Other (for In Person and Room Only participants)  
Endpoint Name  
The name assigned to the participant’s endpoint when  
added to the system  
Connection Status  
The state of the participant’s endpoint connection. Possible  
values include:  
Connected  
Connecting  
Declined  
Disconnected  
Disconnecting  
Error  
Unknown  
Interface Type  
The interface protocol of the participant’s endpoint. Possible  
values include:  
IP  
ISDN  
Number  
Bit Rate  
The IP address or phone number of the participant’s  
endpoint (if a dial-out) or the participant’s port address on  
the MCU (if a dial-in)  
The audio or video data transfer rate (in kbps) of the  
participant’s endpoint  
86  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Conference and Participant Details  
Participant Settings  
The Participant Settings dialog box has these fields.  
Section  
Description  
Name  
The participant’s name.  
Endpoints  
Email  
The participant’s managed endpoint(s) if available.  
The participant’s E-mail address (ASCII only) for  
participants or guests without managed endpoints.  
Type  
The type of participant. Possible values include:  
Domain User  
Local User  
Domain Resource (a room)  
Local Resource (a room)  
Guest  
How will this  
participant join the  
conference?  
How the participant will join the conference. Possible values  
include:  
In Person (requires no dial settings)  
Room Only  
Audio Only (Dial in)  
Use Video  
Bit Rate  
The audio or video data transfer rate (in kbps) of the  
participant’s endpoint.  
Dial Options  
Available only if the participant is joining via a video  
endpoint system. Possible values include:  
Dial-In  
Dial-Out  
Dial Type  
The protocol the audio or video endpoint system uses.  
Select E.164, H323, IP (SiP IRI), or Annex-O. If no dial type  
is selected, it defaults to E.164.  
If you select a Dial Option of Dial-Out for a participant without a managed  
endpoint, the Participant Settings dialog box has these additional fields.  
Section  
Description  
Number  
(H.323 and H.320 dial types) The participant’s phone  
number  
Extension  
The specific dial string for the participant.  
MCU Service  
MCU service defined on the MCUs that the CMA system  
has registered.  
Polycom, Inc.  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Section  
Description  
Country  
(H.320 dial type only) The country to which the system will  
dial out to the participant  
Area/City Code  
(H.320 dial type only) The area code to which the system  
will dial out to the participant  
Use Modified Dial  
Number  
(H.320 dial type only) Click this check box to add a specific  
prefix to the participant’s phone number. The Number field  
becomes active  
Number  
SIP URI  
(H.320 dial type only) The complete modified dial number  
as required to include PBX exit codes, dialing prefixes, or  
other installation-specific dial string requirements.  
SIP dial type only) The SIP URI the MCU must resolve to  
contact the participant.  
88  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9
Endpoint Management Overview  
This chapter provides an overview of the Polycom® Converged Management  
Application™ (CMA®) system’s endpoint management functions. It includes  
these topics:  
Endpoint Menu, Views, and Lists  
The CMA system Endpoint menu provides these views of the Endpoint list:  
Monitor View—Displays the list of all registered and managed endpoints.  
Use this view to monitor and manage endpoints. See “Monitor View” on  
Peripherals View—Displays the list of all peripherals connected to  
managed endpoints. Use this view to see the status of peripherals. See  
Bundled Provisioning—Displays the list of available endpoint  
Automatic Provisioning—Displays the list of dynamically managed  
endpoints eligible for automatic provisioning. See “Automatic  
Scheduled Provisioning—Displays the list of standardly managed  
endpoints eligible for scheduled provisioning. See “Scheduled  
Polycom, Inc.  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Automatic Software Update—Displays the list of dynamically managed  
endpoints eligible for automatic software updates. See “Automatic  
Scheduled Software Update—Displays the list of standardly managed  
endpoints eligible for scheduled software updates. See “Scheduled  
All of the Endpoint views have the following information:  
Section  
Views  
Description  
The views you can access from the page.  
The set of available commands. The constant command in  
Actions  
the Endpoint views is Refresh  
, which updates the  
display with current information.  
Endpoint List  
The context-sensitive Endpoint list for the selected view.  
Device Information  
Information about the endpoint selected in the endpoint list  
including:  
Monitor View  
Use the Endpoint Monitor View to monitor and manage endpoints.  
Endpoint List in the Monitor View  
By default the Endpoint list in the Monitor View displays a list of all  
endpoints that registered automatically with the CMA system gatekeeper and  
endpoints that were added manually for management and monitoring  
purposes.  
90  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Endpoint Management Overview  
The Endpoint list in this view has these fields.  
Field  
Description  
Filter  
Use the filter choices to display other views of the Endpoint  
list, which include:  
Type - Filters the list by type. For more information, see  
Alerts - Filters the list by alert type: Help, Error, or  
Warning.  
Connection Status- Filters the list by connection  
status: In a Call, Online, or Offline.  
Name - Filters the list by system name entered.  
IP Address - Filters the list by IP address entered.  
Dial String- Filters the list by dial string (SIP, H.323, or  
ISDN) entered.  
Site - Filters the list by site location entered.  
Area - (Available only when Areas are enabled.) Filters  
the list by the area with which the endpoint is  
associated.  
VIP - Filters the list for VIP endpoints.  
Status  
The state of the endpoint. Possible values include:  
Online  
Offline  
In a call  
Gatekeeper registered  
Signalling unregistered  
Error  
All paired peripherals are connected without alerts  
One or more paired peripherals are turned off or no  
longer connected  
One or more paired peripherals has an error  
Mode  
The management mode for the endpoint. Possible values  
include:  
Dynamic management mode  
Standard management mode (no icon)  
For a description of these modes, see “Endpoint  
Name  
Model  
The assigned name of the endpoint.  
The type of endpoint. For valid endpoint types, see  
IP Address  
Area  
The IP address assigned to the endpoint.  
(Available only when Areas are enabled.) The area with  
which the endpoint is associated.  
Polycom, Inc.  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
Dial String  
The dial string for the endpoint. If the endpoint has more  
than one dial string, it displays one based on this order:  
SIP  
H.323  
ISDN  
Site  
The site to which the endpoint belongs.  
The user associated with the endpoint.  
Owner  
Actions in the Monitor View  
Besides providing access to the endpoint views, the Actions section of the  
Monitor View may also include these context-sensitive commands depending  
on the selected endpoint type.  
Action  
Use this action to...  
Available for all endpoint types  
Add  
Manually add an endpoint to the CMA system or find a  
endpoint on the network.  
View  
Display all of the Device Details for the selected endpoint.  
Details  
Edit  
Change connection settings for the selected endpoint. Note  
that if this is a managed endpoint, the endpoint may  
overwrite settings entered manually.  
Delete  
Delete the selected endpoints.  
Search Devices  
Search the list of endpoints by IP range. Searching by IP  
range will not include endpoints that are  
dynanmically-managed.  
Available for only selected endpoint types  
Manage  
Open the selected endpoint’s management interface in a  
separate browser window. This command is not available  
for the following endpoint types: iPower, PVX, and Other.  
Send Message  
Send a text message (ASCII only, 100 characters  
maximum) to the selected endpoint’s video monitor. This  
command is not available for the following endpoint types:  
TANDBERG, iPower, and Other.  
Clear Help  
Clear help for the selected endpoint on the CMA system.  
92  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint Management Overview  
Action  
Use this action to...  
Reboot Device  
Reboot the selected endpoint. This command is only  
available for HDX-Series, RealPresence Group Series,  
V-Series and VSX-Series endpoints with a Connection  
Status of Online.  
Search Devices  
Allows you to seach for endpoints within a range of IP  
addresses. The results message displays the number of  
endpoints searched and the number of endpoints found  
within the IP range.  
Manage Owner  
View Peripherals  
Edit information for the user (owner) of the selected  
endpoint. This command is applicable only when a user is  
associated with the endpoint.  
View information about peripherals. This command is only  
available when one or more peripherals is connected to an  
HDX-Series or RealPresence Group Series endpoint.  
Associate User  
Associate Area  
Manually associate a user with the selected endpoint.  
(Available only when Areas are enabled.) Associate the  
selected endpoint to an area so that only specified users  
can manage it.  
For information about these endpoint actions, see “Endpoint and Peripheral  
Peripherals View  
Use the Peripherals View to monitor peripherals connected to dynamically  
managed endpoints.  
Peripherals List in the Peripherals View  
By default, the Peripherals list displays a list of all peripherals that are  
connected or have been connected to endpoints managed by the CMA system.  
Polycom, Inc.  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
The Peripherals list in this view has these fields.  
Field  
Description  
Filter  
Use the filter choices to display other views of the Endpoint  
list, which include:  
Type - Filters the list by type. For more information, see  
Paired Endpoint- Filters the list by the HDX or  
RealPresence Group Series to which the peripherals are  
connected.  
IP Address - Filters the list by IP address entered.  
Hardware Version - Filters the list by hardware version  
entered.  
Software Version - Filters the list by software version  
entered.  
Status  
The state of the peripheral. Possible values include:  
Connected  
- Peripheral is connected to the endpoint.  
Disconnected  
- Peripheral is turned off or no longer  
connected to the endpoint.  
Error  
- Endpoint reports an error with the peripheral.  
Blank - Endpoint is not reporting that the peripheral is  
connected.  
Paired Endpoint  
Name of the endpoint to which the peripheral is connected or  
Not Paired. The Not Paired designation means the  
peripheral was connected to an endpoint, but it is not  
connected to one now.  
Type  
The type of peripheral.  
Serial Number  
IP Address  
Area  
The serial number of the peripheral.  
The IP address assigned to the peripheral, if applicable.  
(Available only when Areas are enabled.) The area with  
which peripheral is associated. The peripheral inherits its  
area from the endpoint to which the peripheral is connected.  
Hardware Version  
Software Version  
The hardware version of the peripheral.  
The software version of the peripheral.  
Actions in the Peripheral View  
Besides providing access to the peripherals, the Actions section of the  
Peripheral View may also include these context-sensitive commands  
depending on the selected peripheral type and its status.  
94  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint Management Overview  
Action  
Use this action to...  
Delete Peripheral  
(Available only when the peripheral is no longer paired with  
an endpoint.) Delete the peripheral from the Peripheral  
View list.  
Display  
Applications  
(Available only for peripherals on which you can install  
multiple applications.) Display a list of installed applications  
and their version.  
Bundled Provisioning View  
Use the Bundled Provisioning View to see the list of provisioning bundles  
available to dynamically managed HDX andRealPresence Group Series  
systems.  
Endpoint List in the Bundled Provisioning View  
By default, the Bundled Provisioning View displays the list of provisioning  
bundles available for use by dynamically-managed HDX or RealPresence  
Group Series systems.  
The bundle list in the Bundled Provisioning View has the following  
information.  
Field  
Description  
Filter  
The filter choices for provisioning bundles that have been  
downloaded to the system. Possible values include:  
Name—Filters by the name of the provisioning bundle.  
Model—Filters by the endpoint type.  
Creation Date—Filters by the date the provisioning bundle was  
downloaded and created on the system.  
Description—Filters by the description of the provisioning  
bundle.  
Name  
Model  
The name assigned to the provisioning bundle when it was  
downloaded and created on the system.  
The exact type of endpoint to which the provisioning bundle applies  
as defined when it was downloaded and created on the system.  
Creation  
Date  
The date the provisioning bundle was downloaded and created on  
the system.  
Description  
The description assigned to the provisioning bundle when it was  
downloaded and created on the system.  
Polycom, Inc.  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Actions in the Bundled Provisioning View  
The Actions section of the Bundled Provisioning View may include these  
context-sensitive commands.  
Action  
Use this action to...  
Download  
Create a new provisioning bundle by downloading the  
bundle from an HDX or RealPresence Group Series system  
on the network.  
Delete  
Delete the selected bundled from the bundle list.  
Automatic Provisioning View  
Use the Automatic Provisioning View to see the list of endpoints that are  
registered to the system for automatic provisioning.  
Endpoint List in the Automatic Provisioning View  
By default the endpoint list in the Automatic Provisioning View displays the  
list of Polycom HDX and RealPresence Group Series system endpoints  
registered to the CMA system for automatic provisioning.  
The endpoint list in the Automatic Provisioning View has the following  
information.  
Field  
Description  
Filter  
The filter choice for endpoint types that can be automatically  
provisioned. Possible values include:  
All—Displays all dynamically managed endpoint systems  
registered to the system.  
HDX Series—Displays just the HDX endpoints registered to the  
system and deployed in dynamic management mode.  
CMA Desktop—Displays just the CMA Desktop clients  
registered to the system.  
VVX—Displays just the VVX systems registered to the system.  
RealPresence Mobile-—Displays just the RealPresence  
Mobile clients registered to the system.  
RealPresence Group Series -—Displays just the  
RealPresence Group Series endpoints registered to the system.  
RealPresence Desktop-—Displays just the registered  
RealPresence Desktop clients registered to the system.  
96  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Endpoint Management Overview  
Field  
Description  
Status  
The status of the endpoint’s last provisioning process. Possible  
values include:  
Success  
Failed  
Clear  
Name  
Type  
The assigned name of the endpoint.  
Note  
The system assigns Polycom CMA Desktop systems a user name  
of LastName_Firstname_CMADesktop  
.
The type of endpoint. Automatic provisioning is only available for  
the endpoint types listed in this table as Filter selections.  
IP Address  
Area  
The IP address assigned to the endpoint.  
The assigned Area associated with the endpoint, if any.  
The date and time of the endpoint’s last provisioning.  
Last  
Note  
CMA Desktop clients are provisioned at the start of each session.  
Actions in the Automatic Provisioning View  
Because automatic provisioning is managed by the endpoint, there are no  
context-sensitive commands available in the Automatic Provisioning View.  
Scheduled Provisioning View  
Use the Scheduled Provisioning View to:  
View the list of endpoints that are eligible for scheduled provisioning  
Schedule one or more endpoints for provisioning  
Cancel a scheduled provisioning  
Endpoint List in the Scheduled Provisioning View  
By default, the endpoint list in the Scheduled Provisioning View displays the  
list of Polycom HDX system endpoints registered to the CMA system that are  
eligible for scheduled provisioning.  
The Endpoint list in this view has the following information.  
Polycom, Inc.  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
Filter  
The filter choice for endpoint types that can be  
scheduled for provisioning. Possible values include:  
HDX Series—Displays the Polycom HDX systems  
operating in standard management mode.  
LifeSize®  
QDX Series  
TANDBERG T150  
TANDBERG C-Series  
TANDBERG MXP  
V and VSX Series  
Viewstation  
Viewstation FX & EX  
Status  
The status of the endpoint’s last provisioning process.  
Possible values include:  
Success  
Pending  
Failed  
Clear  
Name  
Type  
The system name of the endpoint.  
The type of endpoint. Scheduled provisioning is only  
available for the endpoints types listed in this table as  
Filter selections.  
IP Address  
Last  
The IP address assigned to the endpoint.  
The date and time of the endpoint’s last provisioning,  
unless its status has been cleared.  
Pending  
When the endpoint is scheduled for provisioning, this  
field shows the provisioning profile to be used for the  
scheduled provisioning process.  
Scheduled  
When the endpoint is scheduled for provisioning, this  
field shows the date and time for the next scheduled  
provisioning process.  
Actions in the Scheduled Provisioning View  
Besides providing access to the endpoint views, the Actions section of the  
Scheduled Provisioning View also includes these commands:  
98  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint Management Overview  
Action  
Use this action to...  
Provision  
Schedule provisioning for the selected endpoint(s).  
Cancel a previously scheduled provisioning operation.  
Cancel Provision  
Clear Status  
Change the status column for a endpoint to the Clear  
state.  
You can perform these operations on multiple endpoints at the same time. To  
select multiple endpoints, hold the control key while you select the endpoints.  
For information about these endpoint actions, see “Endpoint Provisioning  
Automatic Software Update View  
Use the Automatic Software Update View, available from the Endpoint  
menu, to view the list of endpoints that have registered to the system for  
automatic software updates.  
Endpoint List in the Automatic Software Update View  
By default, the Endpoint list in the Automatic Software Update View  
displays all endpoints eligible for automatic software update. It has the  
following information.  
Field  
Description  
Filter  
Filter choices for this view include:  
Type—Filters the list by endpoint type.  
Name—Searches the list by the endpoint’s system  
name.  
IP Address—Searches the endpoint list by IP  
address.  
ISDN Video Number—Searches the endpoint list  
by ISDN video number.  
Dial String— Searches the endpoint list by dial  
string (SIP, H.323, or ISDN).  
Site—Searches the endpoint list by site location.  
Status  
Name  
The status of the endpoint’s last software update.  
Possible values include:  
Success  
Failed  
Clear  
The system name of the endpoint.  
Polycom, Inc.  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
Type  
The type of endpoint. Automatic software update is only  
available for these endpoint types:  
All—Displays all dynamically managed endpoints  
together.  
CMA Desktop—Displays just the Polycom CMA  
Desktop clients.  
HDX Series—Displays just the Polycom HDX  
endpoints deployed in dynamic management mode.  
VVX—Displays just the Polycom VVX systems.  
Group Series—Displays just the Polycom  
RealPresence Group Series endpoints.  
IP Address  
The IP address assigned to the endpoint.  
Current Version  
The version of software installed during the last  
successful software update procedure.  
Actions in the Automatic Software Update View  
Because automatic (pull) software update is managed by the endpoint, there  
are no actions available in the Automatic Software Update View.  
100  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint Management Overview  
Scheduled Software Update View  
Use the Scheduled Software Update View, available from the Endpoint  
menu, to:  
View the list of endpoints that are eligible for a scheduled software update  
Schedule one or more endpoints for a software update  
Cancel a software update.  
Endpoint List in the Scheduled Software Update View  
By default, the Endpoint list in the Scheduled Software Update View  
displays all endpoints eligible for scheduled software update.  
The Endpoint list in the Scheduled Software Update View has the following  
information.  
Field  
Description  
Filter  
Filter choices for this view include:  
Type—Filters the list by endpoint type.  
Name—Searches the list by the endpoint’s system  
name.  
IP Address—Searches the list by endpoint’s IP  
address.  
ISDN Video Number—Searches the list by  
endpoint’s ISDN video number.  
Alias—Searches the list by endpoint’s alias.  
Site—Searches the list by site location.  
Status  
Name  
The status of the endpoint’s last scheduled software  
update. Possible values include:  
Success  
Failed  
Clear  
The system name of the endpoint.  
Polycom, Inc.  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
Model  
The type of endpoint. Scheduled software update is only  
available for these endpoint types:  
HDX Series—Displays the Polycom HDX endpoints  
operating in standard management mode.  
LifeSize®  
QDX Series  
TANDBERG T150  
TANDBERG C-Series  
TANDBERG MXP  
V and VSX Series  
Viewstation  
Viewstation FX & EX  
IP Address  
The IP address assigned to the endpoint.  
Current Version  
The version of software installed during the last  
successful software update procedure.  
Scheduled  
When the endpoint is scheduled for software update,  
this field shows the date and time for the scheduled  
software update process.  
Scheduled Software Update View Actions  
Besides providing access to the endpoint views, the Action section for the  
Scheduled Software Update View will also include these actions:  
Action  
Use this action to...  
Software  
Update  
Schedule software update for the selected endpoints.  
Cancel Update  
Cancel a scheduled or in progress software update  
operation.  
Clear Status  
Change the status column for an endpoint to the Clear state.  
For information about these endpoint actions, see “Endpoint Software Update  
102  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint Management Overview  
Endpoint Types  
The following tables describe the CMA system support for endpoints based on  
endpoint type and category of support. See the Polycom CMA System Release  
Notes for more information on tested and supported endpoint versions.  
Polycom Endpoint  
Types  
CMA Desktop  
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
HDX Series (dynamic  
management mode)  
HDX Series (standard  
management mode)  
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
VVX Series  
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
N
ViewStation Series  
ViewStation FX and EX  
Series  
V and VSX Series  
QDX Series  
PVX  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
Y
RealPresence Group  
Series  
RealPresence Desktop  
RealPresence Mobile  
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
a. Dynamic Management and Standard Management are mutually exclusive functionality.  
b. Scheduling (Dial In Only) and Scheduling (Dial In and Dial Out) are presented as mutually  
exclusive functionality. Some endpoints, such as Polycom VVX systems do not have  
interfaces that can be ask to perform dialing. Some endpoints, such as CMA Desktop  
clients and VVX systems require external MCU resources for dial-in conferences.  
c. Standard CMA monitoring does not involve using SNMP. It includes endpoint monitoring  
(online/offline status) and alerts.  
d. Command and Control means the CMA system can send a command like Send Message  
and Reboot, and the endpoint can receive and act on the command.  
Polycom, Inc.  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
e. Reports for IP Calls are generated as part of standard gatekeeper functionality. Reports  
for ISDN Calls are additional system functionality. Endpoints that aren't registered with  
the gatekeeper or ISDN calls send an alert to the device management function to record  
CDR information. Some legacy endpoints do not send this alert so the CDRs are not  
written.  
f. Supported behind a Polycom VBP device with Access Proxy enabled.  
Endpoint Type  
TANDBERG 150 MXP  
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
TANDBERG  
990/880/770 MXP  
TANDBERG C Series  
and Other TANDBERG  
Models  
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
LifeSize Team and  
Express 200  
Other LifeSize Models  
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
Other third-party  
endpoints:  
Sony PCS  
Aertha Maia Starr  
VCON  
(Galaxy and Vigo)  
VTEL  
a. Dynamic Management and Standard Management are mutually exclusive  
functionality.  
b. Scheduling (Dial In Only) and Scheduling (Dial In and Dial Out) are presented as  
mutually exclusive functionality.  
c. Standard CMA monitoring does not involve using SNMP. It includes endpoint  
monitoring (online/offline status) and alerts.  
d. Command and Control means the CMA system can send a Reboot command, and  
the endpoint can receive and act on the command.  
e. Reports for IP Calls are generated as part of standard gatekeeper functionality.  
104  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint Management Overview  
Some notes about the TANDBERG connection to the Global Address Book:  
TANDBERG endpoints do not need to register with the CMA system  
gatekeeper to access the Global Address Book.  
Even if the Global Address Book is password protected, TANDBERG  
endpoints are not required to provide a password. They have unrestricted  
access to the Global Address Book.  
Any third-party endpoint, including TANDBERG endpoints, that are  
registered to the CMA system gatekeeper are displayed in the Global  
Address Book. In this case, endpoints are not filtered out based on  
capability.  
A CMA system may also list an endpoint type of Other. The CMA system  
cannot manage endpoints with a type of Other and cannot direct these  
endpoints to initiate point-to-point calls. A scheduled point-to-point call  
between two endpoint systems with an endpoint type of Other requires the  
use of an MCU.  
Note  
The Polycom RealPresence Mobility and Telepresence M100 systems register as  
endpoint type of Other. As such, the CMA can schedule and perform limited  
monitoring of these systems.  
Endpoint Configuration/Provisioning  
Polycom endpoint systems can be configured in three ways:  
In the room by using the system’s remote control to navigate the screens  
and enter information.  
From a remote location by using the system’s web interface to navigate the  
screens and enter information.  
From a remote location by using a management system’s web interface to  
provision configuration settings to the endpoint system. The CMA system  
is a management system that provisions configuration settings.  
The CMA system can provision several types of endpoints. Endpoint  
provisioning, which requires provisioning profiles, allows an administrator to  
remotely configure multiple endpoints of the same type with a standard set of  
settings. This eliminates the need to configure each endpoint individually  
either through the hand-held remote or the endpoint’s web interface.  
The CMA system supports three types of endpoint provisioning: bundled,  
automatic, and scheduled. Enable endpoints for only one type of provisioning.  
Note  
Polycom recommends that all endpoints in a region (that is, a gatekeeper zone) be  
managed by a single management system.  
Polycom, Inc.  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
For more information, see:  
Provisioning Best Practices  
To use the available provisioning options most effectively, we recommend the  
following:  
1
For each site in the CMA system, configure the site provisioning details as  
needed for each site. See “Add a Site” on page 465.  
2
On each HDX and RealPresence Group Series endpoint, configure the  
system settings that are available in bundled provisioning for that model.  
Then download the provisioning bundle for each HDX and RealPresence  
Group Series endpoint to the CMA system. See “Bundled Provisioning”  
3
If you need unique provisioning settings for one or more groups of users,  
create automatic provisioning profiles with those settings and apply them  
to the appropriate groups. See “Automatic Provisioning” on page 107  
For example, you may want to set a higher bit rate for the executives of  
your organization or for conference rooms used for large video  
conferences. You can create a group for these users/rooms and give that  
group an automatic provisioning profile with a higher bit rate.  
Bundled Provisioning  
The CMA system supports a Bundled Provisioning model for dynamically  
managed HDX and RealPresence Group Series endpoints. With Bundled  
Provisioning, a CMA system administrator can download a provisioning  
bundle from any already configured HDX and RealPresence Group Series  
endpoints. Any dynamically-managed HDX and RealPresence Group Series  
endpoints of the same model will receive the provisioning bundle when it next  
polls the CMA system for new provisioning information.  
Note  
Some configuration settings on dynamically managed endpoints that the CMA  
system provisions are associated with the site where the endpoint system is  
located. Site provisioning takes precedence.  
Bundled provisioning provides businesses with an efficient and effective way  
to provision HDX and RealPresence Group Series endpoints consistently  
across each model. HDX and RealPresence Group Series endpoint users with  
106  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Endpoint Management Overview  
administrative rights can still change the settings on an HDX and RealPresence  
Group Series endpoint after the provisioning bundle is applied. However, if a  
newer bundle is sent by the CMA system, it will overwrite the user’s changes.  
The HDX and RealPresence Group Series system parameters that may be  
provisioned in a bundle are limited to the following types:  
Camera configuration settings  
Monitor configuration settings  
Microphone configuration settings  
Security settings  
Home screen settings  
How Bundled Provisioning Works  
In dynamic management mode, when an HDX and a RealPresence Group  
Series system starts up and at designated intervals thereafter, it automatically  
polls for new provisioning information from the CMA system. If a  
provisioning bundle exists on the CMA system that matches the model of the  
polling HDX or RealPresence Group Series endpoint, the provisioning bundle  
is sent over a secure HTTPS connection.  
Endpoints do not poll for provisioning information if they are in a call. They  
restart polling after the call ends.  
Provisioning information is applied in the following order:  
1
2
Bundled provisioning, if a bundle exists for the same model.  
Automatic provisioning profile, if the endpoint is part of a group  
assigned a profile.  
3
Site provisioning, which takes precedence.  
For information about how to download a provisioning profile, see  
Automatic Provisioning  
The CMA system is a gatekeeper; it manages video and audio endpoints.  
However, the system also manages users, because endpoints are only useful  
when they provide access to users.  
Automatic provisioning, which controls the automatic configuration of  
dynamically managed endpoints and the management of its video resources,  
is also tied to users and groups. That’s because some users and groups may  
require significantly more video resources than others.  
Polycom, Inc.  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Note  
Some settings on dynamically managed endpoints that the CMA system provisions  
are associated with the site where the endpoint system is located. Site provisioning  
takes precedence.  
Currently, automatic provisioning is available for:  
Polycom VVX systems deployed in dynamic management mode  
Polycom HDX systems deployed in dynamic management mode  
Polycom RealPresence Group Series systems  
RealPresence Desktop clients  
RealPresence Mobile clients  
Polycom CMA Desktop clients  
Note  
Polycom CMA Desktop provisioning occurs on a session by session basis.  
How Automatic Provisioning Works  
In dynamic management mode, when an endpoint starts up and at designated  
intervals thereafter, it automatically polls for new provisioning information  
from the CMA system. The provisioning information is sent in XML format  
over a secure HTTPS connection.  
Endpoints do not poll for provisioning information if they are in a call. They  
restart polling after the call ends.  
When you add an automatic provisioning profile, the CMA system  
immediately rolls it out. If it rolls it out first thing in the morning, people who  
need to attend a “start the day” conference will have to first wait for their  
endpoint to be provisioned. Better to implement profiles in the middle of the  
work day and then let the provisioning occur at the designated polling  
interval.  
Provisioning information is applied in the following order:  
1
2
Bundled provisioning, if one exists for the same model.  
Automatic provisioning profile, if the endpoint is part of a group  
assigned a profile.  
3
Site provisioning, which takes precedence.  
108  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint Management Overview  
Automatic Provisioning Profiles  
Automatic provisioning is enabled at the endpoint, but the CMA system must  
have automatic provisioning profiles for both the endpoint and the site at  
which the endpoint resides. So to ensure out-of-box usability, the CMA system  
comes with Default Provisioning Profiles for both. However, you can edit  
these default profiles to meet your needs or add additional provisioning  
profiles to assign different video resources to different groups of users.  
Notes  
If an automatic provisioning profile provisions a setting that the endpoint is not  
capable of fulfilling, the endpoint will ignore those settings.  
The name of the Default Provisioning Profile is stored in the system database  
and is not localized into other languages. If you wish to localized it into your  
language, edit the profile and give it a new profile name.  
For information about how to add an automatic provisioning profile, see “Add  
The following table shows the fields you can configure when adding a new  
automatic provisioning profile. You may find more implementation details  
about these fields in the endpoint system documentation.  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
System Settings  
Language  
Specifies the language for the video endpoint system’s  
user interface. Possible values include: English,  
German, Spanish, French, and Chinese (Simplified  
Chinese only).  
Allow Access to User  
Setup  
Specifies whether the User Settings screen is  
accessible to users via the System screen. Select this  
option to allow endpoint system users to change limited  
environmental settings.  
Allow Directory  
Changes  
Specifies whether endpoint system users can save  
changes they make to the directory on contacts/favorites  
list.  
Call Detail Report  
Specifies whether to collect call data for the Call Detail  
Report and Recent Calls list. When selected,  
information about calls can be viewed through the  
endpoint system’s web interface and downloaded as a  
.csvfile.  
Note  
If this setting is disabled, applications such as the CMA  
system or the Polycom Global Management System™  
will not be able to retrieve Call Detail Report (CDR)  
records.  
Polycom, Inc.  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
Maximum Time in Call  
(minutes)  
Specifies the maximum number of minutes allowed for a  
call. Enter 0 to remove any limit.  
Recent Calls  
Specifies whether to display the Recent Calls button on  
the home screen. The Recent Calls screen lists the site  
number or name, the date and time, and whether the  
call was incoming or outgoing.  
Note  
If the Call Detail Report option is not selected, the  
Recent Calls option is not available.  
Screen Saver Wait  
Time  
Specifies how long the system remains awake during  
periods of inactivity. The default is 3 minutes. If the  
system requires users to log in, the screen saver timeout  
also logs out the current user.  
Setting this option to Off prevents the system from going  
to sleep. To prevent image burn-in, specify 3 minutes or  
less.  
Directory Search Mode  
Specifies how endpoint directory searches are initiated  
by the endpoint user. Possible values are:  
Automatic—The search is executed after the user  
stops entering characters.  
Manual—The search is executed only when the user  
explicitly clicks the Search button.  
Home Screen Settings  
Display Contact List as  
Home Screen  
Specifies whether or not to display the contact list as the  
entry screen.  
Display H.323  
Extension  
Lets users placing a gateway call enter the H.323  
extension separately from the gateway ID.  
If you do not select this setting, endpoint system users  
make gateway calls by entering the call information in  
this format:  
gateway ID + ## + extension  
Enable Availability  
Control  
When enabled, lets users set their availability in the  
endpoint system’s local user interface.  
H.323 Settings  
Maximum Speed for  
Receiving Calls (kbps)  
Allows you to restrict the bandwidth used when  
receiving calls.  
If the far site attempts to call the endpoint system at a  
higher speed than selected here, the call is  
re-negotiated at the speed specified in this field.  
110  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
Preferred Speed for  
Placing Calls (kbps)  
Determines the speeds that will be used for calls from  
this endpoint system when:  
The Call Quality selection is either unavailable or  
set to Auto on the Place a Call screen  
The call is placed from the directory  
If the far-site endpoint system does not support the  
selected speed, the endpoint system automatically  
negotiates a lower speed.  
Call Settings  
Preferred Dialing  
Method  
Specifies the preferred method for dialing various call  
types.  
If set to Auto, calls use the configured dialing order.  
If set to Manual, the endpoint systems will prompt  
the user to select the call type from a list when  
placing a call.  
Audio Settings  
Mute Auto Answer  
Calls  
Specifies whether or not to automatically mute incoming  
calls.  
CMA Desktop Settings  
Allow IM/Chat  
When enabled, specifies that the Polycom CMA  
Desktop client can initiate instant messaging.  
Enable Screen Saver  
When in Call  
Calendaring Settings  
Enable Calendaring  
When enabled, specifies that the CMA system will  
provision the endpoint for Polycom Conferencing for  
Outlook. This includes provisioning the Microsoft  
Exchange server and calendaring settings for the  
endpoint system.  
Alert Tone  
When enabled, specifies that an endpoint system  
provisioned for Polycom Conferencing for Outlook will  
play a sound along with the meeting reminder. In this  
case, the endpoint will only play a sound when the  
system is not in a call.  
Display Private Meeting When enabled, specifies that an endpoint system  
provisioned for Polycom Conferencing for Outlook will  
display details about meetings marked private.  
Meeting Reminder  
Time  
Specifies the number of minutes before the meeting an  
endpoint system provisioned for Polycom Conferencing  
for Outlook will display a reminder.  
Polycom, Inc.  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
Microsoft Lync Settings  
Select method to find  
Server  
Specifies how the CMA system will locate the Lync  
server that it will provision to endpoints. Possible values  
are:  
Disable Integration—The CMA system will not  
provision a Lync or Office Communication Server.  
DNS SRV Record—The CMA system will issue a  
DNS query to locate the Lync or Office  
Communication Server and provision that  
information to endpoints.  
Server Name—The CMA system will use the  
specified Server Address. Enter the Lync or Office  
Communication Server address or DNS name.  
Transport Protocol  
Specifies the transport protocol for communications with  
the Office Communications Server. Possible values are:  
Auto—The communication protocol will be  
auto-negotiated.  
TCP—This protocol has error-recovery services,  
message delivery is assured, and messages are  
delivered in the order they were sent.  
UDP—This protocol does not provide error-recovery  
services, message delivery is not assured, and  
messages are not necessarily delivered in the order  
they were sent.  
TLS—This protocol transfers communications over an  
encrypted Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) or Transport  
Layer Security (TLS) connection.  
Group Name  
Specifies the group name for which the endpoint system  
should be provisioned.  
VVX Settings  
Configuration Server  
URL  
Specifies the IP address for the system that will provide  
provisioning service. All addresses can be followed by  
an optional directory and optional filename.  
Logging Server URL  
Configuration Data  
Specifies the directory to use for log files, if required.  
A URL can also be specified. This field is blank by  
default.  
Enter XML data for a custom configuration. Allows the  
CMA system administrators to provision settings that the  
CMA system does not normally provide.  
112  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Profile Order and Priority  
Automatic provisioning profiles are associated with groups, but what about  
those users who belong to more than one group—what determines their  
experience? When you add new profiles, you assign a Profile Order. The  
Profile Order determines which provisioning profile takes priority.  
Consider the following example:  
Jason Smith is part of the Support group and also part of the Executive  
group.  
The Support group is assigned an automatic provisioning profile named  
Low-Bandwidth, which allows a maximum speed for receiving calls of  
128kbps.  
The Executive group is assigned an automatic provisioning profile called  
High-Bandwidth, which allows a maximum speed for receiving calls of  
1920kbps  
The Low-Bandwidth profile is assigned a profile order of 1, while the  
High-Bandwith profile is assigned a profile order of 2.  
In this example, Jason’s endpoint is provisioned with the Low-Bandwidth  
provisioning profile, because it has the higher priority.  
So when you add provisioning profiles, you may want to assign provisioning  
profiles with more robust privileges a higher priority than those providing less  
privileges.  
Scheduled Provisioning  
Scheduled provisioning is enabled at the CMA system. To schedule an  
endpoint for provisioning, the CMA system must already have a scheduled  
provisioning profile created for the endpoint.  
How Scheduled Provisioning Works  
In this standard management mode, administrators with System Setup  
permissions can schedule provisioning for one endpoint or a group of  
endpoints; and they can schedule provisioning to occur immediately or for a  
date and time in the future. The provisioning data is sent in XML format over  
a secure HTTPS connection.  
Scheduled provisioning is available for these endpoint types:  
ViewStation endpoints  
ViewStation FX & EX endpoints  
V and VSX Series endpoints  
Selected TANDBERG endpoints—TANDBERG 150, 990, 880, and 770  
endpoints  
Polycom, Inc.  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
HDX Series--Polycom HDX systems deployed in standard management  
mode  
Scheduled Provisioning Profiles  
The CMA system does not include a default profile for scheduled  
provisioning. You must create a profile before you can schedule a endpoint for  
provisioning. Create a different profile for each endpoint type (Polycom HDX  
system or Polycom CMA Desktop) and group of users.  
Some examples of when to use scheduled provisioning profiles follow.  
To apply a standard set of options to each new endpoint  
By creating templates of standard settings for different types of endpoints,  
or for the needs of different users, you can have the CMA system apply all  
the settings at once. After the endpoint is connected and registered with  
the CMA system, you can use a provisioning profile that defines a range  
of other options.  
To update the password for all endpoints of a particular type  
For security purposes, you can create a provisioning profile to update the  
password for endpoints on a regular basis and reuse the same profile  
quarterly. You might have several profiles, one for each type of endpoint  
to update.  
To change the IP address of the CMA system gatekeeper when the CMA  
system is moved  
For information about how to add a scheduled provisioning profile, see “Add  
Scheduled Provisioning of Polycom Endpoints  
The following table show the fields you can provision when adding a new  
scheduled provisioning profile for the supported Polycom endpoints.  
.
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
General Settings > System Settings > System Settings 1  
Maximum Time in Call  
(minutes)  
Specifies the maximum number of minutes allowed for a  
call. Enter 0 to remove any limit.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Allow Mixed IP and  
ISDN calls  
Specifies whether users can make multipoint calls that  
include both IP and H.320 sites.  
Y
Y
Y
Auto Answer  
Point-to-Point Calls  
Specifies whether to set the endpoint system to answer  
incoming point-to-point calls automatically.  
114  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Endpoint Management Overview  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
Auto Answer Multipoint  
Calls  
Specifies whether to set the endpoint system to answer  
incoming multipoint calls automatically.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Allow Dialing  
Allow users to place calls. You can still place calls from  
the web interface.  
Y
Y
Y
Allow Directory  
Changes  
Specifies whether users can save changes to the  
directory or contacts/favorites list.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Confirm Directory  
Additions Upon Call  
Disconnect  
Specifies whether users are prompted to confirm  
deletions of directory entries.  
Y
Y
Confirm Directory  
Deletions  
Specifies whether users are prompted to confirm new  
directory entries when saving the information for the last  
site called.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Allow Access to User  
Setup  
Specifies whether the User Settings screen is accessible  
to users via the System screen.  
Select this option to allow users to change limited  
environmental settings.  
General Settings > System Settings > System Settings 2  
Far Site Name Display  
Specifies how long the far site name to appear on the  
Y
Y
Y
screen when the call is first connected.  
Display Time in Call  
Displays time that the current call has been connected  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Keypad Audio  
Confirmation  
Allows the user to hear a voice confirmation of the  
numbers selected with the remote control.  
Call Detail Report  
Recent Calls  
Collects call data.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Provides navigational tool for call history.  
Y
Y
Display IP and ISDN  
Information  
Both – Displays both number types on the system’s  
Home screen.  
IP only – Display the system IP number on the Home  
screen.  
ISDN only – Displays the system ISDN number on the  
Home screen.  
None – The system will not display contact numbers  
on the Home screen.  
Show Speed Dial  
Color Scheme  
Allow the user to disable the Speed Dial page and go  
directly to the Address Book.  
Y
Y
Y
Enables the customization of the look of the system with  
five different color schemes.  
Polycom, Inc.  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
Screen Saver Wait  
Time  
The time the system will delay before going into standby  
mode after nonuse  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
General Settings > Home Screen Settings > Home Screen Settings 1  
Dialing Display  
Dialing entry field - Includes the dialing entry field on the  
Home screen.  
Y
Y
Display Marquee - Allows the addition of text to the dialing  
entry field of the Home screen.  
Enter Marquee Text  
Call Quality  
Enter the Marquee text that will appear in the “Dialing  
entry field” when Display Marquee is selected.  
Y
Y
Allow users to select the speed/bandwidth of the call.  
Displays the IP dialing extension on the main call screen  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Display H.323  
Extension  
Directory  
System  
Includes the Directory button on the Home screen.  
Includes the System button on the Home screen.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Multipoint  
Includes the Multipoint navigational item on the Home  
screen.  
General Settings > Home Screen Settings > Home Screen Settings 2  
System Name  
Enable when the system name is to be displayed on the  
Home Screen.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
IP or ISDN Information  
Both – Displays both number types on the system’s  
Home screen.  
IP only – Display the system IP number on the Home  
screen.  
ISDN only – Displays the system ISDN number on the  
Home screen.  
None – The system will not display contact numbers  
on the Home screen.  
Local Date and Time  
Displays the local time on the Home screen.  
Displays availability icons on the Home screen.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Enable Availability  
Control  
Sites  
Displays icons created for frequently called sites on the  
Home screen.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Last Number Dialed  
Displays the last number dialed on the Home screen.  
116  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
General Settings > Security  
Remote Access  
Password  
Specifies the password for administrator access when  
logging in to the system remotely.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
When the remote access password is set, users must  
enter it to manage the system from a computer. The  
remote access password must not contain spaces.  
Meeting Password  
Specifies the password users must supply to join  
multipoint calls on this system if the call uses the internal  
multipoint option, rather than a bridge.  
The meeting password must not contain spaces.  
Do not set a meeting password if multipoint calls will  
include audio-only endpoints. Audio-only endpoints  
cannot participate in password-protected calls.  
Software Update  
Password  
Specifies the password users must enter to update the  
software on their endpoint system.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Enable FTP Access  
Enable Web Access  
Enable Telnet Access  
Specifies that the endpoint system can be accessed via  
an FTP session.  
Y
Y
Y
Note: The system restarts if you change the remote  
access settings. This setting does not deactivate the  
associated port, only the application. Use Web Access  
Port to disable the port.  
Specifies that the endpoint system can be accessed via  
its web interface.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Note: The system restarts if you change the remote  
access settings. This setting does not deactivate the  
associated port, only the application. Use Web Access  
Port to disable the port.  
Specifies that the endpoint system can be accessed via a  
telnet session.  
Note: The system restarts if you change the remote  
access settings. This setting does not deactivate the  
associated port, only the application. Use Web Access  
Port to disable the port.  
Polycom, Inc.  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
AES Encryption  
Specifies how to encrypt calls with other sites that support  
AES encryption.  
Y
Y
Y
Off—AES Encryption is disabled.  
When Available—AES Encryption is used with any  
endpoint that supports it, even if the other endpoints in  
the call don’t support it.  
Required for Video Calls Only—AES Encryption is  
used for all video endpoints in the call. Analog phone  
and voice over ISDN connections are allowed. Video  
endpoints must support AES Encryption to participate  
in the call.  
Required for All Calls—AES Encryption is used for all  
video endpoints in the call. Analog phone and voice  
over ISDN connections are not allowed. All endpoints  
must support AES Encryption to participate in the call.  
Enable SNMP Access  
Specifies that the endpoint system can be accessed via  
an SNMP monitoring system.  
Y
Y
Note: The system restarts if you change the remote  
access settings. This setting does not deactivate the  
associated port, only the application. Use Web Access  
Port to disable the port.  
General Settings > Date and Time 1  
Date Format  
Time Format  
Month  
Specifies the preferred format preference for the date and  
time display and lets you enter your local date and time.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Day  
Year  
Hour  
Minute  
AM/PM  
Primary Time Server  
Address  
Auto Adjust for Daylight  
Saving Time  
Specifies the daylight savings time setting. When this  
setting is enabled, the system clock automatically  
changes for daylight saving time.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Time Difference from  
GMT  
Specifies the time difference between GMT (Greenwich  
Mean Time) and the endpoint system’s location.  
118  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
Time Server  
Specifies connection to a time server for automatic  
system time settings.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Primary Time Server  
Address  
Specifies the address of the time server to use when Time  
Server is set to Manual.  
Video Network > IP Network > Call Preferences  
Enable IP H.323  
Enable H.239  
Allows the system to make IP calls  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Specifies standards-based People+Content data  
collaboration. Enable this option if you know that H.239 is  
supported by the far sites you will call. If callers  
experience issues when sharing content with other  
Polycom systems, disable this setting.  
Enable Transcoding  
Specifies whether the system allows each far-site system  
to connect at the best possible call rate and audio/video  
algorithm. If transcoding is disabled, the Polycom HDX  
system down-speeds all connections to the same call  
rate.  
Y
Y
ISDN Gateway  
IP Gateway  
Allows users to place IP-to-ISDN calls through a gateway.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Allows users to place ISDN-to-IP or IP-to-IP calls through  
a gateway.  
Video Network > IP Network > Gatekeeper  
Use Gatekeeper Specifies whether to use a gatekeeper. Gateways and  
Y
Y
Y
Y
gatekeepers are required for calls between IP and ISDN.  
Off — Calls do not use a gatekeeper.  
Auto — System attempts to automatically find an  
available gatekeeper.  
Specify — Calls use the specified gatekeeper. Enter  
the gatekeeper’s IP address or name (for example,  
gatekeeper.companyname.usa.com, or 10.11.12.13).  
Gatekeeper IP Address If you chose to use an automatically selected gatekeeper,  
this area displays the gatekeeper’s IP address.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
If you chose to specify a gatekeeper, enter the IP  
address.  
Outbound Call Route  
Choices:  
Gateway  
ISDN  
Polycom, Inc.  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
Use Gatekeeper for  
Multipoint Calls  
Specify whether multipoint calls use the system’s internal  
multipoint capability or the Conference on Demand  
feature.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Send Preferred Alias  
Only to Gatekeeper  
Video Network > IP Network > Gateway Number  
Country Code  
Specifies the country code for the system’s location  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Area Code  
Specifies the area or city code for the system’s location  
Specifies the gateway’s number  
Gateway Number  
Gateway Number Type  
Specifies the number type users enter to call this system:  
Y
Direct Inward Dial — Users enter an internal  
extension to call this system directly.  
Note  
If you choose this setting, you must also register the  
number with the gatekeeper as an E.164 alias.  
Number + Extension — Users enter the gateway  
number and the system’s extension to call this  
system.  
Number of digits in DID  
Number  
Specifies the number of digits in the DID number.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
The national or regional dialing plan for your location  
determines the standard number of digits. For instance,  
the US standard is 7 digits.  
Number of digits in  
Extension  
Specifies the number of digits in the extension used when  
Direct Inward Dial is selected.  
Your organization’s dial plan determines this number.  
Video Network > IP Network > Quality of Service Settings  
Type of Service Field Specifies the service type and the priority of IP packets  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
sent to the system for video, audio, and far-end camera  
control:  
IP Precedence — Represents the priority of IP  
packets sent to the system. The value can be between  
0 and 7.  
DiffServ — Represents a priority level between 0 and  
63. If this setting is selected, enter the value in the  
Type of Service Value field.  
120  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
Video Type of Service  
Value  
Specifies the IP Precedence or Diffserv value for video  
packets. This value does not apply to the CMA Desktop  
system. Its value is set by the client’s operating system.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Audio Type of Service  
Value  
Specifies the IP Precedence or Diffserv value for audio  
packets.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
FECC Type of Service  
Value  
Specifies the IP Precedence or Diffserv value for Far End  
Camera Control packets.  
Enable Dynamic  
Bandwidth  
Specifies whether to let the system automatically find the  
optimum line speed for a call  
Enable PVEC  
Allows the system to use PVEC (Polycom Video  
ErrorConcealment) if packet loss occurs.  
Y
Y
Video Network > IP Network > Firewall Settings  
Use Fixed Ports  
Specifies whether to define the TCP and UDP ports.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
If the firewall is H.323 compatible or the endpoint  
systems are not behind a firewall, disable this setting.  
If the firewall is not H.323 compatible, enable this  
setting. The endpoint systems will assign a range of  
ports starting with the TCP and UDP ports you specify.  
The endpoint system defaults to a range beginning  
with port 3230 for both TCP and UDP.  
Note  
You must open the corresponding ports in the firewall.  
You must also open the firewall’s TCP port 1720 to allow  
H.323 traffic.  
Start TCP Port  
Allows you to specify the beginning value for the range of  
TCP ports used by the endpoint systems. The endpoint  
systems will automatically assign a range of ports starting  
with the port you specify.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Note  
You must also open the firewall’s TCP port 1720 to allow  
H.323 traffic.  
Start UDP Port  
Allows you to specify the beginning value for the range of  
TCP ports used by the endpoint systems. The endpoint  
systems will automatically assign a range of ports starting  
with the port you specify.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
System is Behind a  
NAT  
Specifies whether the endpoint systems are behind a NAT  
firewall.  
Polycom, Inc.  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
NAT Configuration  
Specifies whether the endpoint systems should determine  
the NAT Public WAN Address automatically.  
Y
Y
Y
If the endpoint systems are behind a NAT that allows  
HTTP traffic, select Auto.  
If the endpoint systems are behind a NAT that does  
not allow HTTP traffic, select Manual. Then specify a  
NAT Public (WAN) Address.  
If the endpoint systems are not behind a NAT or are  
connected to the IP network through a virtual private  
network (VPN), select Off.  
NAT Public (WAN)  
Address  
When NAT Configuration is set to Manual, specifies the  
address that callers from outside the LAN should use to  
call the endpoint systems.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
NAT is H.323  
Compatible  
Specifies that the endpoint systems are behind a NAT that  
is capable of translating H.323 traffic.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Auto Discover NAT  
Address  
Specifies whether to allow the system to automatically  
discover the NAT firewall address through the domain  
name server.  
Y
Address Displayed in  
Global Directory  
Specifies whether or not to include the endpoint system’s  
information in the global directory  
Y
Y
Y
Video Network > ISDN BRI Protocol  
Enable ISDN H.320  
Allows this system to make H.320 (ISDN) calls.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Number of ISDN  
Channels to Dial in  
Parallel  
Specifies how many channels to dial at one time. You can  
specify up to eight channels. If you experience network  
problems, decrease the number.  
Set this value to 1 for serial dialing. Serial dialing is not  
recommended unless you have trouble connecting calls  
using parallel dialing.  
ISDN Switch Protocols  
Specifies the protocol used by your network’s switch.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Outside Line Dialing  
Prefix  
Specifies the ISDN dialing prefix used to call outside the  
network.  
122  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
Video Network > Preferred Speeds  
Preferred Speed for  
Placing Calls (Kbps)  
Determines the speeds that will be used for IP, ISDN, or  
International ISDN calls from this endpoint system when:  
Y
Y
Y
Y
The Call Quality selection is either unavailable or set  
IP Calls  
Y
Y
Y
Y
to Auto on the Place a Call screen  
ISDN Video Call  
(H.320)  
The call is placed from the directory  
If the far-site endpoint system does not support the  
selected speed, the endpoint system automatically  
negotiates a lower speed.  
International ISDN calls  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Maximum Speed for  
Receiving Calls (Kbps)  
Allows you to restrict the bandwidth used when receiving  
IP or ISDN calls.  
Y
Y
If the far site attempts to call the system at a higher speed  
than selected here, the call is re-negotiated at the speed  
specified in this field.  
IP Calls  
Y
Y
Y
Y
ISDN Video Call  
(H.320)  
Monitors > Monitors 1  
Number of Monitors  
Monitor 1 Options  
Monitor 1  
Y
Y
Specifies the monitor’s aspect ratio.  
4:3 — Select if you are using a regular TV monitor.  
Video Format  
Specifies the monitor’s format:  
Y
Y
DVI — Select if the monitor is connected to the DVI  
connector using a DVI or HDMI cable.  
VGA — Select if the monitor is connected to the DVI  
connector using a VGA cable.  
Component YPbPr — Select if the monitor is  
connected to the DVI connector using component  
cables. Polycom HDX 8000 series and Polycom HDX  
7000 series systems do not support 720p Component  
format for 50 Hz monitors.  
S-Video (Polycom HDX 9000 series only) — Select if  
the monitor is connected to the BNC connectors using  
an S-Video cable.  
Composite (Polycom HDX 9000 series only) — Select  
if the monitor is connected to the BNC connectors  
using a composite video cable.  
Display Icons in Call  
Specifies whether to display all on-screen graphics,  
including icons and help text, during calls.  
Y
Y
Y
Polycom, Inc.  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
Snapshot Timeout  
Lets you choose whether to have slides and snapshots  
time out after a period of four minutes.  
Y
Y
Y
Dual Monitor Emulation Specifies whether the system can show multiple views on  
a single display.  
Output Upon Screen  
Saver Activation  
Specifies whether black video or no signal is sent to the  
monitor when the system goes to sleep and the screen  
saver activates.  
Y
Y
Select Black to display black video. This is the  
recommended setting to prevent burn-in for TV  
monitors.  
Select No Signal to have the display react as if it is  
not connected when the system goes to sleep. This is  
the recommended setting for VGA monitors and  
projectors.  
VGA Resolution  
Monitor 2 Options  
Monitor 2  
Y
Y
Applies to:  
Y
Y
Specifies the second monitor’s aspect ratio:  
Y
Off — Select if you do not have a second monitor.  
4:3 — Select if you are using a regular TV monitor as  
the second monitor.  
Video Format  
Specifies the monitor’s format:  
Y
Y
DVI — Select if the monitor is connected to the DVI  
connector using a DVI or HDMI cable.  
VGA — Select if the monitor is connected to the DVI  
connector using a VGA cable.  
Component YPbPr — Select if the monitor is  
connected to the DVI connector using component  
cables. Polycom HDX 8000 series and Polycom HDX  
7000 series systems do not support 720p Component  
format for 50 Hz monitors.  
S-Video (Polycom HDX 9000 series only) — Select if  
the monitor is connected to the BNC connectors using  
an S-Video cable.  
Composite (Polycom HDX 9000 series only) — Select  
if the monitor is connected to the BNC connectors  
using a composite video cable.  
124  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
Output Upon Screen  
Saver Activation  
Specifies whether black video or no signal is sent to the  
monitor when the system goes to sleep and the screen  
saver activates.  
Y
Y
Select Black to display black video. This is the  
recommended setting to prevent burn-in for TV  
monitors.  
Select No Signal to have the display react as if it is  
not connected when the system goes to sleep. This is  
the recommended setting for VGA monitors and  
projectors.  
People Display Mode  
Content Display Mode  
Color System  
Y
Y
Y
Monitor 3 Options  
Monitor 3  
Specifies the aspect ratio for recording.  
Y
Off — Select if you do not have a VCR or DVD player  
connected to record video conferences.  
4:3 — Select to record for playback on a standard  
monitor.  
16:9—Select to record for playback on a wide-screen  
monitor, if your recording device has this capability.  
See the endpoint product documentation for more  
information about these selections.  
Video Format  
Specifies the VCR or DVD player’s format:  
Y
S-Video — Select if the VCR or DVD player is  
connected to a Polycom HDX system using an  
S-Video cable.  
Composite — Select if the VCR or DVD player is  
connected to a Polycom HDX system using a  
composite video cable and S-Video to RCA adapter.  
Output Upon Screen  
Saver Activation  
Specifies whether black video or no signal is sent to the  
VCR or DVD player when the system goes to sleep and  
the screen saver activates.  
Y
Select Black to send black video.  
Select No Signal to have the VCR or DVD player  
react as if it is not connected when the system goes to  
sleep.  
Polycom, Inc.  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
VCR/DVD Record  
Source  
Specifies the video source to be recorded to videotape or  
DVD.  
Y
If Far is enabled, the recorded video will switch to the  
current far site speaker.  
Near  
Y
Y
Y
Far  
If both Near and Far are enabled, the recorded video  
will switch between near and far sites depending on  
the current speaker.  
Content  
If Content is enabled, any content sent during the call  
is recorded.  
Screen Saver Wait  
Time  
The time the system will delay before going into standby  
mode after nonuse  
Y
Cameras > Cameras 1  
Camera 1 Name  
Camera 1 Icon  
Specifies a name for camera 1.  
Specifies an icon for camera 1.  
Specifies a name for camera 2.  
Specifies an icon for camera 2.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Camera 2 Name  
Camera 2 Icon  
Cameras > Camera Settings  
Camera 1 Name  
Camera 1 Icon  
Camera 2 Name  
Camera 2 Icon  
Camera 3 Name  
Camera 3 Icon  
Cameras > Video Quality  
Camera 1  
Specifies a name for camera 1.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Specifies an icon for camera 1.  
Specifies a name for camera 2.  
Specifies an icon for camera 2.  
Specifies a name for camera 3.  
Specifies an icon for camera 3.  
Specifies Motion or Sharpness for the video input. The  
default is Sharpness.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Camera 2  
Motion — This setting is for showing people or other  
video with motion.  
Camera 3  
Sharpness — The picture will be sharp and clear, but  
moderate to heavy motion at low call rates can cause  
some frames to be dropped. Sharpness is available in  
point-to-point H.263 and H.264 calls only. It is  
recommended for HD calls between 1 Mbps and 2  
Mbps.  
126  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
Video/Camera > Cameras 1  
Snapshot Camera  
Far Control of Near  
Camera  
Specifies whether the far site can pan, tilt, or zoom the  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
near-site camera. When this option is selected, a user at  
the far site can control the framing and angle of the  
camera for the best view of the near site.  
Backlight  
Compensation  
Specifies whether the camera should automatically adjust  
for a bright background. Backlight compensation is best  
used in situations where the subject appears darker than  
the background.  
Primary Camera  
Camera Direction  
Specifies which camera is the main camera.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Specifies the direction the camera moves when using the  
arrow buttons on the remote control.  
Y
Y
Y
Video/Camera > Monitor Setup  
Snapshot Timeout Lets you choose whether to have slides and snapshots  
Y
Y
Y
Y
time out after a period of four minutes.  
Audio Settings > Audio Settings 1  
Sound Effects Volume  
Sets the volume level of the ring tone and user alert  
Y
tones.  
Incoming Video Call  
User Alert Tones  
Specifies the ring tone used for incoming calls.  
Specifies the tone used for user alerts.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Mute Auto Answer  
Calls  
Specifies whether to mute incoming calls.  
Y
Y
Incoming calls are muted by default until you press the  
mute on the microphone or on the remote control.  
Input Type Level  
Sets the volume level for audio input 1.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Content Input Level  
Specifies the volume level for audio input 4 of a Polycom  
HDX 9000 series or Polycom HDX 8000 series system.  
Specifies the volume level for audio input 3 of a Polycom  
HDX 7000 series system. Specifies the volume level for  
the PC audio input of a Polycom HDX 6000 series or  
Polycom HDX 4000 series.  
Line Output Level  
Sets the volume level for audio output.  
Y
Y
Audio Settings > Audio Settings 2  
Polycom, Inc.  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
Master Audio Volume  
Midrange Speakers  
Sets the volume level for audio from the far site.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Specifies whether to use the system’s built-in midrange  
speaker. You may prefer to turn off the midrange speaker  
if you connect the audio output to Monitor 1 or if you  
connect an external speaker system.  
Bass  
Sets the volume level for the low frequencies without  
changing the master audio volume.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Treble  
Sets the volume level for the high frequencies without  
changing the master audio volume.  
LAN Properties > LAN Properties 1  
Connect to My LAN  
IP Address  
Enables connection to the local area network  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Specifies how the system obtains an IP address.  
Y
Obtain IP Address Automatically — Select if the  
system gets an IP address from the DHCP server on  
the LAN.  
Enter IP Address Manually — Select if the IP  
address will not be assigned automatically.  
Use the Following IP  
Address  
If you selected Enter IP Address Manually, enter the IP  
address here.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
LAN Properties > LAN Properties 2  
DNS Servers  
Displays the DNS servers currently assigned to the  
system.  
If the system does not automatically obtain a DNS server  
address, enter up to four DNS servers here.  
Changing this setting causes the system to restart.  
Default Gateway  
Subnet Mask  
Displays the gateway currently assigned to the system.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
If the system does not automatically obtain a gateway IP  
address, enter one here.  
Changing this setting causes the system to restart.  
Displays the subnet mask currently assigned to the  
system.  
If the system does not automatically obtain a subnet  
mask, enter one here.  
Changing this setting causes the system to restart.  
WINS Server  
Displays the server running the Windows Internet Name  
Service  
Y
128  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
WINS Resolution  
Enables connection to the WINS Server for URL  
resolution  
Y
Y
Y
LAN Speed  
Specify the LAN speed to use. Note that the setting you  
choose must be supported by the switch.  
Y
Choose Auto to have the network switch negotiate the  
speed automatically. In this case, the switch must also be  
set to Auto. Choosing Auto automatically sets Duplex  
Mode to Auto.  
If you choose 10 Mbps, 100 Mbps, or 1000 Mbps you  
must set Duplex Mode to Half or Full.  
Changing this setting causes the system to restart.  
Note  
Mismatches with the network switch settings may lead to  
unexpected behaviors.  
Duplex Mode  
Specify the duplex mode to use. Note that the Duplex  
mode you choose must be supported by the switch.  
Y
Y
Y
Choose Auto to have the network switch negotiate the  
Duplex mode automatically. In this case, the switch must  
also be set to Auto. Choosing Auto automatically sets  
LAN Speed to Auto.  
Changing this setting causes the system to restart.  
Global Services > Directory Servers  
Global Directory (GDS)  
Specifies the IP address or DNS address of the Global  
Directory Server.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Password  
Lets you enter the global directory password, if there is  
one.  
Y
Display Name in Global  
Directory  
Specifies whether to display the system’s name in the  
global directories of other registered systems. Global  
Address  
Display Global  
Addresses  
Displays other registered systems in the global directory.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Register  
Registers this system with the Global Directory Server.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Save Global Directory  
to System  
Copies the global directory to this local system. When this  
setting is disabled, the system can display no more than  
1,000 global directory entries. When this setting is  
enabled, the system can display up to 4,000 global  
directory entries.  
Polycom, Inc.  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
LAN/H.323 > Global Directory (GDS) > Preferences  
Show Addresses in  
Address Book  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Preferred Speed for  
Placing Calls (Kbps)  
Determines the speeds that will be used for IP, ISDN, or  
International ISDN calls from this endpoint system when:  
The Call Quality selection is either unavailable or set  
ISDN Video Call  
(H.320)  
to Auto on the Place a Call screen  
The call is placed from the directory  
International ISDN calls  
IP Calls  
Y
Y
Y
Y
If the far-site endpoint system does not support the  
selected speed, the endpoint system automatically  
negotiates a lower speed.  
LAN/H.323 > Global Directory (GDS) > Preferred Alias  
Preferred Alias Possible values include:  
Y
Y
Gateway Number  
ISDN Number  
Called Party Line Identifier  
Extension  
Global Services > Dialing Rules 1  
Number of digits in  
Extension  
Specifies the number of digits in the extension. Your  
organization’s dial plan determines this number.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
International Dialing  
Prefix  
Specifies the dialing prefix needed for international calls  
Public Network Access  
Specifies if calls can be made to the public network  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Public Network Dialing  
Prefix  
Specifies the dialing prefix used to call out to endpoints on  
the public network when the endpoint is not in the same  
area code as the system  
Public Network (same  
area code) Prefix  
Specifies the dialing prefix used to call out to endpoints on  
the public network when the endpoint is in the same area  
code as the system  
Y
Y
Private Network Access Specifies if calls can be made to the private network  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Private Network Dialing  
Prefix  
Specifies the dialing prefix used to call outside the  
network  
Always Dial Area Code  
Specify whether the phone number must always include  
an area code  
Y
Y
130  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Field  
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...  
Dial 1+ for all USA  
Calls  
Specify whether to preface calls within the United States  
with 1  
Y
Y
Y
Global Services > Dialing Rules 2  
If Area Code Equals/  
Dial Prefix Pairs  
Create additional dialing rules and routing based on area  
code  
Y
Global Services > Account Validation  
Require Account  
Number to Dial  
Specify whether to require an account number for placing  
calls and whether that number should be validated by the  
system.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Validate Account  
Number  
Specify whether to require an account number for placing  
calls and whether that number should be validated by the  
system.  
Global Services > My Information  
Contact Person  
Contact Number  
Contact Email  
Contact Fax  
Specifies the name of the person responsible for this  
system  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Specifies the phone number of the person responsible for  
this system  
Specifies the email address of the person responsible for  
this system  
Specifies the Fax number of the person responsible for  
this system  
Tech Support  
Specifies the contact information for Technical Support for  
this system  
City  
Specifies the location of the person responsible for this  
system  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
State/Province  
Country  
Video Network > IP Network > Gateway Setup  
Speed  
Prefix  
Suffix  
Enter a prefix or suffix for each bandwidth allowed for  
gateway calls.  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Associating prefixes and suffixes with particular  
bandwidths on your gateway can optimize the use of  
bandwidth by your organization. Be sure the gateway is  
configured to use the same prefixes and suffixes you  
define for the system.  
Polycom, Inc.  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Scheduled Provisioning Notes  
Some notes about scheduled provisioning profiles and the scheduled  
provisioning of endpoints:  
Each page in the scheduled Provisioning Fields dialog box has a  
Provision This Page option. When this option is selected, the system  
provisions all of the values on that page. When this option is not selected,  
the system does not provision any of the values on that page. At least one  
page must be provisioned, or the system returns an error stating, “No data  
to save in profile. Either press Cancel or add pages.”  
Until the CMA system successfully provisions an endpoint scheduled for  
provisioning, provisioning remains in the Pending state and the system  
attempts to provision the endpoint until it succeeds or until the  
provisioning is cancelled.  
If an endpoint scheduled for provisioning is In a Call, the system waits  
until the call ends before provisioning the endpoint. The system checks the  
endpoint at 15 minute intervals.  
If an endpoint scheduled for provisioning is Offline, the system attempts  
to connect to it at 60 minute intervals until the endpoint is Online.  
Provisioning may reboot the endpoint  
You can schedule provisioning for an unlimited number of endpoints, but  
the system may limit the number of active provisioning processes  
Endpoint Gatekeeper Registration Policies  
If the CMA system gatekeeper registration policy allows endpoints to register  
automatically (that is, a primary gatekeeper setting of Allow Registration of  
All Endpoints, Allow Registration of Endpoints in Defined Sites, or Allow  
Registration of Endpoints with Defined E.164 Prefixes), those registered  
endpoints are automatically added to the endpoint list.  
If the CMA gatekeeper registration policy does not allow endpoints to register  
automatically (that is, a gatekeeper setting of Allow Registration of  
Predefined Endpoints Only), you must manually add all endpoints to the  
CMA system.  
No matter what the gatekeeper registration policy, any endpoint that is  
automatically provisioned, any endpoint that is registered with the Global  
Address Book, and any endpoint that is added manually to the CMA system  
can automatically register with the gatekeeper. For more information, see  
Note  
You can manually add endpoints to the CMA system for monitoring purposes only.  
132  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint Management Overview  
Endpoint Software Updates  
The CMA system software update feature, which requires a software update  
profile for the endpoint type and model, allows an administrator to upgrade  
the software on one or more endpoints with a standard software package. This  
eliminates the need to upgrade each endpoint individually.  
The CMA system supports two exclusive software update processes:  
automatic and scheduled. Automatic and scheduled software update are  
exclusive endpoint management scenarios. Endpoints enabled for automatic  
software update should not be scheduled for software updates through the  
system.  
Note  
Polycom recommends that all endpoints in a region (that is, a gatekeeper zone) be  
managed by a single management system.  
For more information, see:  
Automatic Software Updates  
Automatic software update, which controls the endpoint’s software version  
level, is tied to the endpoint type. Currently, the automatic software update  
feature is only available for these endpoint types.  
Polycom HDX system endpoints deployed in dynamic management mode  
Polycom RealPresence Group Series  
Polycom CMA Desktop systems  
How Automatic Software Update Works  
In dynamic management mode, when a endpoint starts up and at designated  
intervals thereafter, it automatically polls the CMA system for a newer  
software update package. If a software update is necessary, the package is sent  
in XML format over a secure HTTPS connection.  
Endpoints do not poll for software update packages if they are in a call. They  
restart polling after the call ends.  
Automatic Software Update Profiles  
Automatic software update is enabled at the endpoint, but the CMA system  
must have an automatic software update profile for the endpoint type to fulfill  
the process. A default automatic software update profile—with the  
Polycom, Inc.  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
description CMA Desktop - shipped version—is available for the Polycom  
CMA Desktop client. Default automatic software update profiles are not  
available for other endpoint systems. To create an automatic software update  
profile, you upload the software package and create a profile for the update.  
Automatic Software Update Versions  
After creating an automatic software update profile, you can use the Version  
to use and Allow this version or newer selections to manage the roll out of  
software update packages. These selections also allow you to manage the  
release of multiple software packages for the same endpoint type.  
Here’s how it works: All endpoints have a current version of software. To  
automatically overwrite that current software with a different software  
version on all dynamically managed endpoint systems:  
1
You first create a new automatic software update profile that includes the  
new software update package.  
2
Then to activate the roll out, you change the Version to use selection  
from the current value (None by default) to the new version number and  
Update the page.  
The next time a dynamically managed endpoint polls the CMA system, it will  
detect that it has a different software version than the Version to use selection,  
so it will automatically download and install the identified software update  
package. Use this method to force users to use a specific software version.  
Note  
Until the Version to use selection is enabled, the automatic software update is not  
activated.  
If you also enable the Allow this version or newer selection, anytime you  
package a newer version of software into an automatic software profile that  
package will be automatically installed on all dynamically managed endpoint  
systems.  
Some important things to note about software versions  
Newer software is identified by the version number. If the Allow this  
version or newer selection is enabled, when a dynamically managed  
endpoint polls the CMA system, the system will compare the current  
software version number with the packaged software version numbers.  
The CMA system will send the software package with the highest version  
number to the endpoint.  
You can also use the Version to use selection to roll endpoints back to  
older software versions. If you change the Version to use selection to an  
older software version and clear the Allow this version or newer  
selection, the CMA system will send the specifically identified software  
package to the endpoint even if it is an older version.  
134  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint Management Overview  
Note  
Currently to roll back a Polycom CMA Desktop client to an older version, you must  
first remove the existing Polycom CMA Desktop client via the Windows Add or  
Remove Software selection. Then you can install the older software package.  
Peripheral Software Updates  
You can update the platform (operating system) and applications (if  
applicable) for peripherals connected to endpoints. Peripheral software  
updates can be in any of the following states:  
Production - The software update is configured for one or more groups  
that are using the software in production.  
Trial - The software update is configured for one or more groups that are  
trialing the software.  
Both - The software update is configured for one or more groups that are  
trialing the software and for one or groups are using the software in  
production.  
Note  
When doing peripheral upgrades on redundant systems running Microsoft SQL  
Server 2005 or 2008 R1, you may receive an SQL server exception. To resolve this  
exception, upload the peripheral upgrade package to the secondary server as well.  
Scheduled Software Updates  
The scheduled software update feature is enabled at the CMA system. An  
administrator with System Setup permissions can schedule software updates  
for one endpoint or a group of endpoints to occur immediately or for a date  
and time in the future.  
Scheduled software updates are available for these endpoint types.  
ViewStation  
ViewStation FX & EX  
V and VSX Series  
TANDBERG MXP series  
HDX Series--Polycom HDX systems operating in standard management  
mode  
Some notes about scheduled software updates:  
Until the CMA system successfully updates an endpoint scheduled for  
updating, the update remains in the Pending or In Progress state and the  
CMA system attempts to update the endpoint until it succeeds or until the  
update is cancelled.  
Polycom, Inc.  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
If an endpoint scheduled for update is In a Call, the CMA system waits  
until the call ends before updating the endpoint. The system checks the  
endpoint at 15 minute intervals.  
If an endpoint scheduled for update is Offline, the CMA system attempts  
to connect to the endpoint every hour until the endpoint is Online.  
A software update may reboot the endpoint.  
Endpoint Passwords  
A CMA system can manage Polycom endpoints only when the password in  
the device record matches the password in the endpoint. Matching passwords  
are required to:  
Schedule provisioning of an endpoint through a CMA system.  
Use the Scheduled Software Update feature.  
Monitor the endpoint from the Endpoint > Monitor View.  
You can update the password for certain endpoint systems through scheduled  
provisioning only after you have entered the matching password in the CMA  
system. In this case, you must instruct end-users not to change the password.  
Note  
Some companies select an administrative password that is used for all endpoints  
and regularly updated through provisioning.  
For third-party endpoints, passwords may be required to access the endpoint  
management software.  
For information about restrictions in changing passwords for a specific  
endpoint, see the documentation for the endpoint.  
Considerations for Third-Party Endpoints  
The CMA system includes additional command and control for select  
TANDBERG C Series, TANDBERG Edge, and LifeSize Team and Express  
endpoints. The CMA system can send a Reboot command to these endpoints,  
and the endpoints can receive and act on the command. In addition, the CMA  
system can:  
Discover these endpoints by searching for them within a range of IP  
addresses.  
Complete the initial configuration of these endpoints.  
Schedule and launch point-to-point conferences on these endpoints.  
136  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Endpoint Management Overview  
Launch the management interface for these endpoints.  
In the following sections, some additional considerations for supporting  
third-party endpoints are discussed, including  
Enable TANDBERG Endpoints Global Address Book Access  
With CMA system, users of the TANDBERG 150, 990, 880, 770 MXP,  
TANDBERG C Series, and TANDBERG Edge can access the Polycom Global  
Address Book, so they can see the endpoints in the Global Address Book.  
(Note that any third-party endpoint that is registered to the CMA system  
gatekeeper is displayed in the Global Address Book.)  
The timing of the endpoint’s connection with the Global Address Book can  
affect the success of its connection. We recommend the following process:  
1
At the endpoint, enter the information required for directory set up  
including the Polycom Global Address Book/CMA system IP address  
and the path. To do this, on the endpoint, go to Endpoint Configuration  
> General > External Phone Book Settings.  
2
3
Wait for the connections to take effect.  
At the CMA system, go to Endpoint > Monitor View and verify the  
endpoint’s Global Address Book connection status is green.  
Considerations for LifeSize Endpoints  
Consider the following when you must support LifeSize endpoints:  
Enabling Management of LifeSize Endpoints  
To facilitate management of LifeSize endpoints, a CMA system administrator  
must enable the Default Passwords for LifeSize Endpoint Management  
option and enter the SSH and web UI passwords for the LifeSize endpoints.  
Polycom, Inc.  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
To enable LifeSize endpoint management  
1
On the CMA system, go to Admin > Management and Security >  
Endpoint Management Settings.  
2
In the Default Passwords for LifeSize Endpoint Management section of  
the Endpoint Management Settings page, enable Use Default  
Passwords.  
3
4
Enter the Password for SSH User and confirm the password. Refer to the  
LifeSize system documentation for information on using SSH to connect  
to the endpoint, then enter the same SSH password here.  
Enter the Password for Web UI User and confirm the password. Refer to  
the LifeSize system documentation for information on using a web  
browser to connect to the endpoint, then enter the same web UI password  
here.  
5
Click Update.  
Note  
For the CMA system to successfully manage a LifeSize endpoint, SSH must  
be enabled on the endpoint. SSH can be enabled on the endpoint through  
device provisioning.  
Monitoring  
The CMA system can monitor select TANDBERG C Series, TANDBERG Edge,  
and LifeSize Team and Express endpoints, so when properly configured, the  
CMA system can provide online/offline status and alerts, display call status,  
and provide image support including near and far end images for these  
endpoints.  
Scheduled Provisioning of Selected TANDBERG Endpoints  
The following table identifies the fields that the CMA system can provision for  
TANDBERG 150, 990, 880, 770 MXP, and TANDBERG C Series endpoints.  
See the appropriate TANDBERG product documentation for more  
information about these fields and their acceptable values. See “Scheduled  
Provisioning Operations” on page 186 for information on implementing  
scheduled provisioning of endpoints.  
138  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Endpoint Management Overview  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
AdditionalCamera Type  
AlertSpeaker Mode  
AlertTone Telephony  
AlertTone VideoTelephony  
AlertTone Volume  
AllowLatency  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Audio AGC  
Audio AGC AUX  
Audio AGC Microphones  
Audio AGC Received  
Audio AGC VCR  
Audio AudioModule  
Audio AutoMute  
Audio Delay AUX  
Audio Delay VCR  
Audio EchoControl  
Audio EchoControl 1 through 4  
Audio Feedback Mode  
Audio Inputs Line 1 through 3  
Level  
Mode  
Audio Inputs Microphone 1 through 3  
Level  
Mode  
Audio KeyTones  
Audio LocalDetection Mode  
Audio Loudspeaker  
Polycom, Inc.  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
Audio MicrophoneMixer Mode  
Audio Microphones Mode  
Audio Outputs Line 1 through 3  
Level  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Mode  
Type  
Audio Stereo  
Audio StereoSpeakers  
Audio VCRDucking  
Audio Volume  
AutoAnswer Delay  
AutoAnswer Device  
AutoAnswer Mode  
AutoLayout Mode  
AutoPIP Mode  
AutoPIP TimeOut  
Bonding Rebonding  
Bonding Timer  
CallManager Address  
CallVideoSource  
Cameras 1 through 13  
Backlight  
Brightness Level  
Brightness Mode  
DualVisca  
Focus Mode  
Gamma Level  
Gamma Mode  
140  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
IR  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Mirror  
Whitebalance Level  
Whitebalance Mode  
CameraDVI Mode  
CameraSleep Mode  
CameraSwUpgrade  
CameraTracking Speed  
Conference AAC-LD  
Conference AAC-LD-128-Mono  
Conference AAC-LD-128-Threshold  
Conference AIM  
Conference AllowIncomingCallInCall  
Conference AllowIncomingMSCall  
Conference AllowIncomingTlphCall  
Conference BillingCode  
Conference DefaultCall CallRate  
Conference DefaultCall NetProfile  
Conference DefaultCall Restrict  
Conference Downspeed  
Conference Encryption Mode  
Conference Encryption Type  
Conference FallbackToTelephony  
Conference FarTlphEchoSupression  
Conference FloorToFull  
Conference G722  
Conference G722.1  
Conference G728  
Polycom, Inc.  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
Conference H239  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Conference H263  
Conference H264  
Conference H264RCDO  
Conference H331  
Conference IPDualstreamRate  
Conference IPLR Transmit  
Conference MailBox URI  
Conference MaxCallLength  
Conference NaturalVideo  
Conference PeriodicIntra  
Conference PictureMode  
Conference SIP URI  
Conference VideoQualityCP  
Conference VideoText  
Conference VideoTextTimeout  
Conference WebSnapshots  
CorporateDirectory Address  
CorporateDirectory Mode  
CorporateDirectory Path  
CorporateDirectory Protocol  
DefaultPIPPosition  
Directory CallLog  
Directory SmartSearch  
DoNotDisturb Mode  
DualMonitor Mode  
DuoVideoSource  
DynamicResolution Mode  
142  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
E1 Interface CRC4  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Ethernet 1 Speed  
Ethernet 2 Speed  
ExternalNetwork Callcontroll  
ExternalNetwork Clocking  
ExternalNetwork DTRPulse  
ExternalServices Address  
ExternalServices Mode  
ExternalServices Path  
ExternalServices Protocol  
FECC Mode  
FeedbackFilter Call  
FeedbackFilter Conference  
FTP Mode  
G703 Callcontrol  
G703 Interface MaxChannels  
G703 Interface StartChannel  
G703 Linecoding  
G703 PhysicalLayer  
H320 NetType  
H323 Mode  
H323CallSetup Mode  
H323Gatekeeper Address  
H323Gatekeeper Authentication ID  
H323Gatekeeper Authentication Mode  
H323Gatekeeper Authentication  
Password  
H323Gatekeeper Avaya AnnexH  
Y
Y
N
Polycom, Inc.  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
H323Gatekeeper Avaya Mode  
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
H323Gatekeeper Avaya  
MultipointCount  
H323Gatekeeper Avaya Password  
H323Gatekeeper Discovery  
H323Gatekeeper MultipleAlias  
H323Prefix  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
HTTP Mode  
HTTPS Mode  
HTTPS VerifyServerCertificate  
IdReport H323  
IEEE802.1x AnonymousIdentity  
IEEE802.1x EAP-MD5  
IEEE802.1x EAP-PEAP  
IEEE802.1x EAP-TTLS  
IEEE802.1x Identity  
IEEE802.1x Mode  
IEEE802.1x Password  
IMUX Custom bw1152 Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw1152 Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw1152R Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw1152R Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw128 Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw128 Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw128R Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw128R Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw1472 Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw1472 Suffix  
144  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
IMUX Custom bw1472R Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw1472R Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw192 Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw192 Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw1920 Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw1920 Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw1920R Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw1920R Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw192R Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw192R Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw256 Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw256 Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw256R Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw256R Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw320 Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw320 Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw320R Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw320R Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw384 Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw384 Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw384R Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw384R Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw512 Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw512 Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw512R Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw512R Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw64 Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw64 Suffix  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Polycom, Inc.  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
IMUX Custom bw64R Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw64R Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw768 Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw768 Suffix  
IMUX Custom bw768R Prefix  
IMUX Custom bw768R Suffix  
Integrator AMXBeacon Mode  
Integrator Telepresence Mode  
IP Assignment  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
IP DNS Domain Name  
IP DNS Server 1 through 5 Address  
IP Gateway  
IP SubnetMask  
IPMedia MaxVideoTXRate  
IPProtocol  
IRControl Mode  
IRControl NumberKeyMode  
ISDN BRI Alert  
ISDN BRI AutoActivation  
ISDN BRI ChanId  
ISDN BRI Interface 1 through 6  
DirectoryNumber 1  
DirectoryNumber 2  
Mode  
SPID 1  
SPID 2  
ISDN BRI MaxDeactiveTime  
ISDN BRI SwitchType  
146  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
ISDN CliNumbPlan  
ISDN CliNumbSpec  
ISDN CliNumbType  
ISDN HLC  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
ISDN MSN  
ISDN ParallelDial  
ISDN PRI Alert  
ISDN PRI ChanId  
ISDN PRI InitialRestart  
ISDN PRI Interface HighChannel  
ISDN PRI Interface LowChannel  
ISDN PRI Interface MaxChannels  
ISDN PRI Interface  
NumberRangeStart  
ISDN PRI Interface NumberRangeStop  
ISDN PRI Interface Search  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
ISDN PRI L2WindowSize  
ISDN PRI NSFTelephony Mode  
ISDN PRI NSFTelephony Number  
ISDN PRI NSFVideoTelephony Mode  
ISDN PRI NSFVideoTelephony  
Number  
ISDN PRI SwitchType  
ISDN SendComplete  
ISDN SendNumber  
ISDN SpeechTimers  
ISDN SubAddress  
Key AUX  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Polycom, Inc.  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
Key Brightness  
Key Cabinet  
Key CallRegister  
Key Cancel  
N
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Key Connect  
Key Disconnect  
Key DocCam  
Key Down  
Key FarEnd  
Key Grab  
Key Headset  
Key Help  
Key Layout  
Key Left  
Key MainCam  
Key MicOff  
Key Number0 through Number9  
Key Ok  
Key PC  
Key Phonebook  
Key PIP  
Key Presentation  
Key Presets  
Key Right  
Key Selfview  
Key Services  
Key Settings  
Key Softkey1  
148  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
Key Softkey2  
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Key Softkey3  
Key Softkey4  
Key Softkey5  
Key Speaker  
Key Square  
Key Star  
Key Up  
Key VideoOff  
Key VCR  
Key VolumeDown  
Key VolumeUp  
Key ZoomIn  
Key ZoomOut  
Keyboard Layout  
Kiosk AllowIRControl  
Kiosk AutoDial  
Kiosk LanguageMenu English  
Kiosk LanguageMenu French  
Kiosk LanguageMenu German  
Kiosk LanguageMenu Italian  
Kiosk LanguageMenu Mode  
Kiosk LanguageMenu Norwegian  
Kiosk LanguageMenu Spanish  
Kiosk LanguageMenu Swedish  
Kiosk Menu  
Kiosk Mode  
Kiosk OneClickConnect  
Polycom, Inc.  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
Kiosk Phonebook  
LocalLayout Mode  
LocalLayout Toggle  
Logo  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
LoS Duration Exponent  
LoS Duration Offset  
LoS Inhibit  
LoS Initial  
LoS Polarity  
LoS Retry  
MainVideoSource  
MaxBandwidth  
Multipoint Mode  
Multipoint MultiwayMultiprotocol  
Multipoint MultiwayStartupPeriod  
Multipoint MultiwayURI  
NAT Address  
NAT Mode  
NetProfile 1 through 7  
CallPrefix  
CallSuffix  
Name  
NTP Address  
NTP Mode  
OneClickConnect Mode  
OSD CallDuration Mode  
OSD Icon BadNetwork  
OSD Icon CameraTracking  
150  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
OSD Icon DuoVideo  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
OSD Icon Encryption  
OSD Icon Headset  
OSD Icon MicOff  
OSD Icon OnAir  
OSD Icon Telephone  
OSD Icon VolumeOff  
OSD MCUStatusLine Mode  
OSD Menu BalloonHelp  
OSD Menu CodecLabel  
OSD Menu DisableH323IdCalling  
OSD Menu DisableTimeout  
OSD Menu DisplayWelcomeText  
OSD Menu DisplayWelcomeTime  
OSD Menu IconPlacement  
OSD Menu InputEditor Language  
OSD Menu Language  
OSD Menu Mode  
OSD Menu Password  
OSD Menu Simple  
OSD Menu WelcomeMenu  
OSD Menu WelcomeText  
OSD Mode  
OSD Offset Mode  
PacketlossDownSpeed Mode  
PCPort Mode  
PictureProgram 1 Layout  
Polycom, Inc.  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
PictureProgram 1 Window 1 through 6  
Call  
Y
N
N
PictureProgram 1 Window 1 through 6  
Picture  
Y
N
N
PictureProgram 2 Layout  
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
PictureProgram 2 Window 1 through 6  
Call  
PictureProgram 2 Window 1 through 6  
Picture  
Y
N
N
PictureProgram 3 Layout  
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
PictureProgram 3 Window 1 through 6  
Call  
PictureProgram 3 Window 1 through 6  
Picture  
Y
N
N
PictureProgram 4 Layout  
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
PictureProgram 4 Window 1 through 6  
Call  
PictureProgram 4 Window 1 through 6  
Picture  
Y
N
N
PresentationStart  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Preset 1 through 15 Name  
QoS Diffserv Telephony Audio  
QoS Diffserv Telephony Signalling  
QoS Diffserv VideoTelephony Audio  
QoS Diffserv VideoTelephony Data  
QoS Diffserv VideoTelephony  
Signalling  
QoS Diffserv VideoTelephony Video  
QoS Mode  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
QoS Precedence Telephony Audio  
QoS Precedence Telephony Signalling  
152  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
QoS Precedence VideoTelephony  
Audio  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
QoS Precedence VideoTelephony  
Data  
Y
Y
Y
QoS Precedence VideoTelephony  
Signalling  
QoS Precedence VideoTelephony  
Video  
QoS RSVP  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
QoS ToS  
RemoteSwUpgrade Mode  
RemoteSwUpgrade Password  
RTP MTU  
RTP Ports  
Screensaver Delay  
Screensaver LED  
Screensaver Mode  
SecurityLog Mode  
SelfViewOnStartup  
SerialPort 1 BaudRate  
SerialPort 1 DataBits  
SerialPort 1 Mode  
SerialPort 1 Parity  
SerialPort 1 StopBits  
SerialPort 2 BaudRate  
SerialPort 2 DataBits  
SerialPort 2 Mode  
SerialPort 2 Parity  
SerialPort 2 StopBits  
Polycom, Inc.  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
SerialPort Direct Buffer  
SIP Authentication Password  
SIP Authentication UserName  
SIP Legacy Mask  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
SIP Mode  
SIP ReplyTo URI  
SIP Server Address  
SIP Server Discovery  
SIP Server Type  
SIP TLS Verify  
SIP Transport Default  
SNMP CommunityName  
SNMP HostIPAddr 1  
SNMP HostIPAddr 2  
SNMP HostIPAddr 3  
SNMP Mode  
SNMP SystemContact  
SNMP SystemLocation  
SSH Mode  
StartupVideoSource  
StillImageSource  
Streaming Address  
Streaming AllowRemoteStart  
Streaming Announcements  
Streaming Hops  
Streaming Password  
Streaming Port  
Streaming Quality  
154  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
Streaming Source  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Streaming VideoRate  
StrictPassword  
Switch Configuration Primary  
Switch Configuration Secondary  
Switch LogicalInput 1 Map  
Switch LogicalInput 1 Mode 1  
Switch LogicalInput 1 Mode 2  
Switch LogicalInput 1 Mode 3  
Switch LogicalInput 1 Mode 4  
Switch LogicalInput 1 Mode 5  
Switch LogicalInput 2 Map  
Switch LogicalInput 2 Mode 1  
Switch LogicalInput 3 Map  
Switch LogicalInput 3 Mode 1  
Switch LogicalInput 4 Map  
Switch LogicalInput 4 Mode 1  
Switch LogicalInput 5 Map  
Switch LogicalInput 5 Mode 1  
Switch Source  
SystemUnit Multiway  
SystemUnit Password  
T1 Interface CableLength  
Telnet Modea  
TelnetChallenge Mode  
TelnetChallenge Port  
Time DateFormat  
Time DaylightSavings  
Polycom, Inc.  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
C Series  
Time TimeFormat  
Time Zone  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
UseAsLocalPCMonitor  
Video 1 Outputs Animation  
Video 1 Outputs Testpattern  
Video Inputs Source 1 through 6  
Name  
Quality  
Video Outputs DVI 1 and 2  
Mode  
OSD  
VirtualMonitor  
Video Outputs DVIResolution  
Video Outputs Letterbox  
Video Outputs ScreenFormatPC  
Video Outputs ScreenFormatTV  
Video Outputs TV 1 and 2  
Mode  
OSD  
VirtualMonitor  
VNC DisplayNumber  
VNC IPAddress  
VNC Password  
WLAN Community  
WLAN Enable  
WLAN Encryption  
WLAN Key 1  
WLAN Key 2  
156  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Provisioned for supported Tandberg  
models?  
MXP  
MXP  
Models  
990/880/770  
Model  
T150  
Field Name  
WLAN Key 3  
WLAN Key 4  
WLAN Mode  
WLAN SSID  
WLAN UseKey  
C Series  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
a. The CMA system always provisions Telnet Mode to ON, because provisioning Telnet Mode  
to OFF would make the endpoints unmanageable.  
Scheduled Provisioning of LifeSize Endpoints  
The CMA system can provision many fields for LifeSize Team and Express  
endpoints. The following table identifies the fields that the CMA system can  
provision for LifeSize Team 200 endpoints. See the “Endpoint  
scheduled provisioning of endpoints.  
Provisioned for  
selected LifeSize  
Models?  
Field Name  
Calls  
Team 200  
Outgoing Max BandWidth  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Incoming Max BandWidth  
Auto Bandwidth  
Maximum Call Time  
Maximum Redial Entries  
Auto Answer  
Auto Answer Mute  
Audio  
Audio Codecs  
Y
Y
Y
Active Microphone  
Active Microphone Volume  
Polycom, Inc.  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Provisioned for  
selected LifeSize  
Models?  
Field Name  
Primary Audio Output Test  
Team 200  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Audio Mute  
Muted Device(s)  
Video Call Audio Output  
Audio Call Audio Output  
Line Out Treble  
Line Out Bass  
Ring Tone Volume  
DMF Tone Volume  
Status Tone Volume  
Telepresence  
Telepresence  
Y
Y
Y
HD Camera 1 Moment  
HD Camera 2 Moment  
Video Settings > Video Control  
Far Ctrl of Near Camera  
Far Set of Camera Presets  
Far Move to Camera Presets  
Camera Presets Lock  
Camera Pan Direction  
Default Primary Input  
Video Snapshots  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
HD Camera 1 Name  
HD Input 1 Name  
Stretch Video  
Video Settings > Video Quality  
Video Bandwidth Balance  
Primary Video Motion  
Presentation Video Sharpness  
Y
Y
Y
158  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Provisioned for  
selected LifeSize  
Models?  
Field Name  
Video Encoder Quality  
Team 200  
Y
Y
Y
H.241 MaxStaticMBPS  
Video MTU  
Security > General  
Telnet  
Y
Y
SNMP  
Security > Passwords  
SSH Password  
UI Admin Password  
UI User Password  
Network > General  
DHCP  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
IP Address  
Subnet Mask  
Gateway  
Host Name  
DNS Server  
Name Search Domains  
Network Speed  
VLAN Tag  
NTP Server Host Name  
802.1x Authentication  
IPv6 Configuration  
IPv6 Address  
IPv6 Router  
Network > NAT  
Static NAT  
Y
Y
NAT Public IP Address  
Polycom, Inc.  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Provisioned for  
selected LifeSize  
Models?  
Field Name  
Team 200  
Network > Reserved Ports  
UDP Lowest Value  
UDP Highest Value  
TCP Highest Value  
TCP Lowest Value  
Network > Network Qos  
Network QoS  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
DiffServ Audio Priority  
DiffServ Video Priority  
DiffServ Data Priority  
InServ Audio Priority  
InServ Video Priority  
InServ Data Priority  
InServ ToS  
Network > LifeSize® Transit  
LifeSize® Transit  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Transit Hostname  
Transit Username  
Transit Password  
Transit ICE  
Transit Signaling  
Web Proxy URL  
Web Proxy Username  
Web Proxy Password  
Communications > General  
Auto Answer Multiway Calls  
Video Dialing  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Voice Dialing  
Presentations  
160  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Provisioned for  
selected LifeSize  
Models?  
Field Name  
Auto Start Presentations  
Team 200  
Y
Communications > H.323  
H.323  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
H.323 Name  
H.323 Extension  
Gatekeeper ID  
Gatekeeper Mode  
Primary Gatekeeper IP and Port  
Alternate Gatekeeper IP and Port  
H.460  
Communications > SIP  
SIP  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
SIP Username  
SIP Authorization  
SIP Server Type  
SIP Registration  
SIP Proxy  
SIP Proxy Host Name  
SIP Proxy Port  
SIP Registrar  
SIP Registrar Host Name  
SIP Registrar Port  
UDP Signaling  
UDP Signaling Port  
TCP Signaling  
TCP Signaling Port  
TLS Signaling  
TLS Signaling Port  
Polycom, Inc.  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Provisioned for  
selected LifeSize  
Models?  
Field Name  
Team 200  
System > General  
Auto Reboot  
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
System > Identification  
System Name  
Video Number  
Voice Number  
System > Identification  
Timezone  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Month  
Day  
Year  
Hour  
Minute  
Second  
Directory > Auto Discovery  
Auto Discovery  
Auto Discovery Subnets  
Auto Discovery Ignored Subnets  
Directory > LDAP  
LDAP  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
LDAP Hostname  
LDAP Password  
LDAP Base  
LDAP Filter  
LDAP Refresh  
Appearance > General  
Language  
Y
Y
Y
Fade Out Timeout  
Company Logo  
162  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint Management Overview  
Provisioned for  
selected LifeSize  
Models?  
Field Name  
LCD Contrast  
Team 200  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Screen Saver  
Screen Saver Timeout  
Sleep Timeout  
Appearance > Layout  
Picture in Picture  
Y
Y
Display 2 Layout  
Appearance > Display  
Display 1 Resolution  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Display 1 Energy Saver  
Display 2 Energy Saver  
Display 2 Resolution  
Diagnostics > Cameras  
Camera Anti-Flicker  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
HD Camera 1 Brightness  
HD Camera 1 White Balance  
HD Camera 2 White Balance  
HD Camera 2 Brightness  
Diagnostics > DVD-I Input  
DVI-I Input Horizontal Position  
DVI-I Input Vertical Position  
DVI-I Input Coarse Tuning  
DVI-I Input Fine Tuning  
DVI-I Input Brightness  
DVI_I Input Contrast  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
DVI-I Input Scaling  
Polycom, Inc.  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Provisioning of LifeSize Passwords  
Take note of the following when provisioning passwords to LifeSize  
endpoints:  
The Auto password must be provisioned to meet the LifeSize and  
SSH/telnet rules for passwords.  
You cannot provision the Auto password to be blank. If you attempt to  
provision a blank value, the existing value of the password will not be  
overwritten. It will remain valid.  
The Web UI or User password can be provisioned to include the numbers  
0-9 and/or the symbols * and #. The system will silently truncate these  
passwords to a maximum of 16 characters.  
You can provision the Web UI or User password to be blank.  
Refer to the LifeSize documentation for more information about the  
requirements for these password.  
Reporting  
The CMA system includes standard reporting for select TANDBERG C Series,  
TANDBERG Edge, and LifeSize Team and Express endpoints.  
164  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
10  
Endpoint and Peripheral  
Management Operations  
This chapter describes how to perform the Polycom® Converged Management  
Application™ (CMA®) system endpoint management tasks. It includes these  
topics:  
Endpoint Management Operations  
The follow topics describe the actions available in Endpoint > Monitor View:  
Polycom, Inc.  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
View Device Details  
To view detailed information about a managed endpoint  
1
2
3
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.  
Select the endpoint of interest and click View Details.  
The Device Details dialog box displays the following information:  
Field  
Description  
Identification  
System Name  
The name of the endpoint.  
Endpoint names must be unique.  
The name must be in ASCII only and may have an  
unlimited number of characters. Spaces, dashes,  
and underscores are valid.  
When retrieved from a video endpoint system, the  
name is taken from the H.323 ID if the endpoint  
registered with the gatekeeper and it is a third-party  
system. In other cases, it is the system name, which  
might be different than the H.323 ID.  
Device Type  
The type of endpoint. For valid types, see “Endpoint  
IP Address  
Owner  
Site  
The assigned IP address of the endpoint.  
The person to whom the endpoint is assigned.  
The network site for the endpoint. By default, endpoints  
are added to the Primary Site.  
Product ID  
Description  
The product model.  
A free-form text field (extended ASCII only) in which  
information about the endpoint can be added.  
Serial Number  
The serial number (ASCII only) of the endpoint.The  
endpoint provides the serial number if it registered  
successfully or is managed.  
Software Version  
The version of the software installed on the endpoint  
(ASCII only). The endpoint provides the version number  
if it registered successfully or is managed.  
166  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint and Peripheral Management Operations  
Field  
Description  
HTTP URL  
The management URL for the endpoint, if available  
(ASCII only). This URL allows the CMA system to start  
the endpoint‘s management system using the Manage  
function.  
All Polycom endpoints allow management through a  
browser. For these endpoints, this field is completed  
when the endpoint registers with the CMA system.  
HTTP Port  
The HTTP port number for the endpoint. The endpoint  
provides the port number if it registered successfully and  
is managed.  
Addresses  
SIP URI  
A SIP URI is the address used to call another person via  
SIP. In effect it’s a user’s SIP phone number. The SIP  
URI will be of the following format:  
<username>@host(domain or IP):Port  
Aliases  
The aliases that allow you to connect to the endpoint.  
The CMA system converts the aliases to the IP address  
associated with the endpoint.  
Alias Type. Possible types include E.164, H.323 ID,  
URL, Transport Address, E-mail, Party Number, and  
Unknown.  
Alias Value. Value for the alias type shown.  
The value for the H.323 ID is the endpoint name if the  
endpoint registered with the gatekeeper and it is a  
third-party system. In other cases, the endpoint  
name is the system name, which might be different  
from the H323 ID.  
The value of the E.164 alias is the extension dialed  
to reach this endpoint.  
Notes  
To add aliases for the endpoint, edit the endpoint.  
The following Alias Values are ASCII only: H323 ID,  
URL, Transport Address, and Unknown.  
ISDN Video  
Number  
For ISDN endpoints only, the country code + city/area  
code + phone number for the endpoint.  
When you add an endpoint without native ISDN, the  
ISDN gateway, country code, and area code are not  
captured. The CMA system only supports native ISDN.  
LAN Host Name  
The host name of the endpoint on the LAN. This can be  
different from the system name of the endpoint. It is an  
ASCII only name.  
Call Signaling  
Address  
The port on which the CMA system gatekeeper sends  
call signaling information.  
Polycom, Inc.  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
RAS Address  
The port on which the CMA system gatekeeper sends  
RAS addressing information.  
Capabilities  
Supported  
Protocols  
The communications protocols that the endpoint can  
support. Possible values include:  
IP (H.323) - A standard that defines the protocols  
used for multimedia communications on  
packet-based H.323 networks.  
IP (SIP) - A standard that defines the protocols used  
for multimedia communications on SIP networks.  
ISDN (H.320) - A standard that defines the protocols  
used for multimedia communications on switched  
networks, such as ISDN.  
For endpoints with the type Unknown, select H.323.  
The endpoint automatically provides the protocols if it  
registered successfully or is managed.  
Required MCU  
Service  
The MCU service selected for the endpoint to use.  
Capabilities  
Enabled  
Capabilities enabled on this endpoint. Options are:  
MCU - The endpoint can act as a control unit for  
multipoint conferences  
Gateway - The endpoint can act as a gateway for  
call management  
The MCU provides the capability if it registered  
successfully or is managed.  
Monitoring Level  
The monitoring level for the endpoint. Possible values  
include:  
Standard. This endpoint is monitored.  
VIP. This endpoint is monitored closely. The VIP  
identifier and filters are available to operators to  
monitor and manage conferences.  
Available to  
Schedule  
Identifies if the endpoint is available when users are  
scheduling conferences  
Call Info > Sites  
Far Site Name  
The H.323ID of the far site endpoint to which the  
selected endpoint is connected. When multiple endpoints  
are connected through the endpoint's embedded MCU,  
this field displays a concatenation of each endpoint's  
H.323ID separated by ' | ', for example 'ISDN-CO1-7-1 |  
Vsfx-9-1'.  
168  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint and Peripheral Management Operations  
Field  
Description  
Far Site Number  
The address of the far site endpoint to which the  
selected endpoint is connected. The address value for  
the calling endpoint appears to be the dialed address.  
The address value for the called endpoint appears to be  
the IP Address.  
Encryption  
Cause Code  
Error  
The type of encryption the far site uses.  
The cause code showing how the call ended.  
Video FEC Errors  
The number of Forward Error Correction (FEC) errors  
that have been corrected in the current call.  
Sync  
Call Type  
Type of call, such as, H.323, SIP, ISDN, or POTS.  
Call Info > Call Details  
Video Protocol The video connection protocol, both transmission (Tx)  
and reception (Rx), the endpoint is using. Possible  
values include:  
H.261—H.261 is an ITU standard designed for  
two-way communication over ISDN lines and  
supports data rates which are multiples of 64Kbit/s.  
H.261 supports CIF and QCIF resolutions.  
H.263—H.263 is based on H.261 with  
enhancements that improve video quality over  
modems. It supports CIF, QCIF, SQCIF, 4CIF and  
16CIF resolutions.  
H.264  
Video Format  
The video format, both transmission (Tx) and reception  
(Rx), the endpoint is using.  
Video Rate  
The video bandwidth negotiated with the far site.  
Video Rate Used  
The actual video bandwidth used in the call to the far  
site.  
Video Frame Rate  
Audio Protocol  
Specifies the frame rate the endpoint is using.  
The audio connection protocol, both transmission (Tx)  
and reception (Rx), the endpoint is using. Possible  
values include:  
G.711  
G.722  
G.728  
Audio Rate  
The audio bandwidth negotiated with the far site  
Call Info > Quality of Service (Not reported by all endpoint types)  
Polycom, Inc.  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
Total Packet Loss  
Specifies the total packet loss for the currently active call  
that is, the total percentage of packet loss for all currently  
active calls divided by the number of active calls.  
% Packet Loss  
Specifies the average percentage of packet loss for the  
currently active call that is, the total percentage of packet  
loss for all currently active calls divided by the number of  
active calls.  
Audio Packet Loss Specifies the audio packet loss for the currently active  
call.  
Video Packet Loss Specifies the video packet loss for the currently active  
call.  
Audio Jitter  
Video Jitter  
Specifies the audio jitter for the currently active call.  
Specifies the video jitter for the currently active call.  
Call Info > Video Feed  
Near Site  
Far Site  
The video feed from the endpoint.  
The video feed from the endpoint to which the endpoint  
is connected.  
System Alerts  
Errors  
Endpoint error message, for example, GK Registration  
error.  
Warnings  
Endpoint warning message, for example, Low Battery.  
Add an Endpoint or Find an Endpoint on the Network  
This topic describes how to manually add endpoints and how to find  
endpoints on the same network as the CMA system.  
For most endpoints, you enter basic information. The CMA system then  
locates the endpoint and retrieves its information.  
To add an endpoint to a CMA system or find an endpoint on the network  
1
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View and click Add  
.
170  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint and Peripheral Management Operations  
2
In the Add New Device dialog box, select the Device Type. For valid  
types, see “Endpoint Types” on page 103. For endpoints not specified in  
the list, select a Device Type of Other. This dialog is meant for adding  
endpoints that are managed in Standard Management mode.  
Note  
All dynamically-managed endpoints automatically register with the CMA system  
and cannot be added using the Add option.  
3
4
Enter the IP Address of the endpoint.  
Click Find Device.  
If the CMA system can find the endpoint on the network, the Add  
New Device dialog box is populated with information retrieved from  
the endpoint. Review any information retrieved from the endpoint.  
If the CMA system cannot find the endpoint on the network, a Device  
Not Found dialog box appears.  
Notes  
If you enter an invalid Admin ID or Password for an endpoint that requires that  
information, the CMA system may still find the endpoint. It depends upon the  
endpoint type.  
V-Series, VSX-Series, and Viewstation endpoints allow the CMA system to  
detect the endpoint type and complete the registration. The endpoint appears in  
the Endpoint list with an alert indicating Incorrect Password.  
Polycom HDX systems and ViewStation FX systems won’t allow the CMA  
system to detect the endpoint type and complete the registration. You can  
manually add the endpoint, but the CMA system cannot communicate with it  
until you’ve entered a valid Admin ID or Password for the endpoint. In this  
case, the CMA system records an error message in an error log.  
The Find Device function only works for endpoints with a specified Device  
Type. If you selected a Device Type of Other, the CMA system will report an  
error.  
5
Assign the endpoint a System Name.  
Endpoint names must be unique, must be in ASCII only, and may have an  
unlimited number of characters. Spaces, dashes, and underscores are  
valid.  
6
7
If necessary, enter the Admin ID and Password for the endpoint. Some  
endpoints may not require this information. Other endpoints may require  
only a password.  
Complete the Identification, Addresses, and Capabilities sections of the  
Add New Device dialog box.  
Pay particular attention to the Capabilities options, because the settings  
on it determine how the endpoint is used throughout the CMA system.  
Polycom, Inc.  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
For example, you can select it as a VIP endpoint and determine whether it  
will be Available to Schedule through the scheduling interface.  
Note that many fields in this dialog box are ASCII only. Depending on the  
selected type, some of these fields may not be displayed or may not be  
editable.  
Field  
Description  
Identification  
Description  
A free-form text field (extended ASCII only) in which  
information about the endpoint can be added.  
GAB Display  
Name  
Enter a name for the endpoint as it will appear in the  
Global Address Book.  
Site  
The network site for the endpoint.The system determines  
the site based upon IP address.  
Serial Number  
The serial number (ASCII only) of the endpoint.The  
endpoint provides the serial number if it registered  
successfully or is managed.  
Software Version  
HTTP URL  
The version of the software installed on the endpoint  
(ASCII only). The endpoint provides the version number  
if it registered successfully or is managed.  
The management URL for the endpoint, if available  
(ASCII only). This URL allows the CMA system to start  
the endpoint ‘s management system using the Manage  
function.  
All Polycom endpoints allow management through a  
browser. For these endpoints, this field is completed  
when the endpoint registers with the CMA system.  
HTTP Port  
The HTTP port number for the endpoint. The endpoint  
provides the port number if it registered successfully and  
is managed.  
Addresses  
DNS Name  
The name for the endpoint as entered on the domain  
name server.  
SIP URI  
The address used to call the endpoint via SIP.  
<username>@host(domain or IP):Port  
172  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Endpoint and Peripheral Management Operations  
Field  
Description  
Aliases  
The aliases that allow you to connect to the endpoint.  
The CMA system converts the aliases to the IP address  
associated with the endpoint.  
Alias Type. Possible types include E.164, H.323 ID,  
URL, Transport Address, E-mail, Party Number, and  
Unknown.  
Alias Value. Value for the alias type shown.  
Notes  
The following Alias Values are ASCII only: H323 ID,  
URL, Transport Address, and Unknown.  
The value for the H.323 ID is the endpoint name if the  
endpoint registered with the gatekeeper and it is a  
third-party system. In other cases, the endpoint  
name is the system name, which might be different  
from the H323 ID.  
The value of the E.164 alias is the extension dialed  
to reach this endpoint.  
ISDN Video  
Number  
For ISDN endpoints only, the country code + city/area  
code + local phone number for the endpoint.  
When you add an endpoint without native ISDN, the  
ISDN gateway, country code, and area code are not  
captured. The CMA system only supports native ISDN.  
Capabilities  
Supported  
Protocols  
The communications protocols that the endpoint can  
support. Possible values include:  
IP (H.323) - A standard that defines the protocols  
used for multimedia communications on  
packet-based H.323 networks.  
IP (SIP) - A standard that defines the protocols used  
for multimedia communications on SIP networks.  
ISDN (H.320) - A standard that defines the protocols  
used for multimedia communications on switched  
networks, such as ISDN.  
For endpoints with the type Unknown, select H.323.  
The endpoint automatically provides the protocols if it  
registered successfully or is managed.  
Required MCU  
Service  
The MCU service selected for the endpoint to use.  
Polycom, Inc.  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
Capabilities  
Enabled  
Capabilities enabled on this endpoint. Options are:  
MCU - The endpoint can act as a control unit for  
multipoint conferences  
Gateway - The endpoint can act as a gateway for  
call management  
The MCU provides the capability if it registered  
successfully or is managed.  
Monitoring Level  
The monitoring level for the endpoint. Possible values  
include:  
Standard. This endpoint is monitored.  
VIP. This endpoint is monitored closely. The VIP  
identifier and filters are available to operators to  
monitor and manage conferences.  
Available to  
Schedule  
Identifies if the endpoint is available when users are  
scheduling conferences  
8
Click Add.  
The endpoint appears in the Endpoint list. By default, the system may  
also:  
Add the endpoint to the applicable site.  
Set the HTTP Port to 80  
Add an Alias for the endpoint.  
Make the endpoint Available to Schedule  
Set the Monitoring Level to Standard  
Note  
For third-party endpoints, the HTTP URL, serial number, and DNS name are not  
captured during endpoint registration.  
Once you’ve added an endpoint, you can associate it with a user. See “Assign  
Edit an Endpoint  
The CMA system automatically detects IP address changes and updates its  
database with the new information for Polycom and third-party endpoints  
that are registered with the CMA system.  
174  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint and Peripheral Management Operations  
To edit an endpoint in the CMA system  
1
2
3
4
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.  
Select the endpoint of interest and click Edit  
.
As required, edit the Identification, Addresses, and Capabilities  
sections of the Edit Device dialog box. For more information, see “View  
Note that many fields in this dialog box are ASCII only.  
5
Click Update.  
Note  
Editing information for an endpoint on the CMA system does not change the  
information in the endpoint. To make changes in the endpoint information, use  
Provisioning or change it at the endpoint interface. Note that for managed  
endpoints, the endpoint may overwrite settings entered manually.  
Delete an Endpoint  
To delete an endpoint from the CMA system  
1
2
3
4
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.  
Select the endpoint of interest and click Delete.  
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
The Endpoint list is updated.  
Note  
If your gatekeeper registration policy allows endpoints to register automatically with  
the CMA system (that is, a gatekeeper setting of Allow Registration of All  
Endpoints or Allow Registration of Endpoints in Defined Sites or Allow  
Registration of Predefined Prefixes Only) an endpoint that you delete may  
re-appear in the Endpoint list.  
Polycom, Inc.  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
View an Endpoints Video Feed  
Note  
This procedure is available on the following endpoint types:  
Polycom HDX system  
TANDBERG  
V-Series and VSX-Series  
ViewStation  
To view the video feed for an endpoint (near site or far site)  
1
2
3
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the Endpoint list.  
Select the endpoint of interest and click View Details.  
The Device Details dialog box appears. For information about these  
4
Click Call Info to expand the Call Info options and select Video Feed.  
The Endpoint Video section shows the video feed from the near and far  
site.  
Clear an Endpoint Help Request  
To clear an endpoint help request from the CMA system  
1
2
3
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the Endpoint list.  
Select the endpoint of interest and click Clear Help.  
The Confirm Endpoint Help Clear dialog box appears.  
4
To send a message to the endpoint as well as clear the help request, check  
Also send message to endpoint.  
5
6
Click Clear.  
If you selected the Also send message to endpoint check box, enter the  
text message to send the endpoint in the Send Message to Endpoint  
dialog box and click Send.  
The Endpoint list is updated and alerts for the endpoint are cleared.  
Note  
If the reason for the original alert still exists on the endpoint, the alert will likely  
reappear in the Endpoint list.  
176  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Endpoint and Peripheral Management Operations  
Send a Message to an Endpoint  
In some situations, such as in response to a help request, you can send a  
message to some types of endpoints.  
To send a message to an endpoint from the CMA system  
1
2
3
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the Endpoint list.  
Select the endpoint of interest.  
If the endpoint can receive text messages, a Send Message option appears  
in the Action menu.  
4
5
Click Send Message.  
In the Send Message to Endpoint dialog box, enter a text message and  
click Send.  
The message is sent to the endpoint.  
Reboot an Endpoint  
In some situations, for example when a remote endpoint is unresponsive, you  
may need to reboot an endpoint remotely through the CMA system.  
To reboot an endpoint from the CMA system  
1
2
3
4
5
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the Endpoint list.  
Select the endpoint of interest.  
Click Reboot Device.  
To confirm the request, click Reboot.  
Associate a User with an Endpoint  
To associate an endpoint to a user within the CMA system  
1
2
3
4
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the Endpoint list.  
Select the endpoint of interest.  
Click Associate User.  
Polycom, Inc.  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
5
In the Last Name field of the Associate User dialog box, enter all or part  
of the user’s last name and click Search.  
The system displays the list of users who meet your search criteria.  
6
Select the user of interest and click Close.  
Search for Endpoints in a Range of IP Addresses  
To search for a set of endpoints within a range of IP addresses  
1
2
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View and click Search Devices.  
In the Search Devices dialog box, enter the starting IP address and  
ending IP address for the search range and click Search.  
The system begins searching for endpoints. A progress bar displays the  
status of the search and a results message displays the number of  
endpoints searched and the number of endpoints found within the IP  
range.  
View Peripherals  
If an endpoint has one or more peripherals connected, you can view  
information about the peripherals.  
1
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View and select an endpoint that has  
peripherals connected.  
2
3
Click View Peripherals.  
From the Peripherals dialog box, select the peripheral of interest to see  
the following information.  
Field  
Description  
Status  
The status shows if a paired peripheral is one of the  
following connection states:  
Connected  
Disconnected  
Paired Endpoint  
Name of the HDX or RealPresence Group Series  
endpoint that the peripheral is connected to.  
Serial Number  
IP Address  
The serial number of the peripheral.  
IP address of the peripheral, if applicable.  
Version of the peripheral hardware.  
Version of the peripheral software.  
Hardware Version  
Software Version  
178  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Endpoint and Peripheral Management Operations  
Peripheral View Operations  
The following topics describe the actions available in the Endpoint >  
Peripherals View:  
Delete Peripheral  
You can delete peripherals from the Peripherals View list when the peripheral  
is no longer connected to an endpoint.  
1
Go to Endpoint > Peripherals View and select a peripheral that is listed  
as Not Paired.  
2
3
Click Delete Peripheral.  
In the Confirm Delete dialog box, click Yes.  
Display Applications  
For peripherals on which you can install multiple applications, you can  
display a list of installed applications and their version.  
1
2
Go to Endpoint > Peripherals View and select a peripheral.  
Click Display Applications.  
The Applications Installed on dialog box for the selected peripheral  
appears.  
Field  
Description  
Application Name  
Version  
Name of the peripheral application.  
Version of the peripheral application.  
3
Click Close.  
Polycom, Inc.  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
180  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11  
Endpoint Provisioning Operations  
This chapter discusses Polycom® Converged Management Application™  
(CMA®) system automatic and scheduled endpoint provisioning operations.  
It includes these topics:  
Bundled Provisioning Operations  
This topic describes the bundled provisioning operations a user assigned the  
Device Administrator role can perform. These are:  
Bundled provisioning is not available when Maximum Security is enabled.  
View the Provisioning Bundle List  
To view the provisioning bundle list  
1
2
Go to Endpoint > Bundled Provisioning.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the list of provisioning bundles.  
Polycom, Inc.  
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Download a Provisioning Bundle  
After you download a provisioning bundle for a specific HDX or RealPresence  
Group Series model, any dynamically managed HDX or RealPresence Group  
Series system of the same model will receive the provisioning bundle when an  
HDX or RealPresence Group Series system next polls the CMA system for new  
provisioning information.  
If a provisioning bundle already exists for the model you select, the existing  
bundle is overwritten with the new one.  
For more information about provisioning bundles, see “Bundled  
To download a provisioning bundle  
1
2
Go to Endpoint > Bundled Provisioning.  
Click Download.  
The Download Provisioning Bundle From an Endpoint dialog lists all of  
the HDX and RealPresence Group Series systems registered with the CMA  
system.  
3
4
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.  
Select an HDX or a RealPresence Group Series system that is configured  
the way you want for the provisioning bundle.  
5
6
Complete the Bundle Name and Description fields.  
Click Download.  
The system confirms that the bundle downloaded successfully.  
Click OK.  
7
Delete a Provisioning Bundle  
When you no longer need a provisioning bundle for an HDX or a RealPresence  
Group Series model, you can delete it. An existing provisioning bundle is also  
removed when you download a bundle for the same HDX or RealPresence  
Group Series model. The newly downloaded bundle overwrites the existing  
one.  
1
2
3
4
5
Go to Endpoint > Bundled Provisioning.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the list of provisioning bundles.  
Select the bundle you want to delete.  
Click Delete.  
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
The system confirms that the bundle was deleted.  
182  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Endpoint Provisioning Operations  
Automatic Provisioning Operations  
This topic describes the automatic provisioning operations a user assigned the  
Device Administrator role can perform. These are:  
View the Automatic Provisioning List and Details  
To view the automatic provisioning list and details about an automatic  
provisioning operation  
1
2
3
4
Go to Endpoint > Automatic Provisioning.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the Endpoint list.  
Select the endpoint of interest.  
Expand the Provisioning Details tab in the Device Details section.  
Add an Automatic Provisioning Profile  
This topic describes how to add automatic provisioning profiles.  
TIP  
Add provisioning profiles in the middle of the work day, not first thing in the morning.  
When you add an automatic provisioning profile, the CMA system  
immediately rolls it out. If it rolls it out first thing in the morning, people who  
need to attend a “start the day” conference will have to first wait for their  
endpoint to be provisioned. Better to implement profiles in the middle of the  
work day and then let the provisioning occur at the designated polling  
interval.  
To add an automatic provisioning profile  
1
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Automatic Provisioning  
Profiles.  
Polycom, Inc.  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
2
3
4
In the Automatic Provisioning Profiles page, click Add  
.
In the Add Profile dialog box, enter a name for the profile and click Next.  
Complete the System Settings, Home Screen Settings, H.323 Settings,  
Call Settings, Audio Settings, and (if applicable) CMA Desktop Settings  
sections of the Provisioning Fields dialog box.  
For information about these fields, see “Automatic Provisioning” on  
page 107. The sections may differ depending on the endpoint type  
selected.  
5
6
Click OK.  
The provisioning profile appears at the bottom of the Automatic  
Provisioning Profiles list.  
To change the priority order of the automatic provisioning profiles:  
a
Click in the Profile Order text box preceding the provisioning profile  
of interest and enter the priority for the profile.  
b
Click Update Profile Order.  
The system assigns the provisioning profile the selected priority and  
shuffles and reassigns priorities to the other provisioning profiles.  
Edit an Automatic Provisioning Profile  
To edit an automatic provisioning profile  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Automatic Provisioning  
Profiles.  
In the Automatic Provisioning Profiles page, select the profile of interest  
and click Edit  
.
Edit the System Settings, Home Screen Settings, H.323 Settings, Call  
Settings, Audio Settings, and (if applicable) CMA Desktop Settings  
sections of the Provisioning Fields dialog box.  
For information about these fields, see “Automatic Provisioning” on  
page 107. The sections may differ depending on the endpoint type  
selected.  
4
Click OK.  
The provisioning profile is updated.  
184  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint Provisioning Operations  
Edit the Profile Order for an Automatic Provisioning Profile  
To edit the profile order for an automatic provisioning profile  
1
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Automatic Provisioning  
Profiles.  
2
In the Automatic Provisioning Profiles page, select the profile of interest,  
click in the Profile Order text box preceding the provisioning profile of  
interest, and enter the priority for the profile.  
3
Click Update Profile Order.  
The system assigns the provisioning profile the selected priority and  
shuffles and reassigns priorities to the other provisioning profiles.  
Clone an Automatic Provisioning Profile  
To clone an automatic provisioning profile  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Automatic Provisioning  
Profiles.  
In the Automatic Provisioning Profiles page, select the profile of interest  
and click Clone  
.
In the Clone Profile dialog box, enter a name for the new profile and click  
Save.  
The provisioning profile appears last in the Automatic Provisioning  
Profiles list.  
4
As needed, edit the profile. See “Edit an Automatic Provisioning Profile”  
Delete an Automatic Provisioning Profile  
To delete an automatic provisioning profile  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Automatic Provisioning  
Profiles.  
In the Automatic Provisioning Profiles page, select the profile of interest  
and click Delete  
.
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
The profile is deleted from the CMA system.  
Polycom, Inc.  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Scheduled Provisioning Operations  
This topic describes the scheduled provisioning operations a user assigned the  
Device Administrator role can perform. These are:  
View the Scheduled Provisioning List and Details  
To view the automatic provisioning list and details about a scheduled  
provisioning operation  
1
2
3
4
Go to Endpoint > Scheduled Provisioning.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the Endpoint list.  
Select the endpoint of interest.  
Expand the Provisioning Details tab in the Device Details section.  
Add a Scheduled Provisioning Profile  
To add a scheduled provisioning profile  
1
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Scheduled Provisioning  
Profiles.  
2
3
In the Scheduled Provisioning Profiles page, click Add  
.
In the Add Profile dialog box, select the Endpoint Type for the  
provisioning profile, enter a name for the profile, and click Next.  
186  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Endpoint Provisioning Operations  
4
5
As needed, select Provision This Page and complete the General  
Settings, Video Network, Monitors, Cameras, Audio Settings, LAN  
Properties, and Global Services sections of the Provisioning Fields  
dialog box.  
For information about these fields, see “Scheduled Provisioning” on  
page 113. The sections may differ depending on the endpoint type  
selected.  
Click OK.  
The provisioning profile appears in the updated Scheduled Provisioning  
Profiles list.  
Edit a Scheduled Provisioning Profile  
To edit a scheduled provisioning profile  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Scheduled Provisioning  
Profiles.  
In the Scheduled Provisioning Profiles list, select the profile of interest  
and click Edit Profile.  
As needed, select Provision This Page and complete the General  
Settings, Video Network, Monitors, Cameras, Audio Settings, LAN  
Properties, and Global Services sections of the Provisioning Fields  
dialog box.  
For information about these fields, see “Scheduled Provisioning” on  
page 113. The sections may differ depending on the endpoint type  
selected.  
4
Click OK.  
The provisioning profile is updated.  
Clone a Scheduled Provisioning Profile  
To clone a scheduled provisioning profile  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Scheduled Provisioning  
Profiles.  
In the Scheduled Provisioning Profiles page, select the profile of interest  
and click Clone Profile.  
In the Clone Profile dialog box, enter a name for the new profile and click  
Save.  
The provisioning profile appears first in the updated Scheduled  
Provisioning Profiles list.  
Polycom, Inc.  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
4
Edit the sections of the Provisioning Fields dialog box. The sections and  
fields differ depending on the endpoint type selected. For more  
information on these fields, see the product documentation for the  
selected endpoint.  
5
6
Review each page of the scheduled provisioning profile and determine if  
you want the parameters on the page provisioned. If you do want the  
parameters on the page provisioned, select Provision This Page.  
Click OK.  
The provisioning profile is updated.  
Delete a Scheduled Provisioning Profile  
To delete a scheduled provisioning profile  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Scheduled Provisioning  
Profiles.  
In the Scheduled Provisioning Profiles page, select the profile of interest  
and click Delete Profile.  
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
The profile is deleted from the CMA system.  
Schedule an Endpoint for Provisioning  
To schedule an endpoint for provisioning  
1
2
3
4
5
Go to Endpoint > Scheduled Provisioning.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.  
Select the endpoints of interest.  
Click Provision.  
In the Schedule Endpoint Provisioning dialog box, select the  
appropriate provisioning profile.  
6
7
8
In the Schedule field, select Now or Later.  
If you select Later, enter a Date and Time for the provisioning.  
Select either Use Server Date/Time or Use Endpoint Date/Time as these  
may differ.  
9
Click Schedule.  
The Scheduled Provisioning View reappears.  
188  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Endpoint Provisioning Operations  
10 Click Refresh  
and check the Pending column for the provisioning  
status.  
For each endpoint you selected, the name of the profile appears in the  
Pending column, and the date and time you entered appears in the  
Scheduled column.  
Check the Status of a Scheduled Provisioning  
To check the status of a scheduled provisioning  
1
2
3
4
Go to Endpoint > Scheduled Provisioning.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.  
Select the endpoint of interest.  
Expand the Provisioning Details tab in the Device Details section.  
For information about the fields in this section, see “View the Scheduled  
Clear the Status of Scheduled Provisioning  
To clear the status of a scheduled provisioning  
1
2
3
4
Go to Endpoint > Scheduled Provisioning.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.  
Select the endpoints of interest.  
Click Clear Status.  
The endpoint provisioning status returns to Clear.  
Cancel a Scheduled Provisioning  
You can only cancel provisioning of a Pending process. You cannot cancel the  
provisioning of an endpoint while it is In Progress.  
To cancel a pending scheduled provisioning  
1
2
3
Go to Endpoint > Scheduled Provisioning.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.  
Select the endpoints of interest.  
Polycom, Inc.  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
4
Click Cancel Provision.  
The provisioning operation is cancelled and the provisioning status  
returns to Clear.  
190  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
Endpoint Software Update  
Operations  
This chapter describeshow to use Polycom® Converged Management  
Application™ (CMA®) system to update the software on Polycom endpoints  
when a new software package is available. It includes these sections:  
Automatic Software Update Operations  
For automatic software update, it includes these topics:  
View Automatic Software Update Information  
To view information for endpoints that are eligible for automatic software  
updates  
1
Go to Endpoint > Automatic Software Update.  
The Automatic Software Update page appears.  
2
3
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list. Filter choices  
include Type, Name, IP Address, ISDN Video Number, Alias, and Site.  
Select the endpoint of interest.  
Polycom, Inc.  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
4
In the Device Details section, expand the Software Update Details tab.  
View Automatic Software Update Packages  
To view the list of automatic software update packages  
1
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.  
The Automatic Software Updates page appears and the Polycom HDX  
Series automatic software update packages are displayed. The Automatic  
Software Updates page includes this information.  
Field  
Description  
Version to use  
Displays the default automatic software update  
profile to be used for the endpoint type and  
model.  
Allow this version or newer When checked, indicates that when a newer  
automatic software update package for the  
endpoint type and model is added, that package  
should be used as the default package.  
Endpoint Type  
The type of endpoint system. For valid endpoint  
system types, see “Endpoint  
Version  
The version of the software package associated  
with the automatic software update package.  
Description  
Uploaded  
Trial Group  
The meaningful name given to the automatic  
software update package when it was created.  
The date and time when the automatic software  
update package was created.  
The trial group assigned to the software update  
package, if applicable.  
2
To view the Polycom CMA Desktop automatic software update  
packages, click the CMA Desktop tab.  
192  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint Software Update Operations  
Set Maintenance Window for Automatic Software Updates  
You can restrict automatic software updates of dynamically-managed  
endpoint systems to a scheduled maintenance window.  
Typically, automatic software updates occur as specified by the Software  
Update Polling Interval (Admin > Site > Edit Site Provisioning Details >  
Provisioning Settings). Enabling the maintenance window feature in the  
CMA system overrides the Software Update Polling Interval. The CMA  
system provisions the maintenance window to the endpoints, and the  
endpoints hold their automatic software update requests until the  
maintenance window starts.  
Some notes about this feature:  
It applies to dynamically-managed HDX and RealPresence Group Series  
systems only.  
To avoid automatically updating the software on all HDX or RealPresence  
Group Series systems at the start of the maintenance window, the systems  
randomize their automatic software update requests.  
To restrict automatic software updates to a scheduled maintenance window  
1
Go to Admin > Software Update > Automatic Software Update >  
Maintenance Window.  
2
In the Maintenance Window dialog box, click Enable Maintenance  
Window and set a maintenance window Start Time and either an End  
Time or Duration.  
Set the maintenance window start time to the endpoint’s system local  
time, not the CMA system local time. For example, if you set the  
maintenance window start time to 3am, the maintenance window for each  
HDX system will start at 3am local time. Therefore, the maintenance  
window for HDX systems in Buffalo, NY will start at 3am EST; the  
maintenance window for HDX systems in Denver, CO will start at 3am  
MST; and the maintenance window for HDX systems in San Francisco, CA  
will start at 3am PST.  
3
Click Save.  
Implement Automatic Software Updates for Endpoints  
To implement automatic software updates, complete the following tasks:  
1
2
3
Polycom, Inc.  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
4
on page 196. For more information on software update packages, see  
5
List the Serial Numbers for the Endpoints to be Updated  
To list the serial numbers for the endpoints to be updated  
1
2
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.  
Click Get Serial Numbers  
.
The Endpoint Serial Number List appears listing the endpoints eligible  
for automatic software update. Endpoints without serial numbers and  
endpoints that are not actively managed by the system are excluded.  
3
4
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.  
Select the specific endpoints to be updated. To select all endpoints in the  
list, click the check box in the column header.  
5
6
Click Get Serial Numbers.  
The serial number(s) appear in the text box on the page.  
When updating a single endpoint:  
a
b
Record the serial number:____________________________________  
Click Close.  
The Automatic Software Updates list reappears.  
c
7
When updating multiple endpoints:  
a
Create a .txtfile that you can submit to the Polycom Product  
Activation site. Put each License Number - Serial Number  
combination on a separate line as shown in the following example.  
X1006-3202-3027-0101  
X1009-0453-6027-0202  
X1009-1624-6027-0303  
VR207071500x  
VR207071500x  
VR207071500x  
b
c
Return to the Endpoint Serial Number List and click Close.  
The Automatic Software Updates list reappears.  
Repeat steps 2 through 7 for each endpoint or set of endpoints to be  
updated. You may include all of the serial numbers for all of the  
different endpoint types in the same .txtfile.  
d
Save the .txt file.  
194  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Endpoint Software Update Operations  
e
Download the Required Software Package  
To download the software package required to update the endpoint  
1
On your local system, create a directory to which to save the software  
package (if one does not already exist).  
2
For Polycom endpoints:  
a
b
Open a web browser and go to http://support.polycom.com.  
In the Documents and Downloads section, select the Product Type  
for the required software package (Telepresence and Video for video  
endpoints such as Polycom HDX systems or Voice for endpoints such  
as Polycom VVX systems).  
c
On the product listing page, click the link to the product page of  
interest.  
d
e
Select the software package and save it to the directory created in  
step 1.  
Repeat steps a through d for each endpoint type to be updated. Note  
that the software package may contain the software for different  
models of the same endpoint type.  
3
For third-party endpoints, follow the company’s recommended  
procedure for downloading a software package. Save it to the directory  
created in step 1.  
Request Update Activation Keys  
Note  
In general, you need an activation key when updating to a major release (for  
example, 3.x to 4.x) or minor release (for example, 3.1 to 3.2). You do not need an  
activation key when updating a point release (for example, 3.1.1 to 3.1.2). However,  
you should read the product release notes for specific information about whether or  
not you’ll need an activation key.  
To request upgrade activation keys  
1
2
3
For Polycom endpoints, open a web browser and go to  
http://support.polycom.com  
.
In the Licensing & Product Registration section, select the  
Activation/Upgrade.  
Log in or Register for An Account.  
Polycom, Inc.  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
4
5
Select Product Activation.  
To activate a single license:  
a
b
c
Click SITE & Single Activation/Upgrade.  
Enter the Serial Number and click Next.  
Read and click Accept Agreement to continue.  
d
Enter the License Numbers you received for the upgrade and click  
Upgrade.  
e
f
The key code is returned on the screen.  
Record the key code and create a .txtfile with the Serial Number -  
Key Code combination to be updated.  
6
To activate a batch of licenses:  
a
b
Click Batch Activation.  
Click Browse and browse to the location of the .txt file you created  
in step 7 on page 194.  
c
Click Upload.  
A file containing the Serial Number - Key Code combinations will be  
E-mailed to the specified E-mail account.  
d
When you receive the .txtfile, save it to your local system.  
7
For third-party endpoints, follow the company’s recommended  
procedure for requesting an upgrade activation key.  
Upload the Software Package and Create a Software Update  
Package  
After you receive notification about a new software package for a Polycom  
endpoint, upload the software update to the CMA system and create a  
software update profile to use for the update.  
Note  
When uploading a software package, log into the CMA system web interface using  
its fully qualified domain name (for example, CMAsystem.domain.com) rather than  
its IP address. As long as your browser did not display any certificate errors when  
logging in, you should be able to upload the software package successfully.  
To upload the software package and create an automatic software update  
profile  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.  
Select the tab for the endpoint type of interest.  
Click Upload Software Update.  
196  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint Software Update Operations  
4
5
In the Upload Software Update dialog box, verify the endpoint type and  
model.  
If an activation key code is required to activate the software update, click  
the Update Requires Key check box and in the Software Update Key  
File field browse to the .txt key file received in “Request Update  
Note  
The key is generated from the endpoint serial number and version number, and  
Polycom sends it as a text (.txt) file to the customer when new software is  
available. Customers can review their key history at  
http://support.polycom.com  
.
6
7
Enter a meaningful description that will help other users to understand  
the purpose of the software update.  
Click OK.  
An automatic software update profile for the endpoint type and model  
type appears in the Automatic Software Updates list.  
If you receive a message that indicates “This version is the first for its  
endpoint type, so it will be assumed to be the policy for this endpoint  
type,” the software update profile also appears in the Version to use field.  
Set an Automatic Software Update Policy  
To set an automatic software update policy for an endpoint type  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.  
Select the tab for the endpoint type of interest.  
Choose one of these policies:  
To specify a minimum version of automatic software update package,  
make that version the Version to use and select Allow this version or  
newer.  
To require a specific version of automatic software update package,  
make that version the Version to use and clear Allow this version or  
newer.  
To turn automatic software update off for an endpoint type, change  
the Version to use value to (none).  
4
Click Update.  
Polycom, Inc.  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Trial a Software Update Package  
To trial a software update package:  
1
Get the things you need to create the package. Complete these tasks:  
a
b
c
2
Set up testing. Complete these tasks:  
a
b
Package” on page 199. For more information on software update  
3
Once your testing of the trial software package is complete, do one of  
these tasks:  
Create a Local Trial Group  
To trial a software update with a specific group of local and/or enterprise  
users, create a local group that includes these users, as described in “Add a  
Local Group” on page 268. The people in this group will receive the trial  
software update package when their endpoint goes through its normal,  
automated software update process.  
Notes  
You can use an existing enterprise group as a trial group, but you will not be  
allowed to change the enterprise group in any way.  
If the trial software group is a parent group with children, all of its children will  
inherit trial permissions.  
198  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Endpoint Software Update Operations  
Upload the Software Package and Create a Trial Software Update  
Package  
To upload the software package and create a trial automatic software update  
package  
1
2
3
4
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.  
Select the tab for the endpoint type of interest.  
Click Upload Software Update.  
In the Upload Software Update dialog box, verify the endpoint type and  
model.  
5
If an activation key code is required to activate the software update, click  
the Update Requires Key check box and in the Software Update Key  
File field browse to the .txt key file received in “Request Update  
Note  
The key is generated from the endpoint serial number and version number, and  
Polycom sends it as a text (.txt) file to the customer when new software is  
available. Customers can review their key history at  
http://support.polycom.com  
.
6
7
Enter a meaningful description that will help other users to understand  
the purpose of the software update.  
To trial the software with the group created previously, select Trial  
Software and from the Select Trial Group menu, select the trial group  
8
Click OK.  
A trial automatic software update package for the endpoint type and  
model type appears in the Automatic Software Update list. You can tell it  
is a trial package, because the Trial Group column includes your entry.  
The next time members of the trial group log into the system, their systems  
will be upgraded with the trial software package.  
Promote the Trial Software Update Package to Production  
If you determine that the trial software update package is acceptable for  
production, you can then promote it to production.  
To promote a trial software update package to production  
1
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.  
Polycom, Inc.  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
2
3
Select the tab for product to update.  
Select the software update package of interest and click Promote to  
Production.  
4
Click Yes to confirm the promotion.  
The package becomes a production automatic software update package.  
Delete the Trial Software Update Package  
If you determine that the trial software update package is unacceptable for  
production, you can delete it.  
To delete a trial software update package  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.  
Select the tab for product to update.  
Select the software update package of interest and click Delete Software  
Update.  
4
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
The package is removed from the Automatic Software Updates list.  
5
6
To return your trial group to the last production version of software, clear  
the Allow this version or newer option and click Update.  
When all endpoints are back to the last production version of software,  
reset your automatic software update policy. See “Set an Automatic  
View and Implement Software Updates for Peripherals  
For peripherals that permit software updates from the CMA system, you can  
download the updates from http://support.polycom.comand make them  
available from the CMA system web server. You also configure which updates  
are for trial or production use. The following topics describe software updates  
for peripherals:  
Note  
When doing peripheral upgrades on redundant systems running Microsoft SQL  
Server 2005 or 2008 R1, you may receive an SQL server exception. To resolve this  
exception, upload the peripheral upgrade package to the secondary server as well.  
200  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Endpoint Software Update Operations  
View Software Updates for Peripherals  
To view software updates for peripherals  
1
2
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.  
Select the tab for a peripheral.  
The tab includes this information.  
Field  
Description  
Production URL  
URL where the peripheral can access software  
updates configured for production use. The URL  
consists of the IP dress of the CMA system plus  
/repo.  
Trial URL  
URL where the peripheral can access software  
updates configured for trial use. The URL  
consists of the IP dress of the CMA system plus  
/repotrial.  
Package Name  
Displays the name of the software update  
package. Updates listed as platform are  
updates to the peripheral’s operating system.  
Other updates are for specific applications.  
Description  
The meaningful name given to the software  
update package when it was created  
Version  
Status  
The version of the software package  
The status of the software update. Possible  
values are:  
None - The software update has not been  
configured for production or trial.  
Production - The software update is  
configured for production. It is available only  
from the Production URL.  
Trial - The software update is configured for  
trial. It is available only from the Trial URL.  
Both - The software update is configured for  
both production and trial. It is available from  
both the Production URL and the Trial  
URL.  
Uploaded  
The date and time when the software update  
package was uploaded  
Polycom, Inc.  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Upload Peripheral Software Updates to the CMA Web Server  
After you download the software updates from  
http://support.polycom.comand save them on your hard drive, you can  
upload them to the CMA system web server.  
To upload software updates to the CMA system web server  
1
2
3
4
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.  
Select the tab for the peripheral.  
Click Upload Software Update.  
In the Select File to Upload dialog box, navigate to and select the  
software update that you saved to your hard drive.  
5
Click Open.  
The update is added to the list on the peripheral tab.  
Note  
If this is the first update for the platform or an application, the update is  
automatically configured for production.  
Configure Peripheral Updates for Production  
To configure software updates for production  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.  
Select the tab for the peripheral.  
Click Configure Production.  
The Configure Production dialog box includes the following information.  
Field  
Description  
Configure Platform  
Platform Description  
The meaningful name given to the platform  
software update package when it was created  
202  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Endpoint Software Update Operations  
Field  
Description  
Status  
The current status of the platform software  
update. Possible values are:  
None - The software update has not been  
configured as production or trial.  
Production - The software update is  
configured as production. It is available only  
from the Production URL.  
Trial - The software update is configured as  
trial. It is available only from the Trial URL.  
Both - The software update is configured as  
both production and trial. It is available from  
both the Production URL and the Trial URL.  
Configure Application  
Application Description  
The meaningful name given to the application  
software update package when it was created  
Platform Compatible  
Status  
Column title shows the version of the currently  
selected platform. Use the drop-down list to  
select available application versions that match  
the platform version.  
The current status of the application software  
update. Possible values are:  
None - The software update has not been  
configured as production or trial.  
Production - The software update is  
configured as production. It is available only  
from the Production URL.  
Trial - The software update is configured as  
trial. It is available only from the Trial URL.  
Both - The software update is configured as  
both production and trial. It is available from  
both the Production URL and the Trial URL.  
4
From the Configure Platform section, select the platform version to  
configure for production.  
You can select only one platform version for production.  
5
6
Click Configure Application.  
For each application, select the version to configure for production from  
the Platform Compatible drop-down list.  
The version selected must be compatible with the platform version listed  
in the column heading. If the application is not selected (no check mark),  
the application will not be configured for production.  
Polycom, Inc.  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
7
Click OK.  
From the peripheral itself, the configured software updates are now  
available using the Production URL.  
Configure Peripheral Updates for Trial  
To configure software updates for trial  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.  
Select the tab for the peripheral.  
Click Configure Trial.  
The Configure Trial dialog box includes the following information.  
Field  
Description  
Configure Platform  
Platform Description  
The meaningful name given to the platform  
software update package when it was created  
Status  
The current status of the platform software  
update. Possible values are:  
None - The software update has not been  
configured as production or trial.  
Production - The software update is  
configured as production. It is available only  
from the Production URL.  
Trial - The software update is configured as  
trial. It is available only from the Trial URL.  
Both - The software update is configured as  
both production and trial. It is available from  
both the Production URL and the Trial  
URL.  
Configure Application  
Application Description  
The meaningful name given to the application  
software update package when it was created  
Platform Compatible  
Column title shows the version of the currently  
selected platform. Use the drop-down list to  
select available application versions that match  
the platform version.  
204  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint Software Update Operations  
Field  
Description  
Status  
The current status of the application software  
update. Possible values are:  
None - The software update has not been  
configured as production or trial.  
Production - The software update is  
configured as production. It is available only  
from the Production URL.  
Trial - The software update is configured as  
trial. It is available only from the Trial URL.  
Both - The software update is configured as  
both production and trial. It is available from  
both the Production URL and the Trial  
URL.  
4
From the Configure Platform section, select the platform version to  
configure for trial.  
You can select only one platform version for trial.  
5
6
Click Configure Application.  
For each application, select the version to configure for trial from the  
Platform Compatible drop-down list.  
The version selected must be compatible with the platform version listed  
in the column heading. If the application is not selected (no check mark),  
the application will not be configured for trial.  
7
Click OK.  
From the peripheral itself, the configured software updates are now  
available using the Trial URL.  
Scheduled Software Update Operations  
For scheduled software update, it includes these topics:  
Polycom, Inc.  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
View Scheduled Software Update Information  
To view information about software updates that are scheduled or for endpoints  
that are eligible for scheduled software updates  
1
2
Go to Endpoint > Scheduled Software Update.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list. Filter choices  
include Type, Name, IP Address, ISDN Video Number, Alias, and Site.  
3
4
Select the endpoint of interest.  
In the Device Details section, expand the Software Update Details tab.  
View List of Software Update Packages  
To view the list of scheduled software update packages  
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Scheduled Software Updates.  
The Scheduled Software Updates page appears listing all of the endpoint  
types and models for which the CMA system can perform a scheduled  
software update. It includes this information. If a software update package  
has been uploaded to the system, the Description and Uploaded fields are  
populated for the endpoint.  
Implement Scheduled Software Updates for Endpoints  
To implement a scheduled software update, you must perform this series of  
tasks.  
1
2
3
4
on page 196. For more information on software update profiles, see  
5
List the Serial Numbers for the Endpoints to be Updated  
To list the serial numbers for the endpoints to be updated  
1
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Scheduled Software Updates.  
206  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Endpoint Software Update Operations  
2
3
Select the appropriate Endpoint Type and Endpoint Model combination  
for the endpoint to update.  
Click Get Serial Numbers  
.
The Endpoint Serial Number List appears listing the endpoints of the  
selected type and model that are eligible for scheduled software updates.  
4
5
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.  
Select the specific endpoints to be updated. To select all endpoints in the  
list, click the check box in the column header.  
6
7
Click Get Serial Numbers.  
The serial number(s) appear in the text box on the page.  
When updating a single endpoint:  
a
b
Record the serial number:_____________________________________  
Click Close.  
The Scheduled Software Updates list reappears.  
8
When updating multiple endpoints:  
a
Copy and paste the serial numbers from the endpoint serial number  
list to a .txtfile that you can submit to the Polycom Product  
Activation site. Put one serial number per line as shown in the  
following example.  
82071007E1DACD  
82070407E010CD  
820418048078B2  
82040903E00FB0  
b
c
Return to the endpoint serial number list and click Close.  
The Scheduled Software Updates list reappears.  
Repeat steps 2 through 8 for the each endpoint or set of endpoints to  
be updated. You may include all of the serial numbers for all of the  
different endpoint types in the same .txtfile.  
d
Save the .txt file.  
Download the Required Software Package  
To download the software package required to update the endpoints  
1
On your local system, create a directory to which to save the software  
package (if one does not already exist).  
2
For Polycom endpoints:  
a
Open a web browser and go to http://support.polycom.com.  
Polycom, Inc.  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
b
c
In the Downloads section, select the Product and Category for the  
required software package.  
Select the software package and save it to the directory created in  
step 1.  
d
Repeat steps a through d for each endpoint type to be updated. Note  
that the software package may contain the software for different  
models of the same endpoint type.  
3
For third-party endpoints, follow the company’s recommended  
procedure for downloading a software package. Save it to the directory  
created in step 1.  
Request Update Activation Keys  
To request upgrade activation keys  
1
For Polycom products  
a
b
c
Go to http://support.polycom.com  
Log in or Register for An Account.  
Select Product Activation.  
.
d
In the Software Upgrade KeyCode section, click Retrieve Software  
KeyCode.  
e
When upgrading a single endpoint:  
»
Enter the serial number of the endpoint to be updated into the  
Serial Number field of the Single Upgrade Key Code section.  
»
Enter the version number to which you are upgrading and click  
Retrieve.  
»
»
The key code is returned on the screen.  
Record the key code and create a .txtfile with the Serial Number  
- Key Code combination to be updated.  
»
Close the Product Activation screens.  
f
When updating multiple endpoints from a prepared .txtfile (step 7  
on page 194):  
»
»
»
»
In the Multiple Upgrade KeyCode section, click Add  
Attachment.  
Browse to the location of the .txt file you created in step 7 on  
page 194 and click Upload.  
A file containing the Serial Number - Key Code combinations will  
be E-mailed to the specified E-mail account.  
When you receive the .txtfile, save it to your local system.  
208  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint Software Update Operations  
»
Close the Product Activation screens.  
2
For third-party endpoints, follow the company’s recommended  
procedure for requesting an upgrade activation key.  
Upload the Software Package and Create a Software Update  
Profile  
To upload the software package and create an automatic software update  
profile  
1
2
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Scheduled Software Updates.  
On the Software Update Profiles list, click the check box to select the  
appropriate Endpoint Type and Endpoint Model combination for the  
endpoints to be updated. To select all endpoints in the list, click the check  
box in the column header.  
3
4
In the Upload Software Update dialog box, verify the endpoint type and  
model.  
If an activation key code is required to activate the software update, click  
Update Requires Key and in the Software Update Key File field browse  
to the .txt key file (received in “Request Update Activation Keys” on  
Note  
The key is generated from the endpoint serial number and version number, and  
Polycom sends it as a text (.txt) file to the customer when new software is  
available. Customers can review their key history at  
http://support.polycom.com.  
5
6
Enter a meaningful description that will help other users to understand  
the purpose of the software update.  
Click OK.  
A scheduled software update profile for the endpoint type and model type  
is created.  
7
In a redundant configuration, repeat steps 1 through 6 on the redundant  
server.  
Schedule the Software Update for Endpoints  
To schedule one or more endpoints for software update  
1
Go to Endpoint > Scheduled Software Update.  
Polycom, Inc.  
209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
2
3
4
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.  
Select the endpoints of interest and click Software Update.  
In the Schedule Software Update dialog box, specify when the update  
should occur.  
a
b
c
In the Schedule field, select Now or Later.  
If you select Later, enter a Date and Time for the update.  
Select either Use Server Date/Time or Use Endpoint Date/Time as  
these may differ.  
5
Select from these options.  
Fields  
Description  
Remove address  
book entries  
Select this check box to have all local address book  
entries removed after the update.  
Remove system files  
Select this check box to have all endpoint settings  
removed after the update. You must then reconfigure  
the endpoint.  
Allow endpoint to be  
a DHCP server  
Select this check box to allow the endpoint to be a  
DHCP server.  
Applies to V-Series, VSX-Series, and ViewStation  
endpoints only. For more information, see the  
endpoint’s user guide.  
Note  
You may apply a single software update request to multiple endpoint models. If the  
request includes one or more scheduling options that are not valid for a selected  
endpoint model, the system applies only the options that are valid.  
6
Click Schedule.  
For each endpoint selected, the status changes to Pending and the date  
and time for the software update appears in the Scheduled column.  
Cancel Software Updates  
You can cancel scheduled software updates for an endpoint. You cannot  
explicitly cancel automatic software updates for an endpoint. You must do  
that at the endpoint.  
To cancel scheduled software updates  
1
Go to Endpoint > Scheduled Software Update.  
210  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Endpoint Software Update Operations  
2
3
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.  
Select the endpoint or endpoints of interest and click Cancel Update.  
A confirmation dialog box appears. The dialog box may indicate that one  
or more of the selected endpoints had a software update in progress.  
4
Click Ok to cancel in progress and future software updates for the  
selected endpoints and clear their status.  
You can cancel software update operations that are in progress, but you  
may wish to check the endpoint afterward to verify it was left in a  
operational state.  
Polycom, Inc.  
211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
212  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
13  
Device Details  
This chapter lists the fields found in the Device Detail section of the Polycom®  
Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system interface. It includes  
these topics:  
Device Summary Information  
The Device Summary information in the Device Details section includes the  
following fields.  
Field  
Name  
Type  
Description  
The name of the device.  
The type of device. For valid device types, see “Endpoint  
ID  
The system-generated ID for the device.  
(Endpoints only) The user associated with the device.  
The assigned IP address of the device.  
Owner  
IP Address  
Area  
Area with which the device is associated.  
Polycom, Inc.  
213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
ISDN Video  
Number  
For ISDN devices only, the country code + city/area code +  
phone number for the device.  
When you add an endpoint without native ISDN, the ISDN  
gateway, country code, and area code are not captured.  
The CMA system only supports native ISDN.  
Site  
The network site for the device. By default, devices are  
added to the Primary Site.  
Software Version  
The version of the software installed on the device (ASCII  
only). The device provides the version number if it  
registered successfully or is managed.  
Serial Number  
The serial number (ASCII only) of the device.The device  
provides the serial number if it registered successfully or is  
managed.  
Available to  
Schedule  
Select this option to make the device available when users  
are scheduling conferences.  
Note  
The Available to schedule field is disabled for MGC and  
RMX devices.  
Monitoring Level  
(Endpoints only—grayed out for MCU devices.)  
The monitoring level for the device. Possible values include:  
Standard. This device is monitored.  
VIP. This device is monitored closely. The VIP identifier  
and filters are available to operators to monitor and  
manage conferences.  
Supported  
Protocols  
The communications protocols that the device can support.  
Possible values include:  
IP (H.323) - A standard that defines the protocols used  
for multimedia communications on packet-based  
networks, such as IP.  
ISDN (H.320) - A standard that defines the protocols  
used for multimedia communications on switched  
networks, such as ISDN.  
For devices with the type Unknown, select H.323.  
The device automatically provides the protocols if it  
registered successfully or is managed.  
Notes  
If an endpoint is configured as a gateway (ISDN), only  
the H.323 check box is selected. If the endpoint  
supports true ISDN, the H.323 and ISDN check boxes  
are selected.  
RMX MCUs support only the H.323 protocol.  
214  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Device Details  
Field  
Description  
Capabilities to enable on this device. Options are:  
Capabilities  
Enabled  
MCU - The device can act as a control unit for multipoint  
conferences  
Gateway - The device can act as a gateway for call  
management  
The MCU provides the capability if it registered successfully  
or is managed.  
Note  
Currently, RMX MCUs cannot be Gateway devices.  
Alias (type)  
The alias to connect to the device. The CMA system  
converts the aliases to the IP address associated with the  
device.  
Alias Type. Possible types include E.164, H.323 ID,  
URL, Transport Address, E-mail, Party Number, and  
Unknown.  
Alias Value. Value for the alias type shown.  
Device Status Information  
The Device Status information in the Device Details section includes the  
following fields.  
Field  
Description  
Gatekeeper  
Registration  
The status of the device’s registration with the gatekeeper  
service. Possible values include:  
Registered  
Unregistered  
Directory  
Registration  
The status of the device’s registration with the Global  
Directory Service. Possible values include:  
Registered  
Unregistered  
Presence  
Registration  
The status of the device’s registration with the presence  
service. Possible values include:  
Registered  
Unregistered  
Exchange  
Registration  
The status of the device’s registration with the Microsoft  
Exchange service.  
SIP Registration  
The status of the device’s registration with the SIP service.  
Polycom, Inc.  
215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
Device Managed  
Indicates whether or not the CMA system is managing the  
device.  
Last GK  
The date and time of the device’s last gatekeeper  
Registration  
registration in a default format of mm-dd-yyyy hh:mm:ss  
AM | PMwith adjustment to the client-machine GMT offset  
Device Local Time  
The local time as set within the device in a default format of  
hh:mm:ss AM | PM. This field is blank for the following  
device types: MGC, RMX, GW/MCU, Other, and  
TANDBERG.  
ISDN Line Status  
Type  
The status of the ISDN line. Possible values include:  
Operational  
Non-operations  
This field is blank for the following device types: PVX, MGC,  
RMX, GW/MCU, Other, and TANDBERG.  
ISDN Assignment  
Type  
How the ISDN type was assigned to the device. Possible  
values include:  
Administrator, when the ISDN type was assigned  
manually by an administrator  
Endpoint, when the ISDN type was natively assigned in  
the endpoint  
Auto-Assigned, when the ISDN type was automatically  
assigned by the CMA system based on the site  
configuration  
From Network, when the ISDN type was derived from  
the gateway and extension  
Undefined, when the CMA system cannot identify the  
source for the ISDN type assignment  
This field is blank for the following device types: PVX, MGC,  
RMX, GW/MCU, Other, and TANDBERG.  
Device ISDN Type  
The ISDN network interface type installed in the device.  
Possible values include:  
ISDN_QUAD_BRI  
ISDN_PRI_T1  
ISDN_BRI  
ISDN_UNKNOWN  
This field is blank for the following device types: PVX, MGC,  
RMX, GW/MCU, Other, and TANDBERG.  
216  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Device Details  
Call Information  
The Call Info in the Device Details section includes the following fields.  
Field  
Description  
Call Type  
The connection protocol for the call in which the device is  
participating. Possible values include: H.323, H.320, and  
S.IP  
Video Protocol  
The video connection protocol, both transmission (Tx) and  
reception (Rx), the device is using. Possible values include:  
H.261—H.261 is an ITU standard designed for two-way  
communication over ISDN lines and supports data rates  
which are multiples of 64Kbit/s. H.261 supports CIF and  
QCIF resolutions.  
H.263—H.263 is based on H.261 with enhancements  
that improve video quality over modems. It supports  
CIF, QCIF, SQCIF, 4CIF and 16CIF resolutions.  
H.264  
Video Format  
Audio Protocol  
The video format, both transmission (Tx) and reception  
(Rx), the device is using.  
The audio connection protocol, both transmission (Tx) and  
reception (Rx), the device is using. Possible values include:  
G.711  
G.722  
G.728  
Far Site Name  
The H.323ID of the far site device to which the selected  
endpoint is connected. When multiple endpoints are  
connected through the device's embedded MCU, this field  
displays a concatenation of each endpoint's H.323ID  
separated by ' | ', for example 'ISDN-CO1-7-1 | Vsfx-9-1'.  
Far Site Number  
The address of the far site device to which the selected  
endpoint is connected. The address value for the calling  
device appears to be the dialed address. The address value  
for the called device appears to be the IP Address.  
Cause Code  
Encryption  
Standard H.323 cause code that reflects normal call  
termination or the nature of an internal failure, for example,  
'16' or '211'.  
The status of encryption for the call. Possible values  
include: Off, Disabled, AES, and DH-1024  
Polycom, Inc.  
217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Device Alerts Information  
The Device Alerts information in the Device Details section includes the  
following fields.  
Field  
Description  
Errors  
Device error message text, for example, GK Registration  
error  
Warnings  
Device warning message text, for example, Low Battery  
Provisioning Details  
The Provisioning Details information in the Device Details section includes  
the following fields.  
Field  
Description  
Last Profile Applied  
The name of the last provisioning profile that was or was not  
successfully applied to the device. The Provisioning  
Status will be either Success or Failed.  
Provisioning Status  
The device’s current provisioning status. Possible values  
include:  
Clear. No provisioning has been done.  
Pending. Provisioning is scheduled for this device.  
In Progress. The device is currently being provisioned.  
Success. Provisioning has been completed  
successfully on this device.  
Failed. Provisioning was not completed on this device.  
Some endpoint systems expect all configuration fields to be  
provisioned. If any of the fields are not provisioned, the  
status will indicate failed. However, the endpoint will often  
function successfully.  
Pending Profile  
Scheduled  
The name of the provisioning profile that is scheduled to be  
applied to the device. In this case, the Provisioning Status  
will be either Pending or In Progress.  
This field is blank if the device is not scheduled for  
provisioning.  
The date and time, in the default format of yyyy-mm-dd  
hh:mm, when the device is scheduled to be provisioned.  
This field is blank if the device is not scheduled for  
provisioning.  
218  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Device Details  
Field  
Description  
Last Attempt  
Date/Time  
The date and time, in the default format of yyyy-mm-dd  
hh:mm:ss, of the last provisioning message exchanged with  
the device.  
Failure Reason  
A text description of the reason the provisioning failed.  
Causes for failure include:  
The provisioning profile does not exist  
The provisioning profile does not include provisioning  
information  
The CMA system no longer manages the device  
A password for the device is set in the video endpoint  
system, and you must enter it in the CMA system  
The device is busy  
A network error occurred  
An incomplete transfer of provisioning information  
occurred  
Provisioning has timed out  
An internal error occurred on the device, and you must  
reboot it  
An unknown error occurred. Reboot the device.  
Log Message  
A read-only text box that contains messages related to the  
device provisioning status  
Software Update Details  
The Software Update Details information in the Device Details section  
includes the following fields.  
Field  
Description  
Software Update  
Status  
The device’s software update status. Possible values  
include:  
Clear. A software update has not been done.  
Pending. A software update has been scheduled and is  
pending. The device may be offline or in a call.  
In Progress. The software update is in progress.  
Success. A software update has completed  
successfully.  
Failed. A software update could not be performed.  
Polycom, Inc.  
219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
Scheduled  
The date and time, in the default format of yyyy-mm-dd  
hh:mm, when the device software is scheduled to be  
updated.  
This field is blank if the device is not scheduled for  
provisioning.  
Last Attempt  
Date/Time  
The date and time, in the default format of yyyy-mm-dd  
hh:mm:ss, of the last software update message exchanged  
with the device.  
Failure Reason  
A text description of the reason the software update failed.  
Causes for failure may include:  
The software update file location does not exist.  
A password for the device is set in the video endpoint  
system, and you must enter it in CMA.  
A network error has occurred.  
The update has timed out.  
An internal error occurred on the device, and you must  
reboot it.  
A profile has not been configured.  
An endpoint is offline.  
An incorrect activation key is in the key file.  
An unknown error has occurred. Reboot the device  
Log Message  
A read-only text box that contains the log message text  
recorded during the execution of the software update.  
Note that there are no log messages displayed for  
dynamically-managed endpoints.  
220  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14  
Network Device Management  
Overview  
This chapter provides an overview of the Polycom® Converged Management  
Application™ (CMA®) system’s network device management functions. It  
includes these topics:  
Network Device Types  
A CMA system supports these network device types:  
Polycom MGC conferencing bridges  
Polycom RMX conferencing bridges  
Polycom Distributed Management Application™ (DMA®) systems  
Polycom Video Border Proxy (VBP) systems  
Network Device Menu, Views, and Lists  
The CMA system Network Device menu provides these views of the network  
device list:  
Monitor View—Displays the list of all manageable and registered  
network devices. Use this view to manage network devices.  
VBPs (Video Border Proxy systems)—Displays the list of Polycom VBP  
systems registered to the CMA system. Use this view to add, edit, or delete  
VBP systems.  
Polycom, Inc.  
221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
MCUs (Microprocessing Control Units)—Displays the list of Polycom  
MCUs (Polycom RMX or MGC conferencing platforms) registered to the  
CMA system. Use this view to add, edit, or delete MCUs.  
DMAs (Distributed Management Application systems)—Displays the list  
of Polycom DMA systems) registered to the CMA system. Use this view to  
add, edit, or delete DMA systems.  
All of the Network Device views have the following information:  
Section  
Views  
Description  
The views you can access from the page  
The set of available commands. The constant command in  
Actions  
the Network Device views is Refresh  
, which updates  
the display with current information.  
Network Device List The context-sensitive Network Device list for the selected  
view  
Device Details  
Information about the network device selected in the  
network device list including:  
Monitor View  
Use the Network Device > Monitor View to monitor the network devices.  
Network Device List in the Monitor View  
By default, the Network Device list in the Monitor View displays a list of  
network devices the CMA system monitors, including those devices that  
registered automatically with the CMA system and those devices that were  
added manually for management and monitoring purposes.  
The Network Device list in the Monitor View includes MCUs and Polycom  
DMA nodes. It does not include Polycom VBP devices.  
The Network Device list in the Monitor View displays MCUs as two separate  
Device Types, the MCU type and a GW/MCU device. If automatic registration  
is allowed, individual H.323 cards and/or IP blades in Polycom MCUs are  
assigned the device type of GW/MCU during registration. This device type  
represents the cards’ network interface. If automatic registration is not  
allowed, you must add a GW/MCU device record for each H.323 card and IP  
blade.  
222  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Network Device Management Overview  
The Network Device list has these fields.  
Field  
Description  
Filter  
Use the filter choices to display other views of the Network  
Device list, which include:  
Type- Filters the list by device type. For more  
Alerts- Filters the list by alert type: Help, Error, or  
Warning  
Connection Status- Filters the list by connection  
status: In a Call, Online, or Offline  
Name - Filters the list by system name entered  
IP Address - Filters the list by IP address entered  
Alias - Filters the list by the alias entered  
Site - Filters the list by site location entered  
Area - Available only when Areas are enabled. Filters  
the list by the area with which the device is associated.  
Status  
The state of the network device. Possible values include:  
Online  
Offline  
In a call  
Unknown  
Device alert  
Gatekeeper registration error  
Name  
Type  
The system name of the network device  
The type of network device. For valid device types, see  
IP Address  
Site  
The IP address assigned to the network device  
The site to which the network device belongs  
The alias assigned to the network device  
Alias  
Area  
Available only when Areas are enabled. The area with  
which the network device is associated.  
Polycom, Inc.  
223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Actions in the Monitor View  
Besides providing access to the network device views, the Actions section of  
the Monitor View may also include these context-sensitive commands  
depending on the selected device type.  
Action  
Use this action to...  
Available for all device types  
Add  
Manually add a network device to the CMA system or find a  
network device on the network  
View  
Display all of the Device Details for the selected network  
Details  
device  
Edit  
Change connection settings for the selected network  
device. Note that if this is a managed device, the device  
may overwrite settings entered manually.  
Delete  
Delete the selected network devices  
Associate Area  
Available only when Areas are enabled. Associate the  
selected network device to an area so that only specified  
users can manage it.  
Available for only selected network device types  
Manage Open the selected network device’s management interface  
in a separate browser window. This command is not  
available for the following device types: MGC, GW/MCU,  
and Other.  
VBP View  
Use the VBP View to manage Polycom Video Border Proxy™ (VBP™) firewall  
devices on the network.  
Polycom VBP devices, when installed at the edge of the operations center,  
secures critical voice, video, and data infrastructure components including  
VoIP softswitches, video gatekeepers, gateways, media servers, and  
endpoints.  
The VBP list has the following information.  
Field  
Description  
Name  
A unique name to identify the Polycom VBP device.  
The model of Polycom VBP device.  
Model  
Provider-side IP  
The private network IP address for the Polycom VBP  
device.  
224  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Network Device Management Overview  
Field  
Description  
Subscriber-side IP  
The public network IP address for the Polycom VBP  
device.  
MCU View  
DMA View  
Use the MCU View to manage Polycom MCU conferencing platforms on the  
network.  
The MCU list has the same fields as the Network Device > Monitor view. For  
The Polycom® Distributed Media Application (DMA) system is a multipoint  
conferencing manager that uses advanced routing policies to distribute voice  
and video calls among multiple media servers (Multipoint Control Units, or  
MCUs), creating a single virtual resource pool. This greatly simplifies video  
conferencing resource management and uses MCU resources more efficiently.  
Use the DMA View to manage DMA systems v2.3 or earlier. These earlier  
versions of the DMA system register with the CMA system as a  
Gateway/MCU and can be displayed in the DMA list.  
The DMA list has the following information.  
Field  
Description  
Name  
A unique name for the DMA system.  
The virtual IP address for the DMA system.  
Virtual IP Address  
Dial Prefix  
E.164 dial string prefix for calling the system. Must be  
unique among the gatekeeper’s devices and services.  
For more information, see the Polycom DMA 7000  
System Operations Guide.  
Description  
A useful description for the DMA system.  
IMPORTANT  
Newer versions of the DMA system (v3.0 or greater) include call server functionality  
(H.323 gatekeeper and SIP proxy/registrar). For that reason, these DMA systems  
do not register with the CMA system as a Gateway/MCU and should not be added  
to the CMA system as a network device. Instead, these DMA system should be  
added to the CMA system as a trusted neighbor.  
Polycom, Inc.  
225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
226  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
15  
MCU Bridge Management  
Operations  
This chapter describes how to perform the Polycom® Converged Management  
Application™ (CMA®) system MCU bridge management tasks. It includes  
these topics:  
View Device Details  
To view detailed information about a managed MCU bridge  
1
2
3
Go to Network Device > MCUs.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.  
Select the MCU of interest and click View Details  
.
Polycom, Inc.  
227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
The Device Details dialog box for the selected MCU appears.  
Field  
Description  
Identification  
System Name  
The name of the MCU.  
MCU names must be unique.  
The name must be in ASCII only and may have an  
unlimited number of characters. Spaces, dashes,  
and underscores are valid.  
When retrieved from the MCU, the name is taken  
from the H.323 ID if the MCU registered with the  
gatekeeper and it is a third-party system. In other  
cases, it is the system name, which might be  
different than the H.323 ID.  
Device Type  
The type of MCU. For valid types, see “Network Device  
IP Address  
Site  
The assigned IP address of the MCU  
The network site for the MCU. By default, MCUs are  
added to the Primary Site.  
Product ID  
Description  
A free-form text field (Extended ASCII only) in which  
information about the MCU can be added  
Serial Number  
Software Version  
HTTP URL  
The serial number (ASCII only) of the MCU.The MCU  
provides the serial number if it registered successfully or  
is managed.  
The version of the software installed on the MCU (ASCII  
only). The MCU provides the version number if it  
registered successfully or is managed.  
(RMX MCUs only) The management URL for the  
endpoint, if available (ASCII only). This URL allows the  
CMA system to start the endpoint ‘s management  
system using the Manage function.  
All Polycom endpoints allow device management  
through a browser. For these endpoints, this field is  
completed when the endpoint registers with the CMA  
system.  
For third-party endpoints that do not register using an IP  
address, you must enter the URL.  
HTTP Port  
(RMX MCUs only) The HTTP port number for the MCU  
communications. The MCU provides the port number if it  
registered successfully and is managed.  
By default, in non-secure (HTTP) mode, the RMX uses  
port 80 and in secure (HTTPS) mode, the RMX uses port  
443.  
228  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MCU Bridge Management Operations  
Field  
Description  
Addresses  
DNS Name  
Aliases  
The DNS name for the MCU.  
The aliases that allow you to connect to the MCU. The  
CMA system converts the aliases to the IP address  
associated with the MCU.  
Alias Type. Possible types include E.164, H.323 ID,  
URL, Transport Address, E-mail, Party Number, and  
Unknown.  
Alias Value. Value for the alias type shown.  
The value for the H.323 ID is the MCU name if the  
MCU registered with the gatekeeper and it is a  
third-party system. In other cases, the MCU name is  
the system name, which might be different from the  
H323 ID.  
Notes  
To add aliases for the MCU, edit the MCU.  
The following Alias Values are ASCII only: H323 ID,  
URL, Transport Address, and Unknown.  
ISDN Video  
Number  
The country code + city/area code + phone number for  
the MCU.  
Capabilities  
Supported  
Protocols  
The communications protocols that the MCU can  
support. Possible values include:  
IP (H.323) - A standard that defines the protocols  
used for multimedia communications on  
packet-based networks, such as IP.  
ISDN (H.320) - A standard that defines the protocols  
used for multimedia communications on switched  
networks, such as ISDN.  
The MCU automatically provides the protocols if it  
registered successfully or is managed.  
Capabilities  
Enabled  
Capabilities to enable on this MCU. Options are:  
MCU - The device can act as a control unit for  
multipoint conferences  
Gateway - (MGC MCUs only) The device can act as  
a gateway for call management  
The MCU provides the capability if it registered  
successfully or is managed.  
Available to  
Schedule  
Select this option to make the MCU available to users  
who are scheduling conferences  
Monitoring Level  
Not applicable to MCU devices.  
Polycom, Inc.  
229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
MCU (Network) Services  
Service Type  
The available network services may include:  
H.323 Service—Indicates a connection to an IP  
network using the H.323 protocol.  
H.320 Service—Indicates a connection to an ISDN  
phone line using the H.320 protocol.  
Gateway Service—(MGC MCUs only) Indicates a  
connection to both IP and ISDN to enable conversion  
from one protocol to the other.  
Direct Service—Indicates a direct connection  
between an MCU and a video endpoint system,  
using a serial cable.  
Service Name  
Priority  
A descriptive name for the network service.  
The priority set for the network service as compared to  
other services when it was created.  
MCU Resources  
Max Total  
Conferences  
Maximum number of total conferences allowed at once  
on this MCU.  
Max CP  
Conferences  
Maximum number of continuous presence (CP)  
conferences allowed, based on the number of licenses  
available.  
Max Video Ports  
(RMX MCUs only)  
Max Total  
Participants  
Maximum number of total MCU participants allowed at  
once on this MCU.  
Max Transcoding  
Ports  
(MGC MCUs only) Maximum number of transcoding  
ports on which both ISDN and IP participants can be  
connected.  
Use Entry Queue  
Indicates whether the MGC device supports an IVR.  
Entry Queue  
Number ID  
The IP number that conference participants dial to  
access the IVR prompt to join a conference.  
Max Bandwidth  
Capacity (Kbps)  
The maximum bandwidth supported by the Polycom  
RMX MCU.  
230  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MCU Bridge Management Operations  
Field  
Description  
Alerts (RMX MCUs only)  
Category  
Lists the type of error. The following categories may be  
listed:  
File – indicates a problem in one of the files stored on  
the MCU’s hard disk.  
Card – indicates problems with a card.  
Exception – indicates software errors.  
General – indicates a general error.  
Assert – indicates internal software errors that are  
reported by the software program.  
Startup – indicates errors that occurred during  
system startup.  
Unit – indicates problems with a unit.  
MPL - indicates an error related to a Shelf  
Management component (MPL component) other  
than an MPM, RTM or switch board.  
Level  
Code  
Indicates the severity of the problem, or the type of  
event. There are three fault level indicators:  
Major Error  
System Message  
Startup Event  
Indicates the problem, as identified by the error category  
Card Alerts (MGC MCUs only)  
Slot  
Displays an icon according to the HW component type  
and the slot number. The icon displays the hardware  
status as follows:  
An exclamation point (!) indicates errors in the HW  
component.  
Card icon with the reset button () indicates that the  
HW component is currently resetting.  
Card icon with diagnostic tools () indicates that the  
HW component is in diagnostic mode.  
Type  
The type of hardware card  
Polycom, Inc.  
231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Add an MCU Manually  
This topic describes how to add an MCU to a CMA system.  
Note  
Back-end communication with the RMX control units and IP service blades must be  
enabled.  
When you add an MCU device, MCU network services are added  
automatically at the time the IP card registers with the CMA system.  
When you add a gateway device, use the Services page to specify the network  
services available for the device.  
Notes  
Polycom RMX devices may only have H.323 service.  
Once an MCU registers with the CMA system, if you change an MCU service on  
the MCU, the update does not automatically get sent to the CMA system. To  
update the system, you must delete and read the MCU to the system.  
These network services are not the same as the Dial Plan Services such as  
Simplified Dialing and Conference on Demand. Network services describe  
the physical connection that the device supports. Dial plan services provide  
access to specific features used for routing calls by dialing a prefix.  
When you enter network service information manually, remember that the  
CMA system does not create the service at the device. The service must have  
already been defined at the device. Enter information in the CMA system that  
matches the information in the device.  
If you do not define network services, you may not use an MCU or gateway in  
a conference. For example, if you do not define the H.323 service on the MCU,  
when the CMA system tries to schedule a video conference that requires this  
service, it will look for another MCU with this service. If another MCU with  
this service is not available, the conference will not be scheduled.  
To add an MCU bridge to a CMA system or find an MCU on the network  
1
2
Go to Network Device > MCUs and click Add  
.
In the Add New Device dialog box, select the Device Type of interest.  
3
4
Enter the IP Address of the MCU.  
Enter the Admin ID and Password for the MCU.  
232  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
MCU Bridge Management Operations  
5
Click Find Device.  
If the CMA system can find the MCU on the network, the Add New  
Device dialog box is populated with information retrieved from the  
MCU. Review any information retrieved from the MCU.  
If the CMA system cannot find the MCU on the network, a Device Not  
Found dialog box appears.  
6
7
Click OK.  
Complete the Identification, Addresses, Capabilities, MCU Services,  
MCU Resources, and MCU Cascading sections of the Add New Device  
dialog box. (For more information, see “View Device Details” on  
page 227.) At a minimum, assign the MCU a System Name.  
Note  
When naming an RMX system, use lowercase letters to specify the FQDN in the  
System Name field.  
Pay particular attention to the Capabilities options, because the settings  
on it determine how the MCU is used throughout the CMA system.  
8
Click Add.  
The MCU appears in the Network Device list. By default, the system:  
Adds the MCU to the applicable site  
Sets the HTTP Port to 80  
Adds an Alias for the endpoint  
Makes the endpoint Available to Schedule  
Sets the Monitoring Level to Standard  
Notes  
In the Device List, a CMA system displays a single MCU as two separate  
Device Types (an RMX or MGC device and a GW/MCU device). The GW/MCU  
designation represents the network interface.  
For third-party endpoints, the HTTP URL, serial number, and DNS name are not  
captured during endpoint registration.  
Edit an MCU Bridge  
To edit an MCU from the CMA system  
1
2
Go to Network Device > MCUs.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.  
Polycom, Inc.  
233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
3
4
Select the MCU of interest and click Edit  
.
Complete the Identification, Addresses, Capabilities, MCU Services,  
MCU Resources, and MCU Cascading sections of the Edit Device dialog  
box. (For more information, see “View Device Details” on page 227.) At a  
minimum, assign the MCU a System Name.  
5
Click Update.  
Enable Cascading Conferences on Polycom MCUs  
To enable multi-bridge conferences, you must complete the following steps:  
1
Configure entry queues on the participating MCUs. Only bridges with  
entry queues are displayed in the list of available bridges to schedule on  
the people-to-bridge or bridge-to-bridge scheduling page.  
To configure cascading using a Polycom RMX MCU, you must create two  
cascading entry queues—one for which the Master option on the Cascade  
menu is selected and one for which the Slave option on the Cascade menu  
is selected. Also, enable the Use Entry Queue selection.  
The primary purpose for the Master and Slave designation is to determine  
which Polycom RMX MCU is responsible for managing People + Content  
for the conference.  
2
Configure MCU Cascading for each MCU on the CMA system by editing  
each MCU and referencing the appropriate entry queue ID and ISDN  
numbers.  
Some notes about cascading MCUs:  
A Polycom RMX 1000 MCU cannot be used for cascading.  
All devices (MCUs and endpoints) in a cascaded conference must be  
registered to the same CMA system gatekeeper.  
All systems (the CMA system, MCUs, and endpoints) must be time  
synchronized.  
Since ISDN cascade links on Polycom RMX MCUs are not supported, do  
not select Enable ISDN/PSTN Access. The CMA system only supports  
cascaded IP links on Polycom RMX MCUs. It does not support cascaded  
ISDN links on Polycom RMX MCUs.  
Polycom RMX systems enforce a 1x1 layout for the cascaded link between  
bridges, so only one participant on each bridge is displayed at any time.  
To change this on a Polycom RMX system, go to Setup > System  
Configuration and on the MCMS_PARAMETERS_USER page add a  
new flag called FORCE_1X1_LAYOUT_ON_CASCADED_LINK_CONNECTION  
with a Value of NO  
.
234  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
MCU Bridge Management Operations  
To enable cascading conferences  
1
On the MCUs, configure entry queues as required and record the entry  
queue number(s). For more information, see the product documentation  
for the MCU.  
2
3
4
5
Go to Network Device > MCUs.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.  
Select the MCU of interest and click Edit  
.
Go to the MCU Resources section of the Edit Device dialog box and  
select Use Entry Queue.  
6
7
Go to the MCU Cascading section of the Edit Device dialog box.  
For a Polycom RMX MCU:  
a
Enter the Master Entry Queue Number ID and Slave Entry Queue  
Number ID.  
b
(Optional) Enter the Master Entry Queue ISDN Number and Slave  
Entry Queue ISDN Number.  
8
9
For a Polycom MGC MCU:  
a
b
Enter the Cascade Entry Queue Number ID.  
(Optional) Enter the Cascade Entry Queue ISDN Number.  
Click Update.  
Delete an MCU Bridge  
To delete an MCU from the CMA system  
1
2
3
4
Go to Network Device > MCUs.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.  
Select the MCU of interest and click Delete.  
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
The MCU list is updated.  
View Bridge Hardware  
To view the hardware configuration of a bridge  
Go to Network Device > MCUs.  
1
Polycom, Inc.  
235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
2
3
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.  
In the MCU list, select the bridge of interest and click View Hardware.  
A Hardware pane appears below the bridge list. It lists the hardware for  
the selected bridge and displays the Slot number, Card Type, Status,  
Temperature, and Voltage for each piece of hardware.  
View Bridge Services  
To view the network services available on the bridge  
1
2
3
Go to Network Device > MCUs.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.  
In the MCU list, select the bridge of interest and click View Services.  
A Services pane appears below the bridge list. It lists the network services  
for the selected bridge and identifies the Service Type, Service Name, and  
the default setting for the network service.  
View Bridge Conferences  
To view information about the conferences resident on the bridge  
1
2
3
Go to Network Device > MCUs.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.  
In the MCU list, select the bridge of interest and click View Conferences.  
A Conferences pane appears below the bridge list. It lists the conferences  
for the selected bridge and identifies the conference Status, Type, Name,  
Start Time, Bridge, and Owner.  
View Bridge Ports  
To view information about the bridge ports  
1
2
Go to Network Device > MCUs.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.  
236  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MCU Bridge Management Operations  
3
In the MCU list, select the bridge of interest and click View Ports.  
A Ports pane appears below the bridge list. It lists the ports for the selected  
bridge and identifies the Audio Ports Available, Video Ports Available,  
Audio Ports in Use, and Video Ports in Use.  
View Bridge Meeting Rooms  
To view information about meeting rooms on a bridge  
1
2
3
Go to Network Device > MCUs.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.  
In the MCU list, select the bridge of interest and click View Meeting  
Rooms.  
A Meeting Rooms pane appears below the bridge list. It lists the meeting  
rooms for the selected bridge and identifies the meeting room by Name,  
ID, Duration, Conference, Chairperson, Profile.  
View Bridge Entry Queues  
To view information about entry queues on a bridge  
1
2
3
Go to Network Device > MCUs.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.  
In the MCU list, select the bridge of interest and click View Entry  
Queues.  
An Entry Queues pane appears below the bridge list. It lists the entry  
queues for the selected bridge and identifies the entry queue by Name, ID,  
Profile, and Dial-In Number.  
View Bridge Gateway Conferences  
To view information about gateway conferences on a bridge  
Go to Network Device > MCUs.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.  
1
2
Polycom, Inc.  
237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
3
In the MCU list, select the bridge of interest and click View Gateway  
Conferences.  
If the feature is available on the bridge, a Gateway Conferences pane  
appears below the bridge list. It lists the gateway conferences for the  
selected bridge.  
238  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
16  
Management Operations for Other  
Network Devices  
This chapter describes how to perform the Polycom® Converged Management  
Application™ (CMA®) system network device management tasks. It includes:  
Polycom VBP Management Operations  
The Polycom Video Border Proxy (VBP) device management operations  
include these topics:  
Polycom, Inc.  
239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Add a Polycom VBP Device  
IMPORTANT  
When you add a new Polycom VBP device, the CMA system will restart the user  
interface web service. This will interrupt others using the CMA system user  
interface.  
To add a Polycom VBP device to a CMA system  
1
2
Go to Network Device > VBPs and click Add  
.
Configure these settings in the Add VBP dialog box.  
Column  
Description  
Name  
A unique name to identify the Polycom VBP device.  
Provider-side IP  
The Private Network IP address for the Polycom  
VBP device.  
Subscriber-side IP  
The Public Network IP address for the Polycom VBP  
device.  
3
4
Click OK.  
A system dialog box appears indicating that you must restart Apache for  
the settings to take affect. You also have the opportunity to add another  
Polycom VBP device.  
Click Restart Apache.  
The Polycom VBP device is added to the CMA system. However, more  
configuration may be necessary for the device to operate in your network.  
For example, you will probably need to “Copy the CMA System  
Certificate to a Polycom VBP Device” as described in the next topic.  
Copy the CMA System Certificate to a Polycom VBP Device  
To copy the CMA system certificate to a Polycom VBP device  
1
2
Go to Network Device > VBPs  
Select the Polycom VBP device of interest and click Copy Certificate to  
VBP.  
In the Copy Certificate to VBP dialog box, the system automatically  
populates the Filename field with the filename of the CMA system  
certificate and the Username field with root.  
240  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Management Operations for Other Network Devices  
3
Enter the SSH or console Password for the root user and click OK.  
The Polycom VBP device appears in the Network Device list.  
Edit a Polycom VBP Device  
To edit a Polycom VBP device  
1
2
3
4
Go to Network Device > VBPs  
Select the Polycom VBP device of interest and click Edit  
.
Configure these settings as needed in the Edit VBP dialog box.  
Click OK.  
Delete a Polycom VBP Device  
To delete a Polycom VBP device from a CMA system  
1
2
3
Go to Network Device > VBPs.  
Select the Polycom VBP device of interest and click Delete  
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
.
Identify Endpoints Using the Polycom VBP Device  
Note  
This procedure identifies only Polycom HDX, Polycom RealPresence Group Series,  
and CMA Desktop systems that are:  
Registered to the CMA system  
Using the Polycom VBP firewall  
Operating in dynamic-management mode.  
One Polycom HDX or legacy endpoint system operating in standard management  
mode, registered to the CMA system, and using the Polycom VBP firewall may also  
be displayed in the Endpoint list. This entry may represent multiple endpoints,  
since all Polycom HDX or legacy endpoint system operating in standard  
management mode register with the same information.  
To identify which endpoints are using the Polycom VBP firewall  
1
2
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View.  
Click Select Filter and select IP Address.  
Polycom, Inc.  
241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
3
Enter the provider-side IP address of the Polycom VBP device and press  
Enter.  
The Endpoint list displays the dynamically-managed endpoints that are  
registered to the CMA system and using the Polycom VBP firewall. All of  
the endpoints display the same IP address, which is the Provider-side IP  
address of the Polycom VBP device. However, the endpoints will have  
different aliases and owners.  
Polycom DMA Management Operations  
The Polycom DMA device management operations includes these topics:  
Add a Polycom DMA System  
IMPORTANT  
Newer versions of the DMA system (v3.0 or greater) should not be added to the  
CMA system in this way. They include call server functionality (H.323 gatekeeper  
and SIP proxy/registrar), so they do not register with the CMA system as a  
Gateway/MCU. Instead, these DMA system should be added to the CMA system as  
a trusted neighbor.  
To add DMA system  
1
2
Go to Network Device > DMAs and click Add  
.
In the Add DMA dialog box, enter a unique and identifying Name and  
Description for the DMA system.  
3
4
Enter the E.164 dial string prefix for calling the system.  
Click Add.  
The DMA system appears in the Network Device list.  
Edit a Polycom DMA System  
To edit a DMA system  
1
2
Go to Network Device > DMAs.  
Select the DMA system of interest and click Edit  
.
242  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Management Operations for Other Network Devices  
3
4
In the Edit DMA dialog box, edit the Name, Description or Dial Prefix  
for the DMA system.  
Click OK.  
Delete a Polycom DMA System  
To delete a DMA system from a CMA system  
1
2
3
Go to Network Device > DMAs.  
Select the DMA system of interest and click Delete  
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
.
View Registered DMA Nodes  
Logically, the Polycom DMA system is a cooperative two-node cluster. When  
the CMA system is the gatekeeper for a DMA system (v2.3 and earlier) both  
nodes register with the CMA system and can accept and process calls.  
The CMA system routes calls destined for the Polycom DMA system to the  
first node that it finds available. If the first node isn’t available, it automatically  
routes the call to the second node.  
To view the registered DMA nodes  
1
2
Go to Network Device > DMAs.  
Click View DMA Nodes.  
The DMA Node List appears on the DMA page. It includes these columns  
Field  
Description  
Name  
The name of the DMA system node as sent at  
registration.  
IP Address  
Serial Number  
Site  
The IP address of the DMA system node as sent at  
registration.  
The serial number of the DMA system node as sent  
at registration.  
The location of the DMA system node as sent at  
registration.  
Gatekeeper Status  
The status of the DMA system node.  
Polycom, Inc.  
243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
244  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
17  
MCU Bridge Device Details  
This chapter lists the fields found in the MCU Device Detail section of the  
Polycom® Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system interface.  
It includes:  
MCU H.320 Services  
Field  
Description  
MCU H.32O Service  
Service Name  
Channels  
Name of the H.320 ISDN service  
Number of 64K channels dedicated to the MCU  
Number Range  
Dial-in number range of service. These ISDN numbers are  
available on an MCU for all endpoints to use. Also called  
direct inward dialing (DID).  
LCR Table  
The least-cost routing table for calls made through this  
gateway  
Local Prefix  
The prefix required to place a call to a local number outside  
the enterprise. For example, if you dial 9 to reach an  
outside line, the Local Prefix is 9.  
Non-Local Prefix  
The prefix required to dial long distance. For example, in  
certain states in the United States, you must dial 1 before  
you can dial a non-local number.  
Polycom, Inc.  
245  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
International Prefix  
The prefix required to dial an international number. For  
example, in many countries, the international prefix is 00.  
Local Area Code  
Priority  
A list of local area codes, separated by commas  
The priority order for this service  
MCU H.323 Services  
Field  
Description  
Service Name  
The name of the H.323 service (ASCII only) defined in  
the MCU.  
Dialing Prefix  
Prefix to select this service.  
The prefix for the MGC is located in the H.323 Service  
Properties dialog box of the MGC Manager.  
Service IP Address  
Alias  
IP address associated with this network service and  
with this H.323 card in the MCU.  
Alias for the service defined in the MCU.  
Note  
Polycom recommends using E.164 as the alias for this  
service.  
The number is dialed if the endpoints are registered  
with the same gatekeeper. If the endpoints are not  
registered with the same gatekeeper, they use their  
assigned IP address to connect.  
Port  
Number of IP connections available.  
The priority order for this service.  
Priority  
246  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
MCU Bridge Device Details  
MCU Gateway Services  
Field  
Description  
Service Name  
Dialing Prefix  
The name of the H.323 service defined in the MCU.  
Prefix to select this service.  
The prefix for the MGC is located in the H.323 Service  
Properties dialog box of the MGC Manager.  
H320 Service Name  
Select a defined H320 service.  
Channels  
Priority  
Number of 64K channels dedicated to the MCU.  
The priority order for this service.  
MCU Resources—Polycom MGC Platform  
Field  
Description  
Max Total Conferences  
Maximum number of total conferences allowed at  
once on this MCU.  
Max CP Conferences  
Maximum number of continuous presence (CP)  
conferences allowed, based on the number of  
licenses available.  
Max Total Participants  
Max Transcoding Ports  
Maximum number of total MCU participants  
allowed at once on this MCU.  
Maximum number of transcoding ports on which  
both ISDN and IP participants can be connected.  
Total IP Parties  
(Embedded MCU devices)  
Maximum number of IP calls that can be made  
from this endpoint.  
Total ISDN Parties  
(Embedded MCU devices)  
Maximum number of ISDN calls that can be made  
from this endpoint.  
Total Transcoded Parties  
(Embedded MCU devices)  
Maximum number of transcoded calls (IP and ISDN  
calls combined) that can be made from this  
endpoint.  
Use Entry Queue  
Indicates whether the MGC device supports an  
IVR.  
Entry Queue Number ID  
Entry Queue ISDN Number  
The IP number that conference participants dial to  
access the IVR prompt to join a conference.  
The ISDN-allocated phone number of the IVR.  
ISDN devices only.  
Polycom, Inc.  
247  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
MCU Resources—Polycom RMX Platform  
Field  
Description  
Max Total Conferences  
Maximum number of total conferences allowed at  
once on this MCU.  
Max CP Conferences  
Maximum number of continuous presence (CP)  
conferences allowed, based on the number of  
licenses available.  
Max Video Ports  
Maximum number of video ports on which  
participants can be connected.  
Max Total Participants  
Use Entry Queue  
Maximum number of total video participants  
allowed at once on this MCU.  
Indicates whether the RMX device supports an  
IVR.  
Entry Queue Number ID  
Entry Queue ISDN Number  
The number that conference participants dial to  
access the IVR prompt to join a conference.  
The number that conference participants dial to  
access the IVR prompt to join a conference.  
Audio & Video Settings: The following parameters must be set manually to  
synchronize with the RMX device. See the RMX documentation for more  
information about these settings.  
Max Voice Ports  
Set this to the maximum number of audio ports  
configured on the RMX device.  
Refer to the RMX 2000/4000 Administrator’s Guide  
for more information about this field.  
Note  
Up to 10 blocks of RMX video ports can be  
converted to 50 audio-only ports, up to a maximum  
of 200 audio-only ports.  
Max CP Resolution  
Set this to the highest available video format.  
Choices are: HD1080, CIF, SD15, SD30, and  
HD720.  
Refer to the RMX 2000/4000 Administrator’s Guide  
for more information about this field.  
Max Bandwidth Capacity  
(Kbps)  
The maximum bandwidth to the Polycom RMX  
system.  
248  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
18  
Users and Groups Overview  
This chapter provides an overview of the Polycom® Converged Management  
Application™ (CMA®) system users and groups management structure. It  
includes these topics:  
Overview of Groups, Users, and User Roles  
The CMA system allows users assigned the Administrator role to manage  
users, groups, user roles, permissions, and areas (if applicable).  
Most often, a CMA system is integrated with an enterprise directory from  
which users are imported. However, the CMA system also allows  
administrators to add local users (that is, users added manually to the system)  
and associate them with endpoints, groups, and roles.  
Users  
Local Users  
When you manually add local users, the CMA system manages all user  
information and associations.  
At a minimum, when you manually add users, you must enter a user’s First  
Name or Last Name, User ID, and Password. When you enter the minimum  
information, the CMA system automatically assigns local users the basic  
Scheduler role, unless you remove that assignment. They can then schedule  
conferences, be scheduled into conferences, and call into conferences.  
However, the system cannot call out to them until they are associated with  
endpoints.  
Polycom, Inc.  
249  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
You should associate local users with one or more roles and associate them  
with one or more endpoints. Alternatively, you can associate local users with  
roles by associating them with local groups.  
If your company has implemented the Areas feature, you can also associate  
local users with areas for which you are an administrator. For more  
information about areas, see “Area Overview and Operations” on page 347.  
Enterprise Users  
When the CMA system is integrated with an enterprise directory, the CMA  
system manages only the following pieces of an enterprise users’ information:  
the endpoints, roles, alert profiles, and areas assigned to them. The remaining  
information is pulled from the enterprise directory.  
Notes  
Currently, the CMA system supports only a Microsoft Active Directory  
implementation of an LDAP directory.  
The CMA system displays a user’s City, Title, and Department to help  
distinguish between users with the same name.  
When the CMA system is integrated with an enterprise directory, users  
imported into the system through the enterprise directory are by default  
added to the system without a role. This default set up allows users to log into  
the CMA system with their enterprise user IDs and passwords. They can then  
be scheduled into conferences and call into conferences. However, the system  
cannot call out to them until they are associated with endpoints.  
To be fully functional, you must associate enterprise users with one or more  
roles to control their access to system functions and associate them with one or  
more endpoints. Alternatively, you can associate enterprise users with roles by  
associating them with local or enterprise groups.  
If your company has implemented the Areas feature, you can also associate  
enterprise users with areas for which you are an administrator. For more  
information about areas, see “Area Overview and Operations” on page 347.  
If you want the CMA system to, by default, automatically assign enterprise  
users the basic Scheduler role, you must change the appropriate system  
Groups  
Groups provide a more efficient and consistent use of the CMA system,  
because they allow you to assign roles and provisioning profiles to sets of  
users rather than to individual users.  
250  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Users and Groups Overview  
Local Groups  
The CMA system allows you to add local groups (that is, groups added  
manually to the system) and associate them with provisioning profiles and  
roles.  
For local groups, the CMA system manages all group information and  
associations.  
Enterprise Groups  
When the CMA system is integrated with an enterprise directory, groups  
defined to the enterprise directory are not automatically added to the CMA  
system, but you can import them into the system.  
When the CMA system is integrated with an enterprise directory, the system  
manages only three pieces of group information: the provisioning profile  
assigned to the group, the roles assigned to the group, and whether or not the  
group is Directory Viewable (that is, displayed in endpoint directories). The  
remaining group information is pulled from the enterprise directory.  
To take full advantage of the CMA system, the enterprise Microsoft Active  
Directory must:  
Have Global Catalog turned ON. The Global Catalog enables searching for  
Active Directory objects in any domain without the need for subordinate  
referrals, and users can find objects of interest quickly without having to  
know what domain holds the object.  
Use universal groups. The Global Catalog stores the member attributes of  
universal groups only. It does not store local or global group attributes.  
Have a login account that has read access to all domains in the Active  
Directory that the CMA system can use. We recommend an account with  
a administrative username and a non-expiring password.  
Have the Active Directory Domain Name Service correctly configured.  
For more information about Active Directory design and deployment, see  
the Microsoft best practices guides at http://technet.microsoft.com.  
For system and endpoint directory performance purposes, two best practices  
in regards to enterprise groups are:  
Do not import more than 500 enterprise groups into a CMA system.  
Do not mark more than 200 enterprise groups as Directory Viewable.  
Polycom, Inc.  
251  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Roles and Permissions  
The CMA system is a role and permissions based system.  
Users are assigned one or more user roles either directly or through their  
group associations.  
User roles are assigned a set of permissions.  
Users see only the pages and functions available to their roles and  
associated permissions. Permissions are cumulative, so users see all of the  
pages and functions assigned to all of their roles and associated  
permissions.  
Notes  
Users inherit roles from their parent groups—local or enterprise. They cannot  
inherit roles from groups more distantly removed—for example, from their  
grandparent groups.  
The role names Administrator, Operator, and Scheduler are stored in the  
system database and are not localized into other languages. If you wish to  
localize their names into your language, edit the roles and enter new names for  
them.  
If your company has implemented the Areas feature, users only see  
endpoints assigned to their areas.  
An administrator has several options when implementing user roles.  
1
Implement only the default user roles and keep the standard permissions  
assigned to these roles.  
2
Implement only the default user roles but change the permissions  
assigned to these roles.  
Note  
To ensure CMA system access and stability, the default Administrator role cannot  
be deleted or edited.  
3
Implement either option 1 or 2, but also create additional unique,  
workflow-driven user roles and determine which permissions to assign  
to those user roles.  
While the CMA system allows businesses almost unlimited flexibility in  
defining roles, for simplicity and clarity, we recommend keeping the default  
roles with their default permissions and responsibilities. Because users can be  
assigned multiple roles, and permissions are cumulative, your business can  
combine roles as needed to reflect the workload your people undertake to  
manage and use the system.  
252  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Users and Groups Overview  
Some important notes about user roles and permissions:  
Users (local and enterprise) may be assigned more than one role. In this  
case, the permissions associated with those roles are cumulative; a user  
has all of the permissions assigned to all of his roles.  
Users (local and enterprise) may be assigned roles as an individual and as  
part of a group. Again, the permissions associated with those roles are  
cumulative; a user has all of the permissions assigned to all of his roles no  
matter how that role is assigned.  
Users assigned a role with any one of the Administrator Permissions are  
generally referred to as administrators. Users assigned a role with any one  
of the Operator Permissions and none of the Administrator Permissions  
are referred to as Operators. Users assigned a user role with Scheduler  
Permissions and none of the Administrator or Operator Permissions are  
referred to as Schedulers.  
Default CMA System Roles and Permissions  
The CMA system includes a default set of roles. Roles are associated with a set  
of permissions. Roles and permissions define the menus, pages, and functions  
that the system displays. So users see only the menus, pages, and functions  
associated with their roles.  
The following table identifies the default roles. Each of these roles is discussed  
in more detail in the following sections.  
Note  
The role names are stored in the system database and are not localized into other  
languages. If you wish to localized the role names into your language, edit the roles  
and enter new names for them.  
Role  
Permissions  
Comment  
Scheduler  
Schedule Conferences  
Scheduling Level = Basic  
Advanced Scheduler  
View-Only Scheduler  
Schedule Conferences  
Scheduling Level = Advanced  
Schedule Conferences  
Users with this role cannot schedule  
conferences; they can only see  
conferences scheduled  
Scheduling Level = View-Only  
Operator  
Conference Operator  
Reports  
Troubleshooting  
Polycom, Inc.  
253  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Role  
Permissions  
Comment  
Device Administrator  
Administrator  
Monitoring  
Directory Setup  
Dial Plan Setup  
Conferencing Setup  
System Setup  
This role cannot be deleted or edited.  
Assign Users to Areas (when activated)  
Associate Devices to Areas  
(when activated)  
System Maintenance/Troubleshooting  
Provision Profiles  
Auditor  
Auditor  
Except when operating in maximum security mode, most users will also see  
these menu items:  
Description  
Settings. Click here to display a Settings dialog box with the following information:  
User Name  
Remote Server  
Software Version  
Font Size  
In this dialog box, you can also:  
Change the font size used in your display of the CMA system web client  
interface.  
Change your password, if you are a local system user.  
Downloads. Click here to display the Downloads dialog box with the  
downloadable applications that are compatible with the CMA system.  
Downloadable applications include:  
CMA Desktop client for PC or MAC (including the path to the application)  
Polycom Scheduling Plugin for Microsoft Outlook  
Polycom Scheduling Plugin for IBM Lotus Notes  
Polycom File Verification Utility  
Log Out. Click here to log out of the CMA system.  
Note  
The CMA system has an inactivity timer. If you are logged into the system but do  
not use the interface for a specified period of time (10 minutes by default), the  
system automatically logs you out.  
Help. Links to the CMA system online help.  
254  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Users and Groups Overview  
Scheduler Roles, Responsibilities, and Menus  
The CMA system offers three different default Scheduler roles.  
,
Role  
Responsibilities  
Scheduler  
For the areas to which they belong (areas are optional),  
users assigned the Scheduler (sometimes called basic  
scheduler) role can schedule conferences. They do so  
using the conference templates defined for them. But  
basic schedulers cannot change any of the conference  
settings defined in the templates they choose when  
scheduling their conferences.  
Advanced Scheduler  
View-Only Scheduler  
For the areas to which they belong (areas are optional),  
users assigned the Advanced Scheduler role can also  
schedule conferences. And again they do so using the  
conference templates defined for them. But advanced  
schedulers can change selected conference settings  
defined in the template they use when scheduling their  
conferences.  
For the areas to which they belong (areas are optional),  
users assigned the View-only Scheduler role cannot  
schedule conferences; they can only see conferences  
that have been scheduled.  
When basic or advanced schedulers log into the CMA system, the system  
displays the Future conference page and they have access to the following  
menu items:  
When view-only schedulers log into the CMA system, the system displays the  
Ongoing conference page and it is the only menu item to which they have  
access.  
Operator Role, Responsibilities, and Menus  
The Operator role allows businesses to offer high-touch customer service for  
video conferencing. For the areas to which they belong, users assigned the  
Operator role can:  
Schedule conferences.  
Monitor and manage ongoing conferences.  
Monitor endpoints.  
Polycom, Inc.  
255  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Monitor network devices such as MCUs.  
Add, edit, and delete entries in the system Guest Book.  
Create favorites.  
View some system reports.  
When operators log into the CMA system, the system displays the Ongoing  
conference page and they have access to the following menu items:  
Device Administrator Role, Responsibilities, and Menus  
The Device Administrator role is for those users who administrate endpoints,  
bridges, and other network devices. For the areas to which they belong, users  
assigned the Device Administrator role can:  
Monitor endpoints, peripherals, and network devices.  
Add, edit, and delete endpoints and network devices.  
Provision endpoints.  
Update endpoints.  
Add, edit, and delete rooms.  
256  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Users and Groups Overview  
When device administrators log into the CMA system, the system displays the  
system Dashboard and they have access to the following menu items:  
Auditor Role, Responsibilities, and Menus  
The Auditor role allows security-conscious companies to separate system  
administration functions from system auditing functions. This provides an  
added level of system checks and balances. This role must be explicitly  
assigned by an administrator.  
For the areas to which they belong, users assigned the Auditor role can:  
• View audit logs.  
• Backup and delete audit logs.  
• Change the audit log file alert level.  
• Generate online Endpoint Usage Reports.  
• Download CDRs.  
• View and download system log files.  
• Download Windows event logs.  
• Respond to audit log alerts.  
When auditors log into the CMA system, the system displays the Audit Log  
Files page and they have access to the following menu items:  
Polycom, Inc.  
257  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Administrator Role, Responsibilities, and Menus  
The Administrator role is for those users who administrate the CMA system  
itself. Users assigned the Administrator role can generally do almost all  
system functions, however they cannot schedule conferences, monitor  
conferences, or manage endpoints or other network devices.  
When administrators log into the CMA system, the system displays the system  
Dashboard and they have access to the following menu items:  
Customized Roles and Responsibilities  
The CMA system allows you almost unlimited flexibility in defining and  
redefining roles, but for simplicity and clarity, we recommend keeping the  
default roles with their default permissions and responsibilities.  
Users can be assigned multiple roles and permissions are cumulative, so your  
business can combine roles as needed to reflect the workload your people  
undertake to manage and use the system.  
258  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Users and Groups Overview  
Device Associations and Presence  
The CMA system assumes that users will be associated with endpoints. You  
can associate a user with more than one endpoint, but one endpoint is  
designated as the primary endpoint.  
When scheduling a user in a conference, the CMA system will, by default,  
schedule the user’s primary endpoint. The scheduler can choose to change the  
request to schedule one of the user’s other endpoints.  
The CMA system is also a presence service, which is the part of the system that  
maintains online status information for the users of dynamically managed  
endpoints. The presence service allows users to access information about the  
online status of other users. This is important, because when you make a video  
call or start a chat, that action only takes you to an endpoint. It doesn’t ensure  
that you will reach the person you want to reach. The presence service  
provides information about the user’s availability, which improves your  
chances of getting the person.  
Polycom, Inc.  
259  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
260  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
19  
User Management Operations  
This chapter includes information on managing users and groups within the  
Polycom® Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system. It  
includes these topics:  
Manage Users  
In the CMA system, only users assigned the Administrator role can manage a  
user. Some of these tasks include:  
Search for a User  
To search for a user  
1
Go to User > Users and in the Search Users field, enter the name of the  
user of interest.  
Polycom, Inc.  
261  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Note  
Searches for a user are case-insensitive, prefix searches of the Username, First  
Name, and Last Name fields.  
2
3
To search for a local user, press Enter.  
To search both local and enterprise users, first clear the Local Users Only  
check box and then press Enter.  
Note  
If you are not in an enterprise domain, you will not have the option of searching for  
enterprise users.  
The first 500 users in the database that match your search criteria are  
displayed in the Users list.  
4
If the list is too large to scan, further refine your search string.  
View User Information  
You can view information about a user, local or enterprise.  
To view the address book a user is assigned to  
1
2
3
Go to User > Users.  
Select the user you want.  
Click View Details.  
Column  
Description  
General Info  
First Name  
Last Name  
User ID  
The user’s first name.  
The user’s last name.  
The user’s unique login name. This user ID must be  
unique across all rooms and users and across all  
domains.  
Email Address  
The user’s E-mail address. (The E-mail address is  
an ASCII-only field.)  
Note  
The CMA system identifies plugin users and their  
associated endpoints by E-mail address, so this is  
required information for the plugin to work.  
262  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
User Management Operations  
Column  
Description  
Title  
The user’s professional title.  
Department  
City  
The user’s department within the enterprise.  
The city in which the user’s office is located.  
The contact phone number for the user.  
Phone Number  
Associated Permissions  
Permission  
The set of permissions the user is assigned. For  
more information, see “Roles and Permissions” on  
Granted Through  
The role through which the permissions are  
assigned.  
Associated Roles  
Assigned Roles  
The roles assigned to the user. For more information,  
Groups  
Type  
The type of group to which the user belongs.  
Possible values are local and enterprise.  
Name  
The name of the group to which the user belongs.  
Inherited Group Info  
Address Book  
The Address Book(s) the user sees based upon the  
groups to which the user is assigned.  
Add a Local User  
To add a local user  
1
Go to User > Users and click Add.  
The Add New User dialog box appears. The Enable User option is  
selected by default.  
2
Enter the following user information.  
Column  
Description  
First Name  
Last Name  
The user’s first name  
The user’s last name  
Polycom, Inc.  
263  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Column  
Description  
User ID  
The user’s unique login name. This user ID must be  
unique across all rooms and users and across all  
domains.  
Password  
The user’s assigned password. This password must  
be a minimum of eight characters in length.  
Email Address  
The user’s E-mail address. (The E-mail address is  
an ASCII-only field.)  
Note  
The CMA system identifies plugin users and their  
associated endpoints by E-mail address, so this is  
required information for the plugin to work.  
Title  
The user’s professional title  
Department  
City  
The user’s department within the enterprise  
The city in which the user’s office is located  
The contact phone number for the user  
Phone Number  
3
4
In the Associated Endpoints section, select and move the required  
endpoints(s) to Selected Endpoints list. Move the unwanted endpoints(s)  
to the Available Endpoints list. Press Shift-click or Ctrl-click to select  
multiple items in the list.  
In the Associated Roles section, select and move the required role(s) to  
Selected Roles list. Move the unwanted role(s) to the Available Roles  
list. Press Shift-click or Ctrl-click to select multiple items in the list.  
Note  
If the user has multiple endpoints, list the endpoints in order of priority, with the  
primary endpoint first.  
5
If Areas are enabled, in the Associated Areas section, select one of the  
following options to associate the user with an area.  
— None—Does not allow access to any endpoints.  
— All Areas—Gives the user access to all endpoints, regardless of the  
area the endpoints are assigned to.  
— Specific Areas—Give the user access to only endpoints assigned to  
the areas selected below. Select one or more areas in the list below and  
click the right arrow.  
6
In the Associated Alert Profile section, select a Remote Alert  
Notification Profile as appropriate.  
264  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
User Management Operations  
7
8
In the Dial String Reservations section, select the user’s endpoint and  
enter the appropriate dial strings for SIP URI, E164, and H323 ID, then  
click Apply.  
The dial strings appear in the list below.  
If the user has multiple endpoints, enter the dial strings for one endpoint  
type at a time and click Apply each time.  
Click OK.  
If the Phone Number you entered is exactly the same as an existing user  
or endpoint, the Phone Number Conflict dialog box appears and lists the  
names of the other users or endpoints with the same number.  
To keep the duplicate number, click Continue.  
To change the phone number, click Cancel.  
Edit a User  
For local users added manually to the CMA system, you can edit all user  
information. If you change the user ID, the user must log into the associated  
endpoints with the new ID.  
For users added through the enterprise directory, you can edit their roles  
(unless the role is inherited from a group) and associate them to endpoints, but  
you cannot change user names, user IDs, or passwords.  
To edit a user  
1
Go to User > Users and in the Search Users field, enter the name of the  
user of interest.  
Note  
Searches for a user are case-insensitive, prefix searches of the Username, First  
Name, and Last Name fields.  
2
3
To search for a local user, press Enter.  
To search both local and enterprise users, first clear the Local Users Only  
check box and then press Enter.  
Note  
If you are not in an enterprise domain, you will not have the option of searching for  
enterprise users.  
4
5
If the list is too large to scan, further refine your search string.  
Select the user of interest and click Edit.  
Polycom, Inc.  
265  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
6
As required, edit the General Info, Associated Devices, Associated  
Roles, Associated Areas, Associated Alert Profile, and Dial String  
Reservations sections of the Edit User dialog box.  
7
Click OK.  
View Permissions for a User  
A user with the Administrator role can view permissions for a user.  
To view permissions for a user  
1
Go to User > Users and in the Search Users field, enter the name of the  
user of interest.  
Note  
Searches for a user are case-insensitive, prefix searches of the Username, First  
Name, and Last Name fields.  
2
3
To search for a local user, press Enter.  
To search both local and enterprise users, first clear the Local Users Only  
check box and then press Enter.  
Note  
If you are not in an enterprise domain, you will not have the option of searching for  
enterprise users.  
4
5
If the list is too large to scan, further refine your search string.  
Select the user of interest and click View Permissions.  
The View Permissions dialog box displays the permissions information.  
Permission—Lists the permissions assigned to the user.  
Granted Through—Role assigned to the user that grants the listed  
permissions.  
6
Click Close.  
Delete a User  
You can only delete local users from the CMA system. You cannot delete users  
added through integration with an enterprise directory.  
266  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
User Management Operations  
To delete a user  
1
Go to User > Users and in the Search Users field, enter the name of the  
user of interest.  
Note  
Searches for a user are case-insensitive, prefix searches of the Username, First  
Name, and Last Name fields.  
2
3
To search for a local user, press Enter.  
To search both local and enterprise users, first clear the Local Users Only  
check box and then press Enter.  
Note  
If you are not in an enterprise domain, you will not have the option of searching for  
enterprise users.  
4
5
6
If the list is too large to scan, further refine your search string.  
Select the user of interest and click Delete.  
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
The user is deleted from the CMA system.  
Unlock a User Account  
When a local user reaches the Failed login threshold, the system will not allow  
the user to log in until an administrator unlocks the user’s account. When a  
user’s account is locked, the system will display an error message.  
To unlock a user account  
1
Go to User > Users and in the Search Users field, enter the name of the  
user of interest and press Enter.  
2
3
Select the user of interest and click Edit.  
Enable the Unlock User option and click OK.  
The system should allow the user to log in.  
Polycom, Inc.  
267  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Manage Groups  
In the CMA system, only users assigned the Administrator role can:  
Add a Local Group  
To add a local group  
1
2
3
Go to User > Groups.  
In the Groups page, click Add Local Group.  
Complete the General Info section of the Add Local Group dialog box.  
Column  
Description  
General Info  
Group Name  
A meaningful and unique group name assigned  
when creating the group.  
Description  
A more complete description of the group’s purpose  
Directory Viewable  
Whether or not the group is displayed in the endpoint  
directory  
Provisioning Profile  
The automatic provisioning profile assigned when  
creating the group  
Address Book  
Associated Roles  
Available Roles  
Selected Roles  
The list of roles defined to the CMA system  
The list of roles that you assign users when adding  
them to the system. Users have all of the  
permissions associated with all of the roles assigned  
to them (that is, permissions are cumulative).  
268  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
User Management Operations  
Column  
Description  
Group Members (Local Users Only)  
Search Available  
Members  
Search field for finding users  
Search Results  
The users and groups identified to the system that  
you can add to the local group. This list can include  
both local and enterprise users and groups.  
Group Members  
The users and groups selected as part of the group  
4
5
In the Search Available Members field of the Group Members dialog  
box, search for the users and groups to add to this local group.  
In the Search Results section, select and move the users and groups of  
interest to the Group Members list. To select all users and groups listed,  
click the check box in the column header.  
6
Click OK.  
The group appears in the Groups list. It is identified as a LOCAL group.  
Import Enterprise Groups  
To import one or more enterprise groups  
1
2
3
Go to User > Groups.  
In the Groups page, click Import Enterprise Group.  
In the Search Available Groups field of the Import Enterprise Group  
dialog box, type all or part of the group name (with wildcards) and press  
ENTER.  
Note  
Searches for a group are case-insensitive, exact-match searches of the Group  
Name field. Use wildcard characters to perform substring searches.  
4
5
6
In the Search Results list, select the enterprise groups to add. To select all  
enterprise groups, click the check box in the column header.  
Click the right arrow to add the enterprise groups to the Groups to  
Import list.  
Click OK.  
The enterprise group appears in the Groups list. Now you can edit the  
group and associate it with an automatic provisioning profile, user roles,  
and specify whether or not the group directory is viewable. You can also  
search for enterprise users.  
Polycom, Inc.  
269  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Edit a Group  
To edit a local or enterprise group  
1
2
3
Go to User > Groups.  
In the Groups page, select the group of interest and click Edit.  
As required, edit the General Info, Associated Roles, and Group  
Members sections of the Edit Local Groups dialog box.  
Notes  
The Group Members section is only available for Local groups.  
If you remove a user from a group or a role from a group, the user no longer has  
the roles associated with the group.  
4
Click OK.  
Delete a Group  
To delete a local or enterprise group  
1
2
3
Go to User > Groups.  
In the Groups page, select the group of interest and click Delete Group.  
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
The group is deleted from the CMA system.  
Note  
An enterprise group is only deleted from the CMA system, not the enterprise  
directory, so it can be reimported.  
Manage User Roles  
In the CMA system, only users assigned the Administrator role can:  
270  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
User Management Operations  
Polycom, Inc.  
271  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Assign Users Roles and Endpoints  
You can assign roles to both local and enterprise users and associate them with  
endpoints.  
To assign a role and endpoint to a user  
1
2
Go to User > Users.  
To search for a user:  
a
In the Search field of the Users page, type a search string.  
Note  
Searches for a user on the CMA system Users page are case-insensitive, prefix  
searches of the Username, First Name, and Last Name fields.  
b
To search both local and enterprise users, clear the Local Users Only  
check box and press Enter.  
The first 500 users in the database that match your search criteria are  
displayed in the Users list.  
c
If the list is too large to scan, further refine your search string.  
3
4
Select the user of interest and click Edit.  
In the Devices section of the Edit User dialog box, select the endpoint to  
associate with the user and move it to the Selected Devices column. If a  
user has multiple endpoints, the first endpoint listed is the user’s default  
endpoint.  
5
Click Finish.  
View the List of User Roles  
To view the list of User Roles  
Go to User > User Roles.  
The User Roles list appears. It can be filtered by Name and Description.  
Column  
Name  
Description  
The unique name of the user role  
An optional description of the role  
Description  
272  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
User Management Operations  
Add a User Role  
When you add a user role, you also specify permissions for the role.  
To add a new user role  
1
2
3
Go to User > User Roles.  
On the User Roles page, click Add.  
Complete the Name and Description fields of the Add Role dialog box  
and assign permissions to the new role.  
The following table describes the fields of the Add Role dialog box.  
Field  
Description  
Name  
The unique name (ASCII only) of the user role  
(Optional) A useful description (ASCII only) of the user role  
Description  
Administrator  
Permissions  
Identifies which CMA system administrator pages and  
functions are available to the user role.  
Operator  
Permissions  
Identifies which CMA system operator pages and functions  
are available to the user role.  
Scheduler  
Permissions  
Identifies which CMA system scheduling pages and  
functions are available to the user role.  
Scheduling Level. This setting determines the level of  
scheduling available through this role. Possible values are:  
Basic. Users can schedule conferences using the  
conference templates defined for them. They cannot  
access or edit the advanced Conference Settings.  
Advanced. Users can schedule conferences using the  
conference templates defined for them. They can also  
access and edit the advanced Conference Settings.  
4
Click Save.  
The new user role appears in the CMA system.  
Edit Permissions for a User Role  
You can change permissions for the default Operator and Scheduler roles, as  
well as for other user roles that were created manually. You cannot change  
permissions for the default Administrator role.  
To edit the permissions for a user role  
1
Go to User > User Roles.  
Polycom, Inc.  
273  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
2
3
4
As needed, use the Filter to customize the User Roles list.  
In the User Roles list, select the role of interest and click Edit.  
Edit the Description field of the Edit Role dialog box and edit  
permissions for the role.  
5
Click Save.  
Delete a User Role  
You can delete a user role from the CMA system, provided no users are  
currently assigned to it.  
To delete a user role  
1
2
3
4
Go to User > User Roles.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the User Roles list.  
In the User Roles list, select the role of interest and click Delete.  
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
The user role is deleted from the CMA system.  
View the Groups and Users Associated with a User Role  
To view which groups and users are associated with a specific user role  
Go to User > User Roles.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the User Roles list.  
1
2
3
In the User Roles list, select the role of interest and click View Associated  
Groups and Users.  
The View Associated Groups and Users dialog box appears.  
274  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
User Management Operations  
Manage System Guest Book  
This section includes some general information you should know about the  
Conference menu and views. It includes these topics:  
User Menu and Guest Book  
By default, schedulers, operator, and administrators have access to the User  
Menu and Guest Book.  
The Guest Book is a local system directory that includes guest participants  
who were either:  
Explicitly added to the Guest Book.  
Saved to the Guest Book while being added as conference participants.  
They are referred to as static entries because they are not imported through the  
dynamically updated enterprise directory or included in the system Global  
Address Book. The Guest Book is limited to 500 entries. The Guest Book has  
these fields.  
Field  
Name  
Email  
Description  
The guest’s first and last name.  
The guest’s E-mail address. The system validates the  
E-mail structure only.  
Location  
Number  
The location of the guest’s endpoint system. This is a  
free-form entry field that the system does not validate.  
(Optional) The ISDN phone number for the user. This  
number is constructed from the Country code + Area/City  
code + phone number or entered as the modified dial  
number.  
Join Mode  
Dial Options  
Dial Type  
Indicates whether the guest will use an audio endpoint or  
video endpoint to join conferences.  
Indicates whether the guest will dial into conferences or that  
the system should dial out to the guest.  
Indicates whether the guest has an H.323 (IP), SIP (IP), or  
H.320 (ISDN) endpoint.  
Polycom, Inc.  
275  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Context-Sensitive Guest Book Actions  
The Actions section of the Guest Book page may include these  
context-sensitive actions depending on what is selected.  
Actions  
Description  
Add Guest  
Edit Guest  
Delete Guest  
Use this command to add a new guest user.  
Use this command to change information for a guest user.  
Use this command to delete a guest from the Guest Book.  
Deleting a guest is a permanent operation.  
Add a Guest to the System Guest Book  
To add a guest to the system Guest Book  
1
2
Go to User > Guest Book and click Add Guest.  
Configure the Guest Information section of the Add New Guest dialog  
box.  
Field  
Description  
First Name  
Last Name  
Email  
The guest’s first name.  
The guest’s last name.  
The guest’s E-mail address. The system only  
validates the structure of the E-mail address.  
Location  
The location of the guest’s endpoint system. This is a  
free-form field that the system does not validate.  
Dial Type  
Specify the protocol that the guest’s endpoint  
supports: H.323 (IP), SIP (IP), or H.320 (ISDN).  
This selection will determine what other sections of  
the Add New Guest dialog box you will need to  
complete.  
Join Mode  
Specify whether the guest’s endpoint is an audio or  
video endpoint.  
Note  
A guest may have multiple endpoints. Create a  
separate Guest Book entry for each endpoint.  
276  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
User Management Operations  
Field  
Description  
Dial Options  
Specify whether the guest will dial into conferences,  
or require that the system dial out to the guest.  
Note  
To support both options, create a separate Guest  
Book entry for each.  
3
If the guest has an H.323 (IP) endpoint, configure these settings:  
Field  
Description  
Number and  
Number Type  
The specific dial string for the guest, and the format  
of the number that the MCU must resolve to contact  
the guest. This may be an IP address, E.164  
address, H.323, or Annex-O.  
For Annex-O dialing, in the Number field enter the  
H.323.alias@IP, for example:  
Notes  
Polycom endpoints must register with a  
gatekeeper before they will attempt an Annex-O  
call.  
You can enter a dial string for another MCU as a  
guest. If so, you may need to specify the  
conference ID in the Extension field also.  
Extension  
Use this field to connect the conference to another  
conference on another MCU. In this field, specify the  
conference ID or passcode for the conference on the  
other MCU.  
MCU Service  
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on the  
MCUs with which the CMA system is registered.  
Leave this at Any Available Service unless you  
have specific knowledge of MCU services.  
4
If the guest has a SIP (IP) endpoint, configure these settings:  
Polycom, Inc.  
277  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
Sip URI  
The SPI URI the MCU must resolve to contact the  
guest.  
MCU Service  
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on the  
MCUs with which the CMA system is registered.  
Leave this at Any Available Service unless you  
have specific knowledge of MCU services.  
5
If the guest has an H.320 (ISDN) endpoint, configure these settings:  
Field  
Description  
Use Modified Dial  
Number  
Select this option first (as needed) as it will  
determine the other fields you must configure.  
Country  
(Not available when Use Modified Dial Number is  
selected.) The country to which the system will dial  
out to the guest. Click Select to view a list of country  
codes.  
Area/City Code  
(Not available when Use Modified Dial Number is  
selected.) The area code to which the system will  
dial out to the guest.  
Number  
The participant’s phone number.  
Cannot be configured.  
Extension  
MCU Service  
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on the  
MCUs with which the CMA system has registered.  
Leave this at Any Available Service unless you  
have specific knowledge of MCU services.  
6
Click OK.  
Edit a Guest in the System Guest Book  
To edit a guest in the system Guest Book  
1
2
3
Go to User > Guest Book and select the guest of interest.  
Click Edit Guest.  
Change the Guest Information section and endpoint information  
sections of the Add New Guest dialog box, as needed. For more  
information about these fields, see “Add a Guest to the System Guest  
4
Click OK.  
278  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
User Management Operations  
Delete a Guest from the System Guest Book  
To delete a guest from the system Guest Book  
1
2
3
Go to User > Guest Book and select the guest of interest.  
Click Delete Guest.  
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
Manage Favorites  
The CMA system allows operators with Monitoring permissions to create one  
or more Favorites list, which they can use to quickly select participants to  
participate in conferences.  
The operations associated with managing favorites include:  
In the CMA system, only operators with Monitoring permissions can view,  
add, edit, delete, or use Favorites lists and these Favorites lists cannot be  
shared with other operators.  
Add a Favorites List  
To add a Favorites list  
1
2
3
Go to User > Favorites.  
On the Favorites page, click Add.  
Complete the Favorites List Name and Description fields of the Add  
Favorites List dialog box.  
Note  
The Favorites List Name must be unique within the system.  
4
In the Search Available Members field enter all or part of the person’s  
last name or first name and click Search.  
The system searches the Users list (local and domain) for users who are  
associated with endpoints and who meet your search criteria. The results  
appear in the Search Results column.  
Polycom, Inc.  
279  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Notes  
Depending on the search domain, the search function may return different  
results. See Filter and Search a List.  
The search results only include users associated with endpoints.  
5
6
Select the user(s) of interest from the list and move them to the Favorite  
List Members column.  
Repeat step 4 and 5 until you’ve added the users of interest to your  
Favorites list and then click OK.  
The new list appears in the Favorites page.  
Edit a Favorites List  
To edit a Favorites list  
1
2
3
Go to User > Favorites.  
On the Favorites page, select the Favorites list of interest and click Edit.  
In the Edit Favorites List dialog box, edit the Favorites List Name and  
Description fields as needed.  
4
Remove or add users to the Favorite List Members column as needed  
and then click OK.  
Delete a Favorites List  
To delete a Favorites list  
1
Go to User > Favorites.  
2
On the Favorites page, select the Favorites list of interest and click  
Delete.  
3
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
The list is deleted from the CMA system.  
280  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
20  
System Reports  
This chapter describes the reports available through the Polycom® Converged  
Management Application™ (CMA®) system and how to view and export  
them. Use these reports to identify return on investment, troubleshoot  
problems, provide information about network traffic, and ensure accurate  
billing for Polycom video calls.  
The topics include:  
Site Statistics Report  
Use the Site Statistics report to check call rate and call quality statistics for the  
sites. You can view the data in a grid or graphically.  
Polycom, Inc.  
281  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
To view Site Statistics  
1
Go to Reports > Site Statistics.  
The Site Statistics appear with the statistics displayed in a grid. The grid  
shows a snapshot of the current statistics. The data is updated  
automatically every 15 seconds.  
Column  
Description  
Site Name  
Specifies the site to which the statistics apply.  
Specifies the number of currently active calls for the site.  
Num of Calls  
% Bandwidth Used  
Specifies the cumulative bandwidth used by the  
currently active calls.  
Bandwidth  
Avg Bit Rate  
Specifies the average bit rate for the currently active  
calls that is, the total bit rate for all currently active calls  
divided by the number of active calls.  
% Packet Loss  
Specifies the average percentage of packet loss for the  
currently active calls that is, the total percentage of  
packet loss for all currently active calls divided by the  
number of active calls.  
Avg Jitter  
Avg Delay  
Specifies the average jitter for the currently active calls  
that is, the total jitter for all currently active calls divided  
by the number of active calls.  
Specifies the average delay for the currently active calls  
that is, the total delay for all currently active calls divided  
by the number of active calls.  
2
To view the Site Statistics graphically and over a selected period of time:  
a
b
c
Click View Chart.  
In the Site Name list, select the site(s) to chart.  
In the Y-Axis list, select the statistic(s) to chart.  
d
In the Data Limit field, enter the time frame in minutes for which to  
chart the data. The default is 60 minutes.  
The charts are dynamically updated for your selections.  
282  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Reports  
Site Link Statistics Report  
Use the Site Link Statistics report to check call rate and call quality statistics  
for all site links. You can view the data in a grid or graphically.  
To view Site Link Statistics  
1
Go to Reports > Site Link Statistics.  
The SiteLink Statistics appear with the statistics displayed in a grid. The  
grid shows a snapshot of the current statistics. The data is updated  
automatically every 15 seconds  
Column  
Description  
Site Link Name  
Specifies the two linked sites for which the statistics  
apply.  
Num of Calls  
Specifies the number of currently active calls for the site  
link.  
% Bandwidth Used  
Specifies the percentage of bandwidth used by the  
currently active calls, that is, the bandwidth used by the  
currently active calls divided by the total available  
bandwidth for the link expressed as a percentage.  
Bandwidth  
Specifies the total bandwidth of the link.  
Avg Bit Rate  
Specifies the average bit rate for the currently active  
calls, that is, the total bit rate for all currently active calls  
divided by the number of active calls.  
% Packet Loss  
Specifies the average percentage of packet loss for the  
currently active calls that is, the total percentage of  
packet loss for all currently active calls divided by the  
number of active calls.  
Avg Jitter  
Avg Delay  
Specifies the average jitter for the currently active calls  
that is, the total jitter for all currently active calls divided  
by the number of active calls.  
Specifies the average delay for the currently active calls  
that is, the total delay for all currently active calls divided  
by the number of active calls.  
2
To view the Site Link Statistics graphically:  
a
b
c
Click View Chart.  
In the Site Name list, select the site(s) to chart.  
In the Y-Axis list, select the statistic(s) to chart.  
Polycom, Inc.  
283  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
d
In the Data Limit field, enter the time frame in minutes for which to  
chart the data. The default is 60 minutes.  
The charts are dynamically updated for your selections. The site-links  
are displayed in the same order as the site-link grid.  
H.323 Call Detail Records Report  
The H.323 Call Detail Record (CDR) report includes CDRs for Polycom and  
non-Polycom endpoints. Use data from the H.323 Call Detail Record (CDR)  
report to troubleshoot problems, provide information about network traffic,  
and ensure accurate billing for video calls.  
Notes  
Endpoints that access the CMA system through a Polycom VBP device do not  
have CDRs.  
Only calls that go through the gatekeeper are included in this report.  
A Call Detail Record is recorded for each IP call into a conference.  
CDR reports may not include data for calls made in the last 24 hours, depending  
upon when the data in the localcdr.csvfile was last updated.  
To work with the H.323 Call Detail Records report data, extract the report from  
the Logger.dbo.callsdatabase. See your Microsoft SQL Server  
documentation for information about extracting data.  
To view the H.323 Call Detail Records report  
1
Go to Reports > H.323 Call Detail Records.  
The H.323 Call Detail Records report appears. It lists the CDRs for the  
5,000 most recent IP calls made to or from system-managed endpoints. It  
includes the following information.  
Column  
Call ID  
Description  
Specifies the ID automatically generated for the call.  
Conf ID  
Specifies the GUID (global unique identifier) for the  
conference to which the call was made.  
Date/Time  
Source  
Specifies the date and time the call started, provided in  
local time for the server.  
Specifies the name, IP, or alias of the endpoint that  
originated the call.  
Source Address  
Specifies the IP address of the endpoint that originated  
the call.  
284  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System Reports  
Column  
Description  
Destination  
Specifies the name, IP address, or alias of the endpoint  
that received the call. For point-to-point calls this is  
another endpoint. For multipoint calls using an MCU,  
this is the MCU.  
Destination  
Address  
Specifies the IP address of the endpoint that received  
the call.  
Call Type  
Specifies the type of call: scheduled or unscheduled.  
Specifies the bit rate that was used for the call.  
Bandwidth (Kbps)  
Duration (min)  
Specifies how long the call lasted in minutes, up to a  
maximum of 999.  
Q.850 Code  
Specifies the standard cause code for call termination.  
2
Use the Filter to customize the report by Date, IP Address, Endpoint  
Type, Call Type, and Duration.  
Call Detail Record Report Administration  
By default, the CMA system stores the conference and endpoint call detail  
records (CDRs) for 30 days. You can modify the CDR retention period and you  
can schedule a weekly archive of the CDRs. These procedures are described in  
the following topics.  
Modify the CDR Retention Period  
By default, the conference and endpoint CDRs are purged after 30 days.  
To change how long CDR information is retained  
1
2
Go to Admin > Report Administration.  
In the Report Administration page, enter the number of Days to keep  
Conference and Endpoint CDRs.  
3
Click Save Settings.  
Schedule Weekly Archives of the CDR Report  
To schedule weekly archives of CDR information  
1
2
Go to Admin > Report Administration.  
In the Report Administration page, select Enable Weekly FTP  
Archiving of CDR Records.  
Polycom, Inc.  
285  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
3
Configure these settings:  
Field  
Description  
First day of weekly  
archive  
Specifies the day on which the system will transfer  
archives. By default, this is Sunday. As needed,  
you can select a different day for the transfers.  
Use Secure FTP  
(SSL/TLS)  
Specifies whether or not the archives will be  
transferred over an encrypted Secure Sockets  
Layer (SSL) or Transport Layer Security (TLS)  
connection. By default, the system does not secure  
the transfers.  
Host name or IP  
Address of FTP server  
Specifies the server to which the archives will be  
transferred. By default, the system transfers the  
archives to a location on its local server. You can  
change this to an external server.  
FTP Port  
Specifies the port through which the archives will  
be transferred. By default, this is system port 21.  
FTP User Name/  
FTP Password/  
Confirm FTP Password  
Specifies a user name and password combination  
for accessing the FTP server. This must be a valid  
user account on the FTP server.  
FTP Directory  
Specifies the directory on the server to which the  
archives will be transferred.  
4
5
To verify that the FTP settings are functional, click Test Archive Settings.  
When the settings are correct, click Save Settings.  
Endpoint Usage Report  
The Endpoint Usage Report is based on the CDRs extracted from selected  
endpoints and includes entries for ISDN and IP calls. (Currently, the CMA  
system reports CDRs for the Polycom dynamically managed, Polycom  
non-dynamically managed, HDX Series, RealPresence Group Series, V and  
VSX Series, VVX, and CMA Desktop endpoints as well as supported  
TANDBERG and LifeSize endpoint models.)  
Use data from the Endpoint Usage Report to troubleshoot problems, provide  
information about network traffic, and ensure accurate billing for Polycom  
video calls.  
286  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System Reports  
To view the Endpoint Usage Report  
1
Go to Reports > Endpoint Usage Report.  
The Endpoint Usage Report page appears displaying the following  
information for the endpoints for which CDRs are available.  
Field  
Description  
Serial Number  
Endpoint Name  
Site  
The registered serial number of the endpoint.  
The registered name of the endpoint.  
The location at which the endpoint resides.  
The person or room to whom the endpoint is registered.  
Owner/Room  
The CDRs are displayed in alphabetical order for the default Start Date  
and End Date. By default, the CDRs for the last week are reported.  
2
3
4
To restrict the report to a different time period, change the Start Date and  
End Date. The report is dynamically updated.  
Use the Filter to customize the report by endpoint Type, Name, IP  
Address, ISDN Video Number, Alias, Site, or VIP status.  
To generate the Endpoint Usage report, select one or more endpoints to  
include in the report and click Generate Report. Use the CTRL key, to  
select multiple endpoints.  
The Generate Report page displays the Summary usage report for the  
selected endpoints. It includes the following information for the calls.  
Field  
Description  
Number of calls  
Specifies the number of calls the selected endpoints  
joined for the selected date range. Click Details to get  
more information about these calls.  
Total call time  
Specifies the total amount of time the selected endpoints  
spent in conference during the selected date range.  
Average time per  
call  
Specifies the average amount of time the selected  
endpoints spent in conference during the selected date  
range, that is, the total call time divided by the number of  
calls.  
Average rate per  
call  
Specifies the average bit rate for the selected calls.  
5
6
To select a different group of endpoints, click Change Selection, select  
the endpoints, and click Generate Report again.  
Click Call Times to see a chart that identifies the number of calls versus  
the start time for the calls.  
Polycom, Inc.  
287  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
7
8
9
Click Inbound to see a chart that identifies the endpoints from which the  
inbound calls to the selected endpoints originated.  
Click Outbound to see a chart that identifies the endpoints to which the  
selected endpoints called.  
Click Summary CDR Report to see a grid that displays information for  
each of the selected endpoints that participated in calls.  
Field  
Description  
Serial Number  
Endpoint Name  
The registered serial number of the endpoint.  
Identifies the endpoint by name.  
Total Time in Call Specifies the total amount of time the endpoint spent in  
conference during the selected time period.  
Average Time in  
Call  
Specifies the average amount of time the endpoint spent  
per call during the selected time period, that is, the Total  
Time in Call divided by the Total Calls.  
Average Speed  
All Calls  
Specifies the average bit rate for all of the calls in which  
the endpoint participated during the selected time period,  
that is, total bit rate divided by the Total Calls.  
Calls Out  
Calls In  
Specifies the number of calls in which the endpoint  
participated during the selected time period that originated  
from the endpoint.  
Specifies the number of calls in which the endpoint  
participated during the selected time period that did not  
originate from the endpoint.  
Total Calls  
Specifies the total number of calls in which the endpoint  
participated for the selected time period.  
If any of the selected endpoints did not participate in calls during the  
selected time period, it is not included in the Summary CDR Report.  
10 To export the information in the Summary CDR Report, click Export as  
Excel File and either Open or Save the file as needed. Note that only the  
first 1000 lines of the report are exported to the Excel file.  
11 Click Detail CDR Report to see information for each of the endpoints  
that participated in calls.  
The Generate Report page displays System Information and CDR  
information for the first endpoint in the list. For the selected endpoint, the  
System Information section includes the following data.  
288  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Reports  
Field  
Description  
System Information  
Model  
Specifies the name of the selected endpoint.  
Specifies the model number of the selected  
endpoint.  
IP Address  
Specifies the IP address of the selected endpoint.  
Specifies the ISDN number or V.35 number.  
ISDN or V.35 Number  
Serial Number  
Specifies the serial number of the selected endpoint.  
For each call from the selected endpoint, the CDR information includes the  
following data.  
Field  
Description  
Start Date Time  
End Date Time  
Specifies the start date and time for the conference.  
Specifies the end date for the report. This also  
defaults to the current date.  
Call Duration  
Specifies how long the call lasted in hours, minutes,  
and seconds.  
Account Number  
If Require Account Number to Dial is enabled on the  
system, the value entered by the user is displayed  
in this field.  
Remote System Name  
Specifies the endpoint to which the endpoint was  
connected for the call.  
Call Number 1  
Call Number 2  
Specifies the IP or ISDN numbers for the endpoints  
to which the endpoint was connected for the call.  
Transport Type  
The type of call — Either H.320 (ISDN), H.323 (IP),  
or SIP.  
Call Rate  
The bandwidth negotiated with the far site.  
System Manufacturer  
The name of the system manufacturer, model, and  
software version, if they can be determined.  
Call Direction  
Conference ID  
In — For calls received.  
Out — For calls placed from the system.  
A number given to each conference. A conference  
can include more than one far site, so there may be  
more than one row with the same conference ID.  
Call ID  
Identifies individual calls within the same  
conference.  
Polycom, Inc.  
289  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
H.320 Channels  
The total number of ISDN B channels used in the  
call. For example, a 384K call would use six B  
channels.  
Endpoint Alias  
The alias of the far site.  
Endpoint Additional  
Alias  
An additional alias of the far site.  
Endpoint Type  
Terminal, gateway, or MCU.  
Endpoint Transport  
Address  
The actual address of the far site (not necessarily  
the address dialed).  
Audio Protocol Tx  
Audio Protocol Rx  
Video Protocol Tx  
Video Protocol Rx  
Video Format Tx  
Video Format Rx  
Disconnect Info  
The audio protocol transmitted to the far site, such  
as G.728 or G.722.1.  
The audio protocol received from the far site, such  
as G.728 or G.722.  
The video protocol transmitted to the far site, such  
as H.263 or H.264.  
The video protocol received from the far site, such  
as H.261 or H.263.  
The video format transmitted to the far site, such as  
CIF or SIF.  
The video format received from the far site, such as  
CIF or SIF.  
The description of the Q.850 (ISDN) cause code  
showing how the call ended.  
Q850 Cause Code  
Total H.320 Errors  
Avg % Packet Loss Tx  
The Q.850 cause code showing how the call ended.  
The number of errors during an H.320 call.  
The combined average of the percentage of both  
audio and video packets transmitted that were lost  
during the 5 seconds preceding the moment at  
which a sample was taken. This value does not  
report a cumulative average for the entire H.323  
call. However, it does report an average of the  
sampled values.  
Avg % Packet Loss Rx  
The combined average of the percentage of both  
audio and video packets received that were lost  
during the 5 seconds preceding the moment at  
which a sample was taken. This value does not  
report a cumulative average for the entire H.323  
call. However, it does report an average of the  
sampled values.  
290  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Reports  
Field  
Description  
Avg Packet Loss Tx  
The number of packets transmitted that were lost  
during an H.323 call.  
Avg Packet Loss Rx  
Avg Latency Tx  
The number of packets from the far site that were  
lost during an H.323 call.  
The average latency of packets transmitted during  
an H.323 call based on round-trip delay, calculated  
from sample tests done once per minute.  
Avg Latency Rx  
Max Latency Tx  
Max Latency Rx  
Avg Jitter Tx  
The average latency of packets received during an  
H.323 call based on round-trip delay, calculated  
from sample tests done once per minute.  
The maximum latency for packets transmitted  
during an H.323 call based on round-trip delay,  
calculated from sample tests done once per minute.  
The maximum latency for packets received during  
an H.323 call based on round-trip delay, calculated  
from sample tests done once per minute.  
The average jitter of packets transmitted during an  
H.323 call, calculated from sample tests done once  
per minute.  
Avg Jitter Rx  
The average jitter of packets received during an  
H.323 call, calculated from sample tests done once  
per minute.  
Max Jitter Tx  
Max Jitter Rx  
The maximum jitter of packets transmitted during an  
H.323 call, calculated from sample tests done once  
per minute.  
The maximum jitter of packets received during an  
H.323 call, calculated from sample tests done once  
per minute.  
12 To export the information, click Download Report and either Open or  
Save the CDR report in Microsoft Excel format for the selected endpoint  
or in CSV format For All Selected Endpoints. Note that only the first  
1000 lines of the report are exported to the Excel file.  
13 Click Change Selection to return to the Endpoint Usage Report page to  
select a different endpoint.  
Polycom, Inc.  
291  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Conference Type Report  
Use the Conference Type Report option to review monthly summary  
information about past CMA system conferences.  
To create a Conference Type Report  
1
Go to Reports > Conference Type Report.  
An empty Conference Type Report grid appears.  
2
As needed, change the From: and To: dates to select the date range for the  
report, and click View.  
The Conference Type Report for the selected date range appears. It  
includes the following information.  
Column  
Description  
Date  
Information is displayed on a month-by-month basis and  
an average for the selected months.  
Scheduled Confs  
Ad hoc Confs  
The number of conferences scheduled via one of the  
CMA system scheduling interfaces (that is, the CMA  
system application, the Polycom Scheduling Plugin for  
Microsoft Outlook, or the Polycom Scheduling Plugin for  
IBM Lotus Notes).  
The number of conferences that used one or more  
endpoints for which the CMA system was the  
gatekeeper, but that weren’t scheduled via one of the  
CMA system scheduling interfaces.  
MP Confs  
The number of multipoint conferences scheduled using  
one of the CMA system scheduling interfaces.  
P2P Confs  
The number of point-to-point conferences scheduled  
using one of the CMA system scheduling interfaces.  
Gateway Confs  
The number of scheduled conferences that used a  
gateway to reach one or more endpoints.  
Embedded MP  
Confs  
The number of scheduled multipoint conferences that  
used the MCU embedded in a V-Series, VSX-Series, or  
Polycom HDX-Series endpoint rather than an external  
MCU such as an MGC or RMX MCU.  
Two Person  
Conferences on  
MCU  
The number of scheduled point-to-point conferences  
that used an external MCU such as an MGC or RMX  
MCU even through point-to-point conferences do not  
usually require MCU resources.  
Short Confs  
The number of scheduled conferences that were  
scheduled to last 30 minutes or more, but which actually  
lasted less than 30 minutes.  
292  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System Reports  
Column  
Description  
Scheduled Minutes The sum of the scheduled minutes for all CMA system  
scheduled conferences.  
Executed Minutes  
The sum of the actual minutes for all CMA system  
scheduled conferences.  
Total Parts  
The sum of the participants that joined CMA system  
scheduled conferences.  
Avg Parts in MP  
Confs  
The average number of participants that joined  
scheduled CMA system multipoint conferences.  
3
To create one of the conference type report charts, click the appropriate  
chart name below the grid. Chart choices include:  
Column  
Description  
Scheduled vs.  
Ad hoc  
A chart that compares the number of scheduled  
conferences to the number of ad hoc conferences for  
each month  
Scheduled Types  
A chart that compares the number of point-to-point,  
multipoint, gateway, and embedded multipoint  
conferences for each month  
Scheduled vs.  
Executed Mins  
A chart that compares the number of scheduled minutes  
to the number of executed minutes for each month  
Avg Parts in MP  
Confs  
A chart that displays the average number of participants  
in multipoint conferences for each month  
Point-to-Point  
A chart that displays the number of point-to-point  
Confs on MCUs  
conferences hosted on an external MCU for each month  
The selected chart dynamically appears below the grid.  
To export the report:  
4
a
b
c
Click Export.  
In the File Download dialog box, click Save.  
In the Save As dialog box, browse to the location to which to save the  
report and click Save.  
Polycom, Inc.  
293  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Gatekeeper Message Log  
Use the Gatekeeper Message Log page to:  
View messages that endpoints send to the gatekeeper  
Define which messages are logged  
Pause and restart message logging  
Clear the log  
Export the log to another file  
Logging starts when you define the Log Settings. Logging stops only when  
you clear all of the Log Settings. Logging can include these types of messages:  
Warnings/Errors. Messages displayed for all warnings or errors that occur  
on registered Polycom endpoints  
Rogues. Messages displayed for all calls from unregistered endpoints  
Events. Messages display about these events:  
Registration  
Call detail  
Neighboring gatekeeper  
While you can pause logging, the CMA system always logs errors and  
warnings.  
You can also:  
Clear events from the log, which removes data from the database  
Export the log to a a comma-separated value (CSV) file. You can export  
only the data that displays on-screen, and exporting the log may take a  
long time depending on the number of entries in the log.  
View and Export the Gatekeeper Message Log  
To see more details about a log message  
1
2
3
Go to Reports > Gatekeeper Message Log.  
Enter a Filter String to customize the list.  
Select the message of interest.  
The Gatekeeper Message Log report appears. It has these fields:  
294  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Reports  
Column  
Description  
Type  
These types of messages display:  
Information, which indicates normal  
communications between the CMA system and  
the endpoint.  
Warning, which indicates an unscheduled call  
and the inability to assign E.164 and ISDN  
numbers to an endpoint.  
Error, which indicates the registration of an  
endpoint or a call failed, or a lack of resources for  
this gateway or MCU exists.  
Date/Time  
Category  
Date and time of the event.  
Specifies whether an event is a registration, call, or  
neighboring gatekeeper request.  
Description  
Displays the message sent to or received from the  
endpoint, identified by the IP address.  
4
To export a message:  
a
b
Select the message of interest and click Export Log.  
In the Export Log dialog box, click Yes.  
GKexport fileappears in your default text editor.  
Save the file.  
A
c
Define Log Settings  
To define which messages should be logged  
1
2
3
Go to Reports > Gatekeeper Message Log.  
When the Gatekeeper Message Log page appears, click Log Settings.  
In the Gatekeeper Log Settings dialog box, select the events to log.  
Field  
Description  
Registration  
RRQ  
Registration requests  
GRQ  
Gatekeeper requests  
IRR/IRQ  
LWRRQ  
Information response or information sent  
Light-weight registration request  
Polycom, Inc.  
295  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
URQ  
Unregistration request  
Non Standard  
Message  
Neighbors  
LRQ  
Location request  
Call Details  
ARQ  
Admission request  
Disengage request  
Bandwidth request  
DRQ  
BRQ  
Setup  
4
Click OK  
The CMA system begins logging the types of messages you selected.  
Clear Events from the Log  
To clear all events from the log  
1
2
3
Go to Reports > Gatekeeper Message Log.  
When the Gatekeeper Message Log page appears, click Clear Log.  
Click Yes to confirm the action.  
The Gatekeeper Message Log is cleared.  
Pause and Restart Logging  
To pause logging  
1
2
3
Go to Reports > Gatekeeper Message Log.  
When the Gatekeeper Message Log page appears, click Pause Log.  
In the Stop Logging dialog box, click Yes.  
The Start Log button is available and the system stops logging messages  
to the Gatekeeper Message Log.  
4
Click Start Log to restart logging.  
296  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Reports  
Many of the CMA system components can write a System Log File when  
they experience an error or issue. Whether or not they do write a system  
log file depends upon the system log level.  
The following table lists some of the logs the CMA system saves.  
Log Name  
Description  
Log Files Related to Basic System Functionality  
SE200MasterService.txt  
Log file that shows when individual  
services are started and stopped, and  
displays a memory usage summary for  
some of those services (mqm, sitetopo,  
plcmgk, gab) every 30 minutes.  
ESINSTALL-<timestamp>.txt  
Log file that shows the output of the CMA  
system install script. Shows what steps  
were done when installing the CMA  
system software.  
ESUPGRADE-<timestamp>.txt  
Log file that shows the output of the CMA  
system upgrade script (not applicable  
unless an upgrade was performed).  
Log File Related to Dial Plan Functionality  
DialRule_Log.txt  
General log file used by the dial rule  
process. This process generates dial out  
strings to endpoints, controls the dialing  
rules set up in the user interface.  
SiteTopo_Log.txt  
When in debug mode, this log file  
contains messages about site topology  
entry and usage.  
Log File Related to External Database Functionality  
ServiceMonitor_Log.txt Log file for the redundancy service that  
shows when a redundant CMA system  
goes into active or standby mode.  
Log Files Related to Scheduling Functionality  
AdapterLog_SCH.txt .NET remoting log file that shows  
low-level communication errors between  
internal system components--in this case,  
the scheduling component.  
Log Files Related to Global Address Book Functionality  
AdapterLog_GAB.txt .NET remoting log file that shows  
low-level communication errors from the  
GAB communications with the integration  
layer.  
Polycom, Inc.  
297  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Log Name  
Description  
ComponentLog_GAB.txt  
.NET remoting log file that shows  
low-level communication errors from the  
GAB communications with endpoints.  
EXXX_LOG  
x
.txt  
Log files for web services, device  
manager, and conference monitoring.  
This file includes information about  
successful and failed system logins and  
all logouts, as well as system errors,  
major system events, and general system  
information.  
Log Files Related to Device Management Functionality  
AdapterLog_GMS.txt  
.NET remoting log file that shows  
low-level communication errors between  
internal system components--in this case,  
the management component.  
<DeviceType>Device.txt  
Log file that captures device specific  
message.  
<DeviceType>DeviceCollection.txt Log file that captures device specific  
message.  
<DeviceType>PasswdErrs.log  
Log file that captures device specific  
messages related to potential password  
mismatches.  
DeviceManager.txt  
DeviceManagerService.txt  
softwareUpdate  
Log file for the device management  
process.  
Log file for the device management  
process.  
Log file that shows when a endpoint is  
updated with a new software package via  
a scheduled software update.  
Log Files Related to Gatekeeper Functionality  
AdapterLog_PN.txt  
.NET remoting log file that shows  
low-level communication errors between  
internal system components--in this case,  
the gatekeeper component.  
PLCMGK.log  
MQM_Log.txt  
General gatekeeper log file.  
General media quality monitor log file that  
will show any errors when writing CDRs  
or media quality data to the database.  
298  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Reports  
Log Name  
Description  
Log Files Related to Call Management Functionality  
Messages.txt  
Conference launching log used  
exclusively by CodecMngr process. This  
log contains information about the  
conference start up process, that is,  
information that the system sends to  
endpoints at the start of a conference.  
CS_<conf_name>.html  
Conference scheduling log used by the  
conference scheduling process. This log  
contains debug information on how a  
conference is created. A log file is  
created for each scheduled conference,  
with the log file name format:  
CS_<conf_name>.txt  
CS-<conf_name>.txt, where  
<conf_name>is the name of the  
scheduled conference. This is always on,  
and there is no logging level.  
Log Files Related to Web Services Functionality  
apache_access.log.<xxxx>  
Apache web server access log that  
shows when and what URL was  
requested.  
apache_error.log  
mod_jk.log  
Log file that captures error messages  
from the Apache web server.  
Log file that shows which web requests  
were forwarded from Apache web server  
to the Tomcat servlet engine.  
Log Files Related to Presence Functionality  
Jserver.log.<n>  
Log file that shows errors related to the  
internal LDAP, SNMP, DM, Openfire, Site  
Topology and dynamically-managed  
endpoint login and provisioning  
functionality. This circular log has a six  
month limit. The timestamp is the local  
server time.  
boot.log  
JBoss startup log. JBoss is the container  
service for the Jserver service.  
Polycom, Inc.  
299  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
View and Export System Log Files  
Many of the CMA system components can write a System Log File when they  
experience an error or issue.  
Whether or not they do write a system log file depends upon the system log  
level. You can change the system log level. See “Change the System Log Level”  
To view System Log Files  
1
Go to Reports > System Logs.  
The System Log Files list appears listing the logs for the given time period.  
To view a log file:  
2
a
b
Select the log file of interest.  
Click Open.  
3
To export a .zipof all log files:  
a
b
Click Download All.  
To open the .zipfile, in the File Download dialog box, click Open  
with, and browse to the program you use to open.zipfiles.  
c
To save the .zipfile to your local computer, in the File Download  
dialog box, click Save.  
Change the System Log Level  
To edit the current system log level  
1
Go to Reports > System Logs.  
The System Log Files list appears listing the logs for the given time period.  
The Current Log Level indicates which log files are being saved.  
2
3
4
Select the report you want.  
Click Change Settings.  
From the Current Log Level menu, select a new value. Choices include:  
Debug  
Info  
Warn  
Error  
Fatal  
Off  
300  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
System Reports  
5
In a redundant configuration, repeat steps 1 and 4 on the redundant  
server.  
Download Windows Event Log Files  
You can download a .zip file that includes the Windows Event Log Files for the  
CMA system. The Windows Event Log Files include the operating system  
level application, security, and system logs. These logs store events logged by  
Windows system components.  
To download the Windows Event Logs  
1
2
3
Go to Reports > System Log Files.  
Click Download All Event Logs.  
In the File Download dialog box, click Save to save the log file to your  
local system.  
View and Download Audit Log Files  
You can view and download audit log files.  
To view and download audit log files  
1
Go to Reports > Audit Log Files.  
The Audit Log Files page appears listing the logs being stored on the  
system. The following table identifies the CMA system audit log files.  
Log Name  
Description  
apache_access.log.<timestamp>  
Log file that shows every web request  
that was made from client systems. The  
system may have more than one such  
log.  
apache_error.log  
Log file that captures all of the failed  
web requests as well as any internal  
Apache error messages.  
cma_audit_ComponentLog_Apach  
eCert1.log  
Log file that captures security-related  
authentication issues.  
cma_audit_EXXX_LOG1.log  
Log file that captures significant .NET  
application events.  
Polycom, Inc.  
301  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Log Name  
Description  
cma_audit_jserver.log  
Log file that captures significant Java  
Server application events.  
cma_audit_os_patches_hotfixes1.l  
og  
Log file that is created when the system  
first starts up. It displays the operating  
system updates and hotfixes applied to  
the CMA system.  
ntp.log  
Log file that captures time server  
related events.  
opends-access-log.txt  
opends-audit-log.txt  
opends-replication-log.txt  
Log file that captures activity queries  
sent to OpenDS.  
Log file that captures OpenDS  
configuration events.  
Log file that captures redundancy and  
DMA system integration events. Not  
available because redundancy and  
DMA integration are not supported.  
2
3
Select the audit log of interest and click Open.  
In the File Download dialog box, click Open to view the file or click Save  
to save the log file to your local system.  
Backup and Delete Audit Log Files  
You can backup and delete audit log files.  
To backup and delete audit log files  
1
Go to Reports > Audit Log Files.  
The Audit Log Files page appears listing the logs being stored on the  
system.  
2
3
Click Backup and Delete.  
In the Backup and Delete dialog box, select the checkboxes of the log files  
to backup.  
4
5
6
Click Backup to begin backing up the log files into a zip folder.  
Click Save.  
In the Backup and Delete dialog, click on Download Verification  
Utility, if it is not installed already.  
302  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System Reports  
7
To enter the verification code, leave the dialog open, until you get the  
verification code from the File Verification Utility.  
8
9
Run the File Verification Utility.  
In the File Verification Utility dialog box, browse to the location of the  
backed-up file and select it, the utility will run when the file is selected.  
After the utility runs, a verification code will be visible in the Verification  
Value field.  
10 In the File Verification Utility dialog, click Copy.  
11 In the Backup and Delete dialog, click in the Verification Code field and  
press CTRL-V to paste in the Verification code into the field.  
12 Click on Verify and Delete. The backed-up file will be checksum verified  
and the backed-up log files will be deleted.  
Note  
It is important for the user to log into the CMA system with the proper roles to be  
able to view and access the Backup and Delete option, otherwise only the Open  
option will be visible.  
The alerting threshold may be modified through the Change Settings option.  
CMA System Report  
The CMA System Report is not available from the Reports menu, but it can be  
a useful report. It produces a SystemInfo.txtfile that describes the system  
configuration.  
To view CMA System Report  
1
2
Go to Admin > Troubleshooting Utilities.  
In the CMA System Report section of the Troubleshooting Utilities  
page, click Download Report in the CMA System Report section.  
3
When the File Download dialog box appears, either Open or Save the  
SystemInfo.txtfile:  
The report includes this information.  
CMA VERSION  
Software version : 6.00.00.ER012  
Hardware version : REVISION_B  
LDAP Integration : true  
SECURITY SETTINGS  
Polycom, Inc.  
303  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
System under Secure Mode: false  
NETWORK CONFIGURATION  
System name  
: POLYCOM-Dell150  
System IPv4 Address  
System IPv6 Address  
: 10.47.10.150  
: N/A  
System IPv6 Link local: N/A  
System subnet mask  
: 255.255.255.0  
System default gateway: 10.47.10.10  
System DNS domain  
: pe.com  
System DNS server 1: 10.47.10.189  
System DNS server 2: N/A  
LICENSE INFO  
Total number of licenses : 100  
Number of licenses in used: 10  
CONFERENCE SETTINGS  
Conference Time Warning  
: true  
Include Conference Owner in new Conference: false  
Allow Overbooking of dial-In participants : false  
Conference PIN Length  
: 15  
SESSION MANAGEMENT SETTINGS  
Remote Desktop Connection is allowed  
CMA User Interface timeout (in sec)  
Max number of sessions per user  
: true  
: 60  
: 5  
Max number of sessions per user enabled : false  
Max number of sessions per system : 50  
Max number of sessions per system enabled: false  
LOCAL USER ACCOUNT CONFIGURATION  
Failed login threshold  
: 3  
Failed login windows (hours)  
Lockout duration (minutes)  
: 1  
: Indefinite  
Account Inactivity threshold (days): 30  
LOCAL PASSWORD REQUIREMENTS  
Maximum password age (days)  
: 180  
Password warning interval (days): 7  
Number of lowercase letters  
Number of uppercase letters  
Minimum length (characters)  
Minimum password age (days)  
Number of numbers  
: 1  
: 1  
: 8  
: 1  
: 1  
: 8  
: 1  
Reject previous passwords  
Number of special characters  
Minimum number of changed characters : 1  
Maximum consecutive repeated characters: 1  
304  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Reports  
CERTIFICATE INFO  
Certificate Common Name  
: CMA Self-Signed Certificate  
Certificate CRL Version  
Certificate CRL Expired  
Certificate Alias  
: 0  
: false  
:
1.2.840.113549.1.9.1=#1613737570706f727440706f6c79636f6d2e636f6d,c  
n=cma self-signed  
certificate,ou=vsg,o=polycom,l=pleasanton,st=california,c=us  
Certificate Issuer  
: CMA Self-Signed Certificate  
PRIMARY GATEKEEPER INFORMATION  
GateKeeper Id  
: PN:PLCM  
GateKeeper description  
: ReadiManager  
GateKeeper Registration mode : ALL_ENDPOINTS  
GateKeeper deny rogue calls : false  
GateKeeper log rogue calls  
: true  
GateKeeper Statistics enabled: false  
GateKeeper Registration timeout (days)  
: 30  
GateKeeper Registration refresh (seconds): 300  
REDUNDANCY INFORMATION  
Server 1 IP address: 10.47.10.150  
Server 1 is PRIMARY: true  
Server 1 is ON  
: true  
Server 2 IP address: N/A  
Server 2 is PRIMARY: false  
Server 2 is ON  
: false  
Virtual IP address : N/A  
DATABASE CONFIGURATION  
Use external DB  
: false  
Polycom, Inc.  
305  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
306  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21  
System Administration Overview  
This chapter describes the Polycom® Converged Management Application™  
(CMA®) system Dashboard, menu, and actions. It includes these topics:  
Polycom CMA System Dashboard  
When you log into the CMA system with Administrator role and permissions,  
the system first displays the system Dashboard. Use the system Dashboard to  
view information about system health and activity levels.  
Note  
We recommend that you use a minimum monitor display of 1280 x 1024 pixels to  
view the system Dashboard.  
The system Dashboard displays data in an array of charts, forms, data grids,  
and other graphical displays. It is supremely customizable. You can modify  
your system Dashboard layout by moving (select the pane title, hold, drag and  
drop), minimizing, maximizing, closing, and restoring panes. Also note that  
your changes to the system Dashboard are persistent not just for a session but  
between logouts and logins.  
Polycom, Inc.  
307  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Dashboard Buttons  
In general, the system Dashboard displays information only. However, the  
following buttons are available from the Dashboard view.  
Button  
Use this button to....  
Add Panes  
Add additional display panes to the system Dashboard. See  
Refresh  
Update the page with current information. To change the  
frequency of automatic screen refreshes from the default of 5  
seconds, click the down arrow and select another option: 15, 30  
45, or 60 seconds.  
The Refresh button flashes when the system refreshes the  
Dashboard or when you click Refresh.  
Restart  
Shutdown  
Shuts down the CMA system. See “Restart or Shut Down a  
Dashboard Panes  
By default the system Dashboard displays the following informational panes:  
But you can add or remove panes to customize the system Dashboard.  
Additional panes that you can add include:  
Endpoints (multiple, configurable panes)  
MCU Status (multiple, configurable panes)  
308  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Administration Overview  
These panes are described in more detail in the following topics.  
Users Logged In  
The Users Logged In pane displays the type and number of users that are  
currently logged into the system. A sparkline presents the number of logins  
over time (30 minutes total; updated every 5 minutes so there are 6 data points  
on the sparkline) for each user type.  
The system identifies three user types by their permissions: Administrators,  
Operators, and Schedulers.  
Note that these three user types are not necessarily the same as user roles. For  
example, users assigned the default Administrator and default Device  
Administrator roles appear in this pane as Administrators. And users  
assigned the default View Only Scheduler, default Scheduler, and default  
Advanced Scheduler roles appear in this pane as Schedulers.  
For more information, see “Roles and Permissions” on page 252.  
CMA Configuration  
The CMA Configuration pane displays information about the configuration  
of the CMA system, including:  
Field  
Description  
Software  
Version  
Displays the current version of CMA system software running on  
the system.  
Hardware  
Version  
The hardware of the CMA system.  
CMAD  
Shipped  
Version  
Displays the version of CMA Desktop for PC that shipped with  
the version of CMA system software running on the system.  
Users can download this version of the Polycom CMA Desktop  
software from the Downloads page.  
CMAD Mac  
Shipped  
Version  
Displays the version of CMA Desktop for Macintosh that shipped  
with the version of CMA system software running on the system.  
Users can download this version of the Polycom CMA Desktop  
software from the Downloads page.  
Enterprise  
Directory  
Displays the enterprise directory configuration. Possible values  
include:  
Auto—If the system is configured to auto-discover the  
enterprise directory server.  
DNS name or IP address of the enterprise directory  
server—If an enterprise directory server is specified on the  
system configuration page.  
None—If the system is not integrated with an enterprise  
directory server.  
Database  
Displays the database source (Internal or External) and the  
DNS name or IP address of the database server.  
Polycom, Inc.  
309  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
Time Source  
Displays the time server source (Internal or External) and the IP  
address of the time server.  
Redundancy  
Displays whether or not the system is configured for redundancy.  
The Redundancy field may also show two configuration errors:  
Need Virtual IP or Secondary Is Down.  
Remote Alerts  
Displays whether or not the system is configured to send remote  
alert notifications.  
Enterprise  
Directory DC  
If the system is integrated with a domain controller for single sign  
on authentication, displays the domain name for that domain  
controller. If the system is not integrated with a single sign on  
domain controller, this field displays Disabled.  
Remote  
Desktop  
Displays whether or not Remote Desktop Connection is enabled.  
CMA Info  
The CMA Info pane displays general information about the CMA system,  
including:  
Field  
Description  
CPU  
Utilization  
Displays two views of the CMA system control processor unit  
(CPU) usage:  
A sparkline that presents the CPU usage over time (10  
minutes total; updated every 1 minute so there are 10 data  
points on the sparkline)  
A percentage indicator that shows the current usage  
Paging File  
Displays two views of the CMA system paging file usage:  
A sparkline that presents the paging file usage over time (10  
minutes total; updated every 1 minute so there are 10 data  
points on the sparkline)  
A percentage indicator that shows the current usage  
Last Hard  
Displays the date and time of the last complete system start.  
Start/Reboot  
Provisioning in  
Progress  
Displays the number of scheduled endpoint provisioning  
processes that are currently underway.  
Software  
Updates in  
Progress  
Displays the number of scheduled endpoint software update  
processes that are currently underway.  
Hardware  
Alarms  
The number of hardware components in the CMA system  
reporting a warning state.  
Threshold  
Alarms  
The number of hardware components in the CMA system  
reporting an error state  
310  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Administration Overview  
Field  
Description  
Total Memory  
Free Memory  
The total amount of RAM on the CMA system.  
The amount of free RAM space on the CMA system.  
Partition [C:]  
Memory  
The amount of used and unused capacity on the CMA system  
partition C.  
Partition [D:]  
Memory  
The amount of used and unused capacity on the CMA system  
partition D.  
Partition [E:]  
Memory  
The amount of used and unused capacity on the CMA system  
partition E.  
Temperature  
Temperature status information provided by the  
Polycom-branded Dell server agent through its MIB  
Power Supply  
Status  
Power supply status information provided by the  
Polycom-branded Dell server agent thought its MIB  
Battery Status  
Battery status information provided by the Polycom-branded Dell  
server agent thought its MIB  
Cooling Fan  
Fan status information provided by the Polycom-branded Dell  
server agent thought its MIB  
Services  
The Services pane displays information about the CMA system services,  
including:  
How many services are running  
How many services are stopped  
A list of the services and a graphical indicator for each service indicating  
its state: Running  
or Stopped  
. If a service is stopped, select the  
service and a dialog box appears that describes the error, possible reasons  
for the error, and suggestions to correct the error. Click the start service  
icon to restart the service.  
The following table lists the services, their purpose, and whether or not  
they are essential to the health of the system.  
Service  
Manages the system’s...  
Web processes  
Comment  
Essential  
Essential  
Apache2  
MSSQLSERVER  
OpenDS  
Database processes  
Site topology database  
Required for site  
topology functionality  
Polycom Cascader  
Cascaded conferencing  
processes  
Required for  
cascading conferences  
Polycom, Inc.  
311  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Service  
Manages the system’s...  
Comment  
Polycom Conference  
Scheduling Service  
Conference scheduling  
processes  
Essential  
Polycom Device Manager Device management  
processes  
Essential  
Essential  
Polycom DialRuleService Dial rule management  
processes  
Polycom Gatekeeper  
Polycom JServer  
Gatekeeper processes  
Essential  
Essential  
Java processes including  
LDAP, SNMP, device  
management, Site  
Topology, and  
dynamically-managed  
device logins and  
provisioning.  
Polycom Master Service  
Polycom Serial COM  
Basic operation processes  
Essential  
Essential  
Serial port management  
processes  
Polycom Service Monitor  
Redundancy monitoring  
processes  
Required for  
redundancy  
When users log into a CMA system, the system first checks to make sure all  
essential services are running before allowing users to access the system. The  
following situations may occur.  
If all essential services are running, users are allowed to access the system.  
If one or more essential services is down, and the Apache service has been  
running for less than seven minutes, users receive an error message  
saying, “The CMA system is not ready. Please try again in a few minutes.”  
If one or more essential services is down, but the Apache service has been  
running for at least seven minutes, users are allowed to access the system.  
In this case, specific system functions may be unavailable to users.  
Gatekeepers  
The Gatekeepers pane displays information about the CMA system as a  
gatekeeper, including:  
Field  
Description  
Gatekeeper  
Statue  
Displays the status of the CMA system gatekeeper. Possible  
values are Up or Down.  
312  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Administration Overview  
Field  
Description  
Call Model  
Describes how the CMA system routes selected H.225 call  
signaling messages. Possible values include: Routed or Direct.  
For more information, see “Routing Mode” on page 398.  
Neighbors  
Displays the number of neighboring gatekeepers identified for the  
CMA system.  
Alternate  
Configured  
Displays whether or not the CMA system has an alternate  
gatekeeper identified.  
Registered  
Devices  
Displays the number of devices currently registered to the CMA  
system gatekeeper.  
Active Calls  
Displays two views of the current CMA system active calls:  
A number field that shows the current number of active calls  
A graph that presents the percentage of active calls over time  
Maximum  
Allowed  
The maximum number of active calls. This value is dependent on  
the call model (routed or direct) and the total number of licenses  
In routed mode, the maximum number of active calls is 30%  
of the total number of licenses.  
In direct mode, the maximum number of active calls is 60% of  
the total number of licenses.  
CMA Licenses  
The CMA Licenses pane displays information about how the CMA system is  
licensed, including:  
The Total Number of Licenses available on the system  
The Licenses in Use, which displays two views of the CMA system active  
calls:  
A sparkline that presents the license usage over time (60 minutes total;  
updated every 5 minutes so there are 12 data points on the sparkline).  
A percentage indicator that shows the current usage.  
Pre-call Status  
The Pre-call Status pane displays information about the next conference or  
conferences that are scheduled to launch including:  
Field  
Description  
Time to  
Conference  
Displays the system-defined pre-call status reporting time of 10  
minutes. In other words, the Pre-call Status pane always reports  
on conferences that are scheduled to start in the next 10 minutes.  
Scheduled to  
Launch  
Displays the number of conferences scheduled to start in the  
next 10 minutes.  
Polycom, Inc.  
313  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
Ready to  
Launch  
Displays the subset of conferences that are scheduled to start in  
the next 10 minutes and that have passed the resource tests that  
the system executes before launching a conference.  
Ready to  
Launch with  
Device in Call  
Displays the subset of conferences that are scheduled to start in  
the next 10 minutes and that have passed the resource tests but  
that still have one or more devices in another call.  
NOT Ready to  
Launch  
Displays the subset of conferences that are scheduled to start in  
the next 10 minutes but that have not yet passed the resource  
tests.  
Also displays the conferences that are not ready to launch.  
Todays Adhoc Conferences  
The Today’s Adhoc Conferences pane displays information about the ad hoc  
conferences started by video endpoints registered to the CMA system. For the  
current day (starting at 0:00 and ending at 24:00), it displays:  
The number of ad hoc conferences that were Completed for the current  
day  
The number of ad hoc conferences that are Active at the current time  
A bar chart that displays the number of ad hoc conferences (vertical axis)  
plotted against time of day (horizontal axis)  
Todays Scheduled Conferences  
The Today’s Scheduled Conferences pane displays information about the  
scheduled conferences managed by the CMA system. For the current day  
(starting at 0:00 and ending at 24:00), it displays:  
The number of scheduled conferences that were Completed that day  
The number of scheduled conferences that are Active at the current time  
The number of scheduled conferences that are yet to occur (Future)  
A bar chart that displays time on the linear axis plotted against the number  
of scheduled conferences on the horizontal axis  
Endpoints  
The system allows you to add multiple Endpoints panes so you can create  
your own scheme for grouping and monitoring endpoints. When you add an  
Endpoints pane, you can give the pane a meaningful name and select which  
endpoints to monitor. You can save the pane, create others as needed. You can  
also reconfigure an Endpoints pane using the configuration tool.  
Endpoints panes display the following information:  
The number of endpoints being monitored  
The number of monitored endpoints that are In a Call  
314  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
System Administration Overview  
The number of monitored endpoints that are Online  
The number of monitored endpoints that are Offline  
In addition, the Endpoints pane identifies any monitored endpoints that are  
experiencing alert conditions. If you click on an endpoint in the list, the system  
displays the Endpoint > Monitor View.  
Finally, click View Endpoint to see the Status, Name, Alias, IP Address,  
Owner, and Site for the monitored endpoints. This status information is sent  
by the endpoints to the CMA system.  
Systems  
The Systems pane displays summary information about the devices registered  
with the CMA system, including:  
Field  
Description  
Endpoints  
VVXs  
The number of endpoints registered with the CMA system.  
The number of VVX systems registered with the CMA system.  
The number of MCUs registered with the CMA system.  
MCUs  
Gatekeepers  
The number of neighbored gatekeepers identified to the CMA  
system plus the CMA system itself.  
Gateways  
The number of individual H.323 cards and/or IP blades in  
Polycom MCUs are assigned the device type of GW/MCU during  
registration. For more information, see “Network Device Types”  
Rooms  
VBPs  
The number of rooms defined with the CMA system.  
The number of VBPs defined with the CMA system.  
The number of DMAs defined with the CMA system.  
DMAs  
Touch Controls The number of Touch Controls defined with registered endpoints.  
If any of the devices registered with the CMA system experience a fault, the  
Systems pane also displays an alert icon. Click the alert icon to see the  
Endpoint or Network Device view and get more information about the alert.  
Conference Status  
The Conference Status pane displays the list of active conferences, plus 2 of 6  
participants online.  
Click on conference title to go to conference monitor view for that conference.  
Polycom, Inc.  
315  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Failed Enterprise Directory Login Attempts  
The Failed AD Login Attempts pane displays:  
The total number of Failed Logins for Active Directory users in the last 24  
hour period.  
The domain\username for the Active Directory users whose login  
attempts failed and how many times they failed. Click the  
domain\username to view the date and time for the failed attempts.  
Redundancy Status  
The Redundancy Status pane displays information about the CMA system  
redundancy configuration, including:  
Whether or not the system is configured for redundancy. Possible values  
for Status are Configured or Not Configured.  
The Virtual IP Address for the redundant system  
The IP address of the Active Server  
The IP address of the Backup Server  
MCU Status  
The system allows you to add multiple MCU Status panes so you can create a  
pane for all or individual MCUs registered with the CMA system. When you  
add an MCU Status pane, you can give the pane a meaningful name and either  
select an MCU to monitor or select All MCUs. You can save the pane, create  
others as needed. You can also reconfigure an MCU Status pane using the  
configuration tool.  
The MCU Status pane for All MCUs displays the following information:  
:
Note  
Areas may affect an administrator’s ability to View Details for an MCU. The  
administrator and MCU must be assigned to a common area.  
Field  
Description  
Errors  
Displays the cumulative number of alarms for all of the registered  
MCUs.  
Warnings  
Displays the cumulative number of warnings for all of the  
registered MCUs.  
Active  
Conferences  
Displays the total number of active conferences being hosted by  
all of the registered MCUs.  
The MCU Status pane for All MCUs also lists all of the registered MCUs and  
displays the Errors and Warnings for the MCUs.  
316  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
System Administration Overview  
The MCU Status pane for an individual MCU displays the following  
information:  
Field  
Description  
Errors  
Displays the number of alarms on the MCU.  
Warnings  
Displays the number of conferences that are active on the MCU  
at the current time.  
Active  
Conferences  
Displays the number of active conferences currently being  
hosted by the MCU.  
Number of  
Audio Ports  
Displays the number of dedicated audio ports configured on the  
MCU.  
Audio Ports  
Utilization  
Displays two views of the MCU audio port usage:  
A sparkline that presents the audio port usage over time  
A percentage indicator that shows the current usage  
Number of  
Displays the number of video ports configured on the MCU.  
Video Ports  
Video Ports  
Utilization  
Displays two views of the MCU video port usage:  
A sparkline that presents the video port usage over time  
A percentage indicator that shows the current usage  
Expected Port  
Utilization  
A timeline that shows how many ports are scheduled for  
conferences within the next 45 minutes.  
This status information is sent by the MCU to the CMA system.  
In addition, the MCU Status pane identifies when the monitored MCU is  
experiencing alert conditions.  
System Administration Menu  
The system Admin menu gives users with administrative permissions access  
to the day-to-day management tasks they need to monitor, maintain, and  
troubleshoot the CMA system. Besides the Dashboard, it lists these selections:  
Selection  
Use this selection to...  
Conference  
Templates  
Manage (add, edit, and delete) conference templates. See  
Conference Settings Enable or disable Conference Auto-launch and Conference  
Provisioning Profiles Manage (add, edit, and delete) automatic or scheduled  
provisioning profiles.  
Polycom, Inc.  
317  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Selection  
Use this selection to...  
Software Updates  
Manage (add, edit, and delete) automatic or scheduled  
software update packages.  
Rooms  
Manage (add, edit, and delete) rooms in the CMA system  
directory.  
Areas  
Manage Areas for a CMA system.  
Directories  
Manage the directories available to the CMA system  
including the enterprise directory, address books, or Global  
Address Book.  
Server Settings  
Configure the basic CMA system, which includes the  
network, system time, database, directory, licensing,  
redundancy, branding, GAB, remote alert, and E-mail set  
up.  
SNMP Settings  
Manage SNMP messaging for the CMA system.  
Gatekeeper Settings By default the CMA system is made the default gatekeeper  
during the First Time Setup process. Use the Gatekeeper  
Settings option to modify this setting or to add an alternate  
gatekeeper or neighboring gatekeepers.  
Gatekeeper Settings affect how devices register and calls  
are made in your video communications network. These  
settings allow you to:  
Identify the gatekeeper with an identifier and  
description.  
Specify registration-related settings, including the  
default gatekeeper, which endpoints register, the  
registration refresh period, and the offline timeout.  
Set the maximum number of neighboring gatekeeper  
hop counts.  
Specify how to handle calls to and from unregistered  
endpoints.  
Management and  
Security  
Upgrade the CMA system and configure the certificate,  
security, and endpoint management set up.  
Dial Plan and Sites  
Edit the default CMA system Dial Plan and Site settings  
(which includes the definition of sites, site links, dial rules,  
services, and least-cost routing tables) to support your  
network topology and video call routing.  
Alert Settings  
Configure the CMA system to send E-mail alerts for  
specified system or endpoint events.  
Backup System  
Settings  
Download a .zip archive file containing all configuration  
information necessary to restore the system.  
Database Backup  
FIles  
View or backup the CMA system internal database backup  
file.  
318  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Administration Overview  
Selection  
Use this selection to...  
Uploads  
Upload SIP URI data to the CMA system.  
Troubleshooting  
Utilities  
Access all of the troubleshooting information and utilities  
the CMA system has available.  
Report  
Administration  
Configure report administration settings including retention  
periods, etc.  
Polycom, Inc.  
319  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
320  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
22  
Conference Setup Overview  
This chapter describes information about conference templates, options, and  
settings within the Polycom® Converged Management Application™  
(CMA®) system. Two types of configuration settings relate to scheduled  
conferences:  
Conference Templates define most of the settings that become the defaults  
for a conference.  
Conference Settings are global system-wide settings that apply to all  
scheduled conferences.  
Conference Templates  
Conference templates allow you to create various combinations of settings to  
apply to scheduled conferences.  
For scheduled conferences that end on MGC devices, the conference  
template explicitly identifies the settings the MGC should use to control  
the conference.  
For scheduled conferences that end on RMX devices, the conference  
template explicitly identifies the RMX profile which identifies the settings  
the RMX should use to control the conference.  
Users assigned the Administrator role can add or edit Conference Templates.  
They can also identify (by user role) which users have access to which  
Conference Templates and which users have the Advanced Scheduler role.  
Then users select from the different templates available to them to switch  
between different combinations of conference settings.  
If using an existing profile on the RMX system, the CMA system administrator  
must manually synchronize the settings in the CMA system conference  
template and its associated RMX profile.  
Alternatively, you can configure the RMX profile settings in the CMA system  
conference template, which is used by all RMX systems in the conference. For  
more information about the RMX profile settings, see the Polycom® RMX®  
1500/2000/4000 Administrator’s Guide.  
Polycom, Inc.  
321  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
General Settings  
Name  
Enter a unique and meaningful name for the template,  
which can be up to 32 characters long.  
Description  
Enter a meaningful description (ASCII only) of the  
conference settings template.  
Audio-Only  
Template  
Select this option to designate the template as an  
audio-only template. Selecting this option disables many  
settings.  
Supported MCUs  
Specify the supported MCU type. Possible values include:  
MGC  
RMX  
Always Use MCU  
Dial Options  
When selected, an MCU is used for the scheduled  
conference, regardless of the number of participants. When  
not selected, an MCU is used only when necessary.  
These settings apply only to video conferences. The video  
dial options are:  
Dial-In Only (all participants dial into the conference)  
Dial-Out Only (all participants are called by the system)  
Dial-In + Dial-Out (The person setting up the  
conference can specify which participants must dial into  
the conference and which participants are called by the  
system.)  
Template will be  
available to users  
with the selected  
roles...  
Select the roles to which users must be assigned for them  
to see this template when scheduling conferences.  
Available Roles  
Selected Roles  
The list of roles defined to the CMA system.  
The list of roles that can use the conference template being  
defined.  
Common Settings  
Meet Me Per  
Conference  
When selected, only one dial-in number is assigned to the  
conference. When cleared, each dial-in participant is  
assigned a different dial-in number.  
322  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Conference Setup Overview  
Field  
Description  
Sets the video layout for the conference. The default is  
Video Mode  
Video Switching Mode. To change to a Continuous  
Presence layout or mode, click the switching icon and  
select a layout option.  
The video mode determines the initial layout on an  
endpoint’s display during a multipoint conference. This  
option requires an MCU.  
This option is not available for RMX devices if you select  
any of the following:  
Auto layout option (RMX Video Settings)  
Video switching option (RMX General Settings)  
Telepresence mode is On (RMX Video Settings)  
Note  
Make sure you have defined video endpoint systems and  
boards so that they are available for selection in continuous  
presence layouts.  
Presentation Mode  
Select to enable Presentation Mode. In this mode, the  
system uses the selected layout to display all  
participants. When a participant’s speech exceeds a  
predefined time (30 seconds), the system identifies the  
participant as the lecturer and changes to Lecture  
Mode. The video mode for the other participant’s  
automatically changes to full screen, displaying the  
lecturer, while the lecturer’s endpoint displays  
participants in the video mode defined previously. When  
another participant starts talking, the system changes  
back to Presentation Mode and the conference returns  
to its predefined video layout.  
Clear this option do disable Presentation Mode. All  
participants see the conference in the video mode  
defined elsewhere.  
This option is not available if you select any of the following:  
Video switching option (RMX General Settings)  
Same layout option (RMX Video Settings)  
Telepresence mode is On (RMX Video Settings)  
Notes  
RMX 1000 systems do not support Lecture Mode,  
Presentation Mode, or Lecture View Switching.  
Polycom, Inc.  
323  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
Speed (Kbps)  
Sets the speed for the conference, which applies to both  
point-to-point and multipoint calls. Possible values for  
Polycom MGC systems are between 96 to 1920 Kbps and  
Bridged Audio. The default is 384 Kbps.  
Note  
If you use an RMX profile for conferences that land on an  
RMX system, the speed designated here is used to reserve  
bandwidth and must match the line rate defined in the RMX  
profile that is identified in the Profile Name field.  
Lecturer View  
Switching  
Select this option to enable automatic switching of  
participants on the Lecturer’s screen when Lecture Mode  
is set to Presentation Mode and the number of participants  
exceeds the number of windows identified by the video  
mode defined elsewhere.  
This option is not available if you select any of the following:  
Same layout option (RMX Video Settings)  
Telepresence mode is On (RMX Video Settings)  
Note  
RMX 1000 systems do not support Lecture Mode,  
Presentation Mode, or Lecture View Switching.  
MGC Settings  
Entry Tone  
Sets an entry tone sound when a participant enters a  
conference.  
Exit Tone  
Sets an exit tone sound when a participant leaves a  
conference.  
End Time Alert Tone  
Sets an alert tone to play into MCU-hosted conferences  
indicating that the conference is scheduled to end soon.  
Set the End Time Alert (minutes) field to configure when the  
tone should be played into the conference.  
Note  
This feature is not related to the system-based Conference  
Time Warning feature.  
End Time Alert  
(mins)  
Specifies the number of minutes before the conference end  
that the End Time Alert Tone should sound.  
324  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Conference Setup Overview  
Field  
Description  
Video Algorithm  
Sets the compression algorithm that the MCU uses to  
process video. Possible values include:  
Auto  
H261. An ITU standard designed for two-way  
communication over ISDN lines and supports data rates  
which are multiples of 64Kbit/s. H.261 supports CIF and  
QCIF resolutions.  
H263. Based on H.261 with enhancements that  
improve video quality over modems. It supports CIF,  
QCIF, SQCIF, 4CIF and 16CIF resolutions.  
H264  
The default is Auto.  
Note  
Selecting a video algorithm doesn't guarantee that it will be  
chosen for a conference since the MCU device may  
negotiate a different algorithm with the endpoints,  
depending on the endpoint’s capabilities.  
People + Content  
Enable this setting when you have equipment that supports  
the display of people and content. Sets the format type of  
the content. Possible values include:  
None  
People+Content (H.239)  
People and Content V0. To show both the presenter  
and the content on a single display using HDX-Series  
products.  
Polycom Visual Concert PC. To show live PC content  
using standard ViewStation® systems  
Polycom Visual Concert FX. To integrate a laptop with  
graphics into a video call using ViewStation® products  
DuoVideo  
None is the default.  
Note  
The MGC requires that conferences with People+Content  
use a minimum speed of 192 K.  
Talk Hold Time  
(secs)  
Indicates the minimum period that a participant has to  
speak to become the main speaker. During this period, no  
other participant may become the main speaker. The range  
is from 1.5 seconds to 10 seconds, in increments of 0.01  
seconds.  
Polycom, Inc.  
325  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
T120 Rate  
Determines whether T.120 is enabled, and if so, the default  
transfer rate. Enable this setting when you have equipment  
that supports T.120 display of data. Options are: 6.4, 14.4,  
16, 22.4, 24, 30.4, 32, 38.4, 40, 46.4, 54.4, and 62.4.  
Note  
Because this setting uses resources on the MCU device, it  
is recommended that you select None.  
Audio Algorithm  
Sets the compression algorithm that the MGC uses to  
process audio.  
The default is Auto.  
Note  
Selecting a certain video/audio algorithm doesn't guarantee  
that it will be chosen for a conference since an MGC device  
may negotiate a different algorithm with the endpoints,  
depending on the endpoint’s capabilities.  
Audio Mix Depth  
(sites)  
Sets the number of participants with the loudest voices who  
can speak at once during a conference. If additional  
participants speak, their comments are not heard.  
Conference on Port  
When selected, this option conserves bandwidth and ports  
by putting all participants on a single port. When  
Conference on Port is enabled, the Video Mode must be  
set to one of the Continuous Presence layouts.  
RMX General Settings > RMX Profile Settings  
Use existing profile Select to use an existing RMX profile.  
Clear to set all of the RMX profile settings here in the  
conference template. This method ensures that the RMX  
profile settings are the way you want them and avoids  
maintaining identical profiles on all RMX systems.  
Note  
With this option selected, conferences fail if they land on an  
RMX device and a valid RMX profile is not specified below.  
RMX profile name  
Identifies the RMX profile for the conference, if the  
conference is hosted on an RMX system.  
Enter the RMX profile routing name, which is generally (but  
not always) the same as the profile name as specified in the  
RMX platform.  
326  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Conference Setup Overview  
Field  
Description  
RMX General Settings > Conference Settings  
Video switching  
(VSW)  
In Video Switching mode, all participants see the same  
video picture (full screen). The current speaker is displayed  
in full screen on all the participants’ endpoints, while the  
speaker sees the previous speaker. Switching between  
participants is voice-activated; whenever a participant starts  
to speak, he or she becomes the conference speaker and is  
viewed on all screens.  
When selected, the conference is of ultra-high quality video  
resolution, in a special conferencing mode which implies  
that all participants must connect at the same line rate and  
use HD video.  
This feature utilizes the resources more wisely and  
efficiently by:  
Saving utilization of video ports (1 port per participant as  
opposed to 4 ports in CP mode).  
Video display is in full screen mode only.  
Drawbacks of this feature are that all participants must  
connect at the same line rate, (for example, HD), and all  
participants with endpoints not supporting HD will connect  
as secondary (audio only).  
Video layout changes are not enabled during a conference.  
If HD 1080p is selected, endpoints that do not support HD  
1080p resolution are connected as secondary (audio only)  
participants.  
Note:  
This option is not available if MGC is selected as a  
Supported MCU (General Settings).  
Video Switching conferencing mode is unavailable to  
ISDN participants.  
Resolution  
Possible values include:  
H.264 SD 30(v7 with MPM+ or MPMx)  
H.264 720p60(v7 with MPM+ or MPMx)  
H.264 720p30  
H.264 1080p30(MPM+ or MPMx)  
RMX General Settings > Advanced Settings  
Auto redialing Instructs the Polycom RMX to automatically redial IP and  
SIP participants that have been abnormally disconnected  
from the conference.  
The RMX will not redial an endpoint that has been  
disconnected from the conference by the participant.  
The RMX will not redial an endpoint that has been  
disconnected or deleted from the conference by an  
operator or administrator.  
Polycom, Inc.  
327  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
Encryption  
LPR  
Activate encryption for the conference  
Activate lost packet recovery (LPR) for the conference.  
Note:  
LPR can be enabled for VSW conferences, but H.320 and  
SIP participants will not be able to connect.  
Auto terminate  
When selected (default), the conference automatically ends  
when the termination conditions are met:  
Before first joins — No participant has connected to a  
conference during the n minutes after it started. Default  
idle time is 10 minutes.  
At the end - After last participant quits All the  
participants have disconnected from the conference  
and the conference is idle (empty) for the predefined  
time period. Default idle time is 1 minute.  
At the end - When last participant remains — Only  
one participant is still connected to the conference for  
the predefined time period (excluding the recording link  
which is not considered a participant when this option is  
selected). This option should be selected when defining  
a profile that will be used for Gateway Calls and you  
want to ensure that the call is automatically terminated  
when only one participant is connected. Default idle  
time is 1 minute.  
RMX Video Quality > People Video Definition  
Video quality  
Optimizes the video quality based on the amount of  
movement contained in the conference video. Possible  
values include:  
Motion—Provides a higher frame rate without  
increased resolution.  
Sharpness—Provides a higher video resolution and  
requires more system resources.  
Max resolution (v7)  
Depending on whether MPM+ or MPMx cards are installed,  
the possible values include:  
Auto  
CIF  
HD 1080  
HD 720  
SD  
328  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Conference Setup Overview  
Field  
Description  
Video clarity (MPM+  
and MPMx only)  
Applies video enhancing algorithms to incoming video  
streams of resolutions up to and including SD. Clearer  
images with sharper edges and higher contrast are sent  
back to all endpoints at the highest possible resolution  
supported by each endpoint.  
This option is not available if you select any of the following:  
Motion option for Video quality  
Video switching (VSW) option (RMX General  
Settings)  
Auto brightness (v7) Detects and automatically adjusts the brightness of video  
windows that are dimmer than other video windows in the  
conference layout.  
This option is not available if you set Telepresence mode  
to On (RMX Video Settings).  
RMX Video Quality > Content Video Definition  
Content settings  
Select the transmission mode for the content channel:  
Graphics — Basic mode, intended for normal graphics.  
Hi-resolution graphics — Higher bit rate intended for  
high resolution graphic display.  
Live video — Content channel displays live video.  
Selection of a higher bit rate for the content results in a  
lower bit rate for the people channel.  
Content protocol  
The possible values are:  
H.263 – Content is shared using H.263 even if some  
endpoints have H.264 capability.  
Up to H.264 – H.264 is the default content sharing  
algorithm. When selected:  
Content is shared using H.264 if all endpoints have  
H.264 capability.  
Content is shared using H.263 if all endpoints do not  
have H.264 capability.  
Endpoints that do not have at least H.263 capability  
can connect to the conference but cannot share  
content.  
Polycom, Inc.  
329  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
RMX Video Settings  
Send content to  
legacy endpoints  
(MPM+ and MPMx  
only)  
Content can be sent to H.323/ SIP/ISDN endpoints that do  
not support H.239 content (legacy endpoints) over the video  
(people) channel.  
This option is not available if you select any of any of the  
following:  
Video switching (VSW) option (RMX General  
Settings)  
Same layout option  
Notes:  
When enabled, additional video resources are allocated to  
the conference.  
Same layout  
Select this option to force the selected layout on all  
participants in a conference. Displays the same video  
stream to all participants and personal selection of the  
video layout is disabled. If participants are forced to a video  
layout window, they can see themselves.  
This option is not available if you select any of the following:  
MGC as a Supported MCU (General Settings)  
Video switching (VSW) option (RMX General  
Settings)  
Telepresence mode is On (RMX Video Settings)  
Auto layout  
Select this option to have the system automatically select  
the conference layout based on the number of participants  
currently connected to the conference. When a new video  
participant connects or disconnects, the conference layout  
automatically changes to reflect the new number of video  
participants.  
Clear this option to manually select a layout for the  
conference using the Video Mode options.  
This option is not available if you select any of any of the  
following:  
MGC as a Supported MCU (General Settings)  
Video switching (VSW) option (RMX General  
Settings)  
Lecture View Switching option (Common Settings)  
Telepresence mode is On (RMX Video Settings)  
330  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Conference Setup Overview  
Field  
Description  
Telepresence mode  
(v6)  
The possible values are:  
Auto (Default) - If any ITP (Immersive Telepresence)  
endpoints are detected, ITP features are applied to the  
conference video for all participants.The ITP features  
are dynamic. If all ITP endpoints disconnect from the  
conference, normal conference video resumes for all  
participants. ITP features resume for all participants if  
an ITP endpoint reconnects to the conference.  
On - ITP features are applied to the conference video  
for all participants regardless of whether there are ITP  
endpoints connected.  
Off - Normal conference video.  
Note:  
This field is enabled only if the RMX system is licensed  
for Telepresence Mode.  
This option is not available if MGC is selected as a  
Supported MCU (General Settings).  
Telepresence layout  
mode (v6)  
Enables VNOC operators and Polycom Multi Layout  
Applications to retrieve Telepresence Layout Mode  
information from the RMX.  
The possible values include:  
Manual  
Continuous Presence - Room continuous presence  
(default)  
Room Switch - Voice activated room switching  
This option is not available if MGC is selected as a  
Supported MCU (General Settings).  
RMX Audio Settings  
Echo suppression  
(Supported only with MPM+ or MPMx cards.) Enables an  
algorithm to search for and detect sounds outside the  
normal range of human speech (such as echo) and  
automatically mute them when detected.  
Keyboard noise  
suppression  
(Supported only with MPM+ or MPMx cards.) Enables an  
algorithm to search for and detect keyboard noises and  
automatically mute them when detected.  
Audio clarity (v7)  
(Supported only with MPM+ or MPMx cards.) Improves  
received audio from participants connected via low audio  
bandwidth connections, by stretching the fidelity of the  
narrowband telephone connection to improve call clarity.  
The enhancement is applied to the following low bandwidth  
(8kHz) audio algorithms: G.729a and G.711.  
Polycom, Inc.  
331  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
RMX Skins  
Select the skin you want. Skins modify the background and  
frames. With the top two skin options, the frames fill the  
screen with their borders touching.  
These options are not available if you select any of the  
following:  
Video switching (VSW) option (RMX General  
Settings)  
Telepresence mode is On (RMX Video Settings)  
RMX Conference IVR  
Override default  
conference IVR  
service  
Select to override the default conference Interactive Voice  
Response (IVR).  
Conference IVR  
service  
If you selected the override option above, enter the name of  
the conference IVR service you want to use. All RMX  
systems that could be used must have the same  
conference IVR service set up.  
Conferencerequires Select this option to require that a video chairperson control  
chairperson  
the conference from his or her video endpoint system.  
When this option is implemented, the system will assign a  
15-digit password that the conference chairperson must  
enter to control the conference. The conference scheduler  
can change this system-assigned password to any 15-digit  
number.  
In this case:  
The video chairperson must have a video endpoint  
system.  
The conference requires an MCU.  
All conference participants remain in the waiting room  
and cannot join the conference until the conference  
chairperson enters the conference.  
H.243 chair control allows an endpoint to control the  
conference using the H.243 chair control feature. The  
chairperson can disconnect participants, force the use of a  
continuous presence video layout, and terminate the  
conference.  
H.243 cascade control allows the MGC-50 or MGC-100 to  
support a cascading configuration of conferences with the  
capabilities of H.243.  
Note  
Set in the RMX profile for RMX 2000/4000 devices  
The RMX 1000 system does not support the  
Chairperson feature.  
332  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Conference Setup Overview  
Field  
Description  
RMX Recording  
Enable recording  
Enables the recording settings. If no Recording links are  
found, an error message is displayed.  
Record conference  
Recording link (v7)  
The possible values are:  
Immediately – Conference recording is automatically  
started upon connection of the first participant.  
Upon request – The operator or chairperson must  
initiate the recording (manual).  
Enter the name of the Recording link you want to use. The  
recording link defines the connection between the  
conference and the recording system to be used for  
conference recording.  
Recording links defined on the RMX can be given a  
descriptive name and can be associated with a Virtual  
Recording Room (VRR) saved on the Polycom® RSS™  
4000 Version 6.0 Recording and Streaming Server (RSS).  
All RMX systems that could be used must have the same  
recording link set up.  
Audio only  
Records only the audio channel of the conference.  
Indication of  
recording  
Displays a recording icon to all conference participants  
informing them that the conference is being recorded. The  
recording icon is replaced by a paused icon when  
conference recording is paused.  
Polycom CMA system has a Default Template. Administrators with  
Conference Setup permissions can edit the Default Template and create  
additional templates with different settings.  
When scheduling a conference, the Default Template, which is available to all  
users, is selected by default. Schedulers can select a different conference  
template from the list of templates an administrator has made available to  
them. Users with advanced scheduling permissions can edit the template  
settings for a specific scheduled conference. These changes apply only to the  
specified conference.  
Use these best practices when working with conference templates.  
For the Default Template, select settings that are the lowest common  
values for all device types. This ensures that all conferences scheduled  
with the Default Template can successfully launch on whatever devices  
the system has available at the time.  
The template names Default Template and Default Audio Templates are  
stored in the system database and their names are not localized into other  
languages. If you wish to localized their names into your language, edit  
the templates and enter new names for them.  
Polycom, Inc.  
333  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
When creating new templates, give them meaningful purposes and names  
so that your users can easily identify the differences between template  
choices. For example, identify templates according to maximum bit rate,  
specific features implemented by the template (for example, Lecture Mode  
or Chairperson Control), and/or supported MCU type (MGC or RMX).  
In a mixed-MCU environment, consider the advantages and  
disadvantages of creating one or more conference templates for each MCU  
type. This ensures that the system can select a specific type of MCU and  
can implement the chosen conference settings.  
Remember that using an existing RMX profile will override settings  
specified when scheduling a conference through the Polycom CMA  
system. To ensure consistent and expected behavior, make sure to  
synchronize and lock down RMX profiles and Polycom CMA system  
conference templates.  
Note  
Polycom CMA systems do not support scheduling of third-party MCUs. Template  
settings apply only to the MGC or RMX devices.  
Conference Settings  
Conference settings apply to all conferences scheduled using the Polycom  
CMA system. These settings include:  
Field  
Description  
Conference Time  
Warning  
Specifies whether or not the Polycom CMA system sends a  
message to video endpoints in a conference to warn the  
endpoint users that their conference is scheduled to end  
soon. The system sends the message 15 minutes and 5  
minutes before the conference is scheduled to end.  
To support this feature, the video endpoint system must be  
capable of receiving a system Send Message action.  
By default, Conference Time Warning is enabled.  
Note  
This feature is not related to the MCU-based End Time  
Alert Tone feature.  
Automatically  
Include Conference  
Owner (Scheduler)  
Select this option when you wish the system to always  
include the person scheduling the conference as a  
conference participant. Do not select this option if your  
in New Conferences organization has assistants or operators schedule  
conferences for others.  
334  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Conference Setup Overview  
Field  
Description  
Allow overbooking  
of dial-in  
participants  
Select this option to allow schedulers to schedule dial-in  
participants to dial into multiple conferences, but the system  
reserves resources for the participant for only the first  
scheduled conference  
Conference and  
chairperson  
passcode length  
Designate the required length of the system-generated  
conference and chairperson passcodes. The acceptable  
length for both of these passcodes is 9 to 16 characters. By  
default, the required length for both of these passcodes is  
set to 15 characters.  
Note  
Depending on the system settings, the scheduler may  
be allowed to change the conference or chairperson  
passcode. However, the passcode length requirement  
still applies.  
If an administrator changes the passcode length here at  
the same time a scheduler edits the passcode settings  
for a scheduled conference, the scheduling operation  
may use either the old or the new length, depending on  
the exact timing.  
Polycom, Inc.  
335  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
336  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
23  
Conference Setup Operations  
This chapter includes information about conference options and tasks within  
the Polycom® Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system. It  
includes these topics:  
View the Conference Templates List  
To view the Conference Template list  
Go to Admin > Conference Templates.  
The Conference Templates list appears.  
Polycom, Inc.  
337  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Add a Conference Template  
To add a conference template  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Conference Templates.  
On the Conference Templates list, click Add  
.
Complete the General Info and MCU Settings sections of the Add  
Conference Template dialog box first. Your selection for MCU Settings  
affect your choices in the Video Settings section. For more information  
on the Add Conference Template dialog box, see “Conference Templates”  
4
5
Complete the Video Settings and Conf Settings sections of the Add  
Conference Template dialog box.  
Click OK.  
The new template appears in the Conference Template list.  
Note  
The CMA system does not validate the Conference Template settings. When you  
create a new conference template, you must make certain that the settings match  
the capabilities of the MCUs (MGC or RMX device) or endpoints.  
Edit a Conference Template  
To edit a conference template  
1
2
Go to Admin > Conference Templates.  
On the Conference Templates list, select the template of interest and  
click Edit  
.
3
Edit the General Info, Video Settings, MCU Settings, and Conf Settings  
sections of the Edit Conference Template dialog box as required.  
Note  
If you change the conference template Speed setting and there are scheduled  
conferences using that template, all endpoints in the scheduled conferences are  
reset to whichever is less: the new template Speed or the maximum speed that the  
endpoint supports.  
4
Click OK.  
338  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Conference Setup Operations  
Delete a Conference Template  
To delete a conference template  
1
2
Go to Admin > Conference Templates.  
On the Conference Templates list, select the template of interest and  
click Delete  
.
3
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
Set Conference Settings  
To specify conference settings  
1
2
Go to Admin > Conference Settings.  
On the Conference Settings page, make the required selections.  
3
Click Update.  
Disable Conference Auto-Launch  
To disable conference auto-launch  
1
2
Go to Admin > Conference Settings.  
In the Conference Auto-Launch section of the Conference Settings page,  
check the Disabled check box.  
3
Click Update.  
Disable Conference Time Warning  
To disable the conference time warning  
1
2
Go to Admin > Conference Settings.  
In the Conference Time Warning section of the Conference Settings  
page, clear the Enabled check box.  
3
Click Update.  
Polycom, Inc.  
339  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Overbooking Dial-in Participants  
In the CMA system, an administrator can configure the system to allow  
schedulers to overbook dial-in participants. In this case, dial-in participants  
can be scheduled to dial into multiple conferences, but the system reserves  
resources for the participant for only the first scheduled conference. Dial-out  
participants cannot be scheduled into multiple conferences.  
Note  
Schedulers can only overbook dial-in participants if they select a conference  
template that has the Video Dial Option set to Dial-In Only. A conference template  
that has the Video Dial Option set to Dial In+Dial Out will not work for this  
purpose.  
To allow schedulers to overbook dial-in participants  
1
2
Go to Admin > Conference Settings.  
In the Allow Overbooking of dial-in participants section of the  
Conference Settings page, check the Enabled check box.  
3
Click Update.  
Add Customized Text to E-mail Notifications  
To add customized text to all conferencing E-mail notifications  
1
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > E-mail.  
In the Text at the Beginning of the Reminder E-mail section of the  
E-mail page, type in the introductory text you want to appear at the start  
of all conferencing E-mail notifications.  
This text field is limited to 650 characters. The text you type here will  
appear in plain text just as you typed it.  
3
4
In the Text at the End of the Reminder E-mail section of the E-mail page,  
type in the closing text you want to appear at the end of all conferencing  
E-mail notifications.  
This text field is limited to 650 characters. The text you type here will  
appear in plain text just as you typed it.  
Click Update.  
340  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Conference Setup Operations  
Edit Customized Text in E-mail Notifications  
To edit the customized text in all conferencing E-mail notifications  
Go to Admin > Server Settings > E-mail.  
To change the introductory text, replace the text in the Text at the  
1
2
Beginning of the Reminder E-mail section of the E-mail page with the  
new text you want to appear at the start of all conferencing E-mail  
notifications.  
This text field is limited to 650 characters. The text you type here will  
appear in plain text just as you typed it.  
3
4
To change the closing text, replace the text in the Text at the End of the  
Reminder E-mail section of the E-mail page with the new text you want  
to appear at the end of all conferencing E-mail notifications.  
This text field is limited to 650 characters. The text you type here will  
appear in plain text just as you typed it.  
Click Update.  
Delete Customized Text in E-mail Notifications  
To delete the customized text in all conferencing E-mail notifications  
1
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > E-mail.  
To delete the introductory text, select the text in the Text at the  
Beginning of the Reminder E-mail section of the E-mail page and press  
DELETE.  
3
4
To delete the closing text, select the text in the Text at the End of the  
Reminder E-mail section of the E-mail page and press DELETE.  
Click Update.  
Polycom, Inc.  
341  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
342  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
24  
Room Overview and Operations  
This chapter describes how to set up rooms in the Polycom® Converged  
Management Application™ (CMA®) system. It includes these topics:  
Local and Enterprise Meeting Rooms  
The CMA system allows a user assigned the default Administrator role to  
manage local and enterprise meeting rooms and the endpoints associated with  
those meeting rooms.  
Most often a CMA system is integrated with an enterprise directory to which  
rooms have been added. However, the CMA system also allows you to add  
local rooms (that is, rooms added manually to the system) and associate them  
with endpoints.  
For dynamically managed endpoints associated with a room, you must also  
associate each room in the CMA system with a machine account. The machine  
account allows the room’s endpoint to connect and authenticate with the CMA  
system for directory and dynamic management purposes without using the  
endpoint user’s account. After you add a room, you can create the machine  
account and associate the room with the machine account. For more  
Polycom, Inc.  
343  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
View the Rooms List  
To view the Rooms list  
Go to Admin > Rooms.  
The Rooms list appears. It can be filtered by Site.  
Column  
Room Name  
Description  
Site  
Description  
The unique and required name of the room.  
The optional description of the room.  
The location of the room as identified in the site  
topology.  
Associated  
Endpoints  
The primary endpoint associated with this room. A set of  
ellipses (...) indicates the room has more than one  
associated endpoint.  
Add a Local Room  
When you add a local room to a CMA system, you specify settings for it and  
associate one or more endpoints with it.  
To add a local room  
1
2
Go to Admin > Rooms.  
On the Rooms page, click Add  
.
The Add New Room dialog box appears.  
3
4
If you are logged into a domain other than the Local domain, click  
Manually Define.  
Complete the General Info and Associated Devices sections of the Add  
New Room dialog box. The following table shows the room information  
in the CMA system records.  
Field  
Description  
General Info  
Room Name  
The name of the room, which appears in the address  
book for associated endpoints.  
Description  
(Optional) A useful description (ASCII only) of the room.  
344  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Room Overview and Operations  
Field  
Description  
Site  
The site in which the room is located.  
Note  
Rooms and the endpoint associated with them must be  
assigned to the same site.  
Email  
(Optional) The E-mail address of the room administrator.  
Associated Endpoints  
Available  
Endpoints  
The list of unassigned endpoints that are managed by the  
CMA system.  
Selected  
Endpoints  
The list of endpoints assigned to the room. The endpoint  
at the top of the list is the primary endpoint. You can  
change the order of endpoint priority by selecting an  
endpoint and clicking Move Up or Move Down.  
5
6
In the Dial String Reservations section, select the user’s Device and enter  
the appropriate dial strings for SIP URI, E164, and H323 ID, then click  
Apply.  
The dial strings appear in the list below.  
If the user has multiple endpoints, enter the dial strings for one endpoint  
type at a time and click Apply each time.  
Click OK.  
The room is added to the CMA system. Note that the system does not  
distinguish between enterprise rooms and local rooms once they’ve been  
added to the system.  
Add an Enterprise Room  
If your CMA system is integrated with an enterprise directory, you can add a  
room from the enterprise directory to the CMA system.  
To add an enterprise room  
1
2
Go to Admin > Rooms.  
On the Rooms list, click Add Room  
.
The Add New Room dialog box appears.  
Polycom, Inc.  
345  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
3
To find a room in the enterprise directory:  
a
In the Search Value field, type in the first few characters of the room  
name.  
The system does a prefix search of the appropriate fields.  
b
Click Search.  
A list of the enterprise users and rooms that meet the search criteria  
appears. If the search found more than 500 matching entries, only the  
first 500 are displayed.  
c
Select the room of interest and click Define Details.  
4
5
Complete the General Info, Associated Devices, and Dial String  
Reservations sections of the Add New Room dialog box. For information  
on these fields, see “Add a Local Room” on page 344.  
Click OK.  
The room is added to the CMA system. Note that the system does not  
distinguish between enterprise rooms and local rooms once they’ve been  
added to the system.  
Edit a Room  
To edit a room  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Rooms.  
In the Rooms list, select the room of interest and click Edit  
.
Edit the General Info, Associated Devices, and Dial String Reservations  
sections of the Edit Room dialog box. For information on these fields, see  
4
Click OK.  
Delete a Room  
To delete a room  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Rooms  
.
In the Rooms list, select the room of interest and click Delete.  
In the Delete Room dialog box, click Yes.  
The room is deleted from the CMA system.  
346  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
25  
Area Overview and Operations  
This chapter describes how to set up areas in the Polycom® Converged  
Management Application™ (CMA®) system. It includes these topics:  
Areas Overview  
Because the CMA system is a role-based system, users see only the pages and  
functions available to their roles and the permissions assigned to their user  
roles. However, users can perform those functions on any endpoint or  
network device defined to the system unless the Areas feature is implemented.  
By implementing areas, the CMA system administrator with System Setup  
permissions can limit access to endpoints and network devices to a specific set  
of administrators, operators, and schedulers.  
How Areas Work  
Areas add another dimension of permissions to scheduling, monitoring, and  
administration of endpoints and network devices. Besides the permissions  
enabled and disabled by roles and groups, the system now has a set of  
permissions enabled and disabled by areas.  
Polycom, Inc.  
347  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Areas also limit access to directory entries. For example, a user associated with  
Area1 will not see a user associated with Area2 in the directory. However, the  
Area1 user can call the Area2 user with the correct H.323 address.  
To implement areas, complete the following tasks  
1
As a best practice, create an Area Administrator role. Assign that role to  
the people you want to administer devices in areas but not the CMA  
system itself.  
2
A CMA system user with System Setup permissions can configure areas.  
When configuring areas, you can also change the term (both singular and  
plural) used to describe areas. For example, if you plan to limit users’  
access to devices based on their department, you may want to label this  
function Departments. If you plan to limit users’ access to devices based  
on their line of business, you may want to label this function Line of  
Business.  
3
4
A CMA system user with System Setup permissions can add areas.  
Adding areas includes naming the area, assigning devices to the area, and  
associating users with the area.  
A CMA system user with Associate Devices to Areas permissions can  
assign an area when adding or editing an endpoint or network device. To  
assign multiple devices to an area, you can use the Assign Area action on  
the Monitor View page. A device can only be assigned to one area. Only  
administrators associated with All Areas can assign a device with no area  
assignment to an area.  
5
A CMA system user with Assign CMA Users to Areas permissions can  
associate users with one or more areas when adding or editing users. To  
associate multiple users with areas, you can use the Assign Areas action  
on the User > Users page. Users can be associated with multiple areas.  
Note that only users that have a CMA system role can be associated with  
areas.  
Area Best Practices  
Plan your area strategy with the following in mind:  
After you start assigning endpoints to areas, you must associate users with  
areas. The setting of None does not let users see endpoints assigned to an  
area.  
348  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Area Overview and Operations  
Endpoints and network devices can be assigned to only one area.  
Users can be associated with more than one area.  
Schedulers can only schedule endpoints assigned to the same area the  
scheduler is associated with.  
If you set up areas to correspond to sites, you must also set up site links  
between each site to permit calls between sites.  
View Areas  
You can view the list of existing areas from Admin > Areas. The following  
information is available.  
Field  
Description  
Areas list  
Name  
Meaningful name for the area.  
Description of the area.  
Description  
Associated Devices  
Members  
Summary  
Name  
Number of devices assigned to the area.  
Number of users assigned to the area.  
Name of the selected area.  
Description  
Members  
User ID  
Description of the selected area.  
List of users associated with the selected area  
Member’s CMA system user ID.  
Member’s first name.  
First Name  
Last Name  
Member’s last name.  
List of endpoints and network devices assigned to the  
selected area.  
Associated Devices  
Device ID  
Device ID of the associated device.  
Device name of the associated device.  
Site of the associated device.  
Device Name  
Site  
You may not see all areas that exist in the system. Only administrators that are  
associated with All Areas can see all the of areas in the system.  
Polycom, Inc.  
349  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Create Area Administrator Role  
As a best practice, create an area administrator role to separate CMA system  
administration from area administration.  
To create an area administrator role  
1
2
3
Go to User > User Roles.  
On the User Roles page, click Add.  
Complete the Name and Description fields of the Add Role dialog box  
and assign the desired permissions to the new role. At a minimum, add  
Associate Devices to Area permission to this role.  
4
Click Save.  
The new user role appears in the CMA system.  
Enable, Configure, and Customize Areas  
Before you can use areas, you must enable areas for endpoints and network  
devices. You can also change the term Area used in the CMA system interface  
to fit your use of areas.  
To enable, configure, and customize the Areas function  
1
2
Go to Admin > Areas and on the Areas page click Configure Areas.  
In the Configure Areas dialog box, click Enable Areas for endpoints and  
network devices.  
3
(Optional) To use a different term for the Areas function that is more  
meaningful to your business, enter the Singular and Plural term in the  
appropriate field. For example, Agency or Department.  
Note  
This configuration change will not take place until you restart the CMA system.  
4
5
Click Save Configuration.  
If you changed the Area term, go to Admin > Dashboard and click  
Restart to restart the CMA system.  
After the system restarts, the Areas function will be renamed and enabled.  
By default, the CMA system maintains an All area, to which you, as the  
enabler of the function are assigned.  
350  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Area Overview and Operations  
Add Areas  
When you add areas, you can assign devices and users to the area.  
Note  
If the Areas option on your CMA system has been customized and renamed, the  
CMA system user interface will use that custom terminology.  
To add areas  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Go to Admin > Areas and click Add.  
In the Add an Area dialog box, enter the Area Name and Description.  
To associate devices with the area, click Associate Devices.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the device list.  
Select the devices to be assign to the area and click the right arrow.  
To assign users to the area, click Assign Area Members.  
In the Search Users field, enter the name for the user of interest and press  
Enter.  
Note  
Searches for a user are case-insensitive, prefix searches of the Username, First  
Name, and Last Name fields.  
8
9
Select the users to assign to the area and click the right arrow.  
When complete, click OK.  
Assign Devices to Areas  
You can assign one or more unassociated devices to an existing area. Devices  
can only be associated with one area.  
Notes  
After you assign devices with an area, only users associated with the same area  
or to All Areas can see the devices in the CMA system.  
The user setting of None does not let users see endpoints assigned to an area.  
To assign devices to areas  
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View or Network Device > Monitor View.  
1
Polycom, Inc.  
351  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
2
Click Associate Area.  
The Assign Area to Endpoints or Assign Area to Network Devices dialog  
box appears with a list of endpoints or network devices.  
3
4
5
Select the devices to assign to an area.  
From the Assign Area drop-down, select the area to assign.  
Click Assign Area.  
Associate Users with Areas  
You can associate one or more users with an existing area. A user can be  
assigned to as many areas as needed.  
Note  
After you associate users with an area, they can only see devices assigned to the  
same area in the CMA system.  
To associate users with areas  
1
2
Go to Admin > Areas and click Manage Members.  
In the Manage Area Members dialog box, enter the name for the user of  
interest in the Search Users field and press Enter.  
Note  
Searches for a user are case-insensitive, prefix searches of the Username, First  
Name, and Last Name fields.  
3
4
5
Select the users to assign to an area and click the right arrow.  
Click Assign Areas.  
Select one of the following options and click the right arrow.  
— All Areas—Gives the users access to all devices, regardless of the area  
the devices are assigned to.  
— Specific Areas—Give the users access to only devices assigned to the  
areas selected below. Select one or more areas in the list below.  
6
Click OK.  
352  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Area Overview and Operations  
Change Area Association for Users  
To remove area associations from users  
1
2
Go to Admin > Areas and click Manage Members.  
In the Manage Members dialog box, enter the name for the user of  
interest in the Search Users field and press Enter.  
Note  
Searches for a user are case-insensitive, prefix searches of the Username, First  
Name, and Last Name fields.  
3
4
5
6
Select the user of interest and click the right arrow.  
Click Unassign Areas.  
Select the areas to unassign and click the right arrow.  
Click OK.  
Delete an Area  
You can only delete areas that are not associated with devices or assigned  
members.  
To delete an Area from the the Polycom CMA System  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Areas and on the Areas page select the area of interest.  
Click Edit  
.
Click Associate Devices and move any devices out of the Selected  
Devices list.  
4
Click Assign Area Members and move any devices out of the Selected  
Area Members list.  
5
6
7
Click OK.  
When the Areas page reappears, click Delete.  
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
Polycom, Inc.  
353  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
354  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
26  
Directory Operations  
This chapter describes the Polycom® Converged Management Application™  
(CMA®) enterprise directory integration and operations. It includes these  
topics:  
Directory Management Overview  
In a large organization, integrating your CMA system with Microsoft Active  
Directory greatly simplifies the task of managing conference system security.  
Directory management provides the following features.  
Single sign-on capability. Users get the benefits of pass-through  
authentication, allowing them to leverage their Active Directory user  
name and password to login to the Polycom CMA Desktop system. This  
happens without the user having to enter their credentials, creating  
seamless integration for logins.  
Single management environment. After the initial setup of the CMA  
system, adding groups into CMA system is no more complex than adding  
a group to a file share or database. Continue to manage your group  
memberships through Active Directory, then grant those groups rights  
within the CMA system.  
Allows you to continue leveraging the existing role-based security model  
that you have in place, though the CMA system only uses Universal  
groups.  
Polycom, Inc.  
355  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Directory Management Supported Configurations  
There are many possible configurations available within Microsoft Active  
Directory, some of which are not fully supported by the CMA system. This  
section describes the implications of different Microsoft Active Directory  
configurations for integrating with the CMA system.  
Multiple Forests  
Microsoft Active Directory may be set up in either a single-forest or  
multi-forest configuration. However, the CMA system requires that user  
accounts reside in a single forest.  
Multiple Domains  
Microsoft Active Directory forests may contain one or more domains. In either  
configuration, the directory must have a Global Catalog service. The CMA  
system can integrate to either single or multiple domains, so long as they  
reside in the same forest structure.  
Microsoft Active Directory domains are organized into trees, each tree being a  
group of domains which share a consistent DNS namespace (ex: polycom.com  
and na.polycom.com would be in the same tree, while polycom.com and  
CMADevelopment.net would be separate trees, if they were in the same  
forest). The CMA system will integrate to all domains in a multi-tree forest.  
Viable options:  
1
2
Integrate to all domains of a multi-domain forest configuration.  
Restrict to a single domain tree in a multi-domain forest through the use  
of LDAP Search baseDN criteria.  
Groups  
Microsoft Active Directory provides three group scopes: Universal, Global,  
and Domain Local. Both Global groups and Universal Groups are held on all  
Global Catalog servers in the forest. The CMA system supports only the  
Universal groups.  
Microsoft Active Directory provides two group types: Security and  
Distribution. The CMA system supports either of these group types.  
356  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Directory Operations  
Note  
An Active Directory forest with a functional level of Windows 2000 Mixed mode only  
supports Universal Distribution groups. Windows 2000 Native mode, Windows  
2003 Mixed, and Windows 2003 forest functional levels support Universal Security  
and Distribution groups.  
In addition to leveraging Active Directory Universal groups, the CMA system  
also has Local groups, which you can use to grant a standard set of rights to  
multiple users or groups. These CMA system Local groups can have as  
members, CMA system Local users, Active Directory users or Active Directory  
Universal groups. In this fashion, you can nest a variety of users and groups  
into a CMA system Local group and assign those users rights through their  
CMA system Local group membership, simplifying management of rights on  
the CMA system.  
Users  
The CMA system supports both local and enterprise user accounts. Local user  
accounts exist entirely on the CMA system. They can be created and managed  
whether or not the system is integrated to an enterprise directory. Enterprise  
user accounts exist in your enterprise Active Directory. The CMA system  
cannot create or manage Active Directory accounts, except to modify their  
privileges on the CMA system itself.  
If simultaneously using local and enterprise accounts, it is important to avoid  
duplication of account data. For example, if your Active Directory has a user  
named John Doe with a username of jdoe, a local account for this user must  
possess a unique name, such as localjdoe or johndoetest. If duplicate user  
accounts exist in the same domain or across domains, the user associated with  
these accounts will not be able to log into a dynamically-managed endpoint.  
The CMA system accesses the enterprise directory in a read-only mode. It does  
not create, modify, or delete Active Directory users or groups in any way.  
Once you integrate with an enterprise directory, it's best to minimize your  
dependency on local users. A single local administrative user account must  
exist, and it should be used only when there is a problem connecting to the  
enterprise directory.  
This configuration provides flexibility and varying security levels as follows:  
Restricted access: For security reasons, local user accounts do not have  
access to any data in Active Directory, though they can see the Active  
Directory users and groups as defined in the CMA system's security.  
Administration: Active Directory users and their Active Directory group  
memberships are managed through your Active Directory. CMA system  
local users are managed through the CMA system's web interface.  
Polycom, Inc.  
357  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Security: Local accounts have their own passwords, which are stored on  
the CMA system. Active Directory user accounts maintain the same users'  
Active Directory credentials and password complexity policies, which are  
validated by the domain controllers.  
How Global Catalog Searches Work  
When you integrate the CMA system with Active Directory, you can configure  
it to integrate in one of two ways:  
It can access a specific global catalog server by host name or IP address  
(not recommended, due to a lack of redundancy).  
If you select this option, the domain name that you specify for the CMA  
system must match the DNS name suffix of the Global Catalog server  
(example: dc1.polycom.com configured as the Global Catalog, then you  
must enter polycom.com as the domain name of the CMA system server).  
It can auto-discover the server by querying the DNS for the closest Global  
Catalog server (strongly recommended).  
If you select this option, you can specify any domain in the Active  
Directory forest in the Domain Name criteria for the CMA system server.  
The DNS server must contain Active Directory-specific entries.  
It is recommended that you enter the forest root DNS domain name.  
When configured to auto-discover the server, every time the CMA system  
needs to bind to a Global Catalog server for LDAP queries, the CMA system  
performs the following.  
Uses Microsoft's LDAP Ping mechanism to determine the site in which the  
system is located.  
Uses a DNS SRV record query to find a Global Catalog server within the  
same site.  
Connects to the Global Catalog on the domain controller and queries for  
the object in question and any relevant information (such as GUID, userID,  
name, phone number).  
You can secure the connection between the CMA system and the Active  
Directory server's Global Catalog using LDAP-S (via outbound TCP/UDP  
port 3269) or Start TLS (via outbound 3268 TCP/UDP). To implement the  
secure connection, the appropriate ports must be open on any network  
equipment between the Global Catalog and the CMA system.  
358  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Directory Operations  
Accounts Required for the CMA System  
CMA System Service Account  
Before integrating the CMA system with an Active Directory forest, you must  
create a service account for it in Active Directory. This service account is a  
read-only user account that the CMA system uses to perform LDAP queries  
against your Active Directory Global Catalog.  
CMA System Computer Account  
The CMA system requires a computer account to enable secure channel  
communications with the Active Directory forest that is being leveraged for  
authentication. This account must be pre-created and the password set by an  
administrator from a Domain Controller.  
Note  
When setting up a redundant CMA system, the redundant servers use the same  
computer account to create their secure channel connection. The computer  
account name does not have to match the host name of your CMA system server.  
Understanding Base DN  
When the CMA system is integrated with an enterprise directory, the system  
uses the baseDN to determine domains and manage directory searches.  
The Base DN field is where you specify the distinguished name (DN) of a subset  
of the Active Directory hierarchy (a domain, subset of domains, or  
organizational unit) to which you want to restrict the CMA system search. It  
acts like a filter.  
By default, the Base DN field is empty. The first time you tell the system to  
connect to the enterprise directory server, leave the Base DN field empty.  
Once you have established a working connection with your Active Directory,  
then you enter a Base DN.  
The following table illustrates some basic examples of Base DN filter  
expressions.  
Search baseDN expression  
Description  
(ou=CMAGroups,dc=example,dc=com)  
Include only groups and users which  
reside within the CMAGroups OU in the  
example.com domain.  
(dc=example,dc=com)  
Include only groups and users which  
reside within the example.com domain  
or domain tree.  
Polycom, Inc.  
359  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Expressions in the Base DN and exclusion filter fields must be formatted  
according to RFC-4514, section 2.4.  
Some special characters are allowed in the BaseDN field. They include:  
Character  
“ % ”  
“ ”  
Character Name  
Percent  
Space  
“ " ”  
Double quote  
Question mark  
Open brace  
Close brace  
Caret  
“ ? ”  
{ ”  
} ”  
“ ^ ”  
“ ~ ”  
“ [ ”  
Tilde  
Open bracket  
Close bracket  
Single quote  
Ampersand  
Pipe or bar  
“ ] ”  
“ ‘ ”  
“ & ”  
“ | ”  
The special characters that are not allowed in the Base DN field without the  
special escape character (backslash, \) are:  
Character  
“ \ ”  
Character Name  
Backslash  
Equal  
“ = ”  
“ , ”  
Comma  
“ # ”  
“ + ”  
“ ; ”  
Pound  
Plus  
Semicolon  
Less than  
Greater than  
“ < ”  
“ > ”  
360  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Directory Operations  
Therefore, to use these character as part of a name, they must be preceded in  
the Base DN field by a backslash. For example, the baseDN of an ou named  
"
tom,ann,bob" in the "myteam.example.com" domain must be entered as:  
ou=tom\,ann\,bob\ dc=my team,dc=example,dc=com  
Or the baseDN of an ou named "#+,=<>\ " in the "mydomain.example.com"  
domain must be entered as  
ou=\#\+\,\=\<\>\\\ ,dc=mydomain,dc=example,dc=com  
Note that this applies only to attribute values, not the ou=or dc=structure.  
Understanding Exclusion Filters  
Using LDAP exclusion filters, you can exclude objects in your directory based  
on a wide variety of criteria within your Active Directory environment. Any  
LDAP filters that you create must follow the LDAP standard and reference the  
LDAP display name of the attributes against which you are filtering.  
The following table illustrates some basic examples of exclusion filter  
expressions.  
Search baseDN expression  
Description  
Memberof=cn=Restricted Group,OU=users,dc=example,dc=com Excludes all users who are members of  
"Restricted Group" within the Users OU in the  
example.com domain.  
!(Memberof=cn=Video Users,OU=Users,dc=example,dc=com)  
Includes only groups and users within the  
Video Users group in the Users OU in the  
example.com domain.  
Creating exclusion filters can impact the performance of your LDAP queries.  
As a best practice, use indexed attributes and do not use medial searches when  
implementing exclusion filters. For more information, see Creating More  
Polycom, Inc.  
361  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
The following table illustrates some more advanced examples of exclusion  
filter expressions.  
Search baseDN expression  
Description  
!(| (memberof=CN=Sales,DC=europe,DC=example,DC=com)  
(memberof=CN=IT,DC=europe,DC=example,DC=com))  
Includes only users that are members of the  
‘Sales’ or ‘IT’ Groups in the domain  
europe.example.com.  
Notes:  
The expression should be in continuous  
line with no carriage returns or extra  
spaces (not possible in this document’s  
format).  
By excluding an entity, we implicitly mean  
to include all other entities. Conversely, by  
including an entity, we are implicitly  
excluding all other entities. Hence, this  
exclusion filter will suffice for a case where,  
for example, the administrator wants to  
include Sales and IT but exclude Human  
Resources, Engineering, etc., within the  
specified domain.  
&(objectCategory=person)(objectClass=user)(userAccountContr  
ol:1.2.840.113556.1.4.803:=2)  
Excludes all users who are disabled. Note this  
is using a different but valid notation.  
Polycom CMA System and Windows Authentication  
To allow Microsoft Active Directory users with dynamically-managed  
endpoints to securely log into their endpoint without typing in their network  
credentials, the CMA system must be integrated with an Active Directory  
server and trusted by Active Directory.  
When the CMA system starts up, it performs the following actions.  
Uses Microsoft's LDAP ping mechanism to determine the site in which the  
system is located.  
Uses a DNS SRV record query to find a domain controller within the same  
site.  
When an Active Directory user attempts to log into the CMA system, it  
authenticates the user by connecting to the domain controller that it is  
connected to and passes the user's credentials using NTLMv2. The credentials  
are seamlessly passed to the CMA system utilizing a secure channel  
connection from the user's workstation, using the credentials with which they  
logged into the workstation.  
362  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Directory Operations  
Note  
Because the CMA system uses NTLMv2, the password is not stored within and the  
CMA system never receives the user's password.  
Some important notes about the CMA system Active Directory integration:  
The CMA system is not joined to the domain. Other computers on the  
network cannot browse its file system and it cannot be managed remotely  
by existing IT mechanisms such as SMS.  
The CMA system does not modify the Active Directory in any way.  
The CMA system can auto-discover the closest logical domain controller  
and Active Directory servers, but to do this the network DNS server must  
have a DNS SRV record for these servers. Once the domain controller’s  
hostname and IP address have a record on the DNS, the CMA system can  
auto-discover the IP address of the domain controller. If your Active  
Directory does not publish the domain controller’s hostname and IP  
address to the network DNS, you must edit the file to include it.  
The CMA system requires that you enable Digitally sign  
communications on the Active Directory server.  
Directory Management Operations  
This section describes the directory management operations. It includes these  
topics:  
Integrate with Enterprise Directory Server Option  
The process of integrating with an enterprise directory server, involves these  
steps:  
Enabling the Integrate with Enterprise Directory Server option allows CMA  
system users who are included in the Active Directory to log into the CMA  
system interface using their network credentials.  
Polycom, Inc.  
363  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Enabling the Integrate with Enterprise Directory Server option also allows  
endpoint users to select conference participants and rooms from the enterprise  
directory. Because endpoint connections to LDAP use the endpoint user’s  
credentials, the Active Directory access control lists identify which endpoint  
users and rooms each user can see.  
Note  
The CMA system supports only the Microsoft Active Directory for its enterprise  
directory.  
In addition, administrative users can:  
View some enterprise user and group information  
Import enterprise groups into the CMA system  
Assign roles to users in different enterprise groups  
Identify enterprise resources, such as rooms, so that they can be treated as  
resources in the CMA system  
Note  
To allow endpoint users to use NTLM Single Sign On technology to connect to the  
CMA system and access services such as automatic provisioning, automatic  
software update, and presence, see “Allow Delegated Authentication to Enterprise  
For more information about Active Directory and LDAP, see MS Strategy for  
Create the Polycom CMA System Service Account  
To create the CMA system service account  
1
On the Active Directory server, open the Active Directory Users and  
Computers module (Start > Programs > Administrative Tools > Active  
Directory Users and Computers).  
2
3
Click the node for your domain and then right-click the OU folder in  
which you want to add a user account and select New > User.  
At a minimum, in the First name, Full name, and User logon name  
fields, type cmaserviceor an appropriate name for your environment  
and click Next.  
4
In the Password and Confirm Password fields, type a password for the  
service account to use during initial integration. This is the password you  
must enter on the CMA system Enterprise Server page.  
364  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Directory Operations  
5
Select the Password never expires option, unselect the User cannot  
change password option, click Next and then Finish.  
Notes  
You can reset the password for this account manually, but to do so you must  
change it in Active Directory first and then update the CMA system LDAP Server  
page.  
The service account requires the rights to read all properties on all users and  
groups that will be used in the CMA system. Without these permissions, it may  
not function properly.  
Create the Polycom CMA System Computer Account  
To create the CMA System computer account  
1
On the Microsoft Active Directory system, open the Active Directory  
Users and Computers module (Start > Programs > Administrative Tools  
> Active Directory Users and Computers.  
2
3
Select the node for your domain, right-click the OU folder in which to  
add the computer account and then select New > Computer.  
In the Computer name field, type PolycomCMAor an appropriate name  
for your environment and then click Next and Finish (or simply click OK  
depending on your version of Active Directory).  
4
Ensure that the Active Directory Users and Computers console will  
show all available computer options necessary for the remaining steps by  
enabling View > Advanced Features.  
5
6
7
8
Right-click the computer account, select Properties, and then select the  
Security tab.  
In the Group or user names section of the Security tab, select the SELF  
object.  
In the Permissions for SELF section, select Change password, and then  
click OK.  
Login to the domain controller where the computer account was created  
and set the password using the following command:  
net user <computername>$ <password>  
For example: net user polycomcma$ p@ssw0rd  
Polycom, Inc.  
365  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Notes  
Performing the net user command on any machine other than a domain  
controller will not assign the computer account password for the CMA system  
computer account.  
At initial integration, the CMA System will change its Computer Account  
password to a random 120 character string including special characters. This  
password will also be changed, to a new randomly generated password, every  
time the CMA System is rebooted, or every week if no reboots are performed.  
Because this is a Computer account, resetting the password to a known value  
requires use of net user commands on an Active Directory Domain Controller.  
Enable Integration with the Enterprise Directory Server  
To integrate the CMA system to an enterprise directory server  
1
2
Go to Admin > Directories > Enterprise Directory.  
On the Enterprise Directory page, select Integrate with Enterprise  
Directory Server.  
3
4
To have the system auto-discover the server by querying DNS, enable  
Auto-discover in the Enterprise Directory Server DNS Name section;  
otherwise, enter the DNS Name for the enterprise directory server.  
As needed, configure these settings.  
Setting  
Description  
Domain\Enterprise  
Directory User ID  
Domain and Enterprise Directory User ID for an  
account that the CMA system can use to access the  
enterprise directory server and retrieve group, user,  
and room information. This is the account created  
This User ID must have read permissions so it can  
search the entire forest on the enterprise directory  
server.  
This User ID is automatically associated with the  
CMA system administrator role - by default it is the  
ONLY enterprise directory User ID with this role.  
Enterprise Directory  
User Password  
The password for the enterprise directory user  
account  
366  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Directory Operations  
Setting  
Description  
Security Level  
The level of security on the connection between the  
CMA system and the enterprise directory server.  
Possible values include:  
Plain—No security on the connection  
LDAPS—The connection is secured over  
outbound port 3269 using LDAP-S in a manner  
similar to https  
.
If the “Domain Controller: LDAP Server signing  
requirements” setting on the Active Directory  
server is set to “Require Signing”, then you must  
use LDAPS to secure the connection.  
StartTLS—The connection is secured over  
outbound port 3268 (the same port as Plain), but  
it then negotiates security once the socket is  
opened. Some LDAP servers reject any  
unsecured transactions, so the first command is  
the StartTLSnegotiation command.  
Ignore Disabled  
Enterprise Directory  
Users  
Check this field to have the CMA system ignore  
disabled enterprise users in its queries.  
Enterprise Directory  
Exclusion Filter  
If necessary and you understand the filter syntax,  
specify other types of user accounts to exclude.  
Don’t edit these expressions unless you understand  
LDAP filter syntax.  
For more information, see “Understanding Exclusion  
Enterprise Directory  
Search BaseDN  
If necessary and you understand the filter syntax,  
specify the top level of the enterprise directory tree  
(referred to as the base DN) to search. Don’t edit  
these expressions unless you understand the filter  
syntax.  
For more information, see “Understanding Base DN”  
5
If you also wish to implement single sign-on, see the following section  
Otherwise, click Update.  
Allow Delegated Authentication to Enterprise Directory Server  
The CMA system Use Single Sign on (Integrated Windows Authentication)  
option, allows endpoint users who are included in the enterprise directory to  
securely log into their dynamically-managed endpoint without typing in  
credentials.  
Polycom, Inc.  
367  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Note  
To allow CMA system users who enter their network usernames and passwords to  
log into the CMA system and select conference participants from your company’s  
To delegate authentication to the enterprise directory server  
1
2
Go to Admin > Directories > Enterprise Directory.  
On the Enterprise Directory page, select Allow delegated authentication  
to enterprise directory server.  
3
To have the system auto-discover the closest logical domain controller  
and enterprise directory servers, in the Domain controller name section  
enable Auto-discover; otherwise, enter the fully qualified hostname of  
the domain controller (for example, dc1.mydomain.com).  
Note  
To auto discover the domain controller and enterprise directory server, the network  
DNS server must have a DNS SRV record for these servers.  
4
Enter the Username (domain\<computer name>) and Password and click  
Update.  
Remove or Include Dynamically-Managed Endpoints in the Global Address  
Book  
By default the CMA system includes dynamically-managed endpoints in the  
Global Address Book. However, you may not want to take advantage of this  
feature if you have legacy endpoints such as VSX, ViewStation, and FX  
endpoints. These endpoints may not be able to handle the increased size of the  
Global Address Book.  
To remove enterprise users from the CMA system Global Address Book  
1
2
Go to Admin > Directories > Directory Setup.  
In the Directory page, clear Include dynamically-managed devices in  
the Global Address Book.  
3
Click Update.  
To include enterprise users in the CMA system Global Address Book  
Go to Admin > Directories > Directory Setup.  
1
368  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Directory Operations  
2
3
In the Directory page, select Include dynamically-managed devices in  
the Global Address Book.  
Click Update.  
Remove or Include Guest Book Entries in the Directory  
By default the CMA system includes Guest Book entries in the endpoint  
directory, regardless of whether the endpoint directory is the Global Address  
Book or the enterprise directory.  
To remove Guest Book entries from the endpoint directory  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Directories > Directory Setup.  
In the Directory page, clear Show Guest Book entries in the Directory.  
Click Update.  
To include Guest Book entries in the endpoint directory  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Directories > Directory Setup.  
In the Directory page, select Show Guest Book entries in the Directory.  
Click Update.  
Support LifeSize Endpoints in Directories  
You can include LifeSize endpoints in the endpoint directory by configuring  
your directory setup. When you do this, you also need to ensure that your  
LifeSize endpoint is configured to use the correct LDAP settings.  
Complete the following steps:  
Modify Directory Listings  
You need to allow your directory listings to include support for LifeSize  
endpoints.  
To modify directory listings for LifeSize endpoint support  
1
2
Go to Admin > Directories > Directory Setup.  
In the Directory Setup page, mark the Modify directory listings for  
LifeSize endpoint support check box.  
Polycom, Inc.  
369  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
3
Click Update.  
Configure LDAP Settings  
In addition to configuring directory listing support in the directory set up, you  
need to also ensure that the LifeSize endpoint is configured to use the  
RealPresence CMA system’s LDAP settings. You can provision these through  
a scheduled provisioning profile or configure them manually on the endpoint.  
To add LDAP settings to a scheduled provisioning profile  
1
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Scheduled Provisioning  
Profiles.  
2
3
In the Scheduled Provisioning Profiles page, click Add.  
In the Add Profile dialog box, select the Endpoint Type for the  
provisioning profile, enter a name for the profile, and click Next.  
4
As needed, complete the various settings that you would like to provision  
for your LifeSize endpoint.  
For more information about these fields, see “Scheduled Provisioning of  
5
6
For Directory support, select the Directory > LDAP page.  
On the Directory > LDAP page:  
a
b
Mark the Provision This Page check box.  
In the LDAP field, select Enabled from the drop-down list.  
»
»
In the LDAP Username field, enter uid=ldapgab,ou=system  
In the LDAP Password field, enter the password for the Polycom  
Global Address Book if you have one. If not, leave this field blank.  
»
In the LDAP Base field, enter DC=Polycom,dc=com  
7
Click OK.  
If you manually enter the LDAP settings on the LifeSize endpoint, the value for  
the LDAP Base field needs to be the following:  
OU=Endpoints,DC=Polycom,dc=com  
.
370  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
27  
Directory Setup Operations  
This chapter describes how to manage the Global Address Book in the  
Polycom® Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system. It  
includes these topics:  
View the Global Address Book  
The Polycom Global Address Book is a system managed endpoint directory  
that allows users with video endpoints to look up and call other users with  
video endpoints in their video communications network.  
From a video endpoint system, users can locate other user’s endpoints by  
name in the Global Address Book and initiate a call without knowledge of the  
other user’s equipment. The CMA system will filter incompatible endpoints  
out of the Global Address Book (GAB) results so that the GAB presented to  
H.323-only endpoints will not include ISDN-only endpoints and the GAB  
presented to ISDN-only endpoints will not include H.323-only endpoints.  
Note  
GAB filtering applies only to Polycom endpoints. The GAB is not filtered on  
third-party endpoints.  
For more information on the Global Address Book, see “Endpoint Directory  
To view the Global Address Book  
1
2
Go to Admin > Directories > Global Address Book.  
As needed, use the Filter to customize the Global Address Book. It can  
be filtered by Endpoint Name or IP Address.  
Polycom, Inc.  
371  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
The user information found in the Global Address Book includes:  
Column  
Description  
Owner  
The associated user or resource ID.  
The name of the registered endpoint.  
Name  
GAB Display Name  
The name of the registered endpoint as it will be  
displayed to other endpoint users. This display name  
is an ASCII only field.  
Type  
The type of endpoint.  
IP Address  
Phone Number  
Alias  
The IP address of the endpoint.  
The phone number of the endpoint.  
The alias associated with the endpoint.  
Set or Change the GAB Password  
You can require that endpoints be provisioned with a password in order to  
access the Global Address Book on the CMA system. To do so, set a Global  
Address Book password as described here. Use the same procedure to change  
the Global Address Book password.  
Note that even if the Global Address Book is password protected, some  
third-party endpoints may not be required to provide a password because  
they are not directory-password aware. They have unrestricted access to the  
Global Address Book.  
To provision this password to endpoints, see “Add a Scheduled Provisioning  
To set or change the password for the Global Address Book  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Directories > Global Address Book.  
In the Global Address Book, click Set GAB Password  
.
In the Set Client Password dialog box, enter the Old Password and the  
New Password. (Note that the password fields are ASCII only.)  
4
Confirm the new password and click Save.  
Once you set this password, endpoints that are not provisioned with this  
password cannot access the Global Address Book on the CMA system.  
372  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
28  
Multiple Address Books  
This chapter describes how to set up multiple address books in the Polycom®  
Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system. It includes these  
topics:  
Multiple Address Books Overview  
Users assigned the Administrator role can create multiple address books in  
the CMA system. Multiple address books are subsets of the Global Address  
Book (GAB) and let you manage which users (local and enterprise), endpoints,  
rooms, groups, and guests appear in each address book.  
Multiple address books support both the GAB and LDAP protocols. Endpoints  
requesting directory information using either protocol receive either the  
default address book or the address book assigned to the user’s group.  
If you do not want to use multiple address books, you can leave the default  
address book set to All Entries. Using this default, all users will see all entries  
in the directory. Be sure that all groups are assigned either the System Default  
or All Entries option. System Default is the default group setting.  
Polycom, Inc.  
373  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Notes  
Multiple Address Book functionality works in Maximum Security Mode based  
upon LDAP only.  
An endpoint must be associated with a User and the User must be in a Group  
in order to specify an address book.  
How Multiple Address Books Work  
Use address books to limit access to people and endpoints. For example, you  
can set up separate address books for each department in your organization.  
Each address book would include only CMA users in that department and  
only rooms in that department’s location.  
If the CMA system has the Areas feature enabled, you can only associate users  
and endpoints in the same Areas as you are in to address books.  
Users not assigned the Administrator role will not be aware of address books.  
They will see only those users (local and enterprise directory), endpoints,  
rooms, groups, and guests in the same address book that the user is assigned  
to.  
To implement multiple address books, complete the following tasks  
1
CMA system users assigned the Administrator role can create address  
books and associate users (local and enterprise directory), endpoints,  
rooms, groups, and guests with one or more address books. This process  
controls where each entity appears as an address book entry.  
2
3
CMA system users assigned the Administrator role can assign an address  
book to a group. A group can be assigned to only one address book. This  
process controls the address book that users and endpoints have access to.  
CMA system users assigned the Administrator role can set the priority of  
address books. The priority affects which address book a user has access  
to. For example, if a user is a member of two different groups and each  
group is assigned a different address book, the user can access the address  
book that is higher in priority.  
374  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Multiple Address Books  
View the Address Book List and Details  
To view the address book list and details  
1
Go to Admin > Directories > Address Books.  
The Address Book list appears, with details of the selected address book  
in the right pane.  
Column  
Description  
Priority  
The priority affects which address book a user sees. For  
example, if a user is a member of two different groups and  
each group is assigned a different address book, the user  
will see the address book that is higher in priority.  
Address Books  
Description  
Name of the address book.  
A brief description of the address book.  
2
In the Address Book Details in the right pane, expand the tree to view  
the tiers along with users, endpoints, rooms, groups, and guests  
associated with the address book.  
Add an Address Book  
You can add many address books to the CMA system, and each address book  
can have up to 100 tiers.  
Tiers are only meant to allow you to organize the address book contents. They  
will not be visible to endpoint users when they access the directory. Each tier  
can have up to three subtiers., and you can have address book entries at any  
tier level.  
Associating users, endpoints, rooms, groups, and guests with an address book  
controls where these entities appear. For example, if you associate user A with  
address book A, the user will appear as an entry in address book A. You can  
associate any of these entities with more than one address book, and the entity  
will appear as entry in each address book.  
Groups in the CMA system control the address book users, endpoints, and  
rooms have access to. To set which address book an entity has access to, see  
To add an address book  
1
2
Go to Admin > Directories > Address Books.  
Click Add.  
Polycom, Inc.  
375  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
3
Complete the fields in the Add an Address Book dialog box.  
Field  
Description  
Address Book Information  
Name  
A meaningful name to identify this address book.  
Description  
Address Book Tiers  
New Tier  
A brief description of the address book.  
Select where you want to add a tier and click to add a  
new tier to the address book.  
Edit Tier Name  
Delete  
Select a tier and click to change a tier name.  
Select a tier and click to delete a tier.  
4
To associate users with this address book, click Associate Users.  
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the users  
appear in.  
a
Search for the users you want to associate. Use the Filter to customize  
the list.  
b
c
Select the users you want and click Specify Tier.  
Select the tier you want for the users and click OK.  
5
To associate endpoints with this address book, click Associate  
Endpoints.  
Only endpoints that are not associated with a CMA system user appear in  
the list.  
a
Use the Filter to customize the list.  
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the  
endpoints appear in.  
b
c
Select the endpoints you want and click Specify Tier.  
Select the tier you want for the endpoints and click OK.  
6
To associate rooms with this address book, click Associate Rooms.  
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the rooms  
appear in.  
a
b
c
Use the Filter to customize the list.  
Select the rooms you want and click Specify Tier.  
Select the tier you want for the rooms and click OK.  
376  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Multiple Address Books  
7
8
9
To associate groups with this address book, click Associate Groups.  
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the groups  
appear in.  
a
b
c
Use the Filter to customize the list.  
Select the groups you want and click Specify Tier.  
Select the tier you want for the groups and click OK.  
To associate guests with this address book, click Associate Guests.  
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the guests  
appear in.  
a
b
c
Use the Filter to customize the list.  
Select the guests you want and click Specify Tier.  
Select the tier you want for the guests and click OK.  
Click OK.  
Edit an Address Book  
You can edit an address book to add or remove users, endpoints, rooms,  
groups, and guests.  
You can find any of these entities that are not currently associated with an  
address book by selecting Current Association from any Filter, then selecting  
Not Associated With An Address Book.  
If a group is set up with the Enterprise Directory Viewable option not  
selected, you can still add that group to an address book. The group itself will  
not appear as an entry in the address book, but the members of the group will.  
To edit an address book  
1
2
3
4
Go to Admin > Directories > Address Books.  
Select an address book.  
Click Edit.  
Edit the fields in the Edit an Address Book dialog box.  
Field  
Description  
Address Book Information  
Name  
A meaningful name to identify this address book.  
A brief description of the address book.  
Description  
Polycom, Inc.  
377  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
Address Book Tiers  
New Tier  
Select where you want to add a tier and click to add a new  
tier to the address book.  
Edit Tier Name  
Delete  
Select a tier and click to change a tier name.  
Select a tier and click to delete a tier.  
5
To associate users with this address book, click Associate Users.  
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the users  
appear in.  
a
Search for the users you want to associate. Use the Filter to customize  
the list.  
b
c
Select the users you want and click Specify Tier.  
Select the tier you want for the users and click OK.  
d
To delete a user from the address book, select the user and click  
Delete.  
The user is removed from the address book, but remains in the CMA  
system.  
6
To associate endpoints with this address book, click Associate  
Endpoints.  
Only endpoints that are not associated with a CMA system user appear in  
the list.  
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the  
endpoints appear in.  
a
b
c
Use the Filter to customize the list.  
Select the endpoints you want and click Specify Tier.  
Select the tier you want for the endpoints and click OK.  
d
To delete an endpoint from the address book, select the endpoint and  
click Delete.  
The endpoint is removed from the address book, but remains in the  
CMA system.  
7
To associate rooms with this address book, click Associate Rooms.  
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the rooms  
appear in.  
a
b
c
Use the Filter to customize the list.  
Select the rooms you want and click Specify Tier.  
Select the tier you want for the rooms and click OK.  
378  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Multiple Address Books  
d
To delete a room from the address book, select the room and click  
Delete.  
The room is removed from the address book, but remains in the CMA  
system.  
8
To associate groups with this address book, click Associate Groups.  
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the groups  
appear in.  
a
b
c
Use the Filter to customize the list.  
Select the groups you want and click Specify Tier.  
Select the tier you want for the groups and click OK.  
d
To delete a group from the address book, select the group and click  
Delete.  
The group is removed from the address book, but remains in the  
CMA system.  
9
To associate guests with this address book, click Associate Guests.  
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the guests  
appear in.  
a
b
c
Use the Filter to customize the list.  
Select the guests you want and click Specify Tier.  
Select the tier you want for the guests and click OK.  
d
To delete a guest from the address book, select the guest and click  
Delete.  
The guest is removed from the address book, but remains in the CMA  
system.  
10 Click OK.  
Assign Address Books to Groups  
You can assign an address book to a group, but you cannot assign address  
books directly to users. Group assignment controls to which address book  
users and endpoints have access. Each group can have just one address book  
assigned to it, but users can be in more than one group.  
Address book priority affects which address book users and endpoints can  
access. For example, if a user is a member of two different groups and each  
group is assigned a different address book, the user will see the address book  
that is higher in priority. To change priority, see “Change Address Book  
Polycom, Inc.  
379  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
To assign an address book to a group  
1
2
3
Go to User > Groups.  
Select the group you want to assign.  
In the Edit Local Group dialog box, select address book you want from  
the Assign Address Book drop-down list.  
4
Click OK.  
Viewing the Address Book a User is Assigned To  
You can see which address book a user is assigned to. The address book  
assignment controls the address book entries a user or endpoint can access.  
To view the address book a user is assigned to  
1
2
3
4
5
Go to User > Users.  
Select the user you want.  
Click View Details.  
In the View User dialog box, click Inherited Group Info.  
Click OK.  
Delete an Address Book  
You can delete an address book when it is no longer needed. Deleting an  
address book does not delete the users, endpoints, rooms, groups, or guests  
that were in the address from the CMA system.  
Any entity that was assigned the deleted address book will have access to one  
of the following:  
Another address book if the entity is a member of another group that is  
assigned to an existing address book.  
The default address book.  
To delete an address book  
1
2
Go to Admin > Directories > Address Books.  
Select the address book you want to delete.  
380  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Multiple Address Books  
3
4
Click Delete.  
A confirmation message appears.  
Click Yes.  
Change Address Book Priority  
You can change the priority of address books. The priority determines which  
address book a user sees. For example, if a user is a member of two different  
groups and each group is associated with a different address book, the user  
will see the address book that is higher in priority.  
The All Entries address book always has the highest priority and None always  
has the lowest priority. If the address book for one of the groups the user  
belongs to is changed to All Entries, the user will see all entries regardless of  
the priority of the address book for the other group.  
To change address book priority  
1
2
Go to Admin > Directories > Address Books.  
In the Priority column of an address book, enter the priority you want.  
Use only whole numbers and only numbers that fall within the total count  
of address books. For example, if you have four address books, only 1  
through 4 are valid priority values.  
3
Click Update Priority.  
The system changes the order of the address book list.  
Set the Default Address Book  
You can set the default address book. The default address book sets the  
address book all new users have access to if no address book is assigned  
through a group.  
If you do not want to use multiple address books in the CMA system, leave the  
default address book set to All Entries (the default). Using this default, all  
users will be able to see all entries in the directory. Be sure that all groups are  
assigned either the System Default or All Entries option. System Default is  
the default group setting.  
If you create multiple address books, you can change the default address book  
to one of the address books you created.  
Polycom, Inc.  
381  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
To set the default address book  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Directories > Address Books.  
Click Set Default.  
In the Default Address Book dialog box, select the option you want:  
— All Entries—Default setting. All users, endpoints, groups, rooms, and  
guests are in one address book and all have access to all address book  
entries.  
— None— No directory entries will be available.  
— Specify—Select the address book you want as the default.  
Click OK.  
4
Copy an Address Book  
You can copy an existing address book as a shortcut to creating a new address  
book. The copy process can copy the entire address book or just the tier  
structure.  
To copy an address book  
1
2
3
4
Go to Admin > Directories > Address Books.  
Select the address book you want to copy.  
Click Copy.  
In the Copy AddressBook dialog box, select the option you want:  
— Entire AddressBook—This option copies all of the tiers and the users,  
endpoints, rooms, groups, and guests that are associated with the  
address book to the new address book.  
— Tiers only—This option copies only the tier structure to the new  
address book.  
5
6
Enter a meaningful Name and Description.  
Click OK.  
You can now edit the new address book to add or delete entries.  
382  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
29  
Polycom CMA System Setup  
Overview  
This chapter provides an overview of the Polycom® Converged Management  
Application™ (CMA®) System Setup menu. It includes these topics:  
Server Settings  
Most of the selections in the Server Settings menu are entered during the  
CMA system First Time Setup process and do not change frequently. Use the  
Server Settings menu, when you do need to change them.  
The Server Settings menu allows users with Administrator permissions to  
implement the CMA system configuration best suited for their corporate  
environment as identified in the solution design, site survey, and/or network  
design.  
The Server Settings menu includes these items:  
Selection  
Description  
Network  
The basic network setting for the CMA system on your  
network.  
Polycom, Inc.  
383  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Selection  
Description  
Gatekeeper Settings By default the CMA system is made the primary  
gatekeeper during the First Time Setup process. Use the  
Gatekeeper Settings option to modify the primary  
gatekeeper behavior or to add an alternate gatekeeper or  
neighboring gatekeepers.  
Gatekeeper Settings affect how devices register and calls  
are made in your video communications network. These  
settings allow you to:  
Identify the gatekeeper with an identifier and  
description.  
Specify registration-related settings, including the  
default gatekeeper, which endpoints register, the  
registration refresh period, and the offline timeout.  
Set the maximum number of neighboring gatekeeper  
hop counts.  
Specify how to handle calls to and from unregistered  
endpoints.  
Management and  
Security Settings  
Management Settings allow you to upgrade the CMA  
system software and enable auto discovery of endpoints.  
Security Settings allow you to implement HTTPS for the  
CMA system.  
Dial Plan Settings  
Edit the default CMA system Dial Plan and Site settings  
(which includes the definition of sites, site links, dial rules,  
services, and least-cost routing tables) to support your  
network topology and video call routing.  
Polycom CMA System Licensing  
The seat capacity for a CMA 5000 system with the Maximum Security feature  
not enabled scales from 500 to 5,000 devices. The entry-level CMA 5000 system  
has a baseline capacity of 500 client access licenses. Additional licensing is  
offered in 100, 500, and 1000 license pack sizes.  
The seat capacity for a CMA 4000 system with the Maximum Security feature  
not enabled scales from 200 to 400 devices. The entry-level CMA 4000 system  
has a baseline capacity of 200 client access licenses. Additional device licensing  
is offered in 100 license pack size.  
The seat capacity for a CMA 5000 system with the Maximum Security feature  
enabled is fixed at 500 devices with no expansion available. A CMA 4000  
cannot operate in Maximum Security mode.  
Your system comes with a Default Trial key that is valid for 60 days after  
activating your system. With your system order, you will receive one License  
Certificate. You must activate the License Certificate to receive an activation  
key, which you then enter in the CMA system. When you enter this activation  
384  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview  
key into the system, it overwrites the Default Trial key.  
When applied to the system, an expansion license pack augments the device  
license count. For example, applying a 1000-device expansion license pack to  
a baseline CMA 5000 system will yield a total license count of 1500 concurrent  
licenses.  
Where applicable, the number of concurrent calls supported by a CMA system  
is derived from the number of device licenses at a 3/10 ratio (calls/devices).  
For example, a system licensed for 5000 devices supports up to 1500  
concurrent calls in routed mode and 3000 calls in direct mode.  
Device licenses are consumed based on a 1:1 basis for any managed device  
(endpoints, MCU, GK, GW— including personal endpoints, IP blades, and  
more) that can be added to the system by any means, including the user  
interface, registration for management services, or registration for Global  
Address Book services.  
Note  
Device licenses are consumed by managed devices, not by users. You may add  
any number of local or enterprise users to the CMA system.  
The CMA system has the following licensing packages:  
Base system license  
Base system license with Microsoft Outlook  
Base system license with IBM Lotus Notes  
Base system license with Microsoft Outlook and IBM Lotus Notes  
Redundant system licenses (primary and redundant licenses)  
Redundant system licenses with Microsoft Outlook  
Redundant system licenses with IBM Lotus Notes  
Redundant system licenses with Microsoft Outlook and IBM Lotus Notes  
Licensing for the Polycom CMA Desktop client is included with the CMA  
system. When a Polycom CMA Desktop client is provisioned by the CMA  
system, it automatically consumes a license. That license is then reserved for  
that Polycom CMA Desktop client. However, you can configure the CMA  
system to automatically release a Polycom CMA Desktop client license after a  
set number of days of inactivity.  
Licenses consumed by registered hardware devices are never automatically  
released. To release a license from a registered hardware device, an  
administrator must manually delete the device from the system.  
Polycom, Inc.  
385  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Polycom CMA System Site Topology and Dial Plan Set Up  
Site topology information describes your network and its interfaces to other  
networks, including the following elements:  
Site — A local area network (LAN) that generally corresponds with a  
geographic location such as an office or plant. A site contains one or more  
network subnets, so a device’s IP address identifies the site to which it  
belongs.  
Network clouds — A Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) network  
cloud defined in the site topology. An MPLS network is a private network  
that links multiple locations and uses label switching to tag packets with  
origin, destination, and quality of service (QOS) information.  
Note that MPLS clouds are not associated with an IP address ranges, so  
they can be used to group multiple subnets. They could also represent a  
service provider.  
While links to MPLS clouds have bandwidth and bit rate limitations, the  
cloud is infinite. In this way, clouds reflect the way in which businesses  
control bandwidth and bit rate.  
Internet/VPN — A entity that represents your network’s connection to the  
public Internet.  
Site link — A network connection between two sites or between a site and  
an MPLS network cloud.  
Site-to-site exclusion — A site-to-site connection that the site topology  
doesn’t permit an audio or video call to use.  
Territory — A grouping of one or more sites for which a CMA system is  
responsible.  
The site topology you create within the CMA system should reflect your  
network design. Consider the following information and best practices when  
creating your site topology:  
If possible, connect all sites to an MPLS cloud. MPLS clouds are like  
corporate networks, used to connect multiple subnets in multiple sites, but  
all servicing a company.  
Avoid cross loops or multiple paths to a site; otherwise a call may have  
different paths to a single destination. The more cross, circular, and multi  
paths you have, the higher the number of calculations for a conference.  
Link sites that aren’t connected to an MPLS cloud directly to another site  
that is connected to an MPLS cloud. Do not create orphan sites.  
Calls are routed through a bridge, so bandwidth and bit rate limits for the  
site and subnet apply to all calls made using that bridge.  
Reserve the Internet/VPN “site” for IP addresses that fall outside your  
private or corporate network (for example remote workers), because all  
calls routed to the Internet/VPN site will be routed through the site on  
your private or corporate network that has Internet access.  
386  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview  
The CMA system site topology function uses a dynamic, embedded mapping  
tool that graphically displays the sites, clouds (network and Internet), and site  
links (site-to-site or site-to-cloud) in your network.  
Within this global and graphical view of the video conferencing network, you  
can:  
Create and link up to 500 sites  
Zoom and pan to view specific network components  
View system and device alarms  
View the video network capacity for sites and site links as indicated by the  
color and shape of its icons.  
Filter the view by site name, territory name, IP address, network devices,  
and alerts  
Sites List  
The Sites page contains a list of the sites defined to the CMA system.  
Use the commands in the Actions list to add a site, edit or delete existing sites,  
and see information about a site, including the number of devices of each type  
it contains.  
The following table describes the fields in the Sites list.  
Column  
Name  
Description  
Name of the site.  
Description of the site.  
Description  
Polycom, Inc.  
387  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Column  
Description  
Country Code  
The country code for the country in which the site is  
located.  
Area Code  
The city or area code for the site. Do not include a  
leading zero. For example, the city code for Paris is 01;  
however, enter 1 in this field.  
Max Bandwidth (Mbps)  
Max Bit Rate (Kbps)  
The total bandwidth limit for audio and video calls.  
The per-call bandwidth limit for audio and video calls.  
Note  
Bit rate is not the same as bandwidth. Since the bit rate  
applies in both directions and there is overhead, the  
actual bandwidth consumed is about 2.5 times the bit  
rate.  
Territory  
The territory to which the site belongs, which  
determines the CMA system responsible for it.  
Add/Edit Site Dialog Box  
Use the Add Site dialog box to define a new site in the CMA system’s site  
topology and specify which subnets are associated with it. Use the Edit Site  
dialog box to redefine information for an existing site.  
The following table describes the fields in the Add Site and Edit Site dialog  
boxes.  
Field  
Description  
General Info  
Site Name  
A meaningful name for the site. The name can be up to  
32 characters long, and may include spaces, dashes,  
and underscores.  
Description  
A brief description (ASCII only) of the site.  
Override ITU Dialing  
Rules  
Check this box to override the standard dial rules  
established by the International Telecommunications  
Union.  
PBX Access Code  
Country Code  
Area Code  
The access code required to enter the site’s PBX  
system.  
The country code for the country in which the site is  
located.  
The city or area code for the site. Do not include a  
leading zero. For example, the city code for Paris is 01;  
however, enter 1 in this field.  
388  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview  
Field  
Description  
# of Digits in Subscriber  
Number  
The number of digits in a phone number. For example,  
in the United States, subscriber numbers may have  
seven digits or ten digits depending upon the region.  
Default LCR Table  
Assignment Method  
The default least-cost routing table (LCR) for this site.  
This LCR table is used for all calls originating from  
devices associated with this site. The default is None.  
The ISDN number assignment method for the site.  
Possible values include:  
No Auto Assignment. Select this option when  
ISDN numbers are not assigned to IP devices.  
DID (Direct Inward Dial). Select this option when  
you assign a range of phone numbers received from  
the telephone company service.  
Gateway Extension Dialing. Select this option  
when you have a single gateway phone number and  
a range of extensions (E.164 aliases) that are  
internal to the company. In this case, calls go  
through a gateway. Endpoints are differentiated by  
the extension at the end of the dial string.  
When a site is assigned an automatic assignment  
method, devices without an ISDN number are assigned  
one when they register. These numbers allow inbound  
calls to reach specific video endpoints. After an ISDN  
number is assigned to an endpoint, it is reserved for use  
as long as that endpoint remains registered with the  
CMA system.  
Note  
If you do not assign ISDN numbers automatically, you  
cannot call IP-only endpoints through an ISDN line.  
Territory  
Location  
Assigns the site to a territory, and thus to a CMA  
system.  
Specify the geographic location of the site either by  
longitude+latitude or country+city.  
ISDN Number Assignment—  
Assignment Method = DID (Direct Inward Dial)  
# Digits in Call Line  
Identifier  
Enter the number of digits in the Call Line Identifier  
(CLID), which is the dialed number. The maximum is 17.  
For example, in the United States, the number of  
digits in the CLID is often 7 for outside local calls, 4  
for internal calls, or 11 for callers in a different area  
code.  
This number indicates what part of the full dial string  
is sent to the gatekeeper for address resolution.  
Polycom, Inc.  
389  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
# Digits in Short Phone  
Number  
Enter the number of digits in the short form of the dialing  
number.  
For example, in the United States, internal  
extensions are usually four or five digits.  
This number indicates what part of the dial string is  
sent to the gatekeeper for address resolution in  
gateway + extension dialing.  
ISDN Number Range -  
Start  
The starting ISDN number to assign automatically to IP  
devices.  
ISDN Number Range -  
End  
The ending ISDN number to assign automatically to IP  
devices.  
ISDN Number Assignment—  
Assignment Method = Gateway Extension Dialing  
Gateway Phone  
Phone number of the site gateway.  
Number  
E164 Start  
The starting number in a range of available  
extensions to assign automatically to IP devices.  
When a device without native ISDN registers, a  
number within the start and end range is assigned,  
so that the device can be called through an ISDN  
line.  
E164 End  
The ending number in the range of available extensions  
to assign automatically to IP devices.  
Routing/Bandwidth  
Internet calls are not  
allowed  
Disables call routing through the Internet.  
Allowed via H.323  
aware firewall  
Enables call routing through the Internet, using an  
H.323-aware firewall.  
Notes  
For an outbound call to the Internet, you must enter  
the firewall gateway service (e.g. a Polycom VBP  
appliance) code before the IP address in the dial  
string.  
If you select Allowed via H.323 aware firewall you  
must create a site link between this site and the  
Internet/VPN site.  
390  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview  
Field  
Description  
Allowed via H.323  
aware SBC or ALG  
Enables call routing via the Internet, using an  
H.323-aware SBC (Session Border Control) or ALG  
(Application Level Gateway) server.  
Note  
For an outbound call to the Internet, you must enter the  
firewall gateway service (for example, a Polycom VBP  
appliance) code before the IP address in the dial string.  
Call Signaling IP  
Address  
IP address of the SBC or ALG server. Supports only  
IPv4 addresses.  
Port  
Port address of SBC or ALG server.  
Send Unmodified Dial  
String to SBC/ALG  
Select this option if your SBC or ALG requires that the  
original dial string is passed to it. For example, an H.323  
Annex O dial string such as [email protected] is  
passed directly to the SBC or ALG instead of resolving  
company.com to an IP address.  
Deselect this option if your equipment requires a dial  
string that is converted from company.com to  
gatekeeper IP address. This option is appropriate for  
the Polycom VBP.  
Total Bandwidth  
Call Max Bit Rate  
The total bandwidth of the pipe at the site.  
The maximum bandwidth that can be used for each  
intrasite call at the site. The default and maximum value  
is 2000000 (2 GB).  
Subnets  
Subnet IP  
Address/Mask  
Specifies the subnets within the site. For each subnet,  
includes:  
IP Address range  
Subnet mask  
Maximum bandwidth for the subnet  
Maximum bit rate per call for the subnet  
Enterprise Directory Settings—  
Endpoint Enterprise Directory security group settings  
Universal Security  
Group Filter  
When in secure mode, search and select groups that  
are provisioned to the endpoints to represent the valid  
lists of users that can log in as a user or administrator. If  
a user is not a member of one of the selected groups  
then the user is denied access to the endpoint.  
Enterprise Directory  
Admin Group  
Enterprise Directory  
User Group  
Polycom, Inc.  
391  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Site Links  
The Site Links page lists the links defined in the site topology. A link can  
connect two sites, or it can connect a site to an MPLS network cloud (see  
“Network Clouds” on page 102).  
Use the commands in the Actions list to add, edit, or delete a site link. See  
“Add/Edit Site Link Dialog Box” on page 392 for a description of the fields in  
the site list.  
Add/Edit Site Link Dialog Box  
Use the Add Site Link dialog box to define a new site link in the CMA system’s  
site topology. Use the Edit Site Link dialog box to redefine an existing site  
link. A site link can connect two sites, or it can connect a site to an MPLS  
network cloud.  
The following table describes the fields in the Add Site Link and Edit Site  
Link dialog boxes.  
Field  
Description  
Name  
A meaningful name for the site (up to 128 characters).  
A brief description of the site (up to 200 characters).  
Description  
From site  
The originating site of the link. The drop-down list  
includes all defined sites and the Internet. Can’t be  
changed for a site-to-cloud link.  
To site  
The destination site of the link. The drop-down list  
includes all defined sites and an Internet/VPN option.  
Can’t be changed for a site-to-cloud link.  
Total bandwidth (Mbps)  
Call Max bit rate (kbps)  
Specifies the total bandwidth limit for this link.  
Specifies the per-call bandwidth limit for this link.  
Site-to-Site Exclusions  
The Site-to-Site Exclusions page contains a list of the direct site-to-site  
connections that the system won’t permit a call or session to use.  
Use the commands in the Actions list to add and delete site-to-site exclusions.  
The following table describes the fields in the list.  
Column  
Description  
From/To Site  
Name of one of the two sites connected by the excluded  
link.  
To/From Site  
Name of the other site.  
392  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview  
Territories  
The Territories page contains a list of the territories defined in the site  
topology. On the right, it displays information about the selected territory.  
A territory is a set of one or more sites for which a CMA system is responsible.  
By default, there is one territory named Default CMA Territory, and its  
primary node (the CMA system responsible for it) is set to this system.  
Use the commands in the Actions list to add, edit, or delete a territory. See  
the territory list.  
Add/Edit Territory Dialog Box  
Use the Add Territory dialog box to define a new territory in the CMA  
system’s site topology. Use the Edit Territory dialog box to define a new  
territory in the CMA system’s site topology.  
The following table describes the fields in the Add Territory and Edit  
Territory dialog boxes.  
Field  
Description  
Territory Info  
Name  
A meaningful name for the territory (up to 128  
characters).  
Description  
A brief description of the territory (up to 200 characters).  
Primary Node  
The primary node of the CMA system responsible for  
this territory.  
Backup Node  
The second node, if any, of the CMA system  
responsible for this territory.  
Associated Sites  
Search Sites  
Enter search string or leave blank to find all sites.  
Search Result  
Lists sites found and shows the territory, if any, to which  
each currently belongs.  
Select a site and click the right arrow to move it to the  
Selected Sites list.  
Selected Sites  
Lists sites selected and shows the territory, if any, to  
which each currently belongs.  
Polycom, Inc.  
393  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Network Clouds  
The Network Clouds page contains a list of the MPLS (Multiprotocol Label  
Switching) network clouds defined in the site topology.  
Use the commands in the Actions list to add, edit, or delete an MPLS cloud.  
See the Cloud Info section of the “Add/Edit Network Cloud Dialog Box” on  
page 394 for a description of the fields in the Network Clouds list.  
Add/Edit Network Cloud Dialog Box  
Use the Add Network Cloud dialog box to define a new MPLS network cloud  
in the CMA system’s site topology. Use the Edit Network Cloud dialog box to  
redefine an existing MPLS network cloud.  
The following table describes the fields in the Add Network Cloud and Edit  
Network Cloud dialog boxes.  
Field  
Description  
Cloud Info  
Name  
A meaningful name for the cloud (up to 128 characters).  
A brief description of the cloud (up to 200 characters).  
Description  
Linked Sites  
Search Sites  
Search Result  
Enter search string or leave blank to find all sites.  
Lists sites found and shows the territory, if any, to which  
each belongs.  
Select a site and click the right arrow to open the Add  
Site Link dialog box.  
Selected Sites  
Lists sites linked to the cloud and shows the territory, if  
any, to which each belongs.  
Polycom CMA System Gatekeeper Functionality  
The CMA system gatekeeper provides address translation and network access  
control services for endpoints, gateways, and MCUs. It also provides other  
services such as bandwidth management and dial plans services. These  
additional features allow you to configure and manage your gatekeeping  
operations and provide flexibility and scalability.  
Note  
If your system is in maximum security mode, the CMA system gatekeeper  
functionality is not available.  
394  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview  
Default, Redundant, Alternate, and Neighboring Gatekeepers  
Default Gatekeeper  
Typically during the First Time Setup process, the CMA system is designated  
as the default gatekeeper and the default gatekeeper settings are implemented.  
The CMA system as the default gatekeeper responsible for:  
Default, alternate and neighboring gatekeeper management  
Device registration  
Address resolution  
Bandwidth control and management  
Call control signaling  
Call management, authorization, access, and accounting  
Firewall traversal  
When a call originates from the CMA system and the system is unable to  
resolve the dialed address, the call can be forwarded to another gatekeeper for  
resolution. To enable call forwarding, create a neighboring region and a  
dialing rule that routes calls using a particular prefix to the neighboring  
gatekeeper.  
We recommend keeping the CMA system as the default gatekeeper, so that all  
endpoints and other devices on the network capable of automatic registration  
will register with it. This allows the CMA system to serve as the centralized  
manager of the network and more effectively aid in bandwidth management,  
firewall traversal, and device authentication and authorization.  
Note  
MCUs that register with a GRQ instead of a RRQ like the Polycom RMX system,  
will only register with the CMA system when it is enabled as the default gatekeeper  
for the zone.  
Redundant Gatekeeper  
When the CMA system is deployed in a redundant configuration, the  
redundant CMA system operates as a redundant gatekeeper in parallel with  
the primary CMA system sharing endpoint registration information. If the  
primary CMA system becomes unavailable, the redundant CMA system  
replaces it until it returns.  
Polycom, Inc.  
395  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Alternate Gatekeeper  
Within the CMA system, you can designate an alternate gatekeeper. In this  
case, when an endpoint or other device registers with the CMA system  
gatekeeper, the system sends back the alternate gatekeeper information to the  
endpoint. Then, if communication with the CMA system fails, the endpoint  
will attempt to register with the alternate gatekeeper.  
In a redundant configuration, the alternate gatekeeper is the third gatekeeper  
in line after the primary and redundant CMA system gatekeepers.  
Neighboring Gatekeeper  
Neighboring gatekeepers are gatekeepers that manage other H.323 regions  
within an enterprise. When a call originates within one gatekeeper region but  
that region’s gatekeeper is unable to resolve the dialed address, it is forwarded  
to the neighboring gatekeepers for resolution.  
Note  
A neighboring gatekeeper may require additional configuration to completely  
integrate with the CMA system gatekeeper. Also, not all CMA system parameters  
correspond to parameters on a neighboring gatekeeper.  
Within the CMA system, you can also set up a dial rule that will route calls  
with designated prefixes to designated neighboring gatekeepers.  
Device Registration  
The CMA system manages device registration and offers several choices from  
an open registration policy to more restrictive registration policies.  
No matter what the gatekeeper registration policy, any endpoint that is  
automatically provisioned, any endpoint that is registered with the Global  
Address Book, and any endpoint that is added manually to the CMA system  
can automatically register with the gatekeeper.  
The CMA system gatekeeper registration policies include:  
Allow Registration of All Endpoints  
This open Allow Registration of All Endpoints registration policy allows any  
device that can find the CMA system gatekeeper to register with it. This is the  
default policy.  
In this case, devices can register to the CMA system automatically:  
When the device broadcasts a message to find a gatekeeper with which to  
register. In this case, specifying a default gatekeeper is important, because  
devices that register automatically may find multiple gatekeepers.  
396  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview  
Devices register with the system designated as the default gatekeeper,  
unless that gatekeeper is down. Then devices register with the system  
designated as the alternate gatekeeper.  
When registering, devices send a variety of settings to the gatekeeper  
including their IP address, one or more H.323 IDs, and one or more E.164  
aliases. These settings appear in the CMA system as Device Details.  
When devices in dynamic management mode are automatically  
provisioned by the CMA system.  
And devices can be registered to the CMA system manually:  
At the device by specifying the IP address of the CMA system as the  
gatekeeper.  
At the device by specifying the IP address of the CMA system as the  
Global Directory Service. Once the device in the CMA system Global  
Address Book it is registered to the system.  
At the CMA system by adding the device to the one of the device lists  
(Endpoint, MCU, VBP, or DMA lists).  
Once an endpoint is registered, users of other registered endpoints can call the  
endpoint by using either the H.323 ID, a URI, an E.164 alias, or one of the  
services.  
Allow Registration of Predefined Endpoints Only  
The restrictive Allow Registration of Predefined Endpoints Only registration  
policy allows devices to automatically register once they are added to the  
CMA system either when they are automatically provisioned, automatically  
registered to the Global Address Book, or added to the system manually.  
Allow Registration of Endpoints in Defined Sites  
The moderately open Allow Registration of Endpoints in Defined Sites  
registration policy allows endpoints to automatically register if they are within  
one of the Dial Plan sites defined to the CMA system, when they are  
automatically provisioned, when they are automatically registered to the  
Global Address Book, or when they are added to the system manually  
Allow Registration of Predefined Prefixes Only  
With this controlled registration policy, devices within a range of defined  
E.164 prefixes may automatically register with the CMA system.  
Polycom, Inc.  
397  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Routing Mode  
The CMA system has two routing modes.  
Direct Mode  
In this simplest gatekeeper mode, the CMA system gatekeeper resolves IP  
addresses to their E.164 addresses and aliases (similar to the function of a  
domain name server) and grants endpoints permission to place calls. Once the  
gatekeeper performs these two functions, it plays no further role in the call.  
Call signaling and media streams are sent directly between the endpoints in  
the call.  
In Direct mode, the number of concurrent calls supported by a CMA system  
is derived from the number of device licenses at a 3/5 ratio (calls/devices). So,  
for example, a system in Direct mode licensed for 5000 devices supports up to  
3000 calls.  
Use Direct mode when implementing a hierarchical architecture. A  
hierarchical architecture is one with multiple gatekeepers, where one  
gatekeeper—the CMA system in Direct mode—acts as the directory  
gatekeeper at the top of the hierarchy. On the directory gatekeeper, you must  
configure all of the other member gatekeepers as neighbors and on the  
member gatekeepers you must configure the directory gatekeeper as a  
neighbor. However, the member gatekeepers do not have to be neighbored  
with each other.  
When in Direct mode, some advanced CMA system features do not work.  
These features include Simplified Dialing, Conference on Demand, Alternate  
Routing, Least Cost Routing, MCU board hunting, and firewall traversal for a  
Polycom VBP system in "Enterprise" or "E" mode. (Firewall traversal for a  
Polycom VBP system in "Service Provider or "S" mode does work.)  
The advantage of Direct mode is that conferences stay connected even if the  
gatekeeper fails.  
The disadvantage of Direct mode (along with the loss of advanced  
functionality) is that during a failure and restart the gatekeeper loses track of  
active calls that it was not involved in setting up. In this case, after a failure and  
restart, the gatekeeper’s bandwidth calculations will be incorrect until those  
calls end. Also, since the Conference Monitoring function uses gatekeeper  
data, the monitoring information for those calls may be incorrect or  
incomplete.  
Routed Mode  
In this advanced mode, the CMA system gatekeeper, besides performing the  
functions of a Direct mode gatekeeper, also acts as a proxy for the call  
signaling H.225 messages that set up the call. In this mode, only the media  
streams are sent directly between the endpoints in the call.  
398  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview  
In Routed mode, the number of concurrent calls supported by a CMA system  
is derived from the number of device licenses at a 3/10 ratio (calls/devices).  
So, for example, a system in Routed mode licensed for 5000 devices supports  
up to 1500 calls.  
The advantage of Routed mode is that it enables advanced features such as  
Simplified Dialing, Conference on Demand, Alternate Routing, Least Cost  
Routing, MCU board hunting and firewall traversal for a Polycom VBP system  
in "Enterprise" or "E" mode. Routed mode is also supported for the Polycom  
VBP system in "Service Provider" or "S" mode.  
The disadvantage of routed mode is that a gatekeeper failure and restart  
terminates all running conferences that include a registered device. Calls are  
not reestablished after a system failure and restart. Conferences show a status  
of Active, but participants show a status of Disconnected.  
In either mode, CDR information for calls is accurate if the CMA system does  
not fail and the endpoints send a DRQ (Disconnect Request) at the end of the  
call.  
Polycom CMA System Integration with Microsoft Outlook  
Polycom now supports two conferencing methods when integrating Polycom  
conferencing with Microsoft Outlook: Reserved and Reservationless.  
Note  
If you wish to implement both reserved conferencing (enabled by a CMA system)  
and reservationless or ad hoc conferencing (enabled by a Polycom DMA system),  
you should create two pools of RMX bridges as described in “DMA View” on  
page 225. However if you do, Polycom does not recommend using both the  
Polycom Scheduling Plug-in for Microsoft Outlook (Reserved Conferencing) and  
the Polycom Conferencing Add-in for Microsoft Outlook (Reservationless  
Conferencing) on the same client system.  
Standard Polycom CMA System and Reserved Conferencing  
Reserved conferencing is standard with the CMA system. All conferences  
scheduled either through the CMA system web scheduler or one of the  
Scheduling Plugins are reserved conferences, which means the CMA system  
reserves video bridge, network resources, and video endpoints at the  
scheduled time. In this case, the calendars for the endpoints are stored and  
maintained by the CMA system.  
When the conference is scheduled using the Scheduling Plugin for Microsoft  
Outlook and the participants use Microsoft Outlook as their E-mail and  
calendaring tool, the scheduled conferences are also posted as meetings on the  
participants’ Outlook calendars. However, the endpoints themselves do not  
have Outlook calendars.  
Polycom, Inc.  
399  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Polycom Conferencing for Microsoft Outlook, Reservationless Conferencing,  
and Calendaring Management  
The CMA system can also be used to provision Polycom Conferencing for  
Microsoft Outlook, which is reservationless conferencing. When you use this  
method:  
Video bridge, network resources, and video endpoints are not reserved at  
the scheduled time.  
A Polycom RMX or DMA system is required to locate available bridge  
resources when the meeting begins.  
Calendars for the endpoints are stored and maintained by Microsoft  
Exchange and the endpoints have their own Outlook calendar.  
Polycom Conferencing for Outlook, which requires the Polycom Conferencing  
Add-in, allows:  
Conference organizers to:  
Use Microsoft Outlook and its usual meeting request workflow to  
schedule video- and audio-enabled meetings.  
Include recording and streaming into the conference, when required.  
Meeting participants to:  
Track their video- and audio-enabled meetings on the same calendar  
that they track their other meetings.  
Click a link in an E-mail meeting request to join conferences on their  
associated video or audio endpoint system.  
Endpoints to have their own unique credentials and mailbox separate  
from the endpoint user, so that endpoints can display their own calendars.  
This is especially important for room endpoints.  
The CMA system supports the Polycom Conferencing for Outlook solution. It  
allows you to provision endpoints with the credentials, mailbox address,  
Exchange server IP address, and calendaring service settings they need to use  
Polycom Conferencing for Outlook.  
To provision endpoints with the information required to support Polycom  
Conferencing for Outlook, you must complete the following tasks (after your  
sites are set up):  
1
2
3
400  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview  
Polycom CMA System Integration with Microsoft Lync Server  
2010 or Microsoft Office Communications Server 2007  
The CMA system supports the integration of selected Polycom endpoints with  
Microsoft® Lync™ Server 2010 or Microsoft® Office Communications Server  
2007. Integration with these unified communications servers allows Polycom  
HDX system users to see client users who have been added to the Polycom  
HDX system Favorites list and place audio and video calls to them.  
Conversely, client users can also see Polycom HDX system users in their client  
Contacts List and place audio and video calls to them.  
For Polycom HDX systems that are integrated with a Lync or Office  
Communications server, the unified communications server replaces the CMA  
system as the presence and directory service provider. However, the CMA  
system continues to act as the gatekeeper and manager for these endpoint  
systems.  
The CMA system supports the integration with these unified communications  
servers by provisioning endpoints with the credentials, Exchange server IP  
address, and communications service settings they need.  
To provision endpoints with the information required to integrate with these  
unified communications servers, you must complete the following tasks:  
1
2
Endpoint Directory and Directory Settings  
When an endpoint registers with the CMA system, its information is  
automatically entered into the Global Address Book. When information  
changes at the endpoint, the Global Address Book is automatically updated as  
well. If an endpoint is configured to Allow Directory Changes, additions and  
deletions to the Global Address Book are pushed to the endpoint.  
Endpoints that get their global directory from the CMA system will either get  
the Global Address Book or the enterprise LDAP directory. Two Directory  
Setup options allow you to affect which devices and users appear in the  
endpoint directory.  
Typically, standard endpoints (those that are not dynamically managed)  
register for the Polycom GDS and are listed in the CMA system Global  
Address Book. The Global Address Book allows standard endpoint users to  
call other standard endpoint users by selecting them by name. In this case, the  
Global Address Book is limited to 2000 entries, which is the limit that standard  
endpoint systems can manage.  
Polycom, Inc.  
401  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Notes  
The CMA system Global Address Book lists endpoints. Endpoints may or may  
not have users or rooms associated with them. On an endpoint, the Global  
Address Book does not list users unless they have endpoints associated with  
them.  
If your company has more than 100 endpoints, don’t limit the Global Address  
Book on the endpoint side or the endpoint user won’t have access to all Global  
Address Book entries.  
The CMA system Global Address Book does not support unicode data.  
The Include dynamically-managed devices in the Global Address Book  
option changes the Global Address Book so that it includes all standard  
endpoints and all dynamically-managed endpoints such as CMA Desktop and  
Polycom VVX 1500 endpoints in the Global Address Book. In this case, the  
Global Address Book limit is increased to 5000 entries. (Dynamically-managed  
endpoints are always included in the enterprise LDAP directory.)  
By default the Include dynamically-managed devices in the Global Address  
Book option is selected. This brings all of your devices and users together into  
one endpoint directory. However, you may not want to take advantage of this  
feature if you have legacy endpoint systems such as VSX, ViewStation, and FX  
endpoints. These endpoint systems cannot handle the increased size of the  
Global Address Book. For information on clearing this option, see “Remove or  
The second Directory Setup option affects both the Global Address Book and  
the enterprise LDAP directory. The CMA system Guest Book includes static  
user entries. By selecting the Show Guest Book entries in the Directory, these  
static entries are included in the endpoint directory, regardless of whether the  
endpoint directory is the Global Address Book or the enterprise LDAP  
directory. The Show Guest Book entries in the Directory option is also  
selected by default.  
402  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
30  
Server Setting Operations  
This chapter describes how to update the Polycom® Converged Management  
Application™ (CMA®) system configuration settings, many of which were  
entered during First Time Setup. It includes these topics:  
Edit the Polycom CMA System Network Settings  
Edit the system Network settings to change the basic network information for  
the CMA system.  
Note  
Changing the IP address via the Windows Network Settings is not a supported  
operation. To change the CMA system IP address, you must use this procedure.  
To edit the CMA system network settings  
1
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Network.  
Polycom, Inc.  
403  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
2
Configure these settings on the Network page, as necessary.  
Field  
Description  
System Name  
The NetBIOS name (ASCII only) of the CMA system  
server. Must be between 6 and 16 characters long;  
dashes and underscores are valid characters.  
IPv4 Address  
The static IPv4 address for the CMA system.  
IPv4 Subnet Mask  
The network subnet mask for the CMA system IP  
address.  
IPv4 Default Gateway  
DNS Domain  
The static IP address of the CMA system gateway.  
The DNS domain name suffix for the network in  
which the domain name server and CMA system  
server reside. For example polycom.com, not the  
fully qualified path of <hostname>.polycom.com  
.
Note  
If instead of entering a single domain controller, you  
enter an FQDN that maps to multiple servers, be  
sure that all of the mapped servers are directory  
domain controllers with global catalogs.  
Preferred DNS Server  
Alternate DNS Server  
The IP address of the preferred domain name server  
for the network.  
The IP address of the alternate domain name server  
for the network.  
3
4
Click Update.  
If you change the IP address, the system prompts you to restart the CMA  
system. We also recommend that you restart the system if you change the  
subnet mask.  
As required, restart the system.  
Edit the Polycom CMA System Time Settings  
Edit the System Time server settings to change the CMA system server time  
or to synchronize the server with an external NTP server.  
To edit the CMA system time settings  
1
Go to Admin > Server Settings > System Time.  
404  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Server Setting Operations  
2
Configure these settings on the System Time page, as necessary.  
Field  
Description  
System Time Zone  
The time zone in which the CMA system server  
resides.  
Auto adjust for  
Daylight Saving?  
Select this option to adjust the clock automatically for  
daylight savings time.  
Use Current Time  
Select this option to input the current date and time.  
Use External NTP  
Server Time  
Select this option to synchronize the CMA system  
date and time with an external NTP server.  
Synchronization  
IP address or DNS  
resolved name  
The IP address or fully qualified domain name (ASCII  
only) of the NTP server. If needed, enter multiple  
servers separated by a space.  
Note  
Make sure the current system time is correct before synchronizing with an NTP  
server. If you set the system to use an external NTP server when the current date  
and time are incorrect, the system time may be wrong for the amount of time  
specified in the Minutes between synchronization attempts.  
3
Click Update.  
Integrate with Microsoft Exchange Server for Calendaring  
Management  
The CMA system supports the Polycom Conferencing for Outlook solution. It  
allows you to provision endpoints with the credentials, mailbox address,  
Exchange server IP address, and calendaring service settings they need to use  
Polycom Conferencing for Outlook.  
This section describes the tasks that enable provisioning endpoints for  
Polycom Conferencing for Outlook.  
Associate Sites with Microsoft Exchange Servers  
By default, the CMA system is set up to automatically discover the Exchange  
server for the domain in which a site is located. However, if you wish to  
associate sites with an Exchange server using its IP address or DNS name,  
follow this procedure.  
Polycom, Inc.  
405  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
To associate sites with Microsoft Exchange servers by IP address or DNS name  
1
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Calendaring Management.  
In the Manage Calendaring dialog box, click Calendared Sites.  
The Specify Calendaring Exchange Servers page appears listing the sites  
defined on the CMA system.  
3
4
Select the check box for each of the sites you need to associate with a  
single Exchange server and then click Specify Exchange Server.  
In the Add Exchange Server dialog box, enter the Exchange Server  
Address or DNS and click Save.  
The sites appear in the calendared sites list below.  
5
Repeat steps 3 and 4 for each Exchange server for which you need to  
associate sites.  
Assign Calendaring Settings to Provisioning Profiles  
Calendaring settings are included as part of provisioning profiles.  
To assign calendaring settings to provisioning profiles  
1
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Calendaring Management.  
In the Manage Calendaring dialog box, click Group Information.  
The Group Information page appears listing the provisioning profiles  
defined on the CMA system.  
3
4
Select the check box for each of the provisioning profiles to which you  
need to assign the same calendaring settings and then click Specify  
Options.  
In the Manage Calendaring dialog box, configure these options.  
Fields  
Description  
Meeting Reminder  
Time  
Specifies the number of minutes before the meeting  
an endpoint system provisioned for Polycom  
Conferencing for Outlook will display a reminder.  
Enable Alert Tone  
When enabled, specifies that an endpoint system  
provisioned for Polycom Conferencing for Outlook will  
play a sound along with the meeting reminder. In this  
case, the endpoint will only play a sound when the  
system is not in a call.  
Display Private  
Meetings  
When enabled, specifies that an endpoint system  
provisioned for Polycom Conferencing for Outlook will  
display details about meetings marked private.  
406  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Server Setting Operations  
5
6
Click Save.  
The profiles appear in the calendared profiles list below.  
Repeat steps 3 through 5 for each set of profiles to which you need to  
assign calendaring settings.  
Provision the Exchange Mailbox for Calendaring Service-enabled Endpoints  
To use Polycom Conferencing for Outlook (PCO), a Polycom endpoint system  
must have a mailbox on the assigned Exchange server, and the Exchange  
server must authenticate the endpoint before it can access its mailbox.  
To use the CMA system to automatically provision a Polycom endpoint  
system, the endpoint system must use the same credentials (username and  
password) to access both the Exchange server and the CMA system. Only then  
can the CMA system automatically provision a calendaring service-enabled  
endpoint system.  
To provision the Exchange Mailbox for calendaring service-enabled endpoints  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Calendaring Management.  
In the Manage Calendaring dialog box, click Mailbox.  
In the Polycom Conferencing for Outlook page, enable Provision  
Mailbox and click OK.  
For Exchange credentials, each endpoint system will be provisioned with  
the same credentials it used to access the CMA system.  
For its mailbox, each endpoint system will be provisioned with the  
mailbox configured for it in Active Directory. This mailbox must be  
pre-configured for the endpoint system on the Exchange server.  
Integrate with Microsoft Lync Server 2010 or Microsoft  
Office Communications Server 2007  
The CMA system supports the integration with Microsoft® Lync™ Server  
2010 or Microsoft® Office Communications Server 2007 by provisioning  
endpoints with the group and SIP settings they need.  
After you set up integration with Microsoft Lync Server or Office  
Communications Server, all endpoints receive directory information from one  
of those servers. You are no longer using the enterprise directory or the other  
directory functions in the CMA system.  
This section describes describes the tasks that enable provisioning endpoints  
for integration with Microsoft Lync Server or Office Communications Server.  
Polycom, Inc.  
407  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Provision Group for Microsoft Lync or Microsoft Office Communications Server  
Integration  
You have set up the Microsoft Lync or Office Communications Server group  
that needs to be provisioned to endpoints in each automatic provisioning  
profile. This controls the directory that endpoints can see.  
Notes  
You cannot provision integration with a Microsoft Lync or Office  
Communications Server via scheduled provisioning.  
If the endpoint being provisioned is not capable of integration with a Microsoft  
Lync or Office Communications Server, the endpoint will ignore this settings.  
The group setting here applies to both Microsoft Lync and Office  
Communication Server.  
To provision integration with Microsoft Lync or Office Communications Server  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Automatic Provisioning  
Profiles.  
In the Automatic Provisioning Profiles page, select the profile of interest  
and click Edit.  
In the Provisioning Fields dialog box, click Microsoft Lync Settings and  
enter a Group Name.  
The Group Name is the group set in the Microsoft Lync Server or Office  
Communication Server.  
4
Click OK.  
Provision SIP Settings for Microsoft Lync or Microsoft Office Communications  
Server Integration  
By default, SIP is disabled in site provisioning. This procedure describes how  
to change existing site provisioning settings so that they provision integration  
with one of these unified communications servers.  
To integrate with a Microsoft Lync or Office Communications Server, Polycom  
endpoints must have a user account on the Microsoft unified communications  
server infrastructure. To have the CMA system automatically provision a  
Polycom endpoint for this integration, the endpoint must use the same  
credentials (username and password) to access both the unified  
communications server and the CMA system. Only then can the CMA system  
automatically provision a calendaring service-enabled endpoint system.  
408  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Server Setting Operations  
To provision SIP for integration with Microsoft Lync or Office Communications  
Server  
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Sites.  
In the Sites page, select the site of interest and click Edit Site  
Provisioning Details.  
3
In the Edit Site Provisioning Details dialog box, click SIP Settings and  
select these options.  
Settings not listed below are optional, based on the configuration of your  
systems  
Fields  
Description  
Enable SIP  
Specify whether to enable SIP calls.  
Automatically  
Discover SIP Servers  
The CMA system will issue a DNS query to locate the  
SIP server and provision that information to  
endpoints.  
Proxy Server  
Specify the IP address or DNS name of the SIP proxy  
server for the network.  
Registrar Server  
Specify the IP address or DNS name of the SIP  
registrar server for the network.  
In an Microsoft Office Communications Server  
2007 or Microsoft Lync Server 2010 environment,  
specify the IP address or DNS name of the Office  
Communications Server or Lync Server server.  
If registering a remote HDX system with an Office  
Communications Server Edge Server or Lync  
Server Edge Server, use the fully qualified  
domain name of the access edge server role.  
Backup Registrar  
Server  
Specify the IP address or DNS name of a backup SIP  
registrar server for the network  
Transport Protocol  
Indicates the protocol the system uses for SIP  
signaling. The SIP network infrastructure determines  
which protocol is required.  
Auto enables an automatic negotiation of  
protocols in the following order: TLS, TCP, UDP.  
This is the recommended setting for most  
environments.  
TCP provides reliable transport via TCP for SIP  
signaling.  
UDP provides best-effort transport via UDP for  
SIP signaling.  
TLS provides secure communication of the SIP  
signaling. TLS is available only when the system  
is registered with a SIP server that supports TLS.  
When you choose this setting, the system ignores  
TCP/UDP port 5060..  
Polycom, Inc.  
409  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Fields  
Description  
SIP Server Type  
Specify whether the SIP registrar server is a Microsoft  
Office Communications Server or a Microsoft®  
Lync™ Server 2010. Enabling this setting activates  
integration features such as the Microsoft global  
directory and Office Communicator contact sharing  
with presence.  
Verify Certificate  
Enable this option when the endpoint system’s  
certificate should be verified by the certificate  
authority.  
Use Enterprise  
Credentials  
Enable this option when the endpoint system should  
use the credentials the user entered at the endpoint  
to use for authenticate when registering with a SIP  
registrar server.  
User Name  
Specify the name to use for authentication when  
registering with a SIP registrar server, for example,  
[email protected]. If the SIP proxy requires  
authentication, this field and the password cannot be  
blank.  
Password  
Specify the password that authenticates the system to  
the registrar server.  
4
Click OK.  
View Current Polycom CMA System Licensing  
To view current CMA system licensing  
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Licenses.  
The Active License section of the Licenses page displays the following  
information.  
Field  
Description  
Activation Key  
Expiration Date  
Components  
The current activation key for the product.  
The expiration date of the current license key.  
The components for which the CMA system is  
licensed.  
Seats  
The number of seats for which the CMA system is  
licensed.  
410  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Server Setting Operations  
Add Polycom CMA System Licenses  
Adding licenses to your CMA system is a two step process:  
These processes are described in the following topics.  
Request a Software Activation Key Code  
To request a software activation key code  
1
In a separate browser page or tab, log into the CMA system server as an  
administrator.  
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Licenses and record the CMA system  
server serial number:  
____________________.  
3
4
Go to http://support.polycom.com.  
In the Licensing & Product Registration section, select  
Activation/Upgrade.  
5
6
7
Log in or Register for an Account.  
Select Site & Single Activation/Upgrade.  
In the Site & Single Activation page, enter the serial number you  
recorded in step 2.  
8
9
Click Next.  
Accept the EXPORT RESTRICTION agreement.  
10 In the new Site & Single Activation page, enter the software license  
number listed on your License Certificate (shipped with the product) and  
click Activate.  
11 When the activation key appears, record it:  
__________-__________-_________-___________  
12 Repeat this procedure for each additional license key required.  
Enter the Polycom CMA System Activation Key  
To enter the CMA system activation key  
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Licenses.  
1
Polycom, Inc.  
411  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
2
Enter the new activation key into the Add New License > Activation Key  
field and click Add. (Note that the field is ASCII only.)  
Reclaim Polycom CMA Desktop Licenses  
To set the threshold for reclaiming inactive Polycom CMA Desktop licenses  
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Licenses.  
Change the Threshold value in the Reclaim Inactive CMA Desktop  
1
2
Licenses section of the Licenses page. To reclaim licenses more quickly,  
lower the threshold. Set the threshold to zero, to stop reclaiming licenses.  
3
Click Update.  
Add or Remove a Polycom CMA System Custom Logo  
You can add your company’s logo to the CMA system user interface. To avoid  
distortion, we recommend adding a logo in GIF, JPG, or PNG format with a  
size of 300 x 44 pixels.  
To add a custom logo to the CMA system user interface  
1
2
3
4
5
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Custom Logos.  
In the Current Logo section of the Custom Logos page, click Upload...  
In the Select file dialog box, browse to the logo image and select the file.  
Click Open.  
In a redundant configuration, repeat steps 1 through 4 on the redundant  
server.  
To remove a custom logo from the CMA system user interface  
1
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Custom Logos.  
In the Current Server Logo section of the Custom Logos page, click  
Remove.  
412  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Server Setting Operations  
Add or Remove a Polycom CMA Desktop Custom Logo  
You can add your company logo to the Polycom CMA Desktop user interface.  
This logo will be displayed on the application user interface before the user  
logs in. The following illustration shows the default Polycom CMA Desktop  
user interface and a customized Polycom CMA Desktop user interface.  
Default Polycom CMA Desktop  
Branded Polycom CMA Desktop  
To avoid distortion, use a logo in GIF or JPG format with a size of  
approximately 260x215 pixels.  
Because the Polycom CMA Desktop logo is stored in the CMA system  
database, in redundant configurations you do not need to upload the logo to  
both servers.  
To add a custom logo to the CMA Desktop user interface  
1
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Custom Logos.  
In the Current CMA Desktop Logo section of the Custom Logos page,  
click Upload...  
3
4
In the Select file dialog box, browse to the logo image and select the file.  
Click Open.  
Once a user logs in, is provisioned, and then logs out, the logo will be  
displayed on the Polycom CMA Desktop user interface.  
To remove a custom logo from the CMA Desktop user interface  
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Custom Logos.  
1
Polycom, Inc.  
413  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
2
In the Current CMA Desktop Logo section of the Custom Logos page,  
click Restore Default.  
Once a user logs in, is provisioned, and then logs out, the default logo will  
be displayed on the CMA Desktop user interface.  
Edit the Polycom CMA System E-mail Account  
To edit the CMA system e-mail account  
1
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > E-mail.  
On the E-mail page, edit the e-mail account (ASCII only) from which the  
CMA system will send conference notification e-mails or edit the IP  
address of the mail server from which the CMA system will send  
conference notification e-mails.  
Notes  
Many e-mail servers will block or discard e-mails without a qualified From:  
address. To avoid this issue, make sure each person with Scheduler  
permissions has a valid E-mail address.  
Many E-mail servers will block or discard E-mails from un-trusted domains, in  
which case you may need to change the default CMA system E-mail address to  
one in a trusted domain.  
3
Click Update.  
414  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
31  
Polycom CMA System SNMP  
This chapter provides a discussion of the Polycom® Converged Management  
Application™ (CMA®) SNMP support. It includes these topics:  
SNMP Overview  
Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) is a TCP/IP-based  
communication protocol that allows network management systems to manage  
resources across a network.  
SNMP communication takes place between the management system and  
SNMP agents, which are the hardware and software that the management  
system monitors. An agent collects and stores local system information and  
makes this information available to the management system via SNMP.  
The CMA system software includes an SNMP agent. It translates local system  
information into the format defined by the MIB.  
The CMA system resides on a Polycom-branded Dell server. The Dell server  
software also includes an SNMP agent and MIB. However, the CMA system  
acts as a proxy agent to forward the Dell server MIB alarms and alerts, so the  
management system does not need to be configured to receive information  
directly from the Dell server MIB.  
Polycom, Inc.  
415  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Polycom recommends using a MIB browser to explore the CMA system MIB.  
A copy of the MIB can be downloaded from the CMA system. For more  
page 422. The CMA system MIB is self-documenting including information  
about the purpose of specific traps and inform notifications.  
It is important to note that you should understand how your SNMP  
management system is configured to properly configure the CMA system  
SNMP transport protocol requirements, SNMP version requirements, SNMP  
authentication requirements, and SNMP privacy requirements on the CMA  
system.  
The CMA system supports three SNMP levels:  
Disabled—The CMA system SNMP processes are turned off.  
SNMPv2c—The CMA system implements a sub-version of SNMPv2. The  
key advantage of SNMPv2c is the Inform command. Unlike Traps,  
Informs are messages sent to the management system that must be  
positively acknowledged with a response message. If the management  
system does not reply to an Inform, the CMA system resends the Inform.  
SNMPv2c also has improved error handling and improved SET  
commands.  
One drawback of SNMPv2c is that it is subject to packet sniffing of the  
clear text community string from the network traffic, because it does not  
encrypt communications between the management system and SNMP  
agents.  
SNMPv3—The CMA system implements the newest version of SNMP. Its  
primary feature is enhanced security. The contextEngineIDin SNMPv3  
uniquely identifies each SNMP entity. The contextEngineIDis used to  
generate the key for authenticated messages.  
The CMA system implements SNMPv3 communication with  
authentication and privacy (the authPrivsecurity level as defined in the  
USM MIB).  
Authentication is used to ensure that traps are read by only the  
intended recipient. As messages are created, they are given a special  
key that is based on the contextEngineIDof the entity. The key is  
shared with the intended recipient and used to receive the message.  
Privacy encrypts the SNMP message to ensure that it cannot be read  
by unauthorized users.  
416  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System SNMP  
Polycom CMA System SNMP Operations  
This section describes the CMA system SNMP operations including:  
Enable SNMP Messaging  
To enable SNMP messaging you must perform the two tasks:  
Edit the SNMP Settings for a Polycom CMA System  
To edit the SNMP settings for a CMA system  
1
2
Go to Admin > SNMP Settings.  
To enable SNMP, select an SNMP Version. For information on the SNMP  
3
Configure these settings for the connection between the CMA system and  
the SNMP agents on the SNMP Setting page.  
Setting  
Description  
Transport  
Specifies the transport protocol for SNMP  
communications. SNMP can be implemented over  
two transport protocol:  
TCP—This protocol has error-recovery services,  
message delivery is assured, and messages are  
delivered in the order they were sent. Some SNMP  
managers only support SNMP over TCP.  
UDP—This protocol does not provide error-recovery  
services, message delivery is not assured, and  
messages are not necessarily delivered in the order  
they were sent.  
Because UDP doesn't have error recovery services,  
it requires fewer network resources. It is well suited  
for repetitive, low-priority functions like alarm  
monitoring.  
Polycom, Inc.  
417  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Setting  
Description  
Port  
Specifies the port that the CMA system uses for  
general SNMP messages. By default, the CMA  
system uses port 161.  
Community  
For SNMPv2c, specifies the context for the  
information, which is the SNMP group to which the  
devices and management stations running SNMP  
belong.  
The CMA system has only one valid context—by  
default, public—which is identified by this  
Community name. The CMA system will not  
respond to requests from management systems that  
do not belong to its community.  
V3 Context Name  
For SNMPv3, specifies the context for the  
information. The CMA system has only one valid  
context, which is identified by contextName(in our  
case—an empty string) and contextEngineID  
.
V3 Local Engine Id  
Security User  
Auth Type  
For SNMPv3, displays the CMA system  
contextEngineIDfor SNMPv3.  
For SNMPv3, specifies the security name required to  
access a monitored MIB object.  
For SNMPv3, specifies the authentication protocol.  
These protocols are used to create unique  
fixed-sized message digests of a variable length  
message.  
The CMA system implements communication with  
authentication and privacy (the authPrivsecurity  
level as defined in the USM MIB).  
Possible values for authentication protocol are:  
MD5—Creates a digest of 128 bits (16 bytes).  
SHA—Creates a digest of 160 bits (20 bytes).  
Both methods include the authentication key with the  
SNMPv3 packet and then generate a digest of the  
entire SNMPv3 packet.  
Auth Password  
For SNMPv3, specifies the authentication password  
that is appended to the authentication key before it is  
computed into the MD5 or SHA message digest.  
418  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System SNMP  
Setting  
Description  
Encryption Type  
For SNMPv3, specifies the privacy protocol for the  
connection between the CMA system and the SNMP  
agent.  
The CMA system implements communication with  
authentication and privacy (the authPrivsecurity  
level as defined in the USM MIB).  
Possible values for privacy protocol are:  
DES—Uses a 56 bit key with a 56 bit salt to  
encrypt the SNMPv3 packet.  
AES—Uses a 128 bit key with a 128 bit salt to  
encrypt the SNMPv3 packet.  
Encryption Password  
For SNMPv3, specifies the password to be  
associated with the privacy protocol.  
4
Click Save SNMP Settings.  
Add an SNMP Notification Receiver  
You can configure the CMA system to send SNMP messages to different  
notification receivers (e.g., a network management system).  
To add an SNMP notification receiver to a CMA system  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > SNMP Settings.  
In the Notification RCVR Actions section, click Add.  
Configure these settings in the New Notification Receiver dialog box.  
Setting  
Description  
IP Address  
Transport  
Specifies the IP address of the host receiver.  
Specifies the transport protocol for SNMP  
communications to the host receiver. Possible values  
are:  
TCP  
UDP  
Select the transport protocol for which the host  
receiver is configured.  
Port  
Specifies the port that the CMA system will use to  
send notifications. By default, the CMA system uses  
port 162.  
Polycom, Inc.  
419  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Setting  
Description  
Trap/Inform  
Specifies the type of information that should be sent  
to the host receiver. Possible values are:  
Inform—An unsolicited message sent to a  
notification receiver that expects/requires a  
confirmation message. Introduced with SNMP  
version 2c, this option is not supported by  
systems that only support SNMP version 1.  
Trap—An unsolicited message sent to a  
notification receiver that does not expect/require  
a confirmation message.  
SNMP Version  
For SNMPv3, specifies the context for the  
information.  
The CMA system is a proxy-forwarding application. It  
passes SNMP requests to its various  
SNMP-reporting processes based on the context  
information in the SNMP message. For SNMPv3,  
this context is identified by contextNameand  
contextEngineID  
.
V3 Local Engine Id  
Security User  
Auth Type  
For SNMPv3, displays the CMA system  
contextEngineIDfor SNMPv3.  
For SNMPv3, specifies the security name required to  
access a monitored MIB object.  
For SNMPv3, specifies the authentication protocol.  
The CMA system implements communication with  
authentication and privacy (the authPrivsecurity  
level as defined in the USM MIB).  
Possible values for authentication protocol are:  
MD5  
SHA  
These protocols are used to create unique  
fixed-sized message digests of a variable length  
message. MD5 creates a digest of 128 bits (16  
bytes) and SHA creates a digest of 160 bits (20  
bytes).  
Auth Password  
For SNMPv3, specifies the authentication password  
that is appended to the authentication key before it is  
computed into the MD5 or SHA message digest.  
420  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System SNMP  
Setting  
Description  
Encryption Type  
For SNMPv3, specifies the privacy protocol for the  
connection between the CMA system and the  
notification receiver.  
The CMA system implements communication with  
authentication and privacy (the authPrivsecurity  
level as defined in the USM MIB).  
Possible values for privacy protocol are:  
DES  
AES  
Encryption Password  
For SNMPv3, specifies the password to be  
associated with the privacy protocol.  
Configure Alert Thresholds  
The CMA system provides administrators with the ability to configure some  
alert thresholds settings.  
To configure alert thresholds  
1
2
Go to Admin > Alert Settings > CMA Alert Threshold Settings.  
Configure these thresholds:  
Threshold  
Description  
Used disk space alert  
threshold  
Whenever the system disk space usage in a  
partition (as identified in the CMA Info Dashboard  
pane) exceeds this threshold, the system sends an  
alert and an SNMP trap.  
Valid values for this threshold are between 1-100%.  
By default, this threshold is set to 90%.  
A threshold setting of 75% or greater is  
recommended and no greater than 95%.  
Memory usage alert  
threshold  
Whenever the system memory usage (as identified  
in the CMA Info Dashboard pane) exceeds this  
threshold, the system send an alert and an SNMP  
trap.  
Valid values for this threshold are between 1-100%.  
By default, this thresh-%old is set to 95%.  
A threshold setting between 80-95% is  
recommended.  
Polycom, Inc.  
421  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Threshold  
Description  
Average CPU usage  
alert threshold  
Whenever the average system CPU usage (over all  
CPUs as identified in the CMA Info Dashboard  
pane) exceeds this threshold for the length of time  
identified in the Average CPU usage alert  
threshold window, the system sends an alert and  
an SNMP trap.  
Valid values for this threshold are between 1-100%.  
By default, this threshold is set to 95%.  
A threshold setting between 90-100% is  
recommended.  
Average CPU usage  
alert threshold window  
Whenever the average system CPU usage (over all  
CPUs as identified in the CMA Info Dashboard  
pane) exceeds this threshold for the length of time  
identified in the Average CPU usage alert  
threshold window, the system sends an alert and  
an SNMP trap.  
By default, this threshold window is set to 10  
minutes. This threshold can be set to between 1-15  
minutes.  
A threshold setting between 5-10 minutes is  
recommended.  
3
Click Update.  
Download Polycom CMA System MIB Package  
The CMA system enterprise MIB relates information about the system. The  
information is divided into these categories:  
Configuration—The static state of each component, for example  
component type, software version, current owner, values of all configured  
parameters.  
Status—The dynamic state of each component, for example the number of  
connections, number of conferences, number of ports (used and available),  
temperature, fan speed, CPU utilization, memory utilization, network link  
status, number of dropped packets, jitter measurements, number of  
successful calls, number of CPU resets.  
Alerts—To notify that an exception condition has occurred, for example a  
power supply failure, link/down up on a major interface, memory usage  
exceeding a predefined percentage, connections in an MCU exceeding a  
threshold, a logical fault or ungraceful transition.  
Conformance—The historical trend for selected groups of data, for  
example conference load over time for an MCU, bandwidth consumed  
over time for a network device.  
422  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System SNMP  
To download the MIB package for a CMA system  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > SNMP Settings.  
Click Download CMA MIBs.  
In the CMA MIBs dialog box, select the MIB of interest.  
Name  
Description  
Brcm-adapterInfo-MIB  
The interface table (ifTable) shows addresses,  
physical addresses, names, descriptions etc. of  
the network interfaces  
DCS3FRU-MIB  
DELL-ASF-MIB  
Contains all the field replaceable unit names,  
serial numbers, and revisions for the  
Polycom-branded Dell server. For more  
information, see the Dell SNMP documentation.  
Trap definitions for the Polycom-branded Dell  
server. For more information, see the Dell SNMP  
documentation.  
INET-ADDRESS-MIB  
ITU-ALARM-TC-MIB  
MIB-Dell-10892  
A definition file for standard conventions included  
for reference.  
A definition file for standard conventions included  
for reference.  
The primary MIB for the Polycom-branded Dell  
server. It provides 36 traps from the server  
motherboard, including system type, voltages,  
and temperature readings. For more information,  
see the Dell SNMP documentation.  
MIB-Dell-10900  
MIB-Dell-CM  
Trap definitions for the system including  
up/down, CPU, Memory, Network, and Disk  
monitoring. For more information, see the Dell  
SNMP documentation.  
Provides information about devices running on  
the Polycom-branded Dell server. For more  
information, see the Dell SNMP documentation.  
POLYCOM-CMA-MIB  
RFC1213-MIB  
CMA-specific MIB definition  
RFC1213MIB definitions included for reference.  
The CMA system supports all but "egp".  
SNMPv2-CONF  
A definition file for standard conventions included  
for reference.  
Polycom, Inc.  
423  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Name  
Description  
SNMPv2-SMI  
A definition file for standard conventions included  
for reference.  
SNMPv2-TC  
A definition file for standard conventions included  
for reference.  
StorageManagement-MIB Monitoring and information about the hard disks  
and RAID configuration on the server.  
Polycom recommends using a MIB browser to explore the CMA system MIB.  
However, a printed copy of the MIB is available in “Polycom CMA System  
SNMP” on page 415. The CMA system MIB is self-documenting including  
information about the purpose of specific traps and inform notifications.  
Change the SNMP Communication Port  
By default, the CMA system uses port 161 as its standard open port for SNMP  
communications. However, you can change this to another open port.  
To change the SNMP communication port  
1
2
Go to Admin > SNMP Settings.  
In the Port field of the SNMP Settings page, type a new communication  
port number and click Update SNMP Settings.  
424  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
32  
Database Operations  
This chapter describes the Polycom® Converged Management Application™  
(CMA®) database integration and operations. It includes these topics:  
Overview of the Polycom CMA System Database  
CMA system information is stored in these internal databases:  
Database  
Description  
ReadiManager.bak  
The general CMA system database that includes all data  
for scheduling, devices, dial rules, device registration, and  
site topology.  
Logger.bak  
XMPP.bak  
The CMA system database for call detail records and  
gatekeeper diagnostic logs.  
The CMA system database for presence information.  
The following values are recommended for SQL server HD size:  
Readimanager - 2GB with Autogrow  
Logger - 4 GB with Autogrow  
XMPP - 2 GB.  
Polycom, Inc.  
425  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
The Simple Recovery Model should be enabled for SQL backup mode.  
Internal Databases  
External Databases  
The CMA system automatically optimizes its internal database on an ongoing  
basis. It backs up its internal databases daily. The backup files are stored on the  
system’s hard disk. The CMA system maintains the last four internal backups.  
To keep backups for a longer time period, copy them regularly to a different  
location. For more information, see “Copy the CMA System Database Backup  
You can integrate the CMA system to an external Microsoft SQL Server  
database. Some information about integrating with an external database:  
CMA systems with 400 or more registered endpoints and redundant  
systems require an external database.  
If you set up an external database, follow your own corporate policies (or  
Microsoft best practices) to back it up and maintain it. The CMA system  
does not back up its external databases.  
Anytime you switch from the internal CMA system database to an  
external Microsoft SQL Server database, some system configuration  
settings, for example the enterprise directory settings, must be  
reconfigured.  
Take steps to minimize database connection failures. For example:  
Ensure you have good network connectivity between the CMA  
system and the Microsoft SQL Server. You may even consider  
co-locating the CMA system with your Microsoft SQL Server.  
Increase the keep alive checks on the Microsoft SQL Server to once an  
hour.  
If your system does lose connection to the database, you must reboot the  
CMA system to restore login capability; the CMA system does not  
automatically reconnect to the database. For more information, see  
It is recommended that anytime you reboot the external database server,  
you also restart the CMA system in the same maintenance window.  
You can create the CMA system databases manually using Microsoft SQL  
scripts. Contact Polycom Global Services to request the scripts.  
Anytime you switch from database sources (internal to external or  
external to internal), the default administrator’s password is moved to the  
database as part of the switch.  
426  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Database Operations  
Database Restoration  
This section describes how to restore an internal CMA system database. To  
restore from an external Microsoft SQL Server databases, use Microsoft SQL  
Server Management Studio. Refer to your Microsoft SQL Server Management  
Studio documentation for more information.  
You can migrate databases as follow.  
From...  
Internal  
Internal  
External  
To...  
Internal  
External  
External  
When you restore internal or external databases:  
Do not allow users to connect to the server during the restoration process.  
Restore all of the system databases at the same time.  
Restore all of the system databases from backups that were taken at the  
same time.  
Restart the CMA system server when the restoration process is finished.  
Database Operations  
Before performing the database operations described here, Microsoft SQL  
Server should already be installed. (For information about the supported  
Microsoft SQL Server applications and service pack levels, see the Polycom  
CMA System Release Notes for the version you’re running.)  
The Microsoft SQL Server Setup wizard and documentation provides  
guidance for setting up Microsoft SQL Server. As you use the wizard, make  
these choices:  
For Components to Install, at a minimum choose the SQL Server  
Database Services.  
For Instance Name, select Default Instance and configure the database  
instance port (typically 1433).  
For Service Account, select the Use the built-in System account option.  
For Authentication Mode, select Mixed Mode and provide a password  
that meets your enterprise policy for password length and complexity.  
For Collation Settings, select SQL collations. The CMA system is only  
certified with the Microsoft SQL Server set to US-English Collation  
(SQL_Latin1_General_CP1_CI_AS).  
Polycom, Inc.  
427  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Error and Usage Report Settings are optional.  
Integrate a Polycom CMA System to an External Database  
To integrate a CMA system with an external database  
1
Using the Microsoft SQL Server Configuration Manager, change the SQL  
Server keep alive checks (typically, SQL Server 2005 Network  
Configuration > Protocols for MSSQLSERVER > TCP/IP > KeepAlive)  
to 3,600,000 milliseconds.  
2
3
4
5
At the CMA system interface, go to Admin > Server Settings > Database.  
On the Database page, select Use an external SQL Server database.  
Enter the Database Server IP address or DNS Name.  
Enter the Database Server Port and click Update.  
The system will guide you through formatting or upgrading the external  
database, as necessary.  
6
Click Finish.  
Revert a Polycom CMA System to its Internal Database  
To revert a CMA system from an external database to its internal database  
1
2
At the CMA system interface, go to Admin > Server Settings > Database.  
On the Database page, clear Use an external SQL Server database and  
click Update.  
3
Click Update.  
Note  
To go back to the external database, follow the procedure to “Integrate a Polycom  
Copy the CMA System Database Backup Files  
In addition to backing up and restoring database files, you can copy the  
database backup files to and from the CMA system to an external location.  
428  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Database Operations  
To copy the CMA system database backup files using the web interface  
1
At the CMA system interface, go to Admin > Database Backup Files.  
The Database Backup Files list appears showing all of the backup files  
stored on the CMA system. Files with a timestamp included in the name  
are system-generated backup files. Files without a timestamp are user  
forced backups.  
2
3
In the Database Backup Files list, select the backup files of interest and  
click Save.  
In the Save As dialog box, browse to a location and click Save.  
Reformat the Existing Database  
The CMA system has an option that allows you to completely reformat (clean  
out) the system’s existing database.  
IMPORTANT  
Use this option only if your database is corrupted beyond repair or perhaps if you  
need to wipe out a test system to prepare it for production data.  
To reformat the database, you must use the PlcmDbouser name and password  
during the process. This user name is an internal user name found at  
Admin > Management and Security Settings > Database Security. Be sure  
that you know the password for PlcmDbobefore starting the reformat process.  
By default, the password is not listed, but you can reset it. For more  
To reformat the existing databases  
1
From the CMA system web interface, go to Admin > Server Settings >  
Database.  
2
3
On the Database page, select Reformat existing database...  
In the Reformat Existing Database/Database Maintenance dialog box,  
specify the Database Server IP Address and Database Server Port  
Number for the database to be reformatted.  
4
5
Specify the PlcmDbo user Login ID and Password and click  
Reformat/Install Database.  
Click Yes to confirm the reformat operation.  
The system displays a Reformat/Install Progress bar to indicate that the  
system is reformatting the database.  
Polycom, Inc.  
429  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
430  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
33  
Polycom CMA System Redundancy  
This chapter describes how to configure a redundant Polycom® Converged  
Management Application™ (CMA®) system. It includes these topics:  
Polycom CMA 5000 System Redundancy Overview  
A redundant CMA system configuration offers higher reliability and greater  
call success by ensuring that a CMA system server is always available.  
A redundant CMA system configuration requires two CMA system servers  
and three IP addresses in the same subnet on the same network—one physical  
IP address for each of the servers and one virtual IP address dedicated to  
endpoint registration.  
How Redundancy Works  
Terminology is very important in understanding how redundancy works.  
In a redundant configuration, one server is licensed as the primary server and  
the other server is licensed as the redundant server. The primary server is  
always the primary server and the redundant server is always the redundant  
server.  
In a redundant configuration, there is only one active server. The active server  
is the server managing the system. It is the server running all of the CMA  
system services. In a normal operational state, the active server is the primary  
server. In a failover state, the active server is the redundant server.  
Polycom, Inc.  
431  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
In a redundant configuration, there is only one standby server. The standby  
server is the server that is not managing the system. It is the server running  
only the Polycom Service Monitor. In a normal operational state, the  
redundant server is the standby server. In a failover state, the active server is  
the standby server. (If at anytime you receive a Cannot find servererror  
when you try to log into a server, check to see if it is the standby server.)  
The Polycom Service Monitor monitors redundancy. In a normal operational  
state, the redundant/standby server sends a SEND_REQUEST_STATUSmessage  
via TCP every three seconds on port 700 to the primary/active server and  
expects the server to answer with a SERVICE_RUNNINGmessage. (These  
messages do not include any qualitative data about the health of other  
services; they only verify that the active server is available on the network.)  
If the redundant service sends three consecutive SEND_REQUEST_STATUS  
requests that go unanswered, its Service Monitor initiates a failover and the  
redundant server becomes the active server.  
The most common reasons for system failovers are power failures and  
network disconnections. Note that failures in services do not initiate a failover,  
only a server failure.  
If both the primary and redundant servers start simultaneously (for example  
if both are in the same location and recover from a power failure at the same  
time), both servers will initially attempt to become the active server. However,  
the redundant server—the server licensed as the redundant server—retreats to  
standby status once the system reaches its fully functional state.  
An administrator can force a failover via the Switch Server Roles function in  
the CMA system user interface. Failover does not require a system restart.  
The primary and redundant servers share the external CMA system database,  
so what is recorded by one CMA system is read by the other CMA system. An  
external Microsoft SQL Server database is required. The CMA system database  
information—call records, endpoint registration information, and network  
topology configurations—remains consistent and available during a failover  
because both servers point to the same database.  
Also, the failover to the redundant server seems to occur seamlessly because  
the endpoints are registered with the virtual IP address, which remains  
constant.  
During a failover:  
Active conferences are dropped from the system. Conference participants  
can call back in using the same conference information.  
Users logged into the CMA system user interface are disconnected during  
a failover and returned to the main CMA system web page. Users can log  
back in once the failover is completed.  
Users in the middle of an operation may get an error message, because the  
system is not available to respond to a request.  
432  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Redundancy  
The redundant server becomes the active server. Its services start in an  
order designed to prevent the new active server from being flooded with  
requests from endpoints during startup.  
A system failover usually takes approximately 5 minutes, but some system  
settings affect how rapidly a redundant system returns to full functionality.  
The gatekeeper Registration Refresh period affects how quickly endpoints  
re-register with the redundant server after a failover. And if Deny calls  
to/from unregistered endpoints is checked, the gatekeeper rejects calls from  
endpoints that have not re-registered with the redundant server after a  
failover. Therefore, in a redundant system configuration, use a short refresh  
period (30 seconds) unless you have many endpoints or a large amount of  
network traffic.  
Once a failover to a redundant server occurs, the redundant server manages  
all system operations until an administrator switches back to the original  
primary server via the Switch Server Roles function in the CMA system user  
interface.  
Notes  
The CMA system does not automatically switch to the primary server when the  
primary server becomes available. An administrator must Switch Server  
Roles.  
A failover or system restart initiates an encryption routine that changes the  
private key for a redundant system. Therefore, after a failover or system restart,  
schedulers who use one of the scheduling plug-ins will be prompted to re-enter  
their login settings to access the system.  
Redundant Configuration System Administration  
Because the two servers share the external CMA system database, most of their  
configuration information is shared. However, certain information is not  
stored in the database, so an administrator must manually synchronize this  
information. This includes:  
Basic network settings such as IP, default gateway, and DNS settings  
External database information  
Time and external NTP server settings  
The current system log level  
Custom CMA system logo--upload the same logo to both servers  
Software Update profiles for scheduled software updates--upload the  
same software package to both servers  
Whenever you change information in one of these sections on one server you  
should also change it on the other server.  
Licensing and upgrading a redundant system is slightly more complex. The  
primary and redundant server required different licenses.  
Polycom, Inc.  
433  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Implement a Redundant Polycom CMA 5000 System  
You can set up a CMA 5000 system in a fault-tolerant, high-availability,  
redundant configuration. The CMA 4000 system is not available in a  
redundant configuration.  
This section has two procedures. One describes how to convert an existing  
non-redundant CMA 5000 system to a redundant configuration. The other  
describes how to configure redundancy on a newly installed system.  
To add a redundant Polycom CMA system server to an existing system  
1
2
3
4
In a maintenance window when there are no running conferences, verify  
that your primary CMA 5000 system is pointed to an external Microsoft  
SQL Server database and is properly licensed.  
Install the redundant CMA 5000 system as described in the Polycom CMA  
Getting Started Guide. During installation, point the redundant CMA 5000  
system server to its internal database.  
Request the required software activation key code for the redundant  
Enter the redundant license onto the redundant CMA 5000 system server.  
a
Log into the CMA 5000 system, and go to Admin > Server Settings >  
Licenses.  
b
Enter the activation key code for the redundant server into the Add  
New License > Activation Key field and click Add.  
You will receive a message indicating that you’ve entered a  
redundant license and the system must be rebooted. DO NOT  
REBOOT NOW. The redundant server will automatically reboot  
when you perform step 6.  
5
6
On the primary server:  
a
b
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Redundant Configuration.  
Enter the Virtual IP for the redundant system and click Submit.  
The primary system will reboot.  
Wait for the primary system to completely reboot and is back online, and  
then on the redundant server:  
a
b
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Database.  
On the Database page, select the Use an external SQL Server  
database check box.  
c
Enter the database information from the primary server that is, the  
database server’s IP address, and SQL server port number in the  
Database page.  
434  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Redundancy  
d
Click Update.  
The CMA 5000 system connects to the database server and the  
redundant server restarts and comes online.  
7
On the primary server, fail over to the redundant server. See “Failover to  
To configure redundancy on a newly installed Polycom CMA system.  
A redundant CMA system configuration requires the installation of two CMA  
system servers on the same network. During First Time Setup, you are  
instructed to assign these two servers physical IP addresses and leave them  
pointed at their internal databases. This section describes how to complete the  
configuration of these newly installed redundant servers. It includes these  
topics:  
1
2
Note  
This procedure describes implementing a new redundant CMA system. For  
information on converting an existing system to a redundant system, see “Add or  
Configure the External Database for Redundancy  
To configure the two redundant servers to use the same external database  
1
2
Log into both the primary and redundant CMA 5000 system servers.  
On the primary server, go to Admin > Dashboard and click  
Shutdown  
to shut down the primary server.  
3
When the primary server has shutdown completely, on the redundant  
server:  
a
b
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Database.  
On the Database page, select the Use an external SQL Server  
database check box.  
c
Enter the Database Server IP address or DNS Name.  
d
Enter the Database Server Port and click Update.  
The system will guide you through formatting or upgrading the  
external database. The redundant server boots.  
e
After the redundant server restarts completely, log into it again and  
select Admin > Dashboard.  
Polycom, Inc.  
435  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
f
Click Shutdown  
to shut down the redundant server.  
4
When the redundant server has shutdown completely, on the primary  
server:  
a
b
c
Turn ON the primary server.  
Log into the server and go to Admin > Server Settings > Database.  
On the Database page, select the Use an external SQL Server  
database check box.  
d
e
Enter the Database Server IP address or DNS Name.  
Enter the Database Server Port and click Update.  
The system will guide you through formatting or upgrading the  
external database. The primary server restarts and comes online as  
the active server.  
Set the Virtual IP Address for the Redundant System  
To set the virtual IP address for the redundant system  
1
When the primary server has restarted completely, log into the primary  
CMA 5000 system server.  
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Redundant Configuration.  
If the two CMA system servers are installed and configured correctly on  
the network, both servers are displayed in the table on the Redundant  
Configuration page.  
3
Enter the Virtual IP for the redundant system and click Submit. For  
information about this virtual IP address, see “Add or Remove a Polycom  
Note  
Set the virtual IP for the redundant server on the primary server only.  
The primary server restarts and comes online as the active server.  
4
When the primary server has restarted completely, turn ON the  
redundant server and wait for it to boot completely.  
436  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Redundancy  
License a Redundant Polycom CMA System  
To license a non-redundant CMA system, see “Add Polycom CMA System  
Licenses” on page 411. This topic describes how to license a redundant system.  
To license a redundant CMA 5000 system  
1
Request a separate software activation key code for the primary and  
redundant server as described in “Request a Software Activation Key  
2
On the primary CMA 5000 system server:  
a
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Database and verify the database  
information. (If you fail to point the server to the correct database, you  
must re-enter the license when you change databases.)  
b
c
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Licenses.  
Enter the activation key code for the primary server into the Add New  
License > Activation Key field and click Add.  
The license number appears in the list and the number of active  
licenses is updated.  
d
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Redundant Configuration. and  
click Switch Server Role.  
The system fails over to the redundant server.  
3
On the redundant server:  
a
b
c
Log into the CMA system using the virtual IP address, and go to Admin  
> Server Settings > Licenses.  
Enter the software activation key code for the redundant server into  
the Add New License > Activation Key field and click Add.  
Go to Admin > Dashboard and click Restart  
to restart the system.  
The system fails over to the primary server.  
Failover to a Redundant Polycom CMA 5000 System Server  
In a redundant configuration, the CMA 5000 system automatically fails over  
from the primary server to the redundant server. However, you can also  
manually initiate a failover.  
To manually initiate a failover  
1
On either server, go to Admin > Server Settings > Redundant  
Configuration.  
Polycom, Inc.  
437  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
2
On the Redundant Configuration page, click Switch Server Role.  
The system initiates a failover to the other server.  
Discontinue Redundancy on a Polycom CMA 5000 System  
Configuration  
In some circumstances, you may need to discontinue redundancy. Use this  
procedure to do so, but only when the system is in a valid redundant state.  
To discontinue a redundant Polycom CMA 5000 system configuration:  
1
2
3
Log into the CMA 5000 system using the virtual IP address.  
Failover to the redundant server. See page 437.  
On the redundant server:  
a
b
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Database.  
On the Database page, deselect the Use an external SQL Server  
database check box.  
c
Click Update.  
The redundant server restarts.  
4
On the primary server:  
a
b
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Redundant Configuration.  
On the Redundant Configuration page, click Reset Redundant  
Configuration.  
The primary system restarts.  
438  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
34  
Gatekeeper Management  
This chapter describes how to work with gatekeepers within the Polycom®  
Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system. It includes these  
topics:  
Primary Gatekeeper Management Operations  
By default, the CMA system is made the primary gatekeeper during the First  
Time Setup process. Operations for managing the primary gatekeeper  
include:  
Edit the Primary Gatekeeper Settings  
To edit the primary CMA system gatekeeper settings  
1
2
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Primary Gatekeeper.  
On the Primary Gatekeeper page, make the required changes.  
The Primary Gatekeeper Settings include these fields:  
Polycom, Inc.  
439  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
Gatekeeper  
Identifier  
The gatekeeper identifier (ASCII-only) on the network,  
which is used by the endpoints and CMA system for  
communication.  
The maximum number of characters is 254. All ASCII  
characters are valid.  
Gatekeeper  
Description  
The description (AS.CII only) of this gatekeeper on the  
network.  
Default Gatekeeper When enabled, indicates that this CMA system is the  
default gatekeeper on the network.  
Allow Registration  
of  
Defines for the gatekeeper of which endpoints to allow  
to register. For more information, see “Device  
Registration  
Refresh (seconds)  
The number of days that the CMA system gatekeeper  
maintains the endpoint registration information, in case  
the endpoint has not yet received any.  
The default is 30days.  
Enter 999to prevent endpoint registrations from  
expiring automatically.  
Registration  
Refresh (seconds)  
The interval at which the CMA system sends  
“keep-alive” messages to registered endpoints to  
determine whether they are online. The default is 300  
seconds.  
If the endpoint responds with a registration request  
message, the endpoint is online. If not, the endpoint is  
offline.  
When the endpoint is registered to another gatekeeper,  
the CMA system still shows the endpoint’s status.  
To view the endpoint’s state (Online or Offline), go to  
Endpoint> Monitor View.  
Note  
Endpoints are Offline when they have been turned off  
or have been removed from the network. Endpoints  
return to an Online state when they have been turned  
on or have re-registered with CMA system.  
Maximum Neighbor  
Gatekeeper Hop  
Counts  
Limits the number of connections to make when an  
endpoint seeks dialing resolution. The default is  
3.  
Log calls to/from  
unregistered  
endpoints  
Logs calls to and from rogue endpoints. To view call  
logs, select System Management > Reports >  
Gatekeeper Message Log.  
440  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Gatekeeper Management  
Field  
Description  
Deny calls to/from  
unregistered  
endpoints  
Prevents calls to and from rogue endpoints.  
Enable Real-Time  
Statistics  
Select this option to allow the gatekeeper to collect  
statistics from the endpoints.  
IRR frequency  
Specifies the interval (in seconds) at which endpoints  
that can report QoS (Quality of Service) measures will  
report them to the CMA system.  
By default, IRR is set to 0, which is equivalent to  
disabling the Real-time Statistics option. The valid IRR  
frequency range is 20 to 65535.  
Call Model  
Describes how the CMA system routes selected H.225  
call signaling messages (that is, SETUP, CALL  
PROCEEDING, ALERTING, CONNECT, and NOTIFY  
message).  
Possible values include: Routed or Direct. For more  
In any case, Q.931 messages (ARQ, ACF, ARJ, BRQ,  
BCF, and BRJ) are always sent through the CMA  
system gatekeeper.  
3
Click Update.  
Configure Prefixed Based Registration  
A user with administrator permissions can configure the CMA system so that  
only endpoints with specified E.164 prefixes are allowed to register to the  
H.323 gatekeeper.  
Note that when you apply this policy to a system with existing endpoints, all  
existing endpoints that fail to meet the new policy will fail to re-register with  
the gatekeeper. This will be flagged in the Endpoint > Monitor View as a  
gatekeeper registration error.  
To allow only the registration of endpoints with defined E.164 prefixes  
1
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Primary Gatekeeper.  
On the Primary Gatekeeper page, change the Allow Registration of  
setting to Predefined Prefixes Only.  
The Valid E.164 Prefixes entry box appears.  
2
Enter a range of prefixes in the From and To fields and click Add.  
The prefix range appears in the Allowed Prefix Ranges table.  
Polycom, Inc.  
441  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
3
Continue adding prefixes ranges as necessary. To delete a range, select  
the range and click the Delete button for it.  
When you’ve specified all the prefix ranges, click Update.  
Alternate Gatekeeper Management Operations  
Alternate Gatekeeper Management Operations include:  
Add an Alternate Gatekeeper  
To add an alternate gatekeeper  
1
2
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Alternate Gatekeeper.  
On the Alternate Gatekeeper page, enter the required gatekeeper  
information.  
The Alternate Gatekeeper Settings include these fields:  
Field  
Description  
Need to Register Check this box to require that a endpoint register with the  
alternate gatekeeper before sending other registration  
admission status requests.The default setting is  
unchecked.  
Alternate  
The alternate gatekeeper’s network identifier (ASCII only)  
Gatekeeper ID  
IP Address  
Port  
The IP address of the alternate gatekeeper  
The port number (usually 1719) that the alternate  
gatekeeper uses to communicate with endpoints  
Priority  
Indicates the alternate gatekeeper’s priority for endpoint  
registration. A lower number has higher priority (the range  
is  
alternate gatekeeper with a priority of 0. The default  
setting is  
0
to 127), so endpoints would first register with an  
0
.
3
Click Update.  
442  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Gatekeeper Management  
Edit the Alternate Gatekeeper Settings  
To edit the alternate gatekeeper settings  
1
2
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Alternate Gatekeeper.  
On the Alternate Gatekeeper page, make the required changes. For more  
3
Click Update.  
Remove the Alternate Gatekeeper  
To remove the alternate gatekeeper settings  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Alternate Gatekeeper.  
On the Alternate Gatekeeper page, clear the Need to Register check box.  
Click Update.  
Neighboring Gatekeeper Management Operations  
Neighboring Gatekeeper Management Operations include:  
View Neighboring Gatekeepers  
To view the neighboring gatekeepers  
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Neighboring Gatekeepers.  
The Neighboring Gatekeepers list appears.  
Column  
Name  
Description  
The name of the region  
The description of the region  
Description  
Polycom, Inc.  
443  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Add a Neighboring Gatekeeper  
To add a neighboring gatekeeper  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Neighboring Gatekeeper.  
On the Neighboring Gatekeeper page, click Add Neighbor.  
In the Add Neighbor dialog box, enter the required gatekeeper  
information and click Save.  
The neighboring gatekeeper is added to the system.  
Edit a Neighboring Gatekeeper  
To edit the settings for a neighboring gatekeeper  
1
2
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Neighboring Gatekeeper.  
On the Neighboring Gatekeeper page, select the neighboring gatekeeper  
of interest and click Edit Neighbor.  
3
4
In the Edit Neighbor dialog box, make the required changes and click  
Update.  
You’ll need to reboot the CMA system to make the change effective.  
Delete a Neighboring Gatekeeper  
To delete a neighboring gatekeeper  
1
2
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Neighboring Gatekeeper.  
On the Neighboring Gatekeeper page, select the neighboring gatekeeper  
of interest and click Delete.  
3
Click Delete to confirm the deletion.  
444  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
35  
Management & Security Operations  
This chapter describes the Polycom® Converged Management Application™  
(CMA®) system management and security tasks. It includes these topics:  
Update the Polycom CMA System Software  
To update a CMA system with a new software version, complete the following  
tasks:  
1
2
3
4
5
Download the software upgrade file.  
Obtain an upgrade key code.  
Save a backup of the CMA system databases.  
Perform the software upgrade.  
Verify the upgrade.  
Polycom, Inc.  
445  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
For more information on performing each of these tasks, see the Polycom CMA  
System Upgrade Guide.  
Manage Certificates  
Certificates are a security technology that assists networked computers in  
determining whether to trust each other. Each digital certificate is identified by  
its public key. The collection of all public keys used in an enterprise to  
determine trust is known as a Public Key Infrastructure (PKI).  
To manage digital certificates, an enterprise must:  
Establish a Public Key Infrastructure using one or more Certificate  
Authorities (CA). Typically, an enterprise’s IT department has a CA but  
commercial CAs may be used as well.  
Configure each computer that participates in the PKI with a digital  
certificate that identifies it. The certificate must be signed by one of the  
CAs in the PKI  
Configure each computer that participates in the PKI to trust the PKI's  
Certificate Authorities  
Ensure that the PKI is used to protect data exchange by configuring each  
system to use encryption protocols such as Secure Sockets Layer (SSL)  
and/or Transport Level Security (TLS).  
Certificates Accepted by the Polycom CMA System  
By default, to support encrypted communications and establish a minimum  
level of trust, the CMA system presents a self-signed digital certificate to its  
clients. This default certificate will typically not be trusted by clients. Web  
browsers that connect to the CMA system user interface will display a warning  
regarding the certificate.  
Participation in a Public Key Infrastructure requires a CMA system to have  
been configured with at least one root CA certificate, a current certificate  
revocation list (CRL) from the CA, and a digital certificate signed by the CA  
that identifies the CMA system.  
446  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Management & Security Operations  
Certificates come in several forms (encoding and protocol). The following  
table shows the forms that can be installed in the CMA system.  
Standard /  
Encoding  
File Type  
Description and Installation Method  
PEM  
(Base64-encoded  
ASCII text)  
PKCS #7  
standard  
Certificate chain containing:  
A signed certificate for the system,  
authenticating its public key.  
P7B file  
The CA’s public certificate.  
Sometimes intermediate  
certificates.  
Upload file or paste into text box.  
CER (single  
certificate) file  
Signed certificate for the system,  
authenticating its public key.  
Upload file or paste into text box.  
Certificate text  
Encoded certificate text copied from  
CA’s E-mail or secure web page.  
Paste into text box.  
DER  
PKCS #12  
standard  
Certificate chain containing:  
(binary format  
using ASN.1  
Abstract Syntax  
Notation)  
A signed certificate for the system,  
authenticating its public key.  
PFX file  
A private key for the system.  
The CA’s public certificate.  
Sometimes intermediate  
certificates.  
Upload file.  
PKCS #7  
standard  
Certificate chain containing:  
A signed certificate for the system,  
authenticating its public key.  
P7B file  
The CA’s public certificate.  
Sometimes intermediate  
certificates.  
Upload file.  
CER (single  
certificate) file  
(X.509 standard  
format)  
Digital certificate that uniquely identifies  
the system within the PKI.  
Upload file.  
Polycom, Inc.  
447  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Certificate Operations  
In maximum security mode, the root CA certificate must be installed during  
First Time Setup. However, you can complete First Time Setup with just the  
root CA certificate and the CMA system default self-signed certificate. Then  
you can complete the process using the Certificate Management page.  
In standard security mode, you can set up certificates at any time.  
Use the Certificate Management page to:  
View Certificates and Certificate Details  
To view the list of installed certificates  
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security > Certificate Management.  
The Certificate Management page displays the list of currently installed  
certificates. By default, the system will display only one certificate. It will  
be identified as the CMA server identity certificate. When other certificates  
are installed, they will display along with the server identity certificate.  
The Certificate Management page has this information.  
Column  
Description  
Status  
The status of the certificate. Possible values include:  
Certificate is valid  
Certificate is invalid  
Identifier  
The certificate name as assigned by the CA  
448  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Management & Security Operations  
Column  
Description  
The type of certificate. Possible values are:  
Purpose  
CMA server identity—the system identity  
certificate.  
Trusted root certificate—the root certificate for a  
CA.  
Intermediate certificate—certificate from an  
intermediate CA.  
Trusted peer—certificate from any server or  
computer that is not a CA but whose identity is  
trusted. The trusted peer certificate must be  
signed by one of the CAs installed in the CMA.  
Expiration  
The expiration date of the certificate.  
CRL Next Update  
The date by which a new certificate revocation list  
from the CA must be uploaded.  
IMPORTANT  
If an administrator does not upload a new CRL by  
the CRL Next Update date, the system will  
become unresponsive. Recovering from this  
situation requires reinstalling from the recovery  
disk, manually reconfiguring of identity and root  
certificates, and restoring the system from a  
system backup.  
2
To view more information about a certificate, select the certificate and  
click View Certificate Details.  
The Certificate Details dialog box appears with this information.  
Section  
Description  
Certificate Info  
Issued To  
Purpose and alias of the certificate.  
Information about the entity to which the certificate  
was issued and the certificate serial number.  
Issued By  
Validity  
Information about the issuer.  
Issue and expiration dates.  
Fingerprints  
SHA1 and MD5 fingerprints (checksums) for  
confirming certificate.  
Public Key  
CRL Info  
The CMA public key, which in the public key system  
is distributed widely, and is not kept secure.  
The date by which the current certificate revocation  
list must be replaced by a new list and the version of  
the list.  
Polycom, Inc.  
449  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
3
Use the arrows to reveal or hide information. Click Close when you are  
done.  
Create a Certificate Signing Request  
Although the initial CMA system configuration permits using the default,  
self-signed certificate, normal operation in a secure mode requires that you  
install a digital certificate signed by a trusted certificate authority that  
uniquely identifies the CMA system within your public key infrastructure.  
This can be done by creating a certificate signing request for the CMA system  
and submitting it to a certificate authority to be signed.  
Note  
Although it is common for a system to be identified by any number of digital  
certificates, each signed by a different CA, the CMA system currently only supports  
a single identity certificate.  
This procedure describes how to create a certificate signing request (CSR) to  
submit to a certificate authority.  
To create a certificate signing request  
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security > Certificate Management.  
The Certificate Management page displays the list of currently available  
certificates. By default, the system will have one server certificate  
identified as the CMA server identity certificate and one or more root  
certificates or certificate chains.  
2
Click Create Certificate Signing Request.  
If you see the warning “This action will overwrite any previously  
generated or uploaded private key. Do you want to continue?,” do one of  
the following:  
If you are waiting for a previous request to be signed, click No.  
Because the CMA system currently supports only one identity  
certificate, only the most recent private key is retained. The digital  
certificate resulting from the most recent CSR is the only certificate  
that will match the retained private key and is therefore the only  
identity certificate that can be installed.  
If this is a new certificate signing request, click Yes to continue.  
450  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Management & Security Operations  
3
In the Certificate Information dialog box, enter the identifying  
information for your CMA system and click OK.  
Field  
Description  
Country Name  
Two-letter (ASCII only) ISO 3166 country code in  
which the server is located.  
State or Province  
Name  
Full state or province name (ASCII only) in which the  
server is located.  
Locality Name  
City name (ASCII only) in which the server is located.  
Organization Name  
Enterprise name (ASCII only) at which the server is  
located.  
Organizational Unit  
Name  
Subdivision (ASCII only) of the enterprise at which  
the server is located. Optional. Multiple values are  
permitted, one per line.  
Common Name (CN)  
IPv4 Address  
The host name of the system (read-only), as defined  
in the network settings.  
The IPv4 address of the system (read-only), as  
defined in the network settings.  
IPv6 Address  
When applicable, the IPv6 address of the system, as  
defined in the network settings.  
Email Address  
E-mail address (ASCII only) for a contact at the  
enterprise.  
A File Download dialog box appears.  
4
5
In the File Download dialog box, click Save.  
In the Save As dialog box, enter a unique name for the file, browse to the  
location to which to save the file, and click Save.  
6
Submit the file (or text within the file) as required by your certificate  
authority.  
When your certificate authority has processed your request, it sends you  
a signed digital certificate for your CMA system. Some certificate  
authorities send only the signed digital certificate while others send all of  
the certificates that form the chain of trust (including intermediate and/or  
root CA certificates). These certificates may arrive as e-mail text, e-mail  
attachments, or be available on a secure web page.  
Install a Certificate  
This procedure describes how to install a certificate or certificate chain  
provided by a certificate authority. It assumes that you’ve received the  
certificate or certificate chain in one of the formats accepted by the CMA  
Polycom, Inc.  
451  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
CAUTION  
Installing certificates requires a system restart and terminates all active  
conferences.  
When you install a certificate, the change is made to the certificate store  
immediately, but the system can’t implement the change until it restarts and reads  
the changed certificate store.  
To install a signed certificate that identifies the CMA system  
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security > Certificate Management  
and click Install Certificates.  
A warning appears stating that changes made to the certificates will  
require a system restart to take effect.  
2
In the Add Certificates dialog box, do one of the following:  
If you have a PFX, P7B, or single certificate file, click Upload  
certificate, enter the password (if any) for the file, and browse to the  
file or enter the path and file name.  
If you have PEM-format text, copy the certificate text, click Paste  
certificate, and paste it into the text box below. You can paste multiple  
PEM certificates one after the other.  
3
4
Click OK.  
If you are uploading a signed identity certificate for the first time, it will  
replace the CMA system self-signed certificate.  
If you are uploading a signed identity certificate for the first time, you can  
verify that the new signed certificate has replaced the default self-signed  
certificate:  
a
In the list of certificates, select the CMA server identity certificate and  
click View Certificate Details.  
b
When the Certificate Details dialog box appears, verify that the  
information in the Issued To and Issued By sections has been  
replaced by the signed public certificate from the certificate authority.  
c
Click OK to close the dialog box.  
CAUTION  
The CMA 6.2 system requires certificates with Client and Server Authentication in  
the Enhanced Key Usage field, otherwise the certificate installation will fail.  
Upload a Certificate Revocation List  
This section describes how to install a certificate revocation list (CRL)  
provided by a certificate authority.  
452  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Management & Security Operations  
The CMA system requires a CRL for each CA or sub-CA in the certificate  
chain. The CMA system also requires that you upload a new CRL at regular  
intervals. This interval can be as short as a few days in higher security  
environments or a few months in environments with lower security  
requirements.  
IMPORTANT  
If an administrator does not upload a new CRL by the CRL Next Update date, the  
system will become unresponsive. Recovering from this situation requires  
reinstalling from the recovery disk, manually reconfiguring of identity and root  
certificates, and restoring the system from a system backup  
To upload a certificate revocation list  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Management and Security > Certificate Management  
and click Upload Certificate Revocation List.  
In the Select file dialog box, browse to the location of the CRL that you  
obtained from the CA and select the file.  
Click Open.  
Delete a Certificate  
You can delete certificates from the CMA system, but the CMA system  
prevents you from deleting any certificate that breaks the identity certificate’s  
chain of trust. To delete these certificates, new CA certificates must be installed  
and the identity certificate must be replaced.  
Caution  
Removing certificates requires a system restart, which terminates all active  
conferences.  
When you remove a certificate, the change is made to the certificate store  
immediately, but the system can’t implement the change until it restarts and reads  
the changed certificate store.  
To delete a certificate  
1
2
3
Admin > Management and Security > Certificate Management.  
The Certificate Management page displays the list of currently available  
certificates.  
Select the certificate to be deleted and click Delete Certificate.  
A warning appears stating that changes made to the certificates will  
require a system restart to take effect.  
Click Yes to continue.  
Polycom, Inc.  
453  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
4
When prompted, click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
A dialog box informs you that the certificate has been deleted.  
View the Expiration Dates for Certificates and CRLs  
Certificates and certificate revocation lists expire. To view their expiration  
Change the System User Interface Timeout and Number of  
Sessions  
To change the CMA system user interface timeout and number of sessions  
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Session  
Management.  
2
On the Session Management page, configure these settings as needed.  
Field  
Description  
CMA user interface  
timeout  
By default, the CMA system user interface times out  
after 10 minutes of inactivity. Use this procedure to  
change the timeout value for the user interface inactivity  
timer. Possible value is 5 to 60 minutes.  
Maximum number  
of sessions per  
user  
The number of simultaneous login sessions per user ID.  
By default, the maximum number of sessions per user  
ID is 5. Possible value is 1 to 10 sessions.  
Maximum number  
of sessions per  
system  
The number of simultaneous login sessions by all users.  
By default, the maximum number of sessions by all  
users is 50. Possible value is 2 to 50 sessions.  
Note  
If this limit is reached, but none of the logged-in users is  
an Administrator, the first Administrator user to arrive is  
granted access, and the system terminates the  
non-Administrator session that’s been idle the longest.  
3
Click Update.  
454  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Management & Security Operations  
Give Enterprise Users Default Scheduler Role  
By default when local users are added to the CMA system, they are assigned  
the Scheduler role. By default, when you integrate a CMA system to an Active  
Directory, enterprise users are not assigned a role. In this case, you must either  
assign each enterprise user a role, or you can use this procedure to give  
enterprise users the Scheduler role by default.  
To give enterprise users default Scheduler role for a Polycom CMA system  
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Session  
Management.  
2
3
Select the CMA access via default profile allowed option.  
Click Update.  
Change the Message for Enterprise Users without a Role  
To change the message enterprise users without a role see when they try to log  
into a Polycom CMA system  
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Session  
Management.  
2
Edit the Message to be displayed to unauthorized users.  
For example, enter a message such as “Your username and password are  
valid, but you have no permissions on this system. Contact your IT  
department for more information.”  
3
Click Update.  
Control Remote Desktop Connections to the CMA System  
By default, users can access the CMA system using the Windows Remote  
Desktop Connection. You can disable this ability.  
To control CMA system access with Remote Desktop Connection  
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Session  
Management.  
2
3
Clear the Enable remote desktop connections option.  
Click Update.  
Polycom, Inc.  
455  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Automatic Registration Synchronization  
You can configure the CMA system to send registration server addressing  
information for the gatekeeper and/or global directory server (GDS) when the  
endpoint is registered to the CMA system.  
Note  
For the CMA system, the GDS is the same as the global address book (GAB).  
This automatic registration synchronization service only works for endpoints  
that register with the gatekeeper or GDS or are manually added to the CMA  
system after the Automatic Registration Synchronization setting is enabled.  
So if the Automatic Registration Synchronization setting is enabled and an  
endpoint registers with the gatekeeper, the gatekeeper addressing information  
is sent to the endpoint. If the Automatic Registration Synchronization setting  
is enabled and an endpoint registers with the GDS, the GDS addressing  
information is sent to the endpoint. If the Automatic Registration  
Synchronization setting is enabled and an endpoint is added manually to the  
CMA system, both the gatekeeper and GDS addressing information is sent to  
the endpoint.  
If automatic discovery and configuration is not successful, you can manually  
add endpoints.  
Notes  
Automatic Registration Synchronization works only for endpoints that  
register with the gatekeeper or Global Directory Server after the setting is  
enabled; it does not automatically register pre-existing endpoints.  
The CMA system only supports Automatic Registration Synchronization for  
Polycom and selected third-party endpoints operating in standard mode. For  
supported endpoint types, including third-party endpoint types, see “Endpoint  
Types” on page 87.  
To enable Automatic Registration Synchronization of endpoints  
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Endpoint  
Management Settings.  
2
In the Automatic Registration Synchronization section of the Endpoint  
Management Settings page, select Synchronize endpoint registration  
and click Update.  
After you have changed this setting, all endpoints you add are  
automatically provisioned.  
456  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Management & Security Operations  
Set Common Passwords for Endpoints  
The Common Password feature allows you to manage endpoints that have the  
same global administrative password. However, it cannot reset the  
administrative password on endpoints.  
If you use the Common Password feature, access to password-protected data  
within endpoints is granted if the specified common password matches the  
endpoints’ Administrator Password.  
To set common passwords for endpoints  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Endpoint  
Management Settings.  
In the Common Password section of the Endpoint Management Settings  
page, select Use a Common Password.  
Enter the common User Name and the common password in the  
Password and Verify Password fields and click Update.  
Note  
Leave these settings blank if your Polycom endpoints require individual passwords  
or do not have passwords. To configure a global administrative password for all  
Polycom endpoints, use scheduled provisioning.  
Disable Common Password for Endpoints  
To disable common passwords for endpoints  
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Endpoint  
Management Settings.  
2
In the Common Password section of the Endpoint Management Settings  
page, clear Use a Common Password and click Update.  
The common password feature is disabled. However, the values for the  
common password feature are retained in the database, so it can be easily  
re-enabled.  
Polycom, Inc.  
457  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Set Local Account Lockout and Timeout  
To set local account lockout and timeout  
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Local User  
Account Configuration.  
2
On the Local User Account Configuration page, configure these settings  
as needed.  
Field  
Description  
Account Lockout  
Failed login  
threshold  
Specify how many consecutive login failures cause the  
system to lock an account. Possible value is 2 to 10.  
Failed login  
window (hours)  
Specify the time span within which the consecutive  
failures must occur in order to lock the account.  
Possible value is 1 to 24.  
Customized user  
account lockout  
duration (minutes)  
Specify how long the user’s account remains locked.  
Possible value is 1 to 480.  
Account Inactivity  
Customize account  
inactivity threshold  
(days)  
Specify the inactivity threshold that triggers disabling of  
inactive accounts. Possible value is 30 to 180.  
3
Click Update.  
Set Local Password Requirements  
The Local Password Requirements page allows users assigned the  
Administrator role to change, but not disable password, security  
requirements by specifying password age, length, and complexity.  
To set local password requirements  
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Local Password  
Requirements.  
458  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Management & Security Operations  
2
On the Local Password Requirements page, configure these settings as  
needed.  
Field  
Description  
Password Management  
Minimum length  
(characters)  
Specify the number of characters a password must  
contain. Possible value is 8 to 18.  
Minimum changed  
characters  
Specify the number of characters that must be  
different from the previous password. Possible value  
is 1 to 4.  
Minimum password  
age (days)  
Specify how frequently a password can be changed.  
Possible value is 1 to 30.  
Maximum password  
age (days)  
Specify at what age a password expires. Possible  
value is 30 to 180.  
Password warning  
interval (days)  
Specify when users start to see a warning about  
their password expiration. Possible value is 1 to 7.  
Reject previous  
passwords  
Specify how many of the user’s previous passwords  
the system remembers and won’t permit to be  
reused. Possible value is 8 to 16.  
Password Complexity  
Lowercase letters  
Specify the number of lowercase letters (a-z) that a  
password must contain. Possible value is 1 or 2.  
Uppercase letters  
Numbers  
Specify the number of uppercase letters (A-Z) that a  
password must contain. Possible value is 1 or 2.  
Specify the number of digit characters (0-9) that a  
password must contain. Possible value is 1 or 2.  
Special characters  
Specify the number of non-alphanumeric keyboard  
characters that a password must contain. Possible  
value is 1 or 2.  
Maximum consecutive Specify how many sequential characters may be the  
repeated characters  
same. Possible value is 1 to 4.  
3
Click Update.  
Polycom, Inc.  
459  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Add Machine Accounts  
For dynamically managed endpoints associated with a room, a user assigned  
the Administrator role must associate each room in the CMA system with a  
machine account. The machine account allows the room’s endpoint to connect  
and authenticate with the CMA system for directory and dynamic  
management purposes without using the endpoint user’s account.  
You can setup the room and machine account the following ways:  
You can set up a machine account and create a new room at the same time,  
then edit the room to complete the room information.  
You can create a new room, then create the machine account and associate  
the machine account with the existing room. For more informaiotn, see  
In a maximum security environment, dynamically managed HDX systems  
also require a machine account for each HDX that the CMA system will  
manage. The machine account allows the endpoint to connect and authenticate  
with the CMA system for dynamic management purposes without using the  
endpoint user’s account.  
The Add Machine Account dialog box includes the following information.  
Field  
Description  
Enable Machine  
Account  
Select or clear this option to enable and disable  
(respectively) the machine account you create for the  
endpoint.  
Unlock Machine  
Account  
Select this option to unlock machine accounts that  
become locked when they exceed the Failed login  
threshold. This will only happen when the password  
expires.  
User ID  
Enter a unique name for the machine account.  
As a best practice, name the machine account in a way  
that associates it with the corresponding device. For  
example, if your company names endpoint systems for  
the system user or room (for example, bsmith_HDXor  
Evergreen_Room), then give the machine account an  
associated User ID (bsmith_HDX_machineor  
evergreen_room_machine).  
Password/  
Confirm Password  
Enter a password for the machine account user ID.  
This password must meet the Local Password  
Requirements. This password expires in 365 days.  
460  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Management & Security Operations  
Field  
Description  
Description  
Enter a meaningful description for the endpoint.  
Associate with an  
existing user or room  
Select this option to associate the endpoint system with  
a specific user or room. This may be a local or  
enterprise user or room.  
Associate with a new  
room (created  
automatically)  
Select this option to associate the endpoint system with  
a system-generated room. The name of the new room is  
the same as the machine account User Name and can  
be edited when you edit the room.  
Once you have created this machine account on the CMA system, provide this  
information to the appropriate HDX system administrator. They should enter  
this User ID and Password as the User Name and Password on the HDX  
Provisioning Service page.  
Note that the machine account password expires after one year. After the  
expiration, the HDX login will fail. After three failed login attempts, the  
system locks the machine account. You can reset the password and unlock the  
machine account by editing it and assigning a new password.  
To add a machine account  
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Machine  
Accounts.  
2
3
4
Click Add.  
In the Add Machine Account dialog box, complete the fields.  
Click OK.  
Change Internal Database Passwords  
The CMA system uses three user names to access internal databases. You can  
change the passwords for those user names to comply with any requirements  
you may have to change passwords on a regular basis.  
You also use the user listed as PlcmDbo if you should need to reformat your  
internal database. For more information, see “Reformat the Existing Database”  
The system will restart after you change these passwords. Make sure that you  
use this function when no conferences are active or scheduled.  
To change internal database passwords  
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Database Security.  
Polycom, Inc.  
461  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
2
3
4
Select the database user whose password you want to change.  
Click Change Password.  
In the Change Database User Password dialog, enter the new password  
in the New Password and Confirm New Password fields.  
If you want the system to generate a password, click Create Password. Be  
sure to write down the password that displays.  
5
6
Click OK.  
Click Apply Password Changes.  
The system resets the passwords and restarts. It may take the CMA system  
up to 10 minutes to shut down and then restart all server processes.  
462  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
36  
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
This chapter describes how to edit the default Polycom CMA system Dial Plan  
settings to support your company’s site topology. It includes these topics:  
Site Operations  
Site operations include:  
Polycom, Inc.  
463  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
View the Graphical Site Topology  
To view the graphical site topology  
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Site Topology.  
The Site Topology page appears. It graphically displays the sites and site  
links defined to the CMA system.  
Hover over a map element to view information about it.  
Use the slider bar to zoom in or out on the map.  
Select or deselect elements (Site Links, Bandwidth, or Site Names) to  
change what is displayed on the map.  
Use the Select Sites drop-down list to filter (by site name, territory  
name, IP address, network devices, and alerts) which sites are  
displayed on the map.  
View the Sites List  
To view the Sites list  
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Sites.  
The Sites list appears. It includes this information:  
Column  
Description  
Name  
Name of the site.  
Description of the site.  
Description  
Country Code  
The country code for the country in which the site is  
located.  
Area Code  
The city or area code for the site. Do not include a  
leading zero. For example, the city code for Paris is  
01; however, enter 1 in this field.  
Max Bandwidth  
(Mbps)  
The total bandwidth limit for audio and video calls.  
Max Bit Rate (Kbps)  
Territory  
The per-call bandwidth limit for audio and video calls.  
The territory to which the site belongs, which  
determines the CMA system responsible for it.  
464  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
Add a Site  
To add a site  
1
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Sites or Admin > Dial Plan and  
Sites > Site Topology.  
2
3
In the Sites list or Site Topology page, click Add Site.  
In the Add Site dialog box, enter a Site Name and Description for the  
site.  
4
5
6
Complete the General Info, Routing, Subnet, and if applicable ISDN  
Number Assignment, sections of the Add Site dialog box. The minimum  
information required is Site Name, Description, Location, and Subnets.  
Click OK.  
The new site is added to the system and the Edit Site Provisioning dialog  
box appears. These are the site-based parameters that the CMA system  
automatically provisions to endpoint systems operating in dynamic  
management mode.  
As needed, edit the default site provisioning details and click Apply.  
Note  
Not all of the site provisioning parameters apply to all endpoint systems being  
provisioned. If an endpoint system does not have a corresponding parameter, it  
ignores the parameter.  
Field  
For the endpoint systems at the site being provisioned...  
Date and Time Settings  
Country  
Specify the country code for their location.  
Date Format  
Specify the date display format.  
Auto Adjust for  
Specify whether or not to adjust the endpoint’s system clock for daylight savings time.  
Daylight Saving Time  
Time Format  
Specify the time display format.  
Polycom, Inc.  
465  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
For the endpoint systems at the site being provisioned...  
Time Server  
Specify whether to connect to a time server for automatic system time settings.  
Select Auto to require that the video endpoint system synchronize with an external time  
server that is identified by a network domain controller. Because it is identified by a  
network domain controller, you do not need to enter the IP address of the time server.  
Select Manual to require that the video endpoint system synchronize with an external  
time server that may not be identified by a network domain controller. In this case, you  
must also enter the IP address of the time server in the Time Server Address field.  
If Time Server is set to Off, or if the Time Server is set to Manual or Auto but the  
endpoint system cannot connect to the time server, the date and time must be manually  
reset at the endpoint.  
Primary Time Server  
Address  
Specify the address of the primary time server when Time Server is set to Manual.  
Secondary Time  
Server Address  
Specify the address of the secondary time server when Time Server is set to Manual.  
Timezone  
Specify the time difference between GMT (Greenwich Mean Time) and the endpoint  
system’s location.  
Firewall Settings  
Use Fixed Ports  
Specify whether to define the TCP and UDP ports.  
If the firewall is H.323 compatible or the endpoint systems are not behind a firewall,  
disable this setting.  
If the firewall is not H.323 compatible, enable this setting. The endpoint systems will  
assign a range of ports starting with the TCP and UDP ports you specify. The endpoint  
system defaults to a range beginning with port 3230 for both TCP and UDP.  
Note  
You must open the corresponding ports in the firewall. You must also open the firewall’s  
TCP port 1720 to allow H.323 traffic.  
Start TCP Port  
Start UDP Port  
Lets you specify the beginning value for the range of TCP ports used by the endpoint  
systems. The endpoint systems will automatically assign a range of ports starting with the  
port you specify.  
Note  
You must also open the firewall’s TCP port 1720 to allow H.323 traffic.  
Lets you specify the beginning value for the range of TCP ports used by the endpoint  
systems. The endpoint systems will automatically assign a range of ports starting with the  
port you specify.  
Enable H.460 Firewall  
Traversal  
Allows the endpoint system to use H.460-based firewall traversal. For more information,  
see the Administrator’s Guide for Polycom HDX Systems.  
466  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
Field  
For the endpoint systems at the site being provisioned...  
NAT Configuration  
Specify whether the endpoint systems should determine the NAT Public WAN Address  
automatically.  
If the endpoint systems are behind a NAT that allows HTTP traffic, select Auto.  
If the endpoint systems are behind a NAT that does not allow HTTP traffic, select  
Manual. Then specify a NAT Public (WAN) Address.  
If the endpoint systems are not behind a NAT or are connected to the IP network  
through a virtual private network (VPN), select Off.  
NAT Public (WAN)  
Address  
When NAT Configuration is set to Manual, specify the address that callers from outside  
the LAN should use to call the endpoint systems.  
NAT is H.323  
Compatible  
Specify that the endpoint systems are behind a NAT that is capable of translating H.323  
traffic.  
Address Displayed in  
Global Directory  
Specify whether to include the endpoint system’s information in the global directory  
Select Private to exclude the endpoint from the global directory  
Select Public to include the endpoint in the global directory  
H323 Settings  
Enable IP H.323  
Use Gatekeeper  
Specify whether to enable IP H.323 calls.  
When IP H.323 is enabled, Specify whether the endpoint systems will use the CMA  
system as its gatekeeper or another gatekeeper. Gateways and gatekeepers are  
required for calls between IP and ISDN.  
This Server — The endpoint systems will use the CMA system as their gatekeeper.  
Specify — The endpoint systems will use another system as their gatekeeper.  
Gatekeeper IP  
Address  
When Use Gatekeeper is set to Specify, enter the gatekeeper IP address in this field.  
Use Gatekeeper for  
Multipoint Calls  
Specify whether multipoint calls use the endpoint system’s internal multipoint capability or  
the Polycom MCU’s Conference on Demand feature. This feature is available only if the  
system is registered with a PathNavigator or CMA system gatekeeper.  
SIP Settings  
Enable SIP  
Specify whether to enable SIP calls.  
Automatically Discover  
SIP Servers  
The CMA system will issue a DNS query to locate the SIP server and provision that  
information to endpoints.  
Proxy Server  
Specify the IP address or DNS name of the SIP proxy server for the network.  
Specify the IP address or DNS name of the SIP registrar server for the network.  
Registrar Server  
In an Microsoft Office Communications Server 2007 or Microsoft Lync Server 2010  
environment, specify the IP address or DNS name of the Office Communications  
Server or Lync Server server.  
If registering a remote HDX system with an Office Communications Server Edge  
Server or Lync Server Edge Server, use the fully qualified domain name of the access  
edge server role.  
Backup Proxy Server  
Specify the IP address or DNS name of a backup SIP proxy server for the network.  
Polycom, Inc.  
467  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
For the endpoint systems at the site being provisioned...  
Backup Registrar  
Server  
Specify the IP address or DNS name of a backup SIP registrar server for the network  
Transport Protocol  
Indicates the protocol the system uses for SIP signaling. The SIP network infrastructure  
determines which protocol is required.  
Auto enables an automatic negotiation of protocols in the following order: TLS, TCP,  
UDP. This is the recommended setting for most environments.  
TCP provides reliable transport via TCP for SIP signaling.  
UDP provides best-effort transport via UDP for SIP signaling.  
TLS provides secure communication of the SIP signaling. TLS is available only when  
the system is registered with a SIP server that supports TLS. When you choose this  
setting, the system ignores TCP/UDP port 5060..  
SIP Server Type  
Verify Certificate  
Specify whether the SIP registrar server is a Microsoft Office Communications Server or  
a Microsoft® Lync™ Server 2010. Enabling this setting activates integration features  
such as the Microsoft global directory and Office Communicator contact sharing with  
presence.  
Enable this option when the endpoint system’s certificate should be verified by the  
certificate authority.  
Use Enterprise  
Credentials  
Enable this option when the endpoint system should use the credentials the user entered  
at the endpoint to use for authenticate when registering with a SIP registrar server.  
User Name  
Specify the name to use for authentication when registering with a SIP registrar server,  
for example, [email protected]. If the SIP proxy requires authentication, this field  
and the password cannot be blank.  
Password  
Specify the password that authenticates the system to the registrar server.  
Provisioning Settings  
Provisioning Polling  
Interval (minutes)  
Specify the frequency at which the endpoint systems poll the CMA system for new  
provisioning information.  
By default, this interval is 60 minutes. For performance reasons, the minimum positive  
value for this interval is 5 minutes. There is no maximum value enforced. When the value  
of this interval is set to 0, the endpoint systems do not poll the CMA system for new  
provisioning information.  
Software Update  
Polling Interval  
(minutes)  
Specify the frequency at which the endpoint systems poll the CMA system for a new  
software update package.  
By default, this interval is 60 minutes. For performance reasons, the minimum positive  
value for this interval is 5 minutes. There is no maximum value enforced. When the value  
of this interval is set to 0, the endpoint systems do not poll the CMA system for a new  
software update package.  
Quality of Service Settings  
Video Type of Service  
Value  
Specify the IP Precedence or Diffserv value for video packets.  
Audio Type of Service  
Value  
Specify the IP Precedence or Diffserv value for audio packets.  
468  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
Field  
For the endpoint systems at the site being provisioned...  
FECC Type of Service  
Value  
Specify the IP Precedence or Diffserv value for Far End Camera Control packets.  
Type of Service Field  
Specify the service type and the priority of IP packets sent to the system for video, audio,  
and far-end camera control:  
IP Precedence — Represents the priority of IP packets sent to the system. The value  
can be between 0 and 5.  
DiffServ — Represents a priority level between 0 and 63. If this setting is selected,  
enter the value in the Type of Service Value field.  
Maximum  
Transmission Unit Size  
(bytes)  
Specify the Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) size used in IP calls. If the video  
becomes blocky or network errors occur, packets may be too large; decrease the MTU. If  
the network is burdened with unnecessary overhead, packets may be too small; increase  
the MTU.  
Enable PVEC  
Enable RSVP  
Allows the endpoint system to use PVEC (Polycom Video Error Concealment) if packet  
loss occurs. PVEC delivers smooth, clear video over IP networks by concealing the  
deteriorating effects of packet loss  
Allows the endpoint system to use Resource Reservation Setup Protocol (RSVP) to  
request that routers reserve bandwidth along an IP connection path. Both the near site  
and far site must support RSVP in order for reservation requests to be made to routers  
on the connection path.  
Enable Dynamic  
Bandwidth  
Specify whether to let the endpoint system automatically find the optimum line speed for  
a call.  
Maximum Transmit  
Bandwidth (Kbps)  
Specify the maximum transmission line speed.  
Maximum Receive  
Bandwidth (Kbps)  
Specify the maximum reception line speed.  
Security Settings  
Security Profile  
Read-only field. Displays the security level of the CMA system.  
Use Room Password  
for Remote Access  
Specify whether the local endpoint system password and remote access password are  
the same.  
Room Password  
Enter or change the local endpoint system password here.  
When the local password is set, you must enter it to configure the system Admin Settings  
using the remote control. The local password must not contain spaces.  
Administrator ID  
Enter the administrative account that should be used to access the endpoint system  
remotely.  
Remote Access  
Password  
For endpoint systems, enter or change the remote access password here.  
When the remote access password is set, you must enter it to upgrade the software or  
manage the endpoint systems from a computer. The remote access password cannot  
include spaces.  
Polycom, Inc.  
469  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
For the endpoint systems at the site being provisioned...  
Meeting Password  
Specify the password users must supply to join multipoint calls on this endpoint system if  
the call uses the internal multipoint option, rather than a bridge.  
This field can also be used to store a password required by another endpoint system that  
this system calls. If a password is stored in this field, you do not need to enter it at the  
time of the call; the endpoint system supplies it to the system that requires it. The  
meeting password cannot include spaces.  
Enable Secure Mode  
Specify whether to operate in secure mode (also known as security mode), which uses  
TLS, HTTPS, AES, digital signatures, and other security protocols, algorithms, and  
mechanisms. These protocols encrypt management communication over IP, preventing  
access by unauthorized users.  
When devices at a site are provisioned to operate in secure mode, the CMA system can  
only perform the dynamic management operations of automatic provisioning, automatic  
software update, and directory and presence services for the devices. The CMA system  
cannot perform monitoring or control operations for the devices.  
For more information, see the Administrator’s Guide for Polycom HDX Systems.  
AES Encryption  
Specify how to encrypt calls with other sites that support AES encryption.  
Off—No encryption is used.  
When Available—AES Encryption is used with any endpoint that supports it, even if  
the other endpoints in the call don’t support it.  
Required for Video Calls Only—AES Encryption is used for all video endpoints in  
the call. Analog phone and voice over ISDN connections are allowed. Video  
endpoints must support AES Encryption to participate in the call.  
Required for All Calls—AES Encryption is used for all video endpoints in the call.  
Analog phone and voice over ISDN connections are not allowed. All endpoints must.  
support AES Encryption to participate in the call.  
Enable Web Access  
Enable Telnet Access  
Enable SNMP Access  
Specify whether to allow remote access to the endpoint system by the web.  
Note  
The endpoint systems will restart if the remote access settings are changed. This setting  
does not deactivate the associated port, only the application. Use the Web Access Port  
setting to disable the port.  
Specify whether to allow remote access to the system by Telnet.  
Note  
The endpoint systems will restart if the remote access settings are changed. This setting  
does not deactivate the associated port, only the application. Use the Web Access Port  
setting to disable the port.  
Specify whether to allow remote access to the system by SNMP.  
Note  
The endpoint systems will restart if the remote access settings are changed. This setting  
does not deactivate the associated port, only the application. Use the Web Access Port  
setting to disable the port.  
470  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
Field  
For the endpoint systems at the site being provisioned...  
Web Access Port  
Specify the port to use when accessing the endpoint system’s web interface.  
If you change this from the default (port 80), specify a port number of 1025 or higher, and  
make sure the port is not already in use. You will need to include the port number with the  
IP address when you use the Polycom HDX web interface to access the system. This  
makes unauthorized access more difficult.  
Note  
The system restarts if you change the web access port.  
Allow Video Display On  
Web  
Specify whether to allow viewing of the room where the endpoint system is located, or  
video of calls in which the endpoint system participates, using the endpoint system’s web  
interface.  
Note  
This feature activates both near site and far site video displays in Web Director.  
NTLM Version  
Specify the NTLM version the endpoint system should use to authenticate.  
Security Settings 2  
Idle Session Timeout in  
Minues  
When sessions are enabled, Specify the number of minutes your system can be idle  
before the session times out.  
Lock Port after Failed  
Logins  
Specify the number of failed login attempts allowed before the system locks the account.  
If set to Off, the system will not lock the user account due to failed login attempts.  
This selection controls local and web interface login attempts. For example, if you select  
3 here, a user who fails to log in properly twice on the web interface and twice on the  
local interface is locked out on the fourth attempt.  
Failed Login Window in  
Hours  
Specify the amount of time that the account remains locked due to failed login attempts.  
Specify the amount of time that the port remains locked due to failed login attempts.  
Specify how many links a certificate chain can have. The term peer certificate refers to  
Port Lock Duration in  
Minutes  
Maximum Peer  
Certificate Chain Depth any certificate sent by the far-end host to the HDX system when a network connection is  
being established between the two systems.  
Verify Certificates for  
all Web Access  
Specify whether the endpoint requires certificate validation to acces the endpoint.  
Whitelist  
Enable Whitelist of IPs  
When a whitelist is enabled, allows access to an endpoint’s web interface only by those  
systems with an IP address that matches a pattern using regular expression notation.  
Polycom, Inc.  
471  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
For the endpoint systems at the site being provisioned...  
Enter all IPs allowed to  
Connect via the web  
Specify (by IP addresses using regular expression notation) which systems can access  
an endpoint’s web interface. Addresses are matched by pattern, which means that you  
could allows IP address that you did not mean to allow. For example, if you entered an IP  
address of 15.1.2.111, all of the following results would match:  
15.1.2.111  
15.182.1.11  
15.1.252.111  
If you want to allow a range of IP addresses, use the * wildcard instead. For example,  
enter 10.11.*.* to allow all IP addresses that begin with 10.11.  
General Settings  
Heartbeat Posting  
Interval (minutes)  
Specify the frequency at which the endpoint systems poll the CMA system for a  
heartbeat.  
In Call Stats Posting  
Interval (minutes)  
Specify the frequency at which the endpoint systems poll the CMA system for in call  
statistics.  
Calendaring Settings  
Automatically Discover  
Exchange Server  
Specify that the CMA system should discover the Microsoft Exchange server for the site  
by searching DNS records.  
Specify Exchange  
Server  
Specify that the CMA system should use the Microsoft Exchange server specified in the  
Exchange Server Address field.  
Exchange Server  
Address  
Specify the IP address or DNS name of the Microsoft Exchange server for the site.  
LDAP Settings  
Group Display Name  
Specify whether the CMA system should identify groups by their common name (cn) or  
their DisplayName. These names are extracted from the Active Directory.  
User Display Name  
Specify whether the CMA system should identify users by their common name (cn) or  
their DisplayName. These names are extracted from the Active Directory.  
Enterprise Directory  
Admin Group  
Specify the Active Directory group whose members should have access to the Admin  
settings on the HDX system. This name must exactly match the name in the Active  
Directory server for authentication to succeed.  
Enterprise Directory  
User Group  
Specify the Active Directory group whose members should have access to the User  
settings on the HDX system. This name must exactly match the name in the Active  
Directory server for authentication to succeed.  
472  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
View Site Information  
To view information about an existing site  
1
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Sites or Admin > Dial Plan and  
Sites > Site Topology.  
2
In the Sites list or Site Topology page, select the site of interest and click  
Site Information.  
The Site Information dialog box displays the following site information.  
Column  
Name  
Description  
Name of the site.  
Description of the site.  
Description  
Location  
The specified location of the site identified either by  
longitude + latitude or by country + city.  
Bandwidth (Mbps)  
Bandwidth Used  
Device Types  
The specified total bandwidth limit for audio and  
video calls.  
Identifies the percentage of the maximum bandwidth  
currently occupied with audio and video calls.  
Identifies the type (Bridges, DMAs, VBPs, and  
Endpoints) and number of devices assigned to the  
site.  
Alarms  
Identifies the device alarms present within the site.  
Alarm information includes Status, Device Name,  
Device Type, and Description. Click Details to view  
more device details.  
Subnets  
Identifies the subnets within the site. Subnets  
information includes Bandwidth Used, Subnet  
(name), and (maximum) Bandwidth.  
Assign Locations to a Site  
Location has not always been a required field for sites. If your existing sites do  
not include location information, use the Assign Locations action to update  
your sites.  
To assign a location to an existing site  
1
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Sites or Admin > Dial Plan and  
Sites > Site Topology.  
2
Click Assign Locations.  
Polycom, Inc.  
473  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
3
4
In the Assign Locations to Sites dialog box, select the site of interest and  
click Specify Location.  
To specify a location by city name:  
a
b
c
From the Enter Location By drop-down list, select Search for City.  
If you know it, select the Country name for the location.  
Enter the name of the City and click Search.  
The system returns the list of cities that match your entry.  
d
Select the appropriate city using the Country, Division, and  
Subdivision fields to identify it and click Select.  
5
To specify a location by latitude and longitude in decimal degrees format:  
a
b
c
From the Enter Location By drop-down list, select  
Latitude/Longitude (Decimal format).  
Enter the Latitude and Longitude coordinates in decimal degrees (for  
example, Baltimore has a latitude of 39.3° and a longitude of 76.6°).  
Enter a Location Name. The system uses this location name for  
reference only; it does not validated the location name against the  
latitude and longitude coordinates that you enter.  
d
Select the Country name for the location and click Select.  
The system uses the coordinates you input to place the site in the  
proper location on its site topology map.  
6
To specify a location by latitude and longitude in DaysMinutesSeconds  
format:  
a
b
c
From the Enter Location By drop-down list, select  
Latitude/Longitude (DDD:MM:SS format).  
Enter the Latitude and Longitude coordinates in the required format  
and select  
Enter a Location Name. The system uses this location name for  
reference only; it does not validated the location name against the  
latitude and longitude coordinates that you enter.  
d
Select the Country name for the location and click Select.  
The system uses the coordinates you input to place the site in the  
proper location on its site topology map.  
474  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
Edit Site Settings  
Note  
Changing network topology may affect the accuracy of reports based on this  
information. To retain historical data for the current network topology, generate  
reports before making changes.  
To edit settings for a site  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Sites or Admin > Dial Plan and  
Sites > Site Topology.  
In the Sites list or Site Topology page, select the site of interest and click  
Edit Site.  
Edit the General Info, Site Routing, Site Subnet, and if applicable ISDN  
Number Assignment, sections of the Edit Site dialog box. For  
information about these sections, see “Add/Edit Site Dialog Box” on  
4
Click OK.  
Edit Site Provisioning Settings  
To edit the site provisioning settings for a site  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Sites or Admin > Dial Plan and  
Sites > Site Topology.  
In the Sites list or Site Topology page, select the site of interest and click  
Edit Site Provisioning Details.  
As needed, edit the site provisioning details and click Apply. For  
information about these details, see “Add/Edit Site Dialog Box” on  
4
Click OK.  
Polycom, Inc.  
475  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Delete a Site  
Note  
Devices that belonged to a deleted site are automatically reassigned to support  
Internet and VPN calls.  
To delete a site  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Sites or Admin > Dial Plan and  
Sites > Site Topology.  
In the Sites list or Site Topology page, select the site of interest and click  
Delete.  
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
Set Up SIP  
The CMA system supports SIP to establish conference connections. If you  
want to use SIP, you must enable it and configure SIP settings. You must also  
upload SIP URI data.  
To implement SIP, complete the following tasks  
1
Configure the SIP settings for each site.  
When you add a site to the CMA system, you also set up site provisioning,  
which includes the SIP settings. Be sure to enable SIP and configure the  
servers, protocol, and credentials needed for your SIP sever. See “Add a  
2
Import SIP URI data.  
After you enable and configure SIP, you must import your endpoint SIP  
data from your SIP server. The import provides the CMA system with all  
of the URI data it needs to use SIP.  
Note  
If you are using Microsoft as your SIP server, you do not need to import SIP URI  
data. The CMA system can retrieve the SIP URI from the enterprise directory.  
476  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
a
Create a CSV file in the format described here. The import requires a  
CSV file in the following format:  
domain,username,deviceType,URI  
where:  
»
domain—Specifies the domain the user uses to log in to the CMA  
system.  
»
»
username—Specifies the CMA system user name.  
deviceType—Specifies the device type (valid values are HDX,  
VVX, and CMADesktop).  
»
URI—Specifies the SIP URI for this user.  
For example:  
local,johndoe,HDX,[email protected]  
From the CMA system, go to Admin > Uploads.  
Click Upload.  
b
c
d
Navigate to the CSV file, select it, and click Open.  
Whenever you add new users or rooms or need change a SIP URI, you  
must provide SIP URI data. For the methods available for editing the SIP  
Edit SIP URI Data  
You can edit SIP URI data in the following ways:  
Upload a CSV file that has changes or new data.  
Data in the CSV file is added to any existing data.  
For information about the CSV file format and the upload process, see  
Edit individual users or rooms.  
For each CMA system user or room, you can add or edit the SIP URI  
in the Dial String Reservations section of the Edit User or Edit Room  
dialog box.  
Polycom, Inc.  
477  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Site Link Operations  
When you add a site link, you enter the starting and ending sites of the link  
and the maximum bandwidth and bit rates available for calls (audio and  
video) that use the link. Links are bidirectional. After you have created a link  
from Site A to Site B, you automatically have a bi-directional link from Site B  
to Site A, although the link appears as unidirectional.  
Note  
The bit rate can be set at the network level, the device level, and the conference  
level. If there is a discrepancy between these bit rate settings, the system  
implements the lowest bit rate setting. The only exception, is that the bit rate in the  
RMX profile takes precedence over the bit rate in the conference settings.  
Field  
Description  
Name  
Name (ASCII only) of the inter-site link.  
Description (ASCII only of the inter-site link.  
Description  
From Site  
Identifies the first site to be linked. The drop-down list  
includes all defined sites and the Internet.  
To Site  
Identifies the other site to be linked. The drop-down list  
includes all defined sites and an Internet/VPN option.  
Total Bandwidth (kbps)  
The maximum available bandwidth for audio and video  
calls, which you set at the gateway or router.  
Call Max Bit Rate (kbps) The maximum bit rate allowed for an audio and video  
call.  
Site-link operations include:  
478  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
View the Site Links List  
To view the Site Links list  
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Site-Links.  
The Site-Links list appears.  
Column  
Description  
Name  
Name of the link  
Description  
From Site  
To Site  
Description of the link  
First site reached in the call route  
Final site reached through this call link  
Max Bandwidth  
The maximum available bandwidth for audio and video  
calls, which you set at the gateway or router. Only applies  
to direct links.  
Max Bit Rate  
(kbps)  
The maximum bit rate allowed for an audio and video call.  
Only applies to direct links.  
Add a Site Link  
Before you can create a site link, you must add two or more sites to the system.  
To add a site link  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Site-Links.  
In the Site-Links page, click Add.  
In the Add Site-Link dialog box, enter a Name and Description for the  
link and select the starting (From Site) and ending (To Site) sites.  
4
Enter the Bandwidth and Max Bit Rate and click Save.  
The new link appears on the Site Links page.  
Edit a Site Link  
You may need to edit site links when network changes are made.  
If you make a bandwidth change, the current load is not affected; however, the  
bandwidth available for future conferences may be affected.  
Polycom, Inc.  
479  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
To edit a site link  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Site-Links.  
In the Site-Links list, select the link of interest and click Edit.  
In the Edit Site-Link dialog box, edit the Name, Description, Bandwidth  
or Max Bit Rate.  
4
Click Save.  
Delete a Site Link  
You can remove site links from the Polycom CMA system.  
Note  
Avoid removing a link on which a scheduled conference depends.  
To delete a site link  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Site-Links.  
In the Site-Links list, select the site link of interest and click Delete.  
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
Site-to-Site Exclusions  
Create site-to-site exclusions to explicitly deny connection between two sites  
for audio or video calls.  
Site-link exclusion operations include:  
View the Site-to-Site Exclusion List  
To view the Site-to-Site exclusion list  
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Site-to-Site Exclusion.  
The Site-to-Site Exclusions list appears.  
480  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
Add a Site-to-Site Exclusion  
Before you can create a site link exclusion, you must add two or more sites to  
the system.  
Exclusions are by definition bilateral. No call traffic is allowed to flow across  
the site-link in either direction.  
To add a site-to-site exclusion  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Site-to-Site Exclusions.  
In the Site-to-Site Exclusions page, click Add.  
In the Add Site-to-Site Exclusions wizard:  
a
Select the first site of the From/To site pair (by clicking the appropriate  
button). If needed, use the Search Site field to find the site.  
b
Select the second site of the From/To site pair (by enabling the  
appropriate check box) and click Continue. You can select more than  
one site, if needed.  
c
Review the site-to-site exclusion and if it is correct, click Save  
Exclusion.  
Edit a Site-to-Site Exclusion  
You cannot edit a site-to-site exclusion; you can only delete it and then re-add  
it.  
Delete a Site-to-Site Exclusion  
To delete a site-to-site exclusion  
1
2
Go to Dial Plan and Sites > Site-to-Site Exclusions.  
In the Site-to-Site Exclusions page, select the exclusion of interest and  
click Delete.  
3
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
Polycom, Inc.  
481  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Territories  
A territory is a set of one or more sites for which a CMA system is responsible.  
By default, there is one territory named Default CMA Territory, and its  
primary node (the CMA system responsible for it) is set to this system. For  
more information, see “Territories” on page 393.  
Territory operations include:  
View the Territory List  
To view the Territories list  
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Territories.  
The Territories list appears.  
Add a Territory  
To add a territory  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Territories.  
In the Territories page, click Add.  
Complete the Territory Info and Associated Sites sections of the Add  
Territories dialog box. For information about these fields, see “Add/Edit  
4
Click OK.  
Edit a Territory  
To edit a territory  
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Territories.  
In the Territories page, select the territory of interest and click Edit.  
482  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
3
4
Change the Territory Info and Associated Sites information of the Add  
Territories dialog box as needed. For information about these fields, see  
Click OK.  
Delete a Territory  
To delete a territory  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Territories.  
In the Territories page, select the territory of interest and click Delete.  
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
Network Clouds  
To simplify the network topology, define network clouds to represents a hub  
with many sites connected to each other such as a private network or VPN.  
Network cloud operations include:  
View the List of Network Clouds  
To view the Territories list  
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Territories.  
The Territories list appears.  
Add a Network Cloud  
To add a network cloud  
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Network Clouds.  
In the Network Clouds page, click Add.  
Polycom, Inc.  
483  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
3
4
In the Cloud Info section of the Add Network Cloud dialog box, enter a  
unique and meaningful Name and Description for the cloud.  
To create a link between a site and the network cloud:  
a
b
Click Linked Sites.  
In the Search Sites field, enter all or part of the site name or location  
and click Find.  
The list of sites containing the search phrase appear in the Search  
Results column.  
c
Select one or more sites to link with the network cloud and then click  
the right arrow to move them to the Selected Sites column.  
5
Click OK.  
Edit a Network Cloud  
To edit a network cloud  
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Network Clouds.  
In the Network Clouds page, select the network cloud of interest and  
click Edit.  
3
Edit the Cloud Info or to create a link between a site and the network  
cloud:  
a
b
Click Linked Sites.  
In the Search Sites field, enter all or part of the site name or location  
and click Find.  
The list of sites containing the search phrase appear in the Search  
Results column.  
c
Select one or more sites to link with the network cloud and then click  
the right arrow to move them to the Selected Sites column.  
4
Click OK.  
Delete a Network Cloud  
To delete a network cloud  
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Network Clouds.  
In the Network Clouds page, select the network cloud of interest and  
click Delete.  
3
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
484  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
Dial Plan Service Operations  
Dial plan services are special features that video endpoint system users can  
invoke by dialing the prefix assigned in the CMA system to that service.  
The CMA system has two default dial plan services:  
These services can be edited and disabled, but not deleted.  
You can also add other gateway or If a service does not appear automatically  
when a device registers with the CMA system, you can define the service  
manually so that it is available for video endpoint system users. In addition,  
you can add services for certain third-party MCU services.  
Conference on Demand  
With Conference on Demand, video endpoint system users can start an  
unscheduled multipoint conference from their endpoint rather than  
requesting this service from an administrator.  
The initiating endpoint uses the capabilities made available through the MCU.  
When Conference on Demand is enabled on the endpoint, the CMA system  
sends the call directly to the MCU.  
Note  
Conference on Demand is only available on Polycom RMX and MGC MCUs. It is  
not available on Polycom RMX 1000 MCUs.  
The following table provides details on how the Conference on Demand  
service is configured.  
Field  
Description  
General Info  
Service Type  
Enable  
Conference on Demand (read only)  
Indicates whether or not the service is enabled  
Available for New Groups  
Indicates whether or not the service is available for  
new user groups  
Description  
Description (ASCII only) of the service. By default for  
this service, Conference on Demand  
Service Prefix  
The prefix (ASCII only) for the service. By default for  
this service: con  
Polycom, Inc.  
485  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Conference on Demand—MCU Properties  
Login ID User login (ASCII only) for the MCU hosting the  
Description  
conference. This user account must be authorized to  
create new conferences.  
Password  
Password (ASCII only) for the user login. Each time  
you modify the password for the MCU, you must also  
modify it in this page.  
H.323 Network Service  
The corresponding service created on the MCU to  
implement this CMA system service. Set on the MCU  
(ASCII only).  
Default Conference Properties  
MGC: Video Session Indicates what users see. Set to Continuous  
Presence for this service.  
Notes  
MGC only. For RMX MCUs, the profile determines  
this setting.  
Select Transcoding to support IP and ISDN calls.  
MGC: Bit rate (Kbps)  
Default bit rate for calls.  
Notes  
MGC only. The RMX MCU bit rate is dictated by  
the RMX profile.  
The video endpoint system that starts the  
Conference on Demand call may use a higher or  
lower bit rate than is specified in this page.  
RMX: Profile Name  
The name of the RMX profile that has the conference  
settings for the conference.  
Simplified Dialing  
Simplified dialing is a service that allows video endpoint system users to  
access gateway services by dialing 9, and then the phone number or other  
dialing string. Simplified dialing is enabled by default.  
To use simplified dialing, the following settings are also required:  
Sites must specify the country code, city and area code, and number of  
digits in the subscriber line.  
The gateway must be registered with the CMA system and display in the  
List of Devices page.  
Gateway services must be defined.  
The LCR table must be defined.  
486  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
Field  
Description  
Service Type  
Enable  
Name of the service (read only)  
Indicates whether this service is enabled  
The service is available for new user groups  
Description of the service  
Available for New Groups  
Description  
Service Prefix  
The prefix for this service: 9.  
Gateway Service  
These services are provided by a gateway to endpoints. For example, gateways  
usually have distinct services for each speed they support (128 Kbps, 384 Kbps,  
512 Kbps, and so on) and a service for audio-only calls.  
Gateway services tell the CMA system how to route the call during conversion  
between IP and ISDN.  
Note  
Gateway and MCU services must be defined in both the CMA system and the MCU  
platform. They must be defined exactly the same in both locations. If you enter this  
information manually, be sure to type it exactly as it is entered in the MGC or RMX  
system.  
You can simplify entry of services by making sure that the MCUs and gateways on  
your video conferencing network are set to register with the gatekeeper in the CMA  
system. This setting assures the information appears automatically in the List of  
Services page.  
You must define a gateway service for each bit rate available. These services  
should appear automatically in the list when the gateway registers with the  
CMA system. If gateway services do not appear, you can enter them manually.  
If the List of Services page does not include gateway services, alternate  
routing and least-cost routing are disabled. For details, see the following table.  
Field  
Description  
Service Type  
Enable  
Type of service  
Indicates whether this service is enabled  
The service is available to new user groups  
Description of the service  
The prefix for this service.  
Available for New Groups  
Description  
Service Prefix  
Must be a registered E.164 alias for the corresponding  
gateway in the Devices page for Directory Setup.  
Polycom, Inc.  
487  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Field  
Description  
For use in simplified dialing  
Device Capability  
Specify the type of connection the device can handle.  
Select all that apply. Options are:  
H.320. Supports video and voice using the ITU  
H.320 standard.  
Voice. Supports voice over the PSTN network.  
Other. Supports a protocol other than H.320 or  
voice, such as H.321 or video over ATM.  
Bit Rate (Kbps)  
The maximum rate at which the calls can connect.  
Note  
If you select Unknown, this service cannot support  
simplified dialing.  
Insert between prefix and  
first number  
Specify the character to insert in the dial string  
between the prefix and the first number.  
For example, if you specify * as the character, the  
sequence the user enters would be:  
77*2125551212  
Insert between phone  
number  
Specify the character to insert in the dial string  
between phone numbers.  
For example, if you specify # as the character to  
separate numbers, the sequence the user enters  
would be:  
77*5551212#5651213  
Append after full dial  
string  
Specify the character to append after the full dial  
string.  
To process the call, certain gateways require a symbol  
be appended after the final dialing number.  
For example, if you specify ** as the characters to  
append after the final dialing number, the sequence  
the user enters would be:  
77*5551212#5651213#2223232**  
Warning: The CMA system does not recognize dial  
strings that require termination after the ISDN number  
and have an extension after the terminated ISDN.  
For example, the CMA system does not recognize the  
following dial string:  
165024710000**3452  
488  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
MCU Service  
These services allow devices to use specific MCU features and settings when  
making a call. For example, an MCU can define a service for a multipoint video  
call with continuous presence at 384 Kbps and another service for video  
switching at 256 Kbps.  
MCU services and their associated prefixes are defined at the MCU. For MGC  
or RMX MCUs, the MCU services should appear automatically in the List of  
Services page when the MCU registers with the CMA system. Because  
third-party MCUs may not automatically register, you must enter them  
manually in the CMA system.  
Use MCU services to dial the IP gateway segment that translates between IP  
and ISDN, in conference calls with two or more participants, or continuous  
presence.  
Field Name  
Description  
Service Type  
Enable  
Type of service.  
Indicates whether this service is enabled or not.  
The service is available for new user groups.  
Available for New Groups  
Description  
Description of the service. To identify it easily in the  
List of Services page, include the prefix and the  
MCU feature (for example, 384 K video switching).  
Service Prefix  
The prefix for this service, which must be a E.164  
alias that is registered for the MCU on the Device  
page.  
Services operations include:  
Polycom, Inc.  
489  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
View the Services List  
This page shows the services that have been defined in your dial plan. These  
services are available when you place unscheduled calls.  
Note  
E.164 aliases appear in this list as follows:  
For MGC and RMX devices, they appear as gateway services.  
For a device’s H.323 services, they (including the alias prefix) appear as MCU  
services. Gateway service prefixes are the E.164 aliases of the MCU’s gateway  
session profiles.  
To view the Services list  
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > Services.  
The Services list appears.  
Column  
Prefix  
Description  
Prefix of the service.  
Type  
The type of service. Available types include System,  
Gateway, and MCU.  
Description  
Enabled  
Description of the service.  
Tip: When completed automatically, the description  
reflects the value entered in the MGC or RMX  
manager.  
By default, services are enabled. To disable them,  
clear the Enabled check box.  
Add a Service  
If a gateway or MCU service does not appear automatically when the device  
registers with the CMA system, you can define the service manually so that it  
is available for use in unscheduled calls. In addition, you can add services for  
certain third-party MCU services.  
To add a service  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > Services.  
In the Services list, click Add Service.  
Complete the General Info, and if applicable Simplified Dialing or  
Conference on Demand, sections of the Add Service dialog box.  
490  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
4
Click OK.  
The new service is added to the system.  
Edit a Service  
You can make changes to a service.  
Note  
Be sure that the information you enter in the CMA system matches the information  
entered in the MCU.  
To edit a service  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > Services.  
In the Services list, select the service of interest and click Edit Service.  
As required, edit the General Info, and if applicable Simplified Dialing  
or Conference on Demand, sections of the Edit Service dialog box.  
4
Click OK.  
Delete a Service  
You can delete a gateway or MCU service from the CMA system. You cannot  
delete the Conference on Demand or Simplified Dialing service.  
To delete a service  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > Services.  
In the Services list, select the service of interest and click Delete Service.  
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
Notes  
The system returns an error message if you attempt to delete any services that  
were added automatically when the MCU registered with the CMA system. To  
avoid this, first unregister and then delete the MCU.  
MCU services added manually from the Services page are not affected by this  
error.  
Polycom, Inc.  
491  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Dial Rule Operations  
Dial rules describe how the CMA system gatekeeper should resolve addresses  
in an incoming dial string to route a call. This dial string may include an IP  
address, a string of numbers that begin with a prefix associated with a service,  
a string that begins with a country code and city code, or a string that matches  
a particular alias for a device.  
Dial strings may match multiple dial rules. However, you can assign a priority  
to each dial rule. When the CMA system gatekeeper receives a call request and  
associated dial string, it reviews the dial rules in order of priority. The first  
matched (highest priority) dial rule is executed.  
Field  
Description  
General Info  
Name  
Name (ASCII only) of the dial rule.  
Description  
Description (ASCII only) of the dial rule, which can be  
up to 256 characters long.  
Priority  
Priority number of the dial rule, which determines which  
rule the CMA system uses first. The smaller the number  
the higher the priority.  
More than one dial rule may have the same priority. In  
that case, rules with the same priority are applied in  
random order.  
Enabled  
Select the check box to enable the rule.  
Pattern Type  
Specify the type of pattern to be matched. Available  
patterns include:  
Local Directory Services  
DNS Name  
IP Address  
Prefix  
Prefix Range  
Applicable Site  
Site to which this pattern applies. You can select a  
specific site or all sites.  
This field is not available when the Pattern Type is  
Local Directory Services.  
Routing Action > Dial String Manipulation  
IP Address Pattern Data Specify the criteria (ASCII only) to use to match the  
pattern type and additional changes to make when  
routing the call.  
This field is available when the Pattern Type is DNS  
Name, IP Address, or Prefix.  
This field is not available when the Pattern Type is  
Local Directory Services or Prefix Range.  
492  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
Field  
Description  
Start Value  
The starting number to use as a prefix, which displays  
only for rules with the Prefix Range pattern type.  
End Value  
The ending number to use as a prefix, which displays  
only for rules with the Prefix Range pattern type  
# Characters to remove  
Number of digits to remove (from the start or from the  
end) of the dialed string  
This field is available when the Pattern Type is Local  
Directory Services, Prefix, and Prefix Range.  
This field is not available when the Pattern Type is DNS  
Name or IP Address.  
Prefix to add  
Prefix to add to the dialed string  
This field is available when the Pattern Type is Local  
Directory Services, Prefix, and Prefix Range.  
This field is not available when the Pattern Type is DNS  
Name or IP Address.  
Routing Action > Action to perform  
Action  
Specify what action to take for calls that match the  
pattern type and criteria.  
Action to perform when the pattern is matched.  
Depending on the Pattern Type, options may include:  
Route  
Block  
Route within region  
Route out of region  
Route to a gateway with LCR applied  
Route to a gateway service  
Route to a list of gateway services  
Route to a trusted neighbor  
Trusted Neighbors  
Available Region  
When the action is Route to a trusted neighbor, select  
the region to which you want to route.  
Gateway Services  
Selected Gateway  
When the action is Route to a gateway service, this  
Services (prioritized)  
field lists the selected gateway services.  
You can define multiple gateway services for a rule. The  
first in the list is the default gateway service. Others are  
used in priority order when the primary gateway service  
is not available.  
Polycom, Inc.  
493  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Default Dial Rules  
The CMA system has three default dial rules. With these defaults, the system  
can route most calls except those requiring an external DNS lookup.  
Internal IP - This dial rule allows the system to identify the incoming dial  
string as an IP addresses and routes the call out of the region. By default,  
this dial rule applies to all sites.  
Alias - This dial rule allows the system to identify the incoming dial string  
as belonging to the local directory and routes the call to the local device or  
service, as required.  
DNS Name - This dial rule allows the system to identify the incoming dial  
string as a DNS name and block the call.  
Note  
Do not delete the default dial rules or the CMA system will not be able to route calls  
correctly. You can disable a dial rule by editing it and clearing the Enabled check  
box for the rule.  
Parts of a Dial Rule  
A dial rule consists of a pattern type paired with a routing action. When the  
dialed string uses a pattern that matches the pattern type, the associated rule  
is applied.  
Pattern Types  
A pattern type tells the CMA system how to find a match for the dial string.  
The following table shows the available pattern types.  
Pattern Type  
Description  
Local Directory  
Services  
Search the List of Devices and List of Services.  
Includes aliases, which are searched before the service  
prefix.  
DNS Name  
IP Address  
Prefix  
Look up a DNS Name  
Look for an IP addresses in the IPV4 format  
Look for a prefix specified in the dial rule  
Prefix Range  
Look for a prefix within the range of prefixes specified in  
the dial rule  
494  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
Routing Actions  
A routing action informs the CMA system what to do based on the dial rule’s  
associated pattern type. The following table shows the available routing  
actions.  
Routing  
Action  
Pattern  
Type  
Description  
Route  
Block  
All  
Allow the call to pass  
Block the call  
All  
Route within  
region  
IP Address  
Route to any IP address inside the region  
Route out of  
region  
IP Address  
Route to any IP address outside the region  
Note  
The originating site’s Internet access rules still  
apply.  
Route to a  
gateway with  
LCR  
Prefix and  
Prefix  
Range  
Remove the prefix specified in the dial rule and  
route the remaining dial string to a gateway  
service, which has the specified LCR table  
Route to a  
gateway  
service  
Prefix and  
Prefix  
Range  
Remove the prefix specified in the dial rule and  
route the remaining dial string to the specified  
gateway service  
Route to a list  
of gateway  
services  
Prefix and  
Prefix  
Range  
Modify the dial string specified in the dial rule and  
route the remaining dial string to the specified  
gateway service.  
Route to a  
trusted  
neighbor  
Prefix and  
Prefix  
Range  
Modify the dial string as specified in the dial rule  
and ask the specified neighboring gatekeeper to  
route the modified dial string. If the neighboring  
gatekeeper agrees, route the call.  
Note  
The neighboring gatekeeper must be configured  
as a region in the CMA system.  
Examples of Custom Dial Rules  
You use custom dial rules to perform these tasks:  
Block calls. For example, you can block all calls to 900 numbers, which  
usually charge a per-minute fee. Create a dial rule with these settings:  
Pattern type: Prefix  
Prefix to match: 900  
Routing action: Block  
Polycom, Inc.  
495  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Route to a neighboring gatekeeper. If you have entered information  
about neighboring gatekeepers in the List of Regions page, you can create  
a rule to route calls to another gatekeeper. Create a dial rule with these  
settings:  
Pattern type: Prefix Range  
Prefixes to match: Specify the range.  
Routing action: Select Route to a trusted neighbor and the region for  
the neighboring gatekeeper to which you want to route calls.  
IP-specific routing. You can specify which calls may connect, according to  
the IP address. For example, you could allow calls from San Jose to  
Atlanta, but not from San Jose to Pleasanton.  
Dial Rule operations include:  
View the Dial Rules List  
To view the Dial Rules list  
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > Dial Rules.  
The Dial Rules list appears.  
Column  
Name  
Description  
The name of the dial rule  
Pattern Type  
The pattern type in use for this rule. Options are:  
Local Directory Services  
DNS Name  
IP Address  
Prefix  
Prefix Range  
For more information, see “Parts of a Dial Rule” on  
Pattern Data  
Additional criteria that must be met to apply this rule  
496  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
Column  
Description  
The routing action used by this rule. Options are:  
Routing Action  
Route  
Block  
Route within region  
Route out of region  
Route to a GW with LCR applied  
Route to a GW service  
Route to a list of GW services  
Route to a trusted neighbor  
Note  
Not all actions are available for all pattern types.  
Site  
The sites for which this rule is used. May be all sites or a  
specific site  
Priority  
The priority assigned this rule  
Enabled  
Indicates whether or not the dial rule is enabled  
Add a Dial Rule  
To add a dial rule  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > Dial Rules.  
In the Dial Rules list, click Add Dialing Rule.  
Complete the General Info, Routing Action, Trusted Neighbors, and  
Gateway Services sections of the Add Dialing Rule dialog box.  
4
Click OK.  
The new dial rule is added to the system.  
Enable or Disable Dialing Rules  
You can enable or disable dial rules.  
Note  
Use caution when changing the default dial rules, which enable basic operations in  
the CMA system.  
Polycom, Inc.  
497  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
To enable or disable a dialing rule  
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > Dial Rules.  
In the Dial Rules list, select the dial rule of interest and click Edit Dialing  
Rule.  
3
4
On the Dial Rules - General Information page, check or clear the  
Enabled check box.  
Click OK.  
Edit a Dial Rule  
To edit a dial rule  
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > Dial Rules.  
In the Dial Rules list, select the dial rule of interest and click Edit Dial  
Rule.  
3
4
In the Edit Dial Rule dialog box, make the required changes.  
When you are finished, click OK.  
Least-Cost Routing Operations  
Least-cost routing (LCR) allows the CMA system to route ISDN or POTS calls  
made on paths that incur the lowest expense. You can route calls from one site  
through a gateway in another site by referencing LCR tables.  
Least-cost routing is useful when sites already have a high-bandwidth  
connection between them.  
Least-cost routing works with the CMA system’s other routing features.  
Setting up least-cost routing requires you to:  
Determine the LCR information to enter in the CMA system.  
Create LCR tables.  
In the device record for MCUs:  
Define an H.320 service and select the LCR table to use.  
Define a gateway service and select the H.320 service associated with  
the LCR table.  
Note  
Make sure the LCR tables you define match the network setup.  
498  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
You cannot use least-cost routing when:  
The route cannot be identified.  
The required resources are unavailable.  
Bandwidth limitations exist on the WAN.  
How Least-Cost Routing Works  
Each LCR table defines dial strings, which include the country code, area code,  
prefix, and a weighted cost for commonly made calls. You usually create one  
LCR table per site.  
The following table is an example of an LCR table.  
Country Code  
Area Code  
408  
Prefix  
Weighted Cost  
1
1
1
1
565  
0
0
0
5
408  
650  
415  
The CMA system compares the dial string for a call to the dial strings in LCR  
tables. The dial string can match at the country code, area code, or prefix level.  
The CMA system reads the “# of digits to strip” field to determine how many  
digits to remove.  
Note  
For areas of the United States that do not require you dial an access code before  
the area code, exclude this number when you define the number of digits to strip.  
Before determining the final call routing, the CMA system considers cost  
(through LCR tables), bandwidth resources (through site topology and device  
group policies), and gateway availability.  
Example of Least-Cost Routing  
Company ABC has three sites: Site A in San Jose, CA, Site B in Monterey, CA,  
and Site C in Washington, D.C. All sites have gateways.  
LCR Tables for Three Sites  
The LCR tables included area codes that are used frequently in each site and  
considered that calls are made frequently from Site C to Southern California.  
Polycom, Inc.  
499  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
The following table lists area codes for the San Francisco Bay Area and  
Southern California. The prefix 755 for the 408 area code applies for all  
numbers in Site A.  
Area Code  
408  
Prefix  
Weighted Cost  
755  
0
408  
0
650  
0
510  
0
925  
0
415  
5
831  
5
213  
10  
10  
10  
20  
310  
714  
The following table lists area codes for Washington, D.C., Eastern Maryland,  
and Northeastern Virginia.  
Area Code  
202  
Prefix  
Weighted Cost  
238  
0
202  
0
240  
0
301  
0
741  
0
703  
0
410  
5
443  
5
540  
5
804  
10  
20  
500  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
The following table lists area codes for San Jose, Monterrey, and Southern  
California.  
Area Code  
831  
Prefix  
Weighted Cost  
477  
0
831  
0
408  
5
213  
10  
10  
10  
20  
310  
714  
Call Scenario One  
Site C can call San Jose using ISDN through one of two routes:  
Through the Site C gateway to the local phone system, making a long  
distance connection, at a higher cost per minute.  
From Site C through the direct inter-site link to Site A and out its gateway,  
at a lower cost per minute.  
Note  
If you dial an area code that is not in an LCR table, the call goes through the  
gateway from which the call originates.  
Call Scenario Two  
Calls are frequently made from Site C to Los Angeles. The area codes for some  
parts of Southern California are included in the LCR tables for Sites A and B,  
because it is less expensive to make an intrastate long distance call within  
California than an interstate long distance call from Washington, D.C. to Los  
Angeles.  
By including Southern California area codes in LCR tables for San Jose and  
Monterey, if the bandwidth for the San Jose gateway is saturated, the call from  
Site C can be routed through the Monterey gateway. The priority is to call from  
Site A or Site B, because the LCR tables share a relative cost to dial the area  
codes for Los Angeles.  
Polycom, Inc.  
501  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Determining Area Codes  
It is recommended you enter area codes for:  
The area in which the site is located.  
The area surrounding the site.  
Frequently called numbers.  
You should also include special rate plans for intrastate calling.  
Determining Country Codes  
If you make international calls and you determine that calls to a certain  
country are less expensive from a particular gateway, enter the dial string for  
this country in the LCR table for the selected gateway.  
Determining the Weighted Cost  
When you enter call strings in an LCR table, associate a weighted cost with  
each one. You can base the cost on a monetary value or ratio that compares  
costs between several locations. The weighted cost determines which call  
string is most cost-effective to use.  
You can calculate costs for the following types of calls:  
Local  
Local toll  
Intrastate  
Interstate  
International long distance  
Field  
Description  
Name  
Name (ASCII only) for the LCR table.  
Description  
Country  
City Code  
Prefix  
(Optional) (ASCII only)  
Country code for the location to which this call is made.  
City or area code for the location to which this call is made.  
The prefix is the first three numbers in a 7-digit dial string.  
The number of digits to strip before dialing.  
# Digits to Strip  
Cost  
Weighted cost for each call to the selected area or city  
code.  
502  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
LCR operations include:  
View the Least Cost Routing Tables List  
Column  
Name  
Description  
Name of the LCR table.  
Description of the LCR table.  
Description  
To display the list of least cost routing tables  
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > LCR Tables.  
The LCR Tables list appears.  
Add a Least Cost Routing Table  
To add a LCR table  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > LCR Tables.  
In the LCR Tables list, click Add LCR.  
In the Add LCR Tables dialog box, enter the Name, Description, and  
New Route information required to create a new table.  
4
5
6
Click Add.  
Repeat step 3 and 4 for add additional routes to the table.  
Click OK.  
Edit a Least Cost Routing Table  
To edit an LCR table  
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > LCR Tables.  
In the LCR Tables list, select the table of interest and click Edit LCR.  
Polycom, Inc.  
503  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
3
4
In the Edit LCR dialog box, edit the Name, Description, and New Route  
information as required.  
Click Save.  
The changes you made apply to all MCUs associated with a gateway  
service that uses this LCR table.  
Delete a Least Cost Routing Table  
To delete an LCR table  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > LCR Tables.  
In the LCR Tables list, select the table of interest and click Delete LCR.  
Click Delete to confirm the deletion.  
E.164 Numbering Scheme  
E.164 Implementation in the CMA System  
The Polycom E.164 implementation is based on an E.164 Telecommunications  
Recommendation and provides E.164 functionality within the Polycom CMA  
environment.  
The CMA system provides the ability to automatically generate E.164 aliases  
through its E.164 numbering scheme feature. This feature effectively works as  
an E.164 alias generator and allows for two types of E.164 number generation:  
default or custom. When the CMA system is setup correctly, it will generate  
one E.164 alias per dynamically-managed endpoint.  
E.164 Alias Assignment  
The CMA system can assign an E.164 alias to each dynamically-managed  
endpoint at the time of first registration with the CMA System. An E.164 alias  
assignment will be based on the default E.164 numbering scheme or on a  
specified E.164 numbering scheme, if one has been setup. However, if an E.164  
alias already exists in a Dial String Reservation for a User or Room, then it will  
have priority over the E.164 number generation.  
E.164 aliases may also originate from other CMA system sources to include a  
User or Room Dial String Reservation, a Guest E.164 designation, and an E.164  
alias provided directly at the endpoint (this opton is only applicable to some  
non-dynamically-managed endpoints).  
504  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
Within the CMA system, an E.164 alias provided in a Dial String Reservation  
has a higher priority than a generated E.164 alias.  
A single user with multiple endpoints may be assigned a unique E.164 alias  
per endpoint.  
IMPORTANT  
H.323 must be enabled on an endpoint and the it must be registered with the  
Gatekeeper, prior to the CMA system’s application of the E.164 numbering  
scheme.H.323 can be enabled on an endpoint through the CMA system’s site  
provisioning functionality. See “Add a Site” on page 461.  
E.164 Numbering Scheme Default Settings  
The E.164 numbering scheme functionality consists of three main parts: prefix,  
base field, and suffix. The entire E.164 numeric string has a 15-digit maximum.  
Prefix  
Base Field  
Suffix  
Based on Device Type  
Specify Number Range  
No Suffix  
Choosing this selection  
will automatically  
associate a unique  
two-digit identifier to each  
dynamically-managed  
endpoint type. See the  
Settings” section.  
The number range has  
been preset to 1000 and  
9999.  
A suffix will not be  
assigned to the Default  
E.164 Numbering  
Scheme (Aliias).  
Important  
When a numeric range  
runs out of numbers, the  
number generation  
operation will fail.  
The number below is only  
an example of a Prefix  
assignment.  
The number below is only  
an example of a Base  
Field assignment.  
The lack of a number  
below, is only an example  
of a No Suffix  
assignment.  
44 (sample value)  
1009 (sample value)  
(blank sample value)  
E.164 Numbering Scheme Explained  
To give you an idea of how an E.164 numbering scheme would appear, see  
example below. Please note that the example is based on sample default values  
provided in the table above.  
Polycom, Inc.  
505  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
441009 (an example of an E.164 Alias)  
Here the Prefix is derived from the Based on Device Type selection, in this  
case, the “44” in the sample is referring to a Polycom RealPresence Group  
Series endpoint, this number will normally adjust to match the actual endpoint  
type.  
The “1009” assignment is a sample Base Field result derived from the Number  
Range selection, in this example, the range is between 1000 and 9999.  
The Suffix portion of this example was set to No Suffix , which means that a  
suffix value will not be appended to the resulting E.164 Alias.  
506  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
Field  
Description  
Prefix  
The Prefix is the first part of the E.164 Numbering  
Scheme and containz up to three options  
No Prefix  
A Number (specify)  
Based on Devicey Type, available only if shown  
The fist option, No Prefix, means that there will not be  
any digits listed in front of the Base Field assignment  
The second option, A Number,(specify) allows for the  
specification of up to 7 digits, be careful, not to go over  
the allowable15-digit maximum.  
The third option, Based on Device Type, will only be  
visible in the Prefix if if it has not been already selected  
in the Suffix.  
If the Based on Device Type selection is available for  
selection, it will use the two-digits predefined device  
type. See the Based on Device Type Settings section.  
Base Field  
There are two available options for the Base Field  
Specify Number Range...  
Phone Number  
The first opton, Specify Number Range..., allows for the  
designation of a numeric range.The range may fall  
anywhere from 0 through 9999999999.  
The second option, Phone Number, allows for the  
assignment of a phone number from the Actrive  
Directory along with the number of digits to utilize from  
the phone number, and can range anywhere between 3  
to 10 digits. Or, in the event a phone number does not  
exist, a numeric range will be used instead, if defined,  
and it can be anywhere from 0 through 9999999999  
Suffix  
The suffix is the last part of the three-part E.164  
Numbering Scheme and may contain up to three of its  
own options.  
No Suffix  
A Number (specify)  
Based on Device Type.  
The first option, No Suffix, means that there will not be  
any digits listed after the Base Field designation of the  
E.164 Alias.  
The second option, A Number (specify), allows for the  
specification of up to 7 digits, be careful not to exceed  
the allowable 15 digit minimum.  
The third option, Based on Device Type, will use the  
two-digits predefined device type. See the Based on  
Polycom, Inc.  
507  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Based on Device Type Settings  
The CMA system’s Based on device Type option is mutually exclusive to the prefix or  
suffix portion of the E.164 numbering scheme functionality.  
The CMA system will generate this type of prefix or Suffix by matching the actual  
endpoint type to the predefined CMA system values listed below.  
RealPresence Group Series ------ 44  
CMA Desktop ------------------------- 22  
RealPresence Desktop ------------- 66  
VVX -------------------------------------- 33  
RealPresence Mobile --------------- 55  
HDX --------------------------------------11  
Generating E.164 Aliases  
An Administrator may choose to use the default E.164 number generation  
scheme or create a distinct E.164 numbering scheme that is better suited to  
their existing IT environment.  
To use the E.164 number generation scheme, ensure that H.323 functionality is  
enabled on the endpoints. H.323 can be enabled on the endpoints via site  
provisioning through the CMA system. For more information about site  
provisioning, see “Add a Site” on page 461.  
To customize an E.164 number generation scheme  
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > E.164 Numbering Scheme  
In the Prefix section, select your option. The available options are: No  
Prefix, A Number (specify), Based on Device Type (if available for  
selection).  
3
4
In the Base Field section, select your preferred option. The available  
options are: Specify Number Range and Phone Number.  
In the Suffix section. select your preferred option. The available options  
are: No Suffix, A Number (specify), Based on Device Type (if available  
for selection).  
5
Click Update.  
Setting-up an E.164 Alias in a User Dial String Reservation  
To setup an E.164 alias for an existing user  
1
2
Go to User > Users  
Highlight a specific user.  
508  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Dial Plan Setup Operations  
3
4
5
6
7
Click on Edit. The Edit User dialog will display.  
Click on Dial String Reservations.  
Select your endpoint type.  
In the E164 field, enter an E.164 Alias.  
Click Apply then Update.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Go to User > Users  
Click on Add. The Add User dialog will display.  
Click on Dial String Reservations.  
Select your endpoint type.  
In the E164 field, type in an E.164 Alias.  
Click Apply then Update.  
Setting-up an E.164 Alias in a Room Dial String Reservation  
To setup an E.164 alias for an existing room  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Go to Admin > Rooms  
Highlight a specific room.  
Click on Edit. The Edit Room dialog will display.  
Click on Dial String Reservations.  
Select your endpoint type.  
In the E164 field, type in an E.164 Alias.  
Click Apply then Update.  
To setup an E.164 alias for a new room  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Go to Admin > Rooms  
Click on Add. The Add New Room dialog will display.  
Click on Dial String Reservations.  
Select your endpoint type.  
In the E164 field, type in an E.164 Alias.  
Click Apply then Update.  
Polycom, Inc.  
509  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Note  
The total number of digits specified for an E.164 numbering scheme (alias) must be  
15 digits or less. If a user’s phone number is assigned to the Base Field, the system  
reserves one digit to differentiate between the user’s multiple devices. In this case,  
the total number of digit cannot exceed 14 digits  
The E.164 number generation is only applicable to dynamically-managed  
endpoints.  
510  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
37  
Remote Alert Setup Operations  
This chapter describes how to configure the Polycom® Converged  
Management Application™ (CMA®) system to send alerts to users via E-mail  
for specific types of system and endpoint events. It includes these topics:  
Set Up Remote Alerts  
The CMA system remote alerts functionality is very flexible. It allows you to:  
Assign different severity levels to different classifications of CMA system  
and Endpoint alerts.  
Create different alert profiles so that different types of alerts can be sent to  
different people. So if you have administrators who specialize by device  
type (for example bridges, endpoints, or servers), you can create profiles  
that notify each type of administrator of failures related to those specific  
types of devices.  
To set up remote alerts, you must complete the following tasks:  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Polycom, Inc.  
511  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Set Up CMA System-generated E-mail Account  
To set the CMA system-generated E-mail account  
1
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > E-mail.  
On the E-mail page, enter the E-mail account (ASCII only) from which  
the CMA system will send conference notification E-mails and system  
alerts.  
By default, the CMA system E-mails are sent from the  
[email protected]mE-mail account.  
3
Specify the IP address of the mail server from which the CMA system will  
send conference notification E-mails.  
Notes  
Many E-mail servers will block or discard E-mails without a qualified From:  
address. To avoid this issue, make sure each person with Scheduler  
permissions has a valid E-mail address.  
Many E-mail servers will block or discard E-mails from untrusted domains, in  
which case you may need to change the default CMA system E-mail address to  
one in a trusted domain.  
4
Click Update.  
Enable CMA System Remote Alerts  
To enable Polycom CMA system remote alerts  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Remote Alert Setup.  
On the Remote Alert Setup page, select Enable Remote Alerts.  
Set a Remote Alert quiescent time, which is the amount of time (in  
minutes) the system should wait after alerts have been detected but not  
cleared before starting the alert notification process, and if applicable, the  
remote alert notification process.  
4
Click Update.  
512  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Remote Alert Setup Operations  
Set CMA System Remote Alert Level Settings  
The CMA system monitors and reports events regarding its performance,  
connections, and services. It categorizes alerts into three alert levels: Info,  
Minor, or Major.  
By default the Alert Severity Level is set to Info for all of the CMA Alert  
Types it reports. You have these options:  
You can leave all of the Alert Severity Levels set to Info and create a single  
remote alert profile that allows you to notify all users assigned that profile  
about system events of all types.  
You can change some of the Alert Severity Levels to either Minor or  
Major and create multiple remote alert profiles that notify different users  
of system events of different types and severity levels.  
To set the CMA system remote alert level settings  
1
2
Go to Admin > Alert Settings > CMA Alert Level Settings.  
On the CMA Alert Level Settings page, change the Alert Severity Level  
for the following CMA Alert Type system events, as required.  
Alert Type  
Alert indicates...  
Bridge Down  
A Polycom MCU (RMX or MGC) has failed.  
The connection to the database has been lost.  
Database Connection  
Down  
Enterprise Directory  
Connection Down  
The connection to the enterprise directory server has  
been lost.  
Enterprise Directory  
System Account  
Password Failure  
The connection to the enterprise directory server  
could not be established because the account  
password was incorrect.  
CMA Failover  
Occurred  
(In redundant CMA system configurations only.)  
The system has failed over from one system server  
to the other.  
License Capacity  
Threshold Exceeded  
The number of available seats defined by the  
installed license is within 5% of the total license  
capacity.  
Bridge Time  
Discrepancy  
A difference between the clock on the Polycom MCU  
(RMX or MGC) and the CMA system clock.  
CMA Monitor Service  
Stopped  
(In redundant CMA system configurations only.) The  
CMA system redundancy monitoring service is not  
running.  
Polycom, Inc.  
513  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Alert Type  
Alert indicates...  
Redundant Server  
Down  
(In redundant CMA system configurations only.) The  
connection or synchronization between the primary  
and secondary server has been lost.  
Redundancy Conflict  
(In redundant CMA system configurations only.) Both  
the primary and secondary system servers believe  
they are the active server.  
Site Bandwidth  
Threshold Exceeded  
The site bandwidth threshold, which is set at 90% of  
capacity, has been exceeded.  
Subnet Bandwidth  
Threshold Exceeded  
The subnet bandwidth threshold, which is set at 90%  
of capacity, has been exceeded.  
Site Link Bandwidth  
Threshold Exceeded  
The site link bandwidth threshold, which is set at  
90% of capacity, has been exceeded.  
Active Call Exceeded  
90% of Maximum  
The number of active calls has exceeded 90% of the  
maximum allowed. This value is dependent on the  
call model (routed or direct) and the total number of  
licenses.  
In routed mode, the maximum number of active  
calls is 30% of the total number of licenses.  
In direct mode, the maximum number of active  
calls is 60% of the total number of licenses.  
Active Call Exceeded  
100% of Maximum  
The number of active calls has exceeded 100% of  
the maximum allowed. This value is dependent on  
the call model (routed or direct) and the total number  
of licenses.  
In routed mode, the maximum number of active  
calls is 30% of the total number of licenses.  
In direct mode, the maximum number of active  
calls is 60% of the total number of licenses.  
E164 Alias  
Assignment Failed  
The CMA system was unable to assign an E.164  
alias to the endpoint.  
Certificate Expiration  
Warning  
The specified certificate will expire in 30 days. If the  
certificate is not renewed within 30 days, the alert  
continues daily.  
Certificate Expired  
Warning  
The specified certificate has expired. The alert  
continues daily until the certificate is renewed or  
removed.  
Database Backup  
Failure  
The database backup has failed.  
Used disk space  
reaches ___% of the  
total disk space  
Disk space threshold, as entered in the text box, has  
been exceeded.  
514  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Remote Alert Setup Operations  
3
Click Update.  
Set Endpoint Alert Level Settings  
Monitored endpoints send events to the CMA system. The CMA system  
categorizes and reports endpoint alerts into three alert levels: Info, Minor, or  
Major.  
By default the Alert Severity Level is set to Info for all of the Endpoint Alert  
Types it reports. You have these options:  
You can leave all of the Alert Severity Levels set to Info and create a  
remote alert profile for each endpoint type being monitored that allows  
you to notify all users assigned that profile about all endpoint events  
applicable to that endpoint type.  
You can change some of the Alert Severity Levels to either Minor or  
Major and create multiple remote alert profiles that notify different users  
of endpoint events of different types and severity levels.  
To set the endpoint alert level settings  
1
2
Go to Admin > Alert Settings > Endpoint Alert Level Settings.  
On the Endpoint Alert Level Settings page, change the Alert Severity  
Level for the different types of endpoint events as required.  
Alert Type  
Alert indicates...  
Remote Control  
Battery Low  
The battery in the endpoint’s remote needs to be  
replaced.  
Credentials  
Required  
The endpoint system requires that the user enter a valid  
username and password.  
Credentials  
Failed  
An attempt to log into the endpoint system failed.  
HTTP Forbidden  
The endpoint must be used in https:mode only.  
Device Not  
Responding  
The endpoint is not responding to the CMA system.  
Heartbeat  
Timeout  
The endpoint did not send a heartbeat to the CMA system  
within the required timeout period.  
Gatekeeper  
Status Unknown  
The CMA system gatekeeper cannot determine the  
connection status of the endpoint.  
Gatekeeper  
Rejected  
The CMA system gatekeeper rejected the endpoint’s  
attempt to register.  
Gatekeeper  
Unregistered  
The endpoint is not registered to the gatekeeper.  
Polycom, Inc.  
515  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Alert Type  
Alert indicates...  
Directory Status  
Unknown  
The CMA system gatekeeper cannot determine the  
directory status of the endpoint.  
Directory Not  
Registered  
The endpoint is not registered to the directory service.  
Presence Status  
Unknown  
The CMA system gatekeeper cannot determine the  
presence status of the endpoint.  
Presence  
The endpoint is not registered to the presence service.  
Unregistered  
User Assistance  
Request  
The endpoint user sent a request for help.  
Management  
URL Not Set  
The CMA system is not one of the management URLs set  
on the endpoint, possibly because the management URL  
list is full.  
Note  
Because endpoint systems do not have an interface to  
manually delete management URLs, if the management  
list is full you must disconnect the endpoint’s network  
cable for two minutes. This should clear up all the mgmt  
server URLs.  
Touch Control  
Disconnected  
The Touch Control device that was connected to the listed  
HDX is no longer connected to the HDX.  
Touch Control  
Software  
The software version of the Touch Control platform is not  
compatible with the Endpoint software version.  
Incompatiblewith  
Endpoint  
SIP URI Not  
Provisioned  
A dynamically-managed endpoint at a site with SIP  
enabled does not have a SIP dial string reservation. The  
endpoint is provisioned without SIP enabled.  
SIP Status  
Unknown  
The SIP server cannot determine the status of the  
endpoint.  
SIP Unregistered The endpoint is not registered with the SIP server.  
3
Click Update.  
Add a Remote Alert Profile  
You can add a remote alert profile to identify which device alerts from which  
devices should be sent as part of a remote alert profile. Note that using a  
combination of setting alerts by device type and by specific types, provide  
additional granularity in managing device alerts.  
516  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Remote Alert Setup Operations  
To add a remote alert profile  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Alert Settings > Remote Alert Profiles.  
On the Remote Alert Profiles page, click Add.  
In the Add Remote Alert Profile dialog box, enter a Name and  
Description for the profile.  
4
5
To activate the profile, select Enable Profile.  
Configure one of the following:  
To have all CMA system alerts sent as part of this profile, select Info,  
Minor, and Major.  
To have a subset of CMA system alerts sent as part of this profile,  
select any combination of Info, Minor, or Major. These selections  
work in conjunction with the CMA system alert level settings you  
chose previously.  
To have no CMA system alerts sent as part of this profile, leave Info,  
Minor, and Major cleared.  
6
To use the device type to identify which devices and device alerts should  
be sent as part of this profile, click Alert by Device Type and configure  
one of the following. For endpoint systems, these selections work in  
conjunction with the endpoint alert level settings you choose previously.  
a
b
c
To have all device alerts for all device types sent as part of this profile,  
in the Device Type Alert Level Mapping page, select Info, Minor, and  
Major for all of the device types.  
To have a subset of device alerts for all device types sent as part of this  
profile, in the Device Type Alert Level Mapping page, select any  
combination of Info, Minor, or Major for each device type.  
To have all device alerts for a subset of device types sent as part of this  
profile, in the Device Type Alert Level Mapping page, select Info,  
Minor, or Major for each device type to be included in the profile.  
Alerts for those device types that do not have an alert level selected  
will not be included.  
7
To use the device name to identify which devices and device alerts  
should be sent as part of this profile, click Alert by Device.  
Notes  
If you set device alerts for specific devices, these settings override settings  
made on the Alert by Device Type page. The settings are not cumulative.  
You cannot set the system up to send device alerts for specific desktop video  
endpoints. Polycom CMA Desktop and Polycom PVX endpoints are not  
displayed in the Available Device list.  
a
As needed, use the Filter to customize the device list.  
Polycom, Inc.  
517  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
b
c
In the Available Devices list, select the devices to add to the profile.  
Use CTRL to select multiple devices.  
Click the down arrow to add the devices to the Monitored Devices list  
and configure one of the following:  
»
»
»
To have all device alerts for all selected devices sent as part of this  
profile, for the devices in the Monitored Devices list, select Info,  
Minor, and Major for each device.  
To have a subset of device alerts for all selected devices sent as  
part of this profile, for the devices in the Monitored Devices list,  
select any combination of Info, Minor, or Major for each device.  
To have all device alerts for a subset of device types sent as part of  
this profile, for the devices in the Monitored Devices list, select  
Info, Minor, and Major for each device to be included in the  
profile. Alerts for those devices in the Monitored Devices list that  
do not have an alert level selected will not be included.  
8
Click OK.  
Associate a Remote Alert Profile With a User  
To associate a remote alert profile with a user  
Go to User > Users.  
To search for a user:  
In the Search field of the Users page, search for the user of interest.  
1
2
a
Note  
Searches for a user on the CMA system Users page are case-insensitive, prefix  
searches of the Username, First Name, and Last Name fields.  
b
To search both local and enterprise users, clear the Local Users Only  
check box and press Enter.  
The first 500 users in the database that match your search criteria are  
displayed in the Users list.  
c
If the list is too large to scan, further refine your search string.  
3
4
5
6
Select the user of interest and click Edit User.  
In the Edit User dialog box, click Associated Alert Profile.  
Select the Remote Alert Profile to associate with the user.  
Click OK.  
518  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Remote Alert Setup Operations  
Edit a Remote Alert Profile  
To edit a Remote Alert Profile  
1
2
Go to Admin > Alert Settings > Remote Alert Profiles.  
On the Remote Alert Profiles page, select the profile of interest and click  
Edit Remote Alert Profile.  
3
4
As required, edit the General Info, Alert by Device Type, and Alert by  
Device sections of the Edit Remote Alert Profile dialog box.  
Click OK.  
Disable a Remote Alert Profile  
To disable a Remote Alert Profile  
1
2
Go to Admin > Alert Settings > Remote Alert Profiles.  
On the Remote Alert Profiles page, select the profile of interest and click  
Edit Remote Alert Profile.  
3
4
Clear Enable Profile.  
Click Update.  
Delete a Remote Alert Profile  
To delete a Remote Alert Profile  
1
2
Go to Admin > Alert Settings > Remote Alert Profiles.  
On the Remote Alert Profiles page, select the profile of interest and click  
Delete Remote Alert Profile.  
3
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.  
The profile is deleted from the CMA system.  
Polycom, Inc.  
519  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Disable CMA System Remote Alerts  
To disable all (system and device) CMA System remote alerts  
1
2
3
Go to Admin > System Settings > Remote Alert Setup.  
On the Remote Alert Setup page, clear Enable Remote Alerts.  
Click Update.  
520  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
38  
System Management and  
Maintenance  
This chapter describes the following Polycom® Converged Management  
Application™ (CMA®) system operations topics:  
Management and Maintenance Overview  
The CMA system requires relatively little ongoing maintenance beyond  
monitoring the status of the system and downloading backups you want to  
archive. All system management and maintenance tasks can be performed in  
the management interface. See the appropriate topic for your user role:  
Administrator Responsibilities  
As a CMA system administrator, you’re responsible for the installation,  
configuration, and ongoing maintenance of the system. You should be familiar  
with the following tasks and operations:  
Installing licenses when the system is first installed and when additional  
Monitoring system health and performing the recommended regular  
Using the system tools provided to aid with system and network  
diagnostics, monitoring, and troubleshooting. See “System  
Troubleshooting” on page 529. Should the need arise, Polycom Global  
Services personnel may ask you to use these tools.  
Polycom, Inc.  
521  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Upgrading the system when upgrades/patches are made available. See  
Administrative Best Practices  
The following are some of our recommendations for administrative best  
practices:  
Perform the recommended regular maintenance.  
Except in emergencies or when instructed to by Polycom Global Services  
personnel, don’t reconfigure, install an upgrade, or restore a backup when  
there are active conferences on the system. Many of these operations will  
require a system restart to complete, which will result in conferences being  
dropped.  
Before you reconfigure, install an upgrade, or restore a backup, manually  
create a new backup of the system settings. Then download and archive  
this backup in the event that something unforeseen occurs and it becomes  
necessary to restore the system to a known good state.  
For proper name resolution and smooth network operations, configure at  
least one DNS server in your network configuration, and preferably two  
or more. This allows the CMA system to function properly in the event of  
a single external DNS failure.  
Configure at least one NTP server in your time configuration and  
preferably two or more. Proper time management helps ensure that your  
cluster operates efficiently and helps in diagnosing any issues that may  
arise in the future. Proper system time is also essential for accurate audit  
and CDR data.  
Auditor Responsibilities  
As a CMA system auditor, you’re responsible for managing the system’s  
logging and history retention. You should be familiar with the following  
configurations and operations:  
Configuring logging for the system. These settings affect the number and  
the contents of the log archives available for download from the system.  
Polycom Global Services personnel may ask you to adjust the logging  
configuration and/or download and send them logs.  
Configuring history retention levels for the system. These settings affect  
how much system activity history is retained on the system and available  
for download as CDRs.  
522  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Management and Maintenance  
Auditor Best Practices  
The following are some of our recommendations for auditing best practices:  
Unless otherwise instructed by Polycom Global Services, configure  
logging at the production level with a rolling frequency of every day and  
a retention period of 60 days. If hard drive space becomes an issue,  
decrease the retention period incrementally until the disk space issue is  
resolved.  
Download log archives regularly and back them up securely (preferably  
offsite as well as onsite).  
Export CDRs regularly and back them up securely (preferably offsite as  
well as onsite).  
Recommended Regular Maintenance  
Perform the following tasks to keep your CMA system operating trouble-free  
and at peak efficiency. These tasks can be done quickly and should be run at  
least weekly.  
Create and Archive Backups  
Log into the CMA system, go to Admin > Backup System Settings and Create  
and Download a Backup Archive. For more information, see “Backup the  
General System Health and Capacity Checks  
On the Dashboard verify that there are no alerts indicating problems with any  
part of the system. For more information, see “Polycom CMA System  
Certificates  
Go to Admin > Management and Security > Certificate Management and  
verify that the list of certificates contains the certificates you’ve installed and  
looks as you would expect (an archived screen capture may be helpful for  
comparison).  
Display the details for any certificate you’ve installed and verify they are as  
expected (an archived screen capture may be helpful for comparison). For  
more information, see “Manage Certificates” on page 446.  
CDR export  
If you want to preserve detailed call and conference history data in  
spreadsheet form off the Polycom CMA system, periodically download the  
system’s CDR (call detail record) data to your PC.  
Polycom, Inc.  
523  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
524  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
39  
System Backup and Recovery  
Operations  
This chapter provides an overview of the Polycom® Converged Management  
Application™ (CMA®) backup and recovery procedures.  
The backup and recovery of a CMA system includes backup and recovery of  
the CMA system internal database and the backup of the CMA system  
configuration settings. It includes these topics:  
Backup Internal Databases and System Configuration  
Users assigned the Administrator role have two backup options. They can:  
Generate backups of just the internal CMA database files (.bakformat)  
OR  
Create and download a system backup archive (.zipformat), which  
includes both the internal database backup files and the system settings.  
We recommend creating and downloading a system archive weekly. This  
archive makes system restoration much simpler.  
Polycom, Inc.  
525  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Backup the CMA System Internal Databases  
This topic describes how to create a backup of the CMA system internal  
database files. These database backup files cannot be used to restore the  
internal databases to a CMA system. These files can be used for  
troubleshooting or to migrate the system to an external database system.  
To backup the CMA system internal databases only  
1
From the CMA system web interface, go to Admin > Backup System  
Settings.  
2
When the Backup System Settings page appears, click Generate  
Database Backup Files.  
A dialog box appears indicating that the database backup has been  
initiated and the operation will take some time.  
3
To view the list of backup files including those generated in step 2, go to  
Admin > Database Backup Files.  
The Database Backup Files list appears showing all of the backup files  
stored on the CMA system. Files with a timestamp included in the name  
are system-generated backup files. Files without a timestamp are user  
forced backups.  
4
5
To save the downloaded backup files only, select the backup files of  
interest and click Save.  
In the File Download dialog box, click Save, browse to a location on your  
system, and click Save.  
Backup the CMA System Settings  
This topic describes how to create a backup archive of a CMA system,  
including system configuration settings and internal database files. Once the  
backup archive is downloaded, it can be used to restore the system to its last  
archived configuration after a disastrous system failure.  
To backup the CMA system settings  
1
2
3
From the CMA system web interface, go to Admin > Backup System  
Settings.  
When the Backup System Settings page appears, click Create and  
Download a Backup Archive.  
In the Select location for download dialog box, enter a unique File name,  
browse to a location on your system and click Save.  
A File Download dialog box displays the progress of the download  
operation.  
526  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
System Backup and Recovery Operations  
4
5
When the operation is completed, click OK.  
Browse to the location specified in step 3 and verify the file download.  
Restore Database and System Configuration  
A user assigned the Administrator role can restore a CMA system using a  
backup archive. To restore an CMA system, follow the procedures in this  
topic.  
To restore a system from a backup archive  
1
2
Perform First Time Setup. For more information about First Time Setup,  
see the Polycom CMA System Getting Started Guide for this release.  
3
configuration. The archived configuration will overwrite the  
configuration that resulted from First Time Setup. The only CMA system  
configuration settings not included in the archive and thus not  
overwritten are the network settings and the security certificates required  
for an operational system.  
In cases when the CMA system is functional, but the configuration or database  
is corrupted, the backup archive can also be used to return a CMA system back  
to its last known good archive. As long as the network settings and security  
certificates are operational, the last known good archive will return the CMA  
system to its former functional state.  
Restore to Factory Default Image  
In a disaster recovery situation, your Polycom Global Services (PGS) support  
representative may be required to restore your CMA system to its factory  
default image.  
To perform this disaster recovery procedure, you will need the Restore to  
Factory Default DVD that shipped with the CMA system server. This DVD  
has the base image of the CMA system server software.  
WARNING  
This is a last resort, so never do this without being instructed to do so by PGS  
support.  
This process will wipe out your system database and all other system data.  
The Restore to Factory Default DVD is specific to the CMA system server type  
and version.  
Polycom, Inc.  
527  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Restore from a Backup Archive  
A user with the Administrator role can restore the CMA system using a  
backup archive.  
To restore a backup archive  
1
2
Go to Admin > Backup System Settings.  
In the Select Archive File section of the Backup System Settings page,  
click  
.
3
4
In the Select file to upload dialog box, select the archive file to upload  
and click Open.  
Click Restore from Backup Archive.  
Two warnings appear about the backup process. The second warns that  
the process is irrevocable and may result in an usable system.  
5
Click OK.  
The system uses the archive file to restore the CMA system to the state of  
the backup files.  
When the CMA system is functional, but the configuration or database is  
CMA system to its last known good archive. As long as the network settings  
and security certificates are operational, the last known good archive will  
return the CMA system to its former functional state.  
528  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
40  
System Troubleshooting  
This chapter provides Polycom® Converged Management Application™  
(CMA®) system troubleshooting information. It includes the following topics:  
Troubleshooting Utilities Dashboard  
The CMA system has a Troubleshooting Utilities dashboard that brings  
together on one page access to all of the information you might need to  
diagnose system issues. It includes access to various diagnostic files and  
informational panes.  
The diagnostic files include:  
Traces—Use this option to generate and download a network sniffer trace  
that can help you examine the traffic to and from the CMA system.  
Windows Event Logs—Use this option to generate and download a  
WindowsEventLogs.zipfile that includes the Application, Security, and  
System logs. These logs store events logged by applications, events  
related to logon and resource use, and events logged by Windows system  
components respectively. For more information about these event logs,  
CMA System Logs—Use this option to generate and download a  
GetAllLogs.zipfile that includes all of the CMA system log files. For  
more information about these system logs, see “View and Export System  
Polycom, Inc.  
529  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
CMA System Report—Use this option to generate and download a  
SystemInfo.txtfile that describes the system configuration. For more  
information about this report, see “CMA System Report” on page 303.  
Database Backup—Use this option to initiate a backup of selected CMA  
internal databases.  
Test Network Connection—Use this option to perform a Traceroute or  
Ping operation. Traceroute allows you to investigate the route path and  
transit times of packets as they travel across an IP network. Ping allows  
you to test the availability of a host on an IP network..  
Synchronize Certificate Stores—Use this option to reset all certificate  
stores with the currently uploaded certificates and certificate revocation  
lists (CRLs).  
The information panes include:  
Systems—Displays summary information about the devices registered  
with the CMA system. For more information, see “Systems” on page 315.  
CMA Configuration—Displays information about the configuration of  
the CMA system. For more information, see “CMA Configuration” on  
CMA Info—Displays general information about the CMA system. For  
more information, see “CMA Info” on page 310.  
CMA Licenses—Displays information about how the CMA system is  
licensed. For more information, see “CMA Licenses” on page 313.  
Gatekeepers—Displays information about the CMA system as a  
gatekeeper. For more information, see “Gatekeepers” on page 312.  
Users Logged In—Displays the type and number of users that are  
currently logged into the system. For more information, see “Users  
Services—Displays information about the CMA system services. For more  
530  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Troubleshooting  
Troubleshooting Specific Types of Issues  
This section describes information on troubleshooting specific types of issues  
on the CMA system. It includes these topics:  
Registration Problems and Solutions  
Problem  
Description  
Solutions  
Unable to place calls to an  
MCU conference room from  
a registered Polycom HDX  
system  
The CMA system rejects the ARQ  
stating that the "endpoint is not  
registered" to the gatekeeper even  
though the system indicates it is  
registered.  
The MCU is not registered to the  
gatekeeper  
When the gatekeeper  
registration is set to auto-  
discovery, endpoints do not  
register.  
When auto-discovery is used, a  
GRQ message is broadcast and  
sent over multicast. However, the  
CMA system must be able to  
receive one of these messages, and  
does not respond to this message if  
it is not the default gatekeeper.  
Verify that the Default Gatekeeper  
check box is selected in the Admin >  
Gatekeeper Settings > Primary  
Gatekeeper page.  
Verify that a UDP broadcast from the  
endpoint’s network can reach the CMA  
system, or that multicast is enabled on  
all routers between the endpoint and  
the CMA system.  
An endpoint cannot register  
with the CMA system.  
The endpoint is configured to use  
the CMA system as its gatekeeper,  
but is being rejected during  
registration.  
Review the gatekeeper diagnostic logs  
for the RRQ attempt by the endpoint  
and determine the RRJ reason.  
Verify that the endpoint alias is not a  
duplicate of other endpoint aliases.  
In the gatekeeper diagnostic log, an  
error has occurred during the  
RRQ/RCF process that caused the  
registration to fail.  
Verify that the endpoint does not have  
NAT enabled.  
Verify that enough licenses remain.  
An endpoint cannot register  
with the CMA system.  
An endpoint cannot register with  
CMA, but the gatekeeper  
diagnostics do not indicate a  
problem.  
Verify that the IP address that the  
gatekeeper sent to the endpoint is  
correct.  
The gatekeeper sent the RCF  
message, but the endpoint did not  
receive it.  
Polycom, Inc.  
531  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Problem  
Description  
Solutions  
The MCU cannot register  
with the CMA system.  
Some MCU vendors register with a  
GRQ message instead of an RRQ  
message.  
Verify that the Default Gatekeeper  
check box is selected in the Admin >  
Gatekeeper Settings > Primary  
Gatekeeper page.  
Some MCU vendors do not retry  
registration after a first attempt has  
failed.  
Reset the MCU or MGC card to force  
registration to occur.  
An endpoint shows that it is  
not registered to the  
gatekeeper in the  
The CMA system receives the RRQ  
message, but not the LWRRQ  
message from the endpoint.  
Reboot the endpoint.  
Gatekeeper Registration  
field in the Device Status.  
The endpoint did not send a  
LWRRQ message within the offline  
timeout period specified in the  
Admin > Gatekeeper Settings >  
Primary Gatekeeper page.  
The RadVision OnLAN  
MCU continually changes  
state: from online to offline  
and offline to online.  
The Radvision OnLAN MCU ignores  
the RCF Time to Live (TTL) field,  
which is filled in with the value that  
the administrator specified in the  
offline timeout field in the Admin >  
Gatekeeper Settings > Primary  
Gatekeeper page.  
Reconfigure the Radvision OnLAN  
MCU to send the registration requests  
in the same time period specified in  
CMA.  
Add the MCU manually.  
Reboot the MCU to force registration to  
occur.  
Some endpoints are not  
assigned ISDN numbers.  
A registered H.323-only system was  
not assigned an ISDN number. The  
system could belong to a network  
that does not have ISDN number  
ranges assigned to it.  
Verify that the endpoint belongs to the  
site that has assigned ISDN number  
ranges. To do so, go to Admin > Dial  
Plan and Sites > Sites and make sure  
the site has the correct ISDN range  
specified in the ISDN Number  
No ISDN numbers are available to  
assign.  
Assignment pane.  
Verify that ISDN numbers are available  
to assign.  
Verify that the RCF message “Can’t find  
ISDN free pool” from the gatekeeper  
returns to the endpoint.  
Endpoints that were  
previously registered and  
auto-assigned ISDN  
numbers are being rejected  
when attempting to register.  
Inconsistent configuration in ISDN  
number assignment has occurred.  
Verify that the previous ISDN range was  
changed.  
When the CMA system is  
restarted, some registrants  
that were previously online  
are now offline.  
Some endpoints do not reregister  
when the CMA system goes down.  
Reboot the MCU.  
Some MCUs do not reregister  
automatically after two retries.  
532  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Troubleshooting  
Point-to-Point Calling Problems and Solutions  
Problem  
Description  
Solutions  
ViewStation and ViaVideo  
have an incorrect RAS IP  
address.  
These endpoints are configured with  
a NAT address and may not receive  
the RCF message from the  
gatekeeper.  
The endpoints need to be reconfigured to  
disable NAT.  
A call with an alias as the  
dial string from a registered  
endpoint cannot be placed  
to another registered  
endpoint. The two endpoints  
are in different sites.  
The site link between the sites  
in which the endpoints reside is  
not correctly defined or is  
missing.  
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites >  
Site Links and make sure that a site  
link exists between the two networks.  
Make sure that the IP addresses of  
both endpoints are included in their  
respective sites.  
No bandwidth is available to the  
site link.  
The calling bit rate is higher  
than the bit rate defined in the  
site link.  
If site topology is defined for both  
endpoints, verify that there is enough  
bandwidth in the site links between the  
two sites.  
ISDN alternate routing is not  
available.  
Verify that the dialing bit rate is lower or  
equal to that of the maximum bit rate  
defined for the site links.  
Dialing rules may not be  
enabled or may be set to block  
instead of route.  
If the endpoint is ISDN capable, verify  
that the ISDN parameter is correct.  
Dialing by IP address fails.  
A registered endpoint cannot call an  
unregistered endpoint by IP address  
within the same site.  
Check the Reports > Gatekeeper  
Message Log for error messages.  
Verify that the registered endpoint is  
registered.  
A dialing rule is not enabled or is set  
to block instead of route.  
Verify that the Deny calls to/from  
unregistered endpoints check box is  
cleared. Go to Admin > Gatekeeper  
Settings > Primary Gatekeeper to  
change this setting.  
Verify that the IP address dialing rule is  
enabled and set to route.  
Polycom, Inc.  
533  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
MCU and Gateway Dialing Problems and Solutions  
Problem  
Description  
Solutions  
Call fails when using an  
MCU service.  
The call using the MCU service is  
rejected because of one of the  
following:  
Check the Reports > Gatekeeper  
Message Log for error messages  
indicating why the call failed.  
Dialing an MCU service  
results in a network error.  
The MCU is not registered.  
The MCU is offline.  
Verify that the MCU is registered.  
Verify that the MCU is online. If the  
device is offline, reboot it.  
The MCU prefix is not  
registered as an E.164 alias.  
Verify that the MCU service is  
available. Go to the Admin > Dial Plan  
and Sites > Services page. Verify that  
the MCU service prefix is enabled and  
listed.  
The MCU resource issue was  
sent through resource  
allocation indication or resource  
allocation.  
The dialing rule is not enabled.  
The priority of the dialing rule  
may be too high.  
Services are not enabled.  
Simplified dialing does not  
work.  
The call using the simplified dialing  
service is rejected because of one  
of the following:  
Check the Reports > Gatekeeper  
Message Log for error messages.  
When you dial 9, you  
receive a network error.  
Verify that the gateway and simplified  
dialing service prefix is enabled. Go to  
Admin > Dial Plan and Sites >  
Services.  
The simplified dialing prefix  
service in the system  
configuration is disabled.  
No gateway services are  
available.  
Verify that the gateway is registered.  
There is insufficient BRI/PRI  
bandwidth.  
The call uses a higher bit rate  
than the device policy group  
allows.  
534  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System Troubleshooting  
Conference On Demand Problems and Solutions  
Problem  
Description  
Solutions  
Dialing a Conference On Demand  
fails.  
The endpoint dials a CON service,  
and the call is rejected because of  
one of the following:  
Check the diagnostics log for an  
ARJ reason from this endpoint.  
Inviting other endpoints into a  
conference using the CON service  
fails.  
Verify that the MCU is  
registered with the CMA system  
and is online.  
The MCU is not registered or is  
offline.  
The CMA system cannot log  
into the MGC.  
Verify that the MCU registered  
with the CMA system has the  
MCU’s IP address filled out in  
the Devices list.  
The MGC has no resource  
available for the call.  
Verify that the MCU login ID and  
password for the CON service  
are correct.  
The MGC’s IP address is not  
entered in the CMA system.  
Verify that the H.323 network  
service that the MCU is using is  
set as the default service.  
Verify that the MCU has enough  
available resources to start this  
conference.  
Verify that the CON service is  
enabled. Go to Admin > Dial  
Plan and Sites > Services.  
Gatekeeper Cause Codes  
Cause  
Code  
150  
151  
152  
153  
154  
155  
156  
157  
158  
159  
160  
Description  
The gatekeeper is out of resources  
The gatekeeper has insufficient resources  
The gatekeeper registration version is invalid  
The call signal address is invalid  
The registering device’s address is invalid  
The registering device’s terminal type is invalid  
The registering device’s permissions are invalid  
The conference ID is invalid  
The registering device’s ID is invalid  
The caller’s device is not registered  
The called party’s device is not registered  
Polycom, Inc.  
535  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Cause  
Code  
161  
162  
163  
164  
165  
166  
167  
168  
169  
170  
171  
172  
173  
174  
175  
176  
177  
178  
179  
180  
181  
182  
183  
203  
208  
221  
222  
Description  
The registering device’s permissions have expired  
The registering device has a duplicate alias  
The call transport is not supported  
The called device has a call in progress  
The call has been routed to the gatekeeper  
Cannot request a drop for others  
The registering device is not registered with the gatekeeper  
Unknown reason  
Permission failure  
Discovery permissions have expired  
The device is not registered  
No bandwidth available  
Location not found  
Security access denied  
Quality of service not supported  
Resources are exhausted  
Invalid alias  
Cannot unregister others  
Quality of service control is not supported  
Incomplete address  
Registration permissions have expired  
Call routed to SCN  
Inconsistent alias  
Call rejected at destination  
Incorrect address  
The far end is busy  
The far end is not responding  
536  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A
System Security and Port Usage  
This section provides an overview of the port usage and security required by  
the Polycom® Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system and  
includes a comprehensive list of services and clients on the system that are  
required for normal operation. It includes these topics:  
Open Inbound Ports on the Polycom CMA System  
The following table lists the open inbound ports on the CMA system and  
provides a description of their use.  
Port  
Description  
TCP 80  
HTTP web server, through which the web application displays  
and where Polycom endpoints post status messages  
TCP/UDP 161  
TCP 389  
SNMP listener  
Directory services (LDAP)  
HTTPS web server listener  
TCP 443  
TCP 700  
(Polycom proprietary service) Service monitor for redundant  
Polycom CMA servers  
TCP/UDP 1718  
TCP/UDP 1719  
TCP/UDP 1720  
TCP 3601  
H.323 gatekeeper listener--gatekeeper discovery  
H.323 gatekeeper listener--gatekeeper statistics  
H.323 gatekeeper listener--host call  
(Polycom proprietary service) Global Address Book listener  
with which endpoints register  
TCP 3389  
TCP 5222  
Remote desktop  
Presence service (XMPP)  
Polycom, Inc.  
537  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
Port  
Description  
TCP 4449  
(Polycom proprietary service) OpenDS (Data store for site  
topology) admin port  
TCP 8989  
(Polycom proprietary service) OpenDS (Data store for site  
topology) replication port  
Note  
Third-party port-scanning software may incorrectly identify the Polycom proprietary  
services as IANA-registered services, since identification is made by port number  
only and not by the actual protocol being transmitted:  
Outbound Ports Used by the Polycom CMA System  
The following table lists all outbound ports that the CMA system uses to  
communicate with other systems, including endpoints, bridges, database  
servers, and other network equipment.  
As a standard H.323 gatekeeper, the CMA system uses ports 1024-65535 for  
dynamic TCP and UDP traffic.  
Port  
Description  
TCP 20  
Used to FTP data to endpoints.  
TCP 21  
TCP/UDP 24  
TCP/UDP 25  
TCP/UDP 53  
TCP 80  
Used to access the telnet interfaces on endpoints.  
Used to send E-mail messages to SMTP servers.  
Used to access domain name servers (DNS).  
Used to access the web application on endpoints and MGCs,  
version 7.x and higher.  
TCP 135  
TCP 137  
TCP 139  
Active Directory (AD) Single Signon (NetBios/NTLM).  
TCP/UDP 389  
TCP 443  
Used to access directory (LDAP) services  
Secure access to endpoint devices (SSL) including Polycom  
CMA Desktop.  
TCP 445  
AD Single Signon  
TCP/UDP 636  
TCP 1205  
Used to access LDAP over TLS/SSL (LDAPS)  
Used to access MGCs for management and monitoring  
538  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System Security and Port Usage  
Port  
Description  
TCP/UDP 1719  
TCP/UDP 1720  
TCP/UDP 3268  
Used by the gatekeeper for H.323 RAS messages  
Used by the gatekeeper for Q.931 signaling  
Used to access the Microsoft Active Directory Global Catalog  
using StartTLS.  
TCP/UDP 3269  
TCP/UDP 3603  
Used to access the Microsoft Active Directory Global Catalog  
using LDAP-S.  
Used for HTTP communication with the Polycom PVX client  
Used to access MGCs for management and monitoring  
TCP 5001  
TCP 1205  
Polycom, Inc.  
539  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide  
540  
Polycom, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Peavey Musical Instrument Amplifier TransChorus 210 User Manual
Peg Perego Car Seat Base Fissa User Manual
Philips Flat Panel Television BDL6520 User Manual
Philips Stereo System MX5500D User Manual
Philips Surge Protector SPP2303WC User Manual
Philips TV VCR Combo 14PV404 User Manual
Pioneer Portable DVD Player AVH X6500DVD User Manual
Pioneer Speaker DEH P580MP User Manual
Pioneer Stereo Receiver VSX D712 User Manual
Prolific Tech Cooktop EFG 502 User Manual